WEB EDITION OWNER'S MANUAL DEAR VOLVO OWNER THANK YOU FOR CHOOSING VOLVO We hope you will enjoy many years of driving pleasure in your Volvo. The car has been designed for the safety and comfort of you and your passengers. Volvo is one of the safest cars in the world. Your Volvo has also been designed to satisfy all current safety and environmental requirements. In order to increase your enjoyment of the car, we recommend that you familiarise yourself with the equipment, instructions and maintenance information contained in this owner's manual. Table of contents 01 Introduction Reading the owner's manual.................... Recording data......................................... Accessories and extra equipment............ Change of ownership for cars with Volvo On Call*..................................................... Information on the Internet....................... Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy..... The owner's manual and the environment.......................................................... Laminated glass........................................ 02 Safety 15 17 18 General information on seatbelts.............. Seatbelt - putting on................................. Seat belt - loosening................................. Seatbelt - pregnancy................................ Seatbelt reminder...................................... Seatbelt tensioner..................................... Safety - warning symbol........................... Airbag system........................................... Airbags on driver's side............................ Passenger airbag...................................... Passenger airbag - activating/deactivating*............................................................ Side airbag (SIPS)..................................... Side airbag (SIPS) - child seat/booster cushion..................................................... Inflatable Curtain (IC)................................ General information on WHIPS (whiplash protection)................................................. WHIPS - child seats.................................. WHIPS - seating position.......................... When the systems deploy......................... General information on safety mode......... Safety mode - attempting to start the car............................................................. Safety mode - moving the car.................. 24 25 26 26 27 27 28 29 30 30 Pedestrian airbag*..................................... Pedestrian airbag - moving the car........... Pedestrian airbag - folding up.................. General information on child safety.......... Child seats................................................ Child seats - location................................ Child seat - ISOFIX................................... ISOFIX - size classes................................ ISOFIX - types of child seat...................... Child seats - upper mounting points........ 01 02 02 2 18 19 20 22 22 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 31 33 34 34 35 36 36 37 38 39 40 40 41 42 42 44 48 48 49 50 52 Table of contents 03 Instruments and controls Instruments and controls, left-hand drive car - overview........................................... Instruments and controls, right-hand drive car - overview................................... Combined instrument panel...................... Analogue combined instrument panel overview.................................................... Digital combined instrument panel overview.................................................... Eco guide & Power guide*........................ Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols...................................... Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols................................... Outside temperature gauge...................... Trip meter.................................................. Clock......................................................... Volvo Sensus............................................ Key positions............................................ Key positions - functions at different levels.............................................................. Seats, front................................................ Seats, front - electrically operated............ Key memory in remote control key........... Seats, rear................................................. 54 57 60 Steering wheel.......................................... 77 Light switches........................................... 78 Position/parking lamps............................. 80 Daytime running lights.............................. 81 Tunnel detection*...................................... 82 Main/dipped beam.................................... 82 Active high beam*..................................... 83 Active Xenon headlamps*......................... 84 Rear fog lamp........................................... 85 Brake lights............................................... 86 Hazard warning flashers........................... 86 Direction indicators................................... 87 Interior lighting.......................................... 87 Home safe light duration........................... 89 Approach light duration............................ 89 Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern............................................................ 90 Wipers and washing.................................. 93 Power windows......................................... 95 Door mirrors.............................................. 97 Windows and rearview and door mirrors - heating.................................................... 98 Rearview mirror - interior.......................... 99 Glass roof*.............................................. 100 Compass................................................. Menu navigation - combined instrument panel....................................................... Menu overview - analogue combined instrument panel..................................... Menu overview - digital combined instrument panel.............................................. Messages................................................ Messages - handling............................... MY CAR.................................................. MY CAR - operation................................ MY CAR - search paths.......................... MY CAR - menu options......................... MY CAR - Car settings........................... MY CAR - driving support system.......... MY CAR - System options...................... MY CAR - Voice settings........................ MY CAR - Climate settings..................... MY CAR Information............................... Trip computer......................................... Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel..................................... Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel.............................................. Trip computer - functions....................... 03 03 03 60 61 64 65 66 68 68 69 70 71 71 73 74 75 76 100 101 102 102 103 104 104 104 105 106 108 109 111 112 113 114 114 115 119 123 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 3 Table of contents 04 Climate control Trip computer - trip statistics*................ 124 General information on climate control... 126 Actual temperature................................. 126 Sensors - climate control........................ 127 Air cleaning............................................. 127 Air cleaning - passenger compartment filter............................................................ 127 Air cleaning - Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)*.............................................. 128 Air cleaning - IAQS*................................ 128 Air cleaning - material............................. 129 Menu settings - climate control.............. 129 Air distribution in the passenger compartment.................................................. 129 Electronic climate control - ECC*........... 131 Electronic temperature control - ETC..... 132 Heated front seats*................................. 133 Heated rear seat*.................................... 133 Fan.......................................................... 134 Auto-regulation....................................... 134 Temperature control in the passenger compartment.......................................... 135 Air conditioning....................................... 135 Demisting and defrosting the windscreen..................................................... 136 Air distribution - recirculation.................. 137 Air distribution - table............................. 138 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*..................................... 140 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - direct start/immediate stop......................................................... 141 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer.......................... 141 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - messages................. 142 Additional heater*.................................... 143 Fuel-driven additional heater*................. 143 Electric additional heater*....................... 144 03 04 04 4 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Table of contents 05 Loading and storage Storage spaces....................................... Storage compartment driver’s side........ Jacket holder.......................................... Tunnel console........................................ Tunnel console - armrest........................ Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ashtray*................................................... Glovebox................................................. Glovebox - cooling.................................. Inlay mats*.............................................. Vanity mirror............................................ Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets............... Loading................................................... Loading - long load................................. Roof load................................................. Load retaining eyelets............................. Loading - bag holder ............................. Loading - folding bag holder*................. 12 V socket - cargo area......................... Cargo net................................................ Hat shelf.................................................. 06 Locks and alarm 146 148 148 148 149 Remote control key with key blade......... Remote control key/PCC - losing .......... Remote control key/PCC - key memory* Indication locking/unlocking - adjusting. Lock indicator......................................... Remote control key/PCC - Electronic immobiliser.............................................. Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking system....................................... Remote control key - function................ Remote control key - range.................... PCC* - unique functions......................... PCC* - range........................................... Detachable key blade............................. Detachable key blade - detaching/ attaching................................................. Detachable key blade - unlocking doors Remote control key/PCC - replacing the battery..................................................... Keyless*.................................................. Keyless* - remote control key range....... Keyless* - Secure handling of the remote control key.............................................. Keyless* - interference to remote control key function............................................. 159 159 160 160 161 Keyless* - locking................................... Keyless* - unlocking............................... Keyless* - unlocking with the key blade Keyless* - key memory........................... Keyless* - lock settings........................... Keyless* - antenna location.................... Locking/unlocking - from the outside .... Manual locking of the door..................... Locking/unlocking - from the inside....... Total airing function................................ Locking/unlocking - glovebox................. Locking/unlocking - tailgate.................... Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap........... Deadlocks*.............................................. Child safety locks - manual activation.... Child safety locks - electrical activation* Alarm....................................................... Alarm indicator........................................ Alarm - automatic re-arming................... Alarm - automatic arming....................... Alarm - remote control key not working. Alarm signals........................................... Reduced alarm level............................... 05 06 06 149 149 150 150 150 151 152 153 153 153 154 154 155 155 157 161 162 162 163 164 165 165 166 166 167 168 169 169 170 170 171 171 172 172 173 173 174 175 176 176 176 178 178 179 180 181 182 182 182 183 183 183 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 5 Table of contents 07 Driver support Stability and traction control system (DSTC)..................................................... Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - operation.................................. Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - symbols and messages........... Road Sign Information (RSI)................... Road sign information (RSI)* - operation Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations Speed limiter*.......................................... Speed limiter* - getting started............... Speed limiter* - changing speed............. Speed limiter - temporary deactivation and standby mode*................................. Speed limiter* - alarm for speed exceeded.......................................................... Speed limiter* - deactivation................... Cruise control*........................................ Cruise control* - managing speed.......... Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode.................................. Cruise control* - resume set speed........ Cruise control* - deactivate.................... Adaptive cruise control (ACC)*............... Adaptive cruise control* - function......... 185 186 Adaptive cruise control* - overview........ Adaptive cruise control* - managing speed...................................................... Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval............................................................ Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode............ Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking another vehicle........................................ Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate...... Adaptive Cruise Control* - Queue Assist Adaptive cruise control* - switch cruise control functionality................................ Radar sensor........................................... Radar sensor - limitations....................... Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and action............................................... Adaptive cruise control* - symbols and messages................................................ Distance Warning*.................................. Distance Alert* - limitations..................... Distance Alert* - symbols and messages City Safety™........................................... City Safety™ - function........................... City Safety™ - operation........................ 202 203 204 City Safety™ - limitations....................... 219 City Safety™ - laser sensor.................... 220 City Safety™ - symbols and messages.. 222 Collision warning system*....................... 223 Collision warning system* - function...... 224 Collision warning system* - cyclist detection.......................................................... 225 Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians............................................. 227 Collision warning system* - operation.... 228 Collision warning system* - general limitations..................................................... 229 Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations.......................................... 231 Collision warning system* - symbols and message.................................................. 233 Driver Alert System*................................ 235 Driver Alert Control (DAC)*...................... 235 Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation... 236 Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols and messages................................................ 237 Lane Keeping Aid*.................................. 239 Lane keeping assistant - function........... 239 Lane keeping assistant - operation......... 241 Lane keeping assistant - limitations....... 241 07 07 07 6 187 188 188 190 191 191 192 193 194 194 194 195 197 198 199 199 200 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 204 205 206 206 208 209 209 211 212 214 215 216 217 217 218 Table of contents 08 Starting and driving Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages................................................ Park assist syst*...................................... Park assist syst* - function..................... Park assist syst* - backward.................. Park assist syst* - forward...................... Park assist syst* - fault indication........... Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors. Park assist camera.................................. Park assist camera - settings................. Park assist camera - limitations.............. Park Assist Pilot (PAP)*........................... Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function.......... Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation........ Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations....... Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols and messages................................................ BLIS (Blind Spot Information System).... BLIS - operation...................................... CTA (Cross Traffic Alert)*........................ BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages Speed related power steering................. 243 245 245 247 247 248 248 249 252 252 253 253 254 256 Alcolock*................................................. Alcolock* - functions and operation........ Alcolock* - storage.................................. Alcolock* - before starting the engine.... Alcolock* - to bear in mind..................... Alcolock* - symbols and messages........ Starting the engine.................................. Switching off the engine......................... Steering lock........................................... Jump starting.......................................... Gearboxes............................................... Manual gearbox...................................... Gear shift indicator*................................ Automatic gearbox - Geartronic*............ Automatic gearbox - Powershift*............ Gear selector inhibitor............................. Hill start assist (HSA)*............................. Start/Stop*.............................................. Start/Stop* - function and operation....... Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop... Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts........ Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart......................................................... 264 264 265 265 266 268 268 270 270 270 271 272 272 273 276 278 279 279 280 281 282 Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox............................. Start/Stop* - settings.............................. Start/Stop* - symbols and messages..... All Wheel Drive (AWD)*............................ Hill Descent Control (HDC)..................... Foot brake............................................... Foot brake - anti-lock braking system.... Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers......... Foot brake - emergency brake assistance....................................................... Parking brake.......................................... Driving in water....................................... Overheating............................................. Driving with open tailgate....................... Overload - starter battery........................ Before a long journey.............................. Winter driving.......................................... Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing............. Fuel filler flap - manual opening.............. Filling up with fuel................................... Fuel - handling........................................ Fuel - petrol............................................. 284 284 286 288 288 289 291 07 08 08 257 257 258 260 262 262 283 291 291 292 293 293 294 294 295 295 296 296 296 297 298 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 7 Table of contents 09 Wheels and tyres Fuel - diesel............................................. Filling with fuel - with a fuel can.............. Diesel particle filter (DPF)........................ Economical driving.................................. Driving with a trailer................................ Driving with a trailer - manual gearbox... Driving with a trailer - automatic gearbox Towing bracket....................................... Detachable towbar - storage.................. Detachable towbar - specifications........ Detachable towbar - attachment/ removal................................................... Trailer Stability Assist - TSA.................... Towing.................................................... Towing eye.............................................. Recovery................................................. 298 299 299 300 301 302 302 303 303 304 Tyres - direction of rotation.................... Tyres - maintenance............................... Tyres - tread wear indicators.................. Wheel bolts............................................. Jack........................................................ Winter tyres............................................. Wheel and wheel rim dimensions........... Tyres - dimensions.................................. Tyres - load index................................... Tyres - speed ratings.............................. Spare wheel*........................................... Changing wheels - taking out the spare wheel*..................................................... Changing wheels - removing wheels...... Changing wheels - fitting the spare wheel*..................................................... Tyres - air pressure................................. Warning triangle...................................... First aid kit*............................................. Emergency puncture repair*................... Emergency puncture repair kit* - location.......................................................... Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview......................................................... Emergency puncture repair* - operation. 312 312 314 314 315 315 316 316 316 317 317 Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking........................................................... Inflating tyres with the emergency puncture repair kit*.......................................... Emergency puncture repair* - stowing components............................................ Emergency puncture repair kit* - sealant 08 09 09 8 304 307 308 309 310 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 318 319 320 322 323 324 324 325 326 326 328 329 330 330 Table of contents 10 Maintenance and service Volvo service programme....................... 332 Raising the car........................................ 333 Bonnet - opening and closing................. 335 Engine compartment - overview............. 335 Engine compartment - checking............. 336 Engine oil - general................................. 336 Engine oil - checking and filling.............. 337 Coolant - level......................................... 340 Brake and clutch fluid - level.................. 341 Climate control system - fault tracing and repair....................................................... 341 Lamp replacement.................................. 342 Lamp replacement - location of front lamps...................................................... 343 Lamp replacement - headlamps............. 343 Lamp replacement - cover for main/ dipped beam bulbs................................. 344 Lamp replacement - dipped beam......... 344 Lamp replacement - main beam............. 344 Lamp replacement - extra main beam.... 345 Lamp replacement - direction indicators front......................................................... 345 Lamp replacement - position/parking lamps front.............................................. 345 Lamp replacement - daytime running lights....................................................... Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps...................................................... Lamp replacement - direction indicators rear, brake lights and reversing lamp..... Lamp replacement - rear fog lamp......... Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting........................................................... Lamps - specifications ........................... Wiper blades........................................... Washer fluid - filling................................ Starter battery......................................... Battery - symbols.................................... Starter battery - replacement.................. Battery - Start/Stop................................. Fuses - general....................................... Fuses - in engine compartment.............. Fuses - under glovebox.......................... Fuses - under right front seat................. Car washing............................................ Polishing and waxing.............................. Water and dirt-repellent coating............. Rustproofing........................................... Cleaning the interior................................ 346 Paint damage.......................................... 368 346 10 10 10 346 347 348 348 349 351 351 352 353 353 355 356 359 362 364 365 366 366 367 9 Table of contents 11 Audio and media Audio and media..................................... Audio and media - overview................... Audio and media - operating the system Audio and media - menu navigation....... Favourites............................................... Audio and media - audio settings........... Audio and media - general audio settings........................................................ Audio and media - advanced audio settings........................................................ Setting the equaliser............................... Setting the audio profile.......................... Setting the audio volume and automatic volume control........................................ Radio....................................................... Radio tuning............................................ Automatic radio tuning............................ Radio station list..................................... Manual radio tuning................................ Radio stations as presets....................... RDS functions......................................... Alarms in the event of accidents and disasters...................................................... Traffic information (TP)............................ Enhanced Other Networks (EON)........... 371 372 372 374 376 376 News broadcasts.................................... Radio programme types (PTY)................ Searching radio programme types (PTY) Show radio programme types (PTY)....... Volume control for interrupting radio programme types (PTY)............................... Radio text................................................ Automatic radio frequency update (AF).. Regional radio programmes (REG)......... Scan radio frequencies........................... Resetting RDS functions......................... Digital radio* (DAB)................................. Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) Navigation in channel group list (Ensemble).......................................................... DAB to DAB link...................................... Digital radio* (DAB) - frequencies........... Digital radio* (DAB) - subchannel............ Digital radio* (DAB) - resetting................ Media player........................................... CD/DVD*................................................. Fast forward/reverse............................... Random selection of disc track or audio file........................................................... 384 384 385 385 Playback and navigation of DVD video discs........................................................ 392 Camera angle for playback of DVD video discs........................................................ 393 DivX® Video On Demand........................ Picture settings....................................... Media player - compatible file formats... External audio source via AUX/USB* input........................................................ Connecting an external audio source via AUX/USB* input...................................... Playback and navigation of external audio source........................................... Setting the audio volume for external audio source........................................... 11 11 11 10 377 377 378 378 378 379 379 380 380 381 381 382 383 383 384 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 386 386 386 387 387 387 388 388 389 389 389 390 390 390 391 391 392 393 394 394 395 396 396 398 Media Bluetooth®* ................................. 398 Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device.................................. 399 Registering a Bluetooth®* device............ 400 Automatic connection of Bluetooth®* device...................................................... 401 Changing to another Bluetooth®* device 402 Disconnecting the Bluetooth®* device.... 402 Removing a Bluetooth®* device.............. 403 Bluetooth® handsfree phone................... 403 Table of contents Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview 404 Making and receiving calls...................... 404 Bluetooth® handsfree phone - audio settings........................................................ 405 Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - quick commands....................... Voice guidance* control of a mobile phone - dialling a number....................... Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling from the call register..... Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling a contact....................... Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - calling the voice mailbox........... Save as favourite.................................... Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc......................................................... Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files.............................. Scan disc track or audio file................... TV*........................................................... Searching TV* channels/Preset list......... TV* - channel management..................... Information about the current TV* programme................................................... Teletext*.................................................. Reception of TV* channel is lost............. Remote control*...................................... Remote control* - functions.................... Remote control* - battery replacement.. 417 417 Audio and media - menu overview......... Menu overview - AM............................... Menu overview - FM............................... Menu overview - Digital radio (DAB)*...... Main overview - CD/DVD Data............... Menu overview - CD Audio..................... Menu overview - DVD Video................... Menu overview - iPod............................. Menu overview - USB............................. Menu overview - Media Bluetooth.......... Menu overview - AUX............................. Menu overview - Bluetooth handsfree.... Menu overview - TV................................ 11 11 11 Bluetooth® version information............... Phone book............................................. Phone book - quick search for contacts Phone book - character table keypad in centre console........................................ Phone book - searching for contacts..... Phone book - new contact..................... Phone book - speed dial numbers.......... Phone book - receiving a vCard............. Phone book - memory status................. Phone book - clearing............................. Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone...................................................... Language options for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone....................... Help functions for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone....................... Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - user setting and voice volume... Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands....................... 406 406 407 408 409 410 411 412 412 412 413 414 415 416 416 418 418 418 419 419 420 421 421 423 423 428 428 429 429 430 431 431 432 433 433 434 434 435 424 424 425 425 426 427 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 11 Table of contents 12 Specifications Type designations................................... Dimensions............................................. Weights................................................... Towing capacity and towball load.......... Engine specifications.............................. Engine oil - adverse driving conditions... Engine oil - grade and volume................ Coolant - grade and volume................... Transmission fluid - grade and volume... Brake fluid - grade and volume............... Washer fluid - quality and volume.......... Fuel tank - volume.................................. Air conditioning, fluid - volume and grade....................................................... Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions... Tyres - approved tyre pressures............. Electrical system..................................... Starter battery - specification................. Type approval - remote control key system.......................................................... Type approval - radar system................. 13 Alphabetical Index 438 440 441 442 445 446 447 449 450 451 451 452 Alphabetical Index.................................. 476 12 13 453 454 457 458 459 460 460 Type approval - Bluetooth®.................... 462 Licenses.................................................. 470 Symbols in the display............................ 472 12 Table of contents 13 INTRODUCTION 01 Introduction Reading the owner's manual A good way of getting to know your new car is to read the owner's manual, ideally before your first journey. This will give you the opportunity to familiarise yourself with new functions, to see how best to handle the car in different situations, and to make the best use of all the car's features. Please pay attention to the safety instructions contained in the manual. The specifications, design features and illustrations in this owner's manual are not binding. We reserve the right to make modifications without prior notice. © Volvo Car Corporation Options/accessories All types of option/accessory are marked with an asterisk*. In addition to standard equipment, the owner's manual also describes options (factory fitted equipment) and certain accessories (retrofitted extra equipment). The equipment described in the owner's manual is not available in all cars - they have different equipment depending on adaptations for the needs of different markets and national or local laws and regulations. In the event of uncertainty over what is standard or an option/accessory, contact a Volvo dealer. Special texts 01 Decals The car contains different types of decal which are designed to convey important information in a simple and clear manner. The decals in the car have the following descending degree of importance for the warning/ information. WARNING Warning texts appear if there is a risk of injury. IMPORTANT Warning for personal injury "Important" texts appear if there is a risk of damage. NOTE NOTE texts give advice or tips that facilitate the use of features and functions for example. Footnote There is footnote information in the owner's manual that is located at the bottom of the page. This information is an addition to the text that it refers to via a number. If the footnote refers to text in a table then letters are used instead of numbers for referral. Message texts Text messages can be shown in the combined instrument panel and the screen. These text messages are highlighted in the owner's manual by means of the text being slightly larger and printed in grey. Examples of this are in menu texts and message texts in the screen (e.g. Audio settings). G031590 Black ISO symbols on yellow warning field, white text/image on black message field. Used to indicate the presence of danger which, if the warning is ignored, may result in serious personal injury or fatality. Risk of property damage }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 15 01 Introduction 01 || When there is a series of illustrations for step-by-step instructions each step is numbered in the same way as the corresponding illustration. There are numbered lists with letters adjacent to the series of illustrations where the order of the instructions is not significant. White ISO symbols and white text/image on black or blue warning field and message field. Used to indicate the presence of danger which, if the warning is ignored, may result in damage to property. Information G031593 G031592 Arrows appear numbered and unnumbered and are used to illustrate a movement. White ISO symbols and white text/image on black message field. NOTE It is not intended that the decals illustrated in the owner's manual should be exact replicas of those in the car. They are included to show their approximate appearance and location in the car. The information that applies to your particular car is available on the respective decals for your car. Procedure lists Procedures where action must be taken in a certain sequence are numbered in the owner's manual. 16 Arrows with letters are used to clarify a movement when the reciprocal order is of no relevance. If there is no series of illustrations for step-bystep instructions then the different steps are numbered with normal numbers. Position lists Red circles containing a number are used in overview images where different components are pointed out. The number recurs in the position list featured in connection with the illustration that describes the item. Bulleted lists A bulleted list is used when there is a list of points in the owner's manual. Example: • • Coolant Engine oil 01 Introduction Images Recording data The manual's images are sometimes schematic and may deviate from the car's appearance depending on equipment level and market. Certain information about the vehicle's operation and functionality, and any incidents, are recorded in the car. Related information Related information refers to other sections containing related information. To be continued }} This symbol is located furthest down to the right when a section continues on the following page. Related information • The owner's manual and the environment (p. 22) • Information on the Internet (p. 19) Your vehicle contains a number of computers whose function is to continuously check and monitor the vehicle's operation and functionality. Some of the computers can record information during normal driving if they detect an error. In addition, information is recorded in the event of a collision or incident. Parts of the recorded information are required so that technicians can diagnose and rectify faults in the vehicle during servicing and maintenance and so that Volvo can fulfil legal requirements and other regulations. In addition to this, the information is used for research purposes by Volvo in order to continually develop quality and safety, as the information can contribute to a better understanding of the factors that cause accidents and injuries. The information includes details of the status and functionality of various systems and modules in the vehicle with regard to engine, throttle, steering and brake systems, amongst other things. This information may include details regarding the way the driver drives the vehicle, such as vehicle speed, brake and accelerator pedal use, steering wheel movement and whether or not the driver and passengers have used their seatbelts. For the reasons given this information may be stored in the vehicle's computers for a certain length of time, but also as a result of a collision or incident. This information may be stored by Volvo as long as it can help to further develop and further enhance safety and quality and as long as there are legal requirements and other regulations that Volvo needs to consider. 01 Volvo will not contribute to the above-described information being disclosed to third parties without the vehicle owner's consent. However, due to national legislation and regulations Volvo may be required to disclose such information to authorities such as police authorities, or others who may assert a legal right to have access to it. To be able to read and interpret the information recorded by the computers in the vehicle requires special technical equipment that Volvo, and workshops that have entered into agreements with Volvo, have access to. Volvo is responsible that the information, which is transferred to Volvo during servicing and maintenance, is stored and handled in a secure manner and that the handling complies with applicable legal requirements. For further information - contact a Volvo dealer. 17 01 Introduction 01 Accessories and extra equipment Dimensions The incorrect connection and installation of accessories and extra equipment can negatively affect the car's electronic system. Certain accessories only function when associated software is installed in the car's computer system. Volvo therefore recommends that you always contact an authorised Volvo workshop before installing accessories or extra equipment which are connected to or affect the electrical system. Heat-reflecting windscreen* A 65 mm B 150 mm C 125 mm The windscreen is equipped with a heatreflecting film (IR) that reduces the solar heat radiation into the passenger compartment. The positioning of electronic equipment, such as a transponder, behind a glass surface with heat-reflecting film may affect its function and performance. For the optimal function of electronic equipment, it should be positioned on the part of the windscreen with no heat-reflecting film (see the highlighted area in the above illustration). Change of ownership for cars with Volvo On Call* If the car is equipped with Volvo On Call (VOC) it is important to change the owner of the service. VOC is a supplemental service that consists of safety, security and comfort services. In the event of change of ownership it is important to change the owner of the service. Closing the VOC service Contact a Volvo dealer in the event of change of ownership in order to close the VOC service. Starting the VOC service It is very important that the VOC service changes owner so that the previous owner's ability to use services in the car is stopped. Contact a Volvo dealer in the event of a change of ownership. Related information • Areas where IR film is not applied. 18 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Information on the Internet (p. 19) 01 Introduction Information on the Internet 01 At www.volvocars.com there is further information concerning your car. With a personal Volvo ID it is possible to log in to My Volvo web which is a personal web page for you and your car. A QR code reader is required to read the QR code, which is available as a supplemental program for several mobile phones. The QR code reader can be downloaded from e.g. App Store, Windows Phone or Google Play. QR code 19 01 Introduction 01 Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy tured in one of the cleanest and most resource-efficient plants in the world. G000000 Your Volvo complies with strict international environmental standards and is also manufac- Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corporation's core values which influence all operations. We also believe that our customers share our consideration for the environment. Your Volvo complies with strict international environmental standards and is also manufactured in one of the cleanest and most resource-efficient plants in the world. Volvo Car Corporation has global ISO certification, which includes the environmental standard ISO 14001 covering all factories and several of our other units. We also set requirements 20 for our partners so that they work systematically with environmental issues. Fuel consumption Volvo cars have competitive fuel consumption in each of their respective classes. Lower fuel consumption generally results in lower emission of the greenhouse gas, carbon dioxide. It is possible for the driver to influence fuel consumption. For more information read under the heading, Reducing environmental impact. Efficient emission control Your Volvo is manufactured following the concept "Clean inside and out" – a concept that encompasses a clean interior environment as well as highly efficient emission control. In many cases the exhaust emissions are well below the applicable standards. Clean air in the passenger compartment A passenger compartment filter prevents dust and pollen from entering the passenger compartment via the air intake. 01 Introduction A sophisticated air quality system, IAQS* (Interior Air Quality System) ensures that the incoming air is cleaner than the air in the traffic outside. The system consists of an electronic sensor and a carbon filter. The incoming air is monitored continuously and if there is an increase in the level of certain unhealthy gases such as carbon monoxide then the air intake is closed. Such a situation may arise in heavy traffic, queues and tunnels for example. The entry of nitrous oxides, ground-level ozone and hydrocarbons is prevented by the carbon filter. Interior The interior of a Volvo is designed to be pleasant and comfortable, even for people with contact allergies and for asthma sufferers. Extreme attention has been given to choosing environmentally-compatible materials. Reducing environmental impact You can easily help reduce environmental impact - here are a few tips: • Avoid letting the engine idle - switch off the engine when stationary for longer periods. Pay attention to local regulations. • • Drive economically - think ahead. • If the car is equipped with an engine block heater*, use it before starting from cold - it improves starting capacity and reduces wear in cold weather and the engine reaches normal operating temperature more quickly, which lowers consumption and reduces emissions. • High speed increases consumption considerably due to increased wind resistance - a doubling of speed increases wind resistance 4 times. • Always dispose of environmentally hazardous waste, such as batteries and oils, in an environmentally safe manner. Consult a workshop in the event of uncertainty about how this type of waste should be discarded - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Volvo workshops and the environment Regular maintenance creates the conditions for a long service life and low fuel consumption for your car. In this way you contribute to a cleaner environment. When Volvo's workshops are entrusted with the service and maintenance of your car it becomes part of our system. Volvo makes clear demands regarding the way in which our workshops are designed in order to prevent spills and discharges into the environment. Our workshop staff have the knowledge and the tools Following this advice can save money, the planet's resources are saved, and the car's durability is extended. For more information and further advice, see Economical driving (p. 300) and Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions (p. 454). required to guarantee good environmental care. Perform service and maintenance in accordance with the owner's manual's instructions - follow the intervals recommended in the Service and Warranty Booklet. 01 Recycling As a part of Volvo's environmental work, it is important that the car is recycled in an environmentally sound manner. Almost all of the car can be recycled. The last owner of the car is therefore requested to contact a dealer for referral to a certified/approved recycling facility. Related information • The owner's manual and the environment (p. 22) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 21 01 Introduction 01 The owner's manual and the environment The paper pulp in a printed owner's manual comes from FSC® certified forests or other controlled sources. The Forest Stewardship Council® symbol shows that the paper pulp in a printed owner's manual comes from FSC® certified forests or other controlled sources. Laminated glass Laminated glass The glass is reinforced which provides better protection against break-ins and improved sound insulation in the passenger compartment. The windscreen and other windows* have laminated glass. Related information • 22 Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy (p. 20) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. SAFETY 02 Safety General information on seatbelts 02 Heavy braking can have serious consequences if the seatbelts are not used. Ensure that all passengers are using their seatbelts during the journey. • The hip strap must be positioned low down (not over the abdomen). • Tension the hip strap over the lap by pulling the diagonal shoulder belt up towards the shoulder. WARNING The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seatbelt is not used or is used incorrectly, this may diminish the protection provided by the airbag in the event of a collision. WARNING Each seatbelt is designed for only one person. It is important that the seatbelt lies against the body so it can provide maximum protection. Do not lean the backrest too far back. The seatbelt is designed to protect in a normal seating position. Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten their (p. 25) seatbelt by means of an audio and visual reminder (p. 27). Remember 24 • Do not use clips or anything else that can prevent the seatbelt from fitting properly. • The seatbelt must not be twisted or caught on anything. WARNING Never modify or repair the seatbelts yourself. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. If the seatbelt has been subjected to a major load, such as in conjunction with a collision, the entire seatbelt must be replaced. Some of the seatbelt's protective properties may have been lost even if the seatbelt does not appear damaged. The seatbelt must also be replaced if it shows signs of wear or damage. The new seatbelt must be type-approved and designed for installation at the same location as the replaced seatbelt. Related information • • • Seatbelt - pregnancy (p. 26) Seat belt - loosening (p. 26) Seatbelt tensioner (p. 27) 02 Safety Seatbelt - putting on Remember Put on the seatbelt (p. 24) before driving starts. The seatbelt locks and cannot be withdrawn: • • • Pull the belt out slowly and secure it by pressing its locking tab into the seatbelt buckle. A loud "click" indicates that the belt has locked. if it is pulled out too quickly during braking and acceleration if the car leans heavily. 02 Related information Incorrectly fitted seatbelt. The belt must rest on the shoulder. • • • • Seatbelt - pregnancy (p. 26) Seat belt - loosening (p. 26) Seatbelt tensioner (p. 27) Seatbelt reminder (p. 27) Correctly fitted seatbelt. Seatbelt height adjustment. Press the button and move the belt vertically. Position the belt as high as possible without it chafing against your throat. The locking tab at the centre rear seat only fits into the intended seatbelt buckle. 25 02 Safety 02 Seat belt - loosening Seatbelt - pregnancy Loosen the seatbelt (p. 24) when the car is stationary. Seatbelt (p. 24) must always be worn during pregnancy. But it is crucial that it be worn in the correct way. Press the red button on the seatbelt buckle and then let the belt retract. If the seatbelt does not retract fully, feed it in by hand so that it does not hang loose. Seatbelt - putting on (p. 25) G020998 Seatbelt reminder (p. 27) The diagonal section should wrap over the shoulder then be routed between the breasts and to the side of the abdomen. The lap section should lay flat over the thighs and as low as possible under the abdomen. – It must never be allowed to ride upward. Remove the slack from the seatbelt and ensure that it fits as close to the body as possible. In addition, check that there are no twists in the seatbelt. As the pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers must adjust the seat (p. 73) and steering wheel (p. 77) such that they can easily maintain control of the vehicle as they drive (which means that they must be able to easily operate the foot pedals and steering wheel). 26 Related information • • Related information • • The aim should be to position the seat with as large a distance as possible between abdomen and steering wheel. Seatbelt - putting on (p. 25) Seat belt - loosening (p. 26) 02 Safety Seatbelt reminder automatically after approximately 30 seconds driving or after pressing the indicator stalk (p. 101) OK button. If anyone is unbelted then the message can only be acknowledged manually by pressing the indicator stalk OK button. Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten (p. 25) their seatbelt by means of an audio and visual reminder. • Provides a warning if one of the rear seatbelts is unfastened during travel. This warning takes the form of a message in the combined instrument panel along with the audio/visual signal. The warning stops when the seatbelt is re-fastened, or it can also be acknowledged manually by pressing the OK button. Seatbelt tensioner Seatbelts (p. 24) on the driver's side, the passenger side and at the outer rear seats are fitted with seatbelt tensioners. A mechanism in the seatbelt tensioner tightens the seatbelt in the event of a sufficiently violent collision. The seatbelt then provides more effective restraint for the occupants. WARNING Never insert the tongue of the passenger's seatbelt into the buckle on the driver's side. Always insert the tongue of the seatbelt into the buckle on the correct side. Do not make any damages on seatbelts nor insert any foreign objects into a buckle. The seatbelts and buckles would then possibly not function as intended in the event of a collision. There is a risk of serous injury. The combined instrument panel's information display shows which seatbelts are in use. This information is always available. The audio reminder is speed dependent, and in some cases time dependent. The visual reminder is located in the roof console and in the combined instrument panel (p. 60). Child seats are not covered by the seatbelt reminder system. 02 Related information • General information on seatbelts (p. 24) Rear seat The seatbelt reminder in the rear seat has two subfunctions: • Provides information on which seatbelts (p. 24) are being used in the rear seat. A message appears in the combined instrument panel when the seatbelts are in use, or if one of the rear doors has been opened. The message is acknowledged 27 02 Safety Safety - warning symbol 02 WARNING The warning symbol is shown if a fault is detected during fault tracing or if a system has been activated. Where required, the warning symbol is shown together with a message in the combined instrument panel (p. 60) information display. If the warning symbol for the airbag system remains illuminated or illuminates while driving, it means that the airbag system does not have full functionality. The symbol indicates a fault in the airbag system, the belt tensioner system, SIPS, the IC system or some other fault in the system. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop immediately. Warning triangle and warning symbol for the airbag system in the digital combined instrument panel. Warning triangle and warning symbol for the airbag system (p. 29) in the analogue combined instrument panel. 28 The warning symbol in the combined instrument panel is switched on with the remote control key in key position II (p. 71), fault tracing is performed each time the ignition is switched on. The symbol clears after approx. 6 seconds provided the airbag system is fault-free. The warning symbol is shown if a fault is detected during fault tracing or if a system has been activated. Where required, the warning symbol is shown together with a message in the display. If the warning symbol malfunctions, the warning triangle illuminates and SRS airbag Service required or SRS airbag Service urgent appears in the display. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop immediately. Related information • General information on safety mode (p. 38) 02 Safety Airbag system The system consists of airbags and sensors. A sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors and the airbag(s) are inflated and become hot. The airbag cushions the initial collision impact for the occupant. The airbag deflates when compressed by the collision. When this occurs, smoke escapes into the car. This is completely normal. The entire process, including inflation and deflation of the airbag, occurs within tenths of a second. In the event of a frontal collision the airbag system helps to protect the head, face and chest of the driver and passenger. Related information • • • Airbags on driver's side (p. 30) Passenger airbag (p. 30) Safety - warning symbol (p. 28) 02 G018665 WARNING Airbag system viewed from above, left-handdrive car. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop for repair. Defective work in the airbag system could cause malfunction and result in serious personal injury. NOTE G018666 The detectors react differently depending on the nature of the collision and whether or not the seatbelt is fastened. Applies to all seatbelt positions apart from centre seat rear. It is therefore possible that only one (or none) of the airbags may inflate in a collision. The detectors sense the force of the collision on the vehicle and the action is adapted accordingly so that one or more airbags are deployed. Airbag system viewed from above, right-handdrive car. 29 02 Safety Airbags on driver's side 02 To supplement the protection afforded by the seatbelt (p. 24) on the driver side, the car is equipped with two airbags (p. 29). • Passenger airbag (p. 30) Passenger airbag To supplement the protection afforded by the seatbelt (p. 24) on the passenger side, the car is equipped with an airbag (p. 29). One of the airbags is folded up into the centre of the steering wheel. The steering wheel is marked AIRBAG. The airbag is folded up into a compartment above the glovebox. Its cover panel is marked AIRBAG. Knee airbag on the driver's side in a left-handdrive car. Location of the front passenger airbag in a lefthand drive car. The second airbag (at knee level) is fitted in the lower part of the instrument panel on the driver's side; this panel is labelled AIRBAG. WARNING The seatbelts and airbags interact. If the belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this may diminish the protection provided by the airbags in the event of a collision. 30 Related information 02 Safety Passenger airbag - activating/ deactivating* WARNING Never place a child in a child seat or on a booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag is activated. Never allow anybody to stand or sit in front of the front passenger seat. No one shorter than 140 cm should ever sit in the front passenger seat if the airbag is activated. Failure to follow the advice given above can endanger life. Location of the front passenger airbag in a righthand drive car. WARNING The seatbelts and airbags interact. If the belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this may diminish the protection provided by the airbag in the event of a collision. Switch - PACOS* The front passenger airbag can be deactivated (p. 31) if the car is equipped with a switch, PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch). Do not put objects in front of or above the dashboard where the passenger airbag is located. 02 Switch - PACOS The switch for the passenger airbag (PACOS) is located on the passenger end of the instrument panel and is accessible when the passenger door is open. Check that the switch is in the required position. The remote control key's key blade (p. 166) should be used to change position. WARNING To minimise the risk of injury if the airbag deploys, passengers must sit as upright as possible with their feet on the floor and backs against the backrest. Seatbelts must be secured. WARNING Front passenger airbag (p. 30) can be deactivated if the car is equipped with a switch, PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch). If the car is equipped with a front passenger airbag, but does not have a PACOS switch (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch), then the airbag will always be activated. Related information • • Airbags on driver's side (p. 30) Child seats (p. 44) Position of airbag label plus switch. The airbag is activated. With the switch in this position, persons taller than 140 cm can sit in the front passenger seat, but * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 31 02 Safety || never children in a child seat or on a booster cushion. 02 The airbag is deactivated. With the switch in this position, children in a child seat or on a booster cushion can sit in the front passenger seat, but never persons taller than 140 cm. WARNING Activated airbag (passenger seat): Never place a child in a child seat or on a booster cushion on the front passenger seat when the airbag is activated. This applies to everyone shorter than 140 cm. Deactivated airbag (passenger seat): No one taller than 140 cm should ever sit in the front passenger seat when the airbag is deactivated. Failure to follow the advice given above can endanger life. NOTE When the remote control key is in key position II (p. 71) the warning symbol (p. 28) for the airbag is shown in the combined instrument panel for approx. 6 seconds. Following which, the indicator in the roof console is illuminated showing the correct status for the front passenger seat airbag. 32 Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is activated. Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is deactivated. A text message and a warning symbol in the roof console indicate that the airbag for the front passenger seat is activated (see preceding illustration). A text message and a symbol in the roof console indicate that the airbag for the front passenger seat is deactivated (see preceding illustration). WARNING Never place a child in a child seat or on a booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag is activated and the symbol in the roof console is illuminated. Failure to follow this advice could endanger the life of the child. WARNING Do not allow anyone to sit in the front passenger seat if the message in the roof console indicates that the airbag is deactivated, and if the warning symbol (p. 28) for the airbag system is also displayed on the combined instrument panel. This indicates that there has been a severe malfunction. Visit a workshop as soon as possible. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. 02 Safety WARNING Failure to follow the advice given above can endanger the lives of passengers in the car. Related information • Child seats (p. 44) Side airbag (SIPS) In a side impact collision a large proportion of the collision force is transferred by the SIPS (Side Impact Protection System) to beams, pillars, the floor, the roof and other structural parts of the body. The side airbags at the driver's and front passenger seats protect the chest area and the hip and are an important part of the SIPS. 02 Driver's seat, left-hand drive. The SIPS bag system consists of two main components, side airbag and sensors. The side airbags are located in the front seat backrests. Front passenger seat, left-hand drive. A sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors and the side airbags are inflated. The airbag inflates between the occupant and the door panel and thereby cushions the initial impact. The airbag deflates when compressed by the collision. The side airbag is normally only deployed on the side of the collision. 33 02 Safety || WARNING • Volvo recommends that repairs are only carried out by an authorised Volvo workshop. Defective work in the SIPSbag system could cause malfunction and result in serious personal injury. • Do not put objects in the area between the outside of the seat and the door panel, since this area is required by the side airbag. • Volvo recommends the use only of car seat covers approved by Volvo. Other seat covers may impede the operation of the side airbags. 02 • The protection provided by the car to children seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion is not diminished by the side airbag (p. 33). Inflatable Curtain (IC) The inflatable curtain helps to prevent the driver and passengers from striking their heads on the inside of the car during a collision. Child seat/booster cushion (p. 44) can be placed on the front passenger seat provided that the car does not have an activated airbag (p. 31) on the front passenger side. Related information • • Passenger airbag (p. 30) General information on child safety (p. 42) Side airbags are a supplement the seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt. Related information 34 Side airbag (SIPS) - child seat/booster cushion • • • Passenger airbag (p. 30) • Inflatable Curtain (IC) (p. 34) Airbags on driver's side (p. 30) Side airbag (SIPS) - child seat/booster cushion (p. 34) The inflatable curtain IC (Inflatable Curtain) is a part of the SIPS system (p. 33). It is fitted in the headlining along both sides of the roof and protects the car's occupants sitting in the outer seats. A sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors and the inflatable curtain is inflated. 02 Safety WARNING Never hang or attach heavy items onto the handles in the roof. The hook is only designed for light clothing (not for solid objects such as umbrellas for example). Do not screw or install anything onto the car's headlining, door pillars or side panels. This could compromise the intended protection. Volvo recommends that you only ever use Volvo genuine parts that are approved for placement in these areas. General information on WHIPS (whiplash protection) WHIPS (Whiplash Protection System) is a protection against whiplash injuries. The system consists of energy absorbing backrests and specially designed head restraints in the front seats. 02 WARNING Do not load the car higher than 50 mm under the top edge of the windows in the doors. Otherwise, the intended protection of the inflatable curtain, which is concealed in the headlining, may be compromised. WARNING The inflatable curtain is a supplement to the seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt. Related information • • • General information on seatbelts (p. 24) Airbag system (p. 29) Side airbag (SIPS) (p. 33) The WHIPS system is actuated by a rear-end collision, where the angle and speed of the collision, and the nature of the colliding vehicle all have an influence. 35 02 Safety || WARNING The WHIPS system is a supplement to the seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt. 02 Properties of the seat When the WHIPS system is deployed, the front seat backrests are lowered backward to alter the seating position of the driver and front seat passenger. This reduces the risk of whiplash injury. WARNING Never modify or repair the seat or WHIPS system yourself. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. WHIPS - child seats WHIPS - seating position The protection provided by the car to children seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion is not diminished by the WHIPS system (p. 35). In order to obtain optimum protection from the WHIPS system (p. 35) the driver and passenger must have the correct seating position and make sure that the system's function is not obstructed. Child seat/booster cushion (p. 44) can be placed on the front passenger seat provided that the car does not have an activated airbag (p. 31) on the front passenger side. Related information • General information on child safety (p. 42) Seating position Set the correct seating position in the front seat (p. 73) before driving starts. Driver and front seat passenger should sit in the centre of the seat with as little space as possible between the head and the head restraint. Function Related information • • • WHIPS - child seats (p. 36) WHIPS - seating position (p. 36) General information on seatbelts (p. 24) Do not leave any objects on the floor behind the driver's seat/passenger seat that may prevent the WHIPS system from functioning. 36 02 Safety WARNING Do not squeeze rigid objects between the rear seat cushion and the front seat backrest. Make sure you do not to obstruct the function of the WHIPS system. WARNING If a seat has been subjected to extreme forces, such as due to a rear-end collision, the WHIPS system must be checked. Volvo recommends that it is checked by an authorised Volvo workshop. Part of the WHIPS system's protective capacity may have been lost even if the seats appear to be undamaged. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop to have the system checked even after a minor rearend collision. Do not place objects on the rear seat that may prevent the WHIPS system from functioning. WARNING If a rear seat backrest is folded down, the corresponding front seat must be moved forward so that it does not touch the folded backrest. When the systems deploy In the event of a collision Volvo's different personal safety systems work together in order to minimise injury. System Triggered Seatbelt tensioner (p. 27) front seat In the event of a frontal collision, and/or side-impact collision, and/or rear-end collision and/or overturning Seatbelt tensioner (p. 27) rear seatA In a frontal collision and/or side-impact accident and/or overturning Airbags In a frontal collisionB 02 (Steering wheel, knee (p. 30), passenger airbag (p. 30)) Side airbags (SIPS) (p. 33) In a side-impact accidentB 37 02 Safety System Triggered Inflatable Curtain IC (p. 34) In the event of a side impact and/or overturning and/or some frontal collisionsB Whiplash protection WHIPS (p. 35) In a rear-end collision 02 A B There is no seatbelt tensioner at the centre rear seat. The bodywork of the car could be greatly deformed in a collision without airbag deployment. A number of factors such as the rigidity and weight of the object hit, the speed of the car, the angle of the collision etc. affects how the different safety systems of the car are activated. If the airbags (p. 29) have deployed, the following is recommended: • Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo workshop. Do not drive with deployed airbags. • Volvo recommends that you engage an authorised Volvo workshop to handle the replacement of components in the car's safety systems. • Always contact a doctor. NOTE The airbags and belt tensioner system are deployed only once during a collision. 38 WARNING The airbag system's control module is located in the centre console. If the centre console is drenched with water or other liquid, disconnect the battery cables. Do not attempt to start the car since the airbags may deploy. Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo workshop. General information on safety mode Safety mode is a protective state that is enforced when the collision may have damaged any of the car's vital functions, such as the fuel lines, sensors for one of the safety systems, or the brake system. WARNING Never drive with deployed airbags. They can make steering difficult. Other safety systems may also be damaged. The smoke and dust created when the airbags are deployed can cause skin and eye irritation/injury after intensive exposure. In case of irritation, wash with cold water. The rapid deployment sequence and airbag fabric may cause friction and skin burns. Warning triangle in the analogue combined instrument panel. 02 Safety Related information • Safety mode - attempting to start the car (p. 39) • Safety mode - moving the car (p. 40) Safety mode - attempting to start the car If the car is set in safety mode (p. 38) then an attempt to start the car can be made if everything seems normal and the absence of fuel leakage has been checked. 02 First, check that no fuel is leaking from the car. There must be no smell of fuel either. Warning triangle in the digital combined instrument panel. If the car is involved in a collision, the text Safety mode See manual may appear in the combined instrument panel (p. 60) information display. This means that the car has reduced functionality. WARNING Never attempt to repair your car or reset the electronics yourself if the car has been in safety mode. This could result in personal injury or the car not functioning as normal. Volvo recommends that you engage an authorised Volvo workshop to check and restore the car to normal status after Safety mode See manual has been displayed. If everything seems normal and you have checked for indications of fuel leakage, you may attempt to start the car. Remove the remote control key and open the driver's door. If a message is now shown to the effect that the ignition is on, press the start button. Then close the door and reinsert the remote control key. The car's electronics will now try to reset themselves to normal mode. Then try to start the car. If the message Safety mode See manual is still shown on the display, then the car must not be driven or towed, but a vehicle recovery service (p. 310) used instead. Even if the car appears to be driveable, hidden damage may make the car impossible to control once moving. 39 02 Safety || WARNING Never, under any circumstances, attempt to restart the car if it smells of fuel when the Safety mode See manual message is displayed. Leave the car at once. 02 WARNING If the car is in safety mode it must not be towed. It must be transported from its location. Volvo recommends that it is transported to an authorised Volvo workshop. Safety mode - moving the car Pedestrian airbag* If Normal mode is shown after Safety mode See manual has been reset after attempting to start the car (p. 39) , the car can be moved carefully out of a dangerous position. In certain frontal collisions, the pedestrian airbag (Pedestrian Airbag) contributes to mitigating the collision of the pedestrian with the car. Do not move the car further than necessary. Related information • General information on safety mode (p. 38) Related information • Safety mode - moving the car (p. 40) The pedestrian airbag (Pedestrian Airbag) is fitted under the bonnet near the windscreen. In the event of certain frontal collisions with a pedestrian, the sensors in the front bumper react and the airbag inflates if required based on the force of the impact. The sensors are active at a speed of approx. 20-50 km/h and an ambient temperature between -20 and +70°C. The sensors are designed to detect a collision with an object that has similar properties to those of the human leg. 40 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 02 Safety NOTE There may be objects in the traffic environment that prompt a signal to the sensors that is similar to a collision with a pedestrian. It is possible that the system will be activated in the event of a collision with such an object. If the airbag is activated (Pedestrian Airbag) • • • Related information • Pedestrian airbag - moving the car (p. 41) • Pedestrian airbag - folding up (p. 42) Pedestrian airbag - moving the car The car may be moved if it has not been set in safety mode (p. 38). If any of the other airbags in the passenger compartment were activated then the car remains in safety mode. If only the pedestrian airbag (p. 40) Pedestrian Airbag has been activated: the rear part of the bonnet is raised and locked in this position 1. Move the car to a safe location as close as possible. the hazard warning flashers are activated 2. Fold up the airbag in accordance with the instructions (p. 42). the brake system is prepared for the upcoming emergency braking. 3. Seek the nearest workshop. WARNING Do not fit any accessories or change anything in the front if the car is equipped with airbag (Pedestrian Airbag). Incorrect intervention at the front may cause incorrect function in the system and lead to serious injury and damage to the car. Volvo recommends that genuine wiper arms are used and that you only use genuine parts for them. 02 WARNING Volvo recommends that, after activation of the airbag, you contact an authorised Volvo workshop as soon as possible. Related information • Pedestrian airbag* (p. 40) WARNING Volvo recommends contacting an authorised Volvo workshop in the event of damage to the bumper in order to ensure that the system is intact. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 41 02 Safety Pedestrian airbag - folding up The car may be moved if it has not been set in safety mode (p. 38). 02 The pedestrian airbag (p. 40) (Pedestrain Airbag) must be folded up before the car is moved. 2. Gather the airbag fabric along its length on the driver's side. Then fold the gathered fabric towards the centre. Wind the Velcro strap (double sided) around as much fabric as possible and fasten it. 3. Press the rolled up portion of the airbag into the airbag housing (2). 4. Repeat steps 1-3 for the passenger side. It may be necessary to fold the gathered fabric twice on this side in order to wind the Velcro strap around it. 5. The airbag housing cover will be open slightly. This is completely normal. Related information • Pedestrian airbag - moving the car (p. 41) General information on child safety Children of all ages and sizes must always sit correctly secured in the car. Never allow a child to sit on the knee of a passenger. Volvo recommends that children travel in rear-facing child seats until as late an age as possible, at least until 3-4 years of age, and then front-facing booster cushions/child seats until up to 10 years of age. The position of a child in the car and the choice of equipment are dictated by the child's weight and size; see Child seats (p. 44). NOTE Regulations regarding the placement of children in cars vary from country to country. Check what does apply. Airbag (Pedestrian Airbag) Airbag housing Velcro strap, passenger side Velcro strap, driver's side The airbag may feel warm and give off smoke. This is normal. Fold the airbag as follows: 1. Find the Velcro strap on the driver's side (4). 42 Volvo has child safety equipment (child seats, booster cushions & attachment devices) which is designed for your particular car. Using Volvo's child safety equipment provides you with optimum conditions for your child to travel safely in the car. Furthermore, the child safety equipment fits and is easy to use. 02 Safety NOTE In the event of questions when fitting child safety products, contact the manufacturer for clearer instructions. 02 Child safety locks The controls for operating the rear door power windows and the rear door opening handles can be blocked (p. 179) from opening from the inside. Related information • • • • Child seats (p. 44) Child seats - location (p. 48) Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 48) Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 52) 43 02 Safety Child seats 02 NOTE Children should sit comfortably and safely. Make sure that the child seat is being used correctly. When using child safety products it is important to read the installation instructions included. WARNING Do not secure the straps of the child seat to the seat's horizontal adjustment bar, springs or the rails and beams under the seat. Sharp edges may damage the straps. G020739 Look in the installation instructions for the child seat for the correct fitting. Child seats and airbags are not compatible. 44 02 Safety Recommended child seats1 Weight Front seat (with deactivated airbag) Group 0 (L) max 13 kg Group 0+ max 13 kg 02 Type approval: E1 04301146 Group 0+ max 10 kg Centre rear seat Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the ISOFIX fixture system. max 10 kg Group 0 Outer rear seat Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. Type approval: E1 04301146 Type approval: E1 04301146 (U) (U) Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. Type approval: E1 04301146 (U) Group 0 Child seats which are universally max 10 kg (U) approved.A Child seats which are universally approved. (U) Group 0+ max 13 kg 1 With regard to other child seats your car should be included in the manufacturer's enclosed list of vehicles or be universally approved in accordance with the ECE R44 legal requirement. }} 45 02 Safety || 02 Weight Front seat (with deactivated airbag) Outer rear seat Group 1 Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt and straps. Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt and straps. Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192 9-18 kg (L) Group 1 Child seats which are universally 9-18 kg (U) (U) Group 2 Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt and straps. Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt and straps. Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192 (L) (L) Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - front-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - front-facing child seat, secured with the car's seatbelt. Type approval: E5 04191 Type approval: E5 04191 (U) (U) Volvo booster seat with backrest (Volvo Booster Seat with backrest). Volvo booster seat with backrest (Volvo Booster Seat with backrest). Type approval: E1 04301169 Type approval: E1 04301169 (UF) (UF) 15-25 kg Group 2 15-25 kg Group 2/3 15-36 kg 46 (L) approved.A Child seats which are universally approved. Centre rear seat 02 Safety Weight Front seat (with deactivated airbag) Outer rear seat Group 2/3 Booster cushion with and without backrest (Booster Cushion with and without backrest). Booster cushion with and without backrest (Booster Cushion with and without backrest). Type approval: E5 04216 Type approval: E5 04216 (UF) (UF) 15-36 kg Centre rear seat 02 L: Suitable for specific child seats. These child seats may be intended for use in a special car model, limited or semi-universal categories. U: Suitable for universally approved child seats in this weight class. UF: Suitable for front-facing universally approved child seats in this weight class. B: Built-in child seats approved for this weight class. A Only for rear-facing child seat. Set the seat's backrest in upright position. Related information • • • • Child seats - location (p. 48) Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 52) Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 48) General information on child safety (p. 42) 47 02 Safety Child seats - location 02 WARNING Always fit child seats/booster cushions (p. 44) in the rear seat if the passenger airbag is activated (p. 31). If a child is sitting on the front passenger seat then he/she could suffer serious injury if the airbag deploys. Booster cushions/child seats with steel braces or some other design that could rest on the seatbelt buckle's opening button must not be used, as they could cause the seatbelt buckle to open accidentally. Child seat - ISOFIX ISOFIX is a fixture system for car child seats (p. 44) that is based on an international standard. Do not allow the upper section of the child seat to rest against the windscreen. Related information The label for the airbag is visible when the passenger door is opened, see the illustration (p. 31). • • General information on child safety (p. 42) • Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 48) Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 52) You may place: • a child seat/booster cushion on the front passenger seat provided there is no activated airbag on the front passenger side. • one or more child seats/booster cushions in the rear seat. WARNING Never place a child in a child seat or on a booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag (SRS) is activated. No one shorter than 140 cm should ever sit in the front passenger seat if the airbag (SRS) is activated. Failure to follow the advice given above can endanger life. 48 Mounting points for the ISOFIX fixture system are located at the lower section of the rear seat backrest, in the outer seats. The location of the mounting points is indicated by symbols in the backrest upholstery (see preceding illustration). Always follow the manufacturer's installation instructions when connecting a child seat to the ISOFIX mounting points. Related information • • • • ISOFIX - size classes (p. 49) ISOFIX - types of child seat (p. 50) General information on child safety (p. 42) Child seats (p. 44) 02 Safety • • Child seats - location (p. 48) ISOFIX - size classes Child seats - upper mounting points (p. 52) There is a size classification for child seats using the ISOFIX (p. 48) fixture system in order to assist users in choosing the correct type of child seat (p. 50). Size class WARNING Never place the child in the passenger seat if the car is fitted with an activated airbag. NOTE Description A Full size, front-facing child seat B Reduced size (alt. 1), frontfacing child seat B1 Reduced size (alt.2), front-facing child seat C Full size, rear-facing child seat D Reduced size, rear-facing child seat E Rear-facing infant seat F Transverse infant seat, lefthand G Transverse infant seat, righthand 02 If an ISOFIX child seat has no size classification, the car model must be included on the vehicle list for the child seat. NOTE Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo dealer for recommendations about which ISOFIX child seats Volvo recommends. Related information • ISOFIX - types of child seat (p. 50) 49 02 Safety ISOFIX - types of child seat Child seats are in different sizes – cars are in different sizes. This means that not all child 02 Type of child seat Infant seat transverse Infant seat, rear-facing Weight max 10 kg max 10 kg seats are suitable for all seats in all car models. Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIXA installation of child seats Front seat Outer rear seat F X X G X X E X OK (IL) Infant seat, rear-facing max 13 kg E X OK (IL) D X OK (IL) C X OK (IL) Child seat, rear-facing 9-18 kg D X OK (IL) C X OK (IL) 50 02 Safety Type of child seat Front-facing child seat Weight 9-18 kg Size class B Passenger seats for ISOFIXA installation of child seats Front seat Outer rear seat X OKB 02 (IUF) B1 X OKB (IUF) A X OKB (IUF) X: The ISOFIX position is not suitable for ISOFIX child seats in this weight class and/or size class. IL: Suitable for specific ISOFIX child seats. These child seats may be intended for use in a special car model, limited or semi-universal categories. IUF: Suitable for front-facing ISOFIX child seats that are universally approved in this weight class. A B ISOFIX is a fixture system for car child seats that is based on an international standard. Volvo recommends rear-facing child seats for this group. Make sure you select the right size class (p. 49) of child seat with ISOFIX fixture system. Related information • Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 48) 51 02 Safety Child seats - upper mounting points 02 NOTE The car is equipped with upper mounting points for certain front-facing child seats (p. 44). These mounting points are located on the rear of the seat. Upper mounting points In cars with a cargo cover over the luggage compartment, this must be removed before child seats can be attached to the securing points. For detailed information on how the child seat should be tensioned in the upper mounting points, see the seat manufacturer's instructions. WARNING The child seat's straps must always be drawn through the hole in the head restraint leg before they are tensioned at the attachment point. Related information The upper mounting points are primarily intended for use with front-facing child seats. Volvo recommends that small children should sit in rear-facing child seats to as late an age as possible. NOTE Fold the head restraints in order to facilitate fitting this type of child seat in cars with folding head restraints on the outer seats. 52 • • • General information on child safety (p. 42) Child seats - location (p. 48) Child seat - ISOFIX (p. 48) INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS 03 Instruments and controls Instruments and controls, left-hand drive car - overview The overview shows where the car's displays and controls are located. 03 54 03 Instruments and controls Overview, left-hand drive cars 03 }} 55 03 Instruments and controls || 03 56 Function See Function See Menus and messages, direction indicators, main/ dipped beam, trip computer (p. 101), (p. 104), (p. 87), (p. 82) and (p. 123). Hazard warning flashers (p. 86). Cruise control (p. 194) and (p. 199). Control panel for infotainment system and menu navigation (p. 106), (p. 372) and (p. 374). Horn, airbags (p. 77) and (p. 29). Control panel for climate control (p. 131) or (p. 132). Combined instrument panel (p. 60). Gear selector (p. 272), (p. 273) or (p. 276). Menu navigation, audio control, phone control* (p. 106), (p. 372), (p. 374) and (p. 404). Parking brake (p. 292). (p. 93). START/STOP ENGINE button (p. 268). Wipers and washing (p. 77). Ignition switch (p. 71). Steering wheel adjustment Screen for infotainment and display of menus (p. 106), (p. 371), (p. 372) and (p. 372). Bonnet opener (p. 335). Light switch, opener for tailgate (p. 78) and (p. 176). Door handle – Seat adjustment* (p. 74). Control panel (p. 175), (p. 180), (p. 95) and (p. 97). Related information • • • * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Outside temperature gauge (p. 68) Trip meter (p. 68) Clock (p. 69) 03 Instruments and controls Instruments and controls, right-hand drive car - overview The overview shows where the car's displays and controls are located. 03 }} 57 03 Instruments and controls || Overview, right-hand drive cars 03 58 03 Instruments and controls Function See Function See Wipers and washing (p. 93). Menu navigation, audio control, phone control* (p. 106), (p. 372), (p. 374) and (p. 404). Control panel for infotainment system and menu navigation (p. 106), (p. 372) and (p. 374). Horn, airbags (p. 77) and (p. 29). Control panel for climate control (p. 131) or (p. 132). Gear selector Combined instrument panel (p. 60). (p. 272), (p. 273) or (p. 276). Cruise control (p. 194) and (p. 199). Parking brake (p. 292). Menus and messages, direction indicators, main/ dipped beam, trip computer (p. 101), (p. 104), (p. 87), (p. 82) and (p. 123). Steering wheel adjustment (p. 77). Bonnet opener (p. 335). Light switch, opener for tailgate (p. 78) and (p. 176). Seat adjustment* (p. 74). START/STOP ENGINE button (p. 268). Ignition switch (p. 71). Screen for infotainment and display of menus (p. 106), (p. 371), (p. 372) and (p. 372). Door handle – Control panel (p. 175), (p. 180), (p. 95) and (p. 97). Hazard warning flashers (p. 86). • Clock (p. 69) 03 Related information • • Outside temperature gauge (p. 68) Trip meter (p. 68) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 59 03 Instruments and controls Combined instrument panel The combined instrument panel's information display shows information on some of the car's functions, e.g. cruise control and trip computer, as well as messages. 03 • Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61) • Analogue combined instrument panel overview (p. 60) • Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65) • Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols (p. 66) Analogue combined instrument panel - overview Gauges and indicators The combined instrument panel's information display shows information on some of the car's functions, e.g. cruise control and trip computer, as well as messages. The information is shown with symbols and text. Information display Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to only one white marking1, the yellow indicator symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illuminated. See also Trip computer functions (p. 123) and Filling up with fuel (p. 296). Information display, analogue instrument panel. There are further descriptions under the functions that use the display. Eco meter The meter provides an indication of how economically the car is being driven. The higher the reading on the scale, the more economical it is. Speedometer Tachometer. The meter indicates engine speed in thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). Gearchange indicator2 / Gear position indicator3. See also Gear shift indicator* 1 2 3 60 When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red. Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls (p. 272), Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) or Automatic gearbox Powershift* (p. 276). Indicator and warning symbols If the engine does not start or if the functionality check is carried out in key position II then all symbols go out within a few seconds except the symbol for faults in the car's emissions system and the symbol for low oil pressure. Related information • • Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Digital combined instrument panel overview The combined instrument panel's information display shows information on some of the car's functions, e.g. cruise control and trip computer, as well as messages. The information is shown with symbols and text. Information display Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65) • Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols (p. 66) • Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61) 03 Indicator and warning symbols, analogue instrument panel. Indicator symbols Indicator and warning symbols warning symbols4 Functionality check All indicator and warning symbols, apart from symbols in the centre of the information display, illuminate in key position II or when the engine is started. When the engine has started, all the symbols should go out except the parking brake symbol, which only goes out when the brake is disengaged. 4 Information display, digital instrument panel*. There are further descriptions under the functions that use the display. Gauges and indicators Various themes can be selected for the digital combined instrument panel Possible themes are "Elegance", "Eco" and "Performance". The setting for the theme can be stored in the remote control key's memory when locking the car; see pages Remote control key with For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warnings are made via display text; see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 61 03 Instruments and controls || key blade (p. 159) and MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108). A theme can only be selected when the engine is running. 03 To select the theme, press the left-hand stalk switch's OK button and select the Themes menu option by turning the thumbwheel on the lever. Press the OK button. Turn the thumbwheel to select the theme and confirm the selection by pressing the OK button. For more information on menu navigation, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). is illuminated. See also Trip computer functions (p. 123) and Filling up with fuel (p. 296). Temperature gauge for engine coolant Speedometer Tachometer. The meter indicates engine speed in thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). Gearchange indicator6 / Gear position indicator7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 272), Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) or Automatic gearbox Powershift* (p. 276). Gauges and indicators, theme "Eco". Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to only one white marking8, the yellow indicator symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illuminated. See also Trip computer functions (p. 123) and Filling up with fuel (p. 296). Eco guide. See also Eco guide & Power guide* (p. 64). Speedometer Gauges and indicators, theme "Elegance". Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to only one white marking5, the yellow indicator symbol for low level in the fuel tank 5 6 7 8 62 When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red. Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Tachometer. The meter indicates engine speed in thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). Gearchange indicator6 / Gear position indicator7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 272), Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* 03 Instruments and controls (p. 273) or Automatic gearbox Powershift* (p. 276). Functionality check Power guide. See also Eco guide & Power guide* (p. 64). Gearchange indicator6 / Gear position indicator7. See also Gear shift indicator* (p. 272), Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) or Automatic gearbox Powershift* (p. 276). Indicator and warning symbols If the engine does not start or if the functionality check is carried out in key position II then all symbols go out within a few seconds except the symbol for faults in the car's emissions system and the symbol for low oil pressure. Gauges and indicators, theme "Performance". Fuel gauge. When the indicator lowers to only one white marking9, the yellow indicator symbol for low level in the fuel tank is illuminated. See also Trip computer functions (p. 123) and Filling up with fuel (p. 296). Temperature gauge for engine coolant 9 6 7 10 All indicator and warning symbols, apart from symbols in the centre of the information display, illuminate in key position II or when the engine is started. When the engine has started, all the symbols should go out except the parking brake symbol, which only goes out when the brake is disengaged. 03 Related information • • Indicator and warning symbols, digital instrument panel. Speedometer Indicator symbols Tachometer. The meter indicates engine speed in thousands of revolutions per minute (rpm). Indicator and warning symbols Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65) • Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols (p. 66) • Analogue combined instrument panel overview (p. 60) warning symbols10 When the display's message Distance to empty fuel tank: starts to show ----, the marking becomes red. Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warnings are made via display text; see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 63 03 Instruments and controls 03 Eco guide & Power guide* Instantaneous value Eco guide and Power guide are two combined instrument panel (p. 60) instruments which help the driver to drive the car with optimum driving economy. The instantaneous value is displayed here the higher the result on the scale, the better. The car also stores statistics of journeys made, which can be viewed in the form of a block diagram; see Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124). Eco guide This instrument provides an indication of how economically the car is being driven. To view this function, select the theme "Eco"; see Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61). Instantaneous value The instantaneous value is calculated on the basis of speed, engine speed, engine power utilised plus use of the foot brake. Optimum speed (50-80 km/h) and low revs are encouraged. The pointers fall under acceleration and braking. Very low instantaneous values illuminate the red zone on the meter (with a short delay), which means poor driving economy and hence should be avoided. Average value The average value slowly follows the instantaneous value and describes how the car has been driven of late. The higher the pointers on the scale, the better the economy achieved by the driver. 64 Engine power utilised Available engine power The smaller, upper pointer shows the available engine power11. The higher the result on the scale, the more power is available in the current gear. Power guide Engine power utilised This instrument shows the relationship between how much power (Power) is being taken from the engine and how much power is available. The larger, lower pointer shows the engine power utilised11. The higher the result on the scale, the more power is being taken from the engine. To view this function, select the theme "Performance"; see Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61). A large gap between the two pointers indicates a large power reserve. Average value 11 Available engine power Power is dependent on engine speed. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls Combined instrument panel meaning of indicator symbols Symbol Start/Stop, the engine autostopped; see Start/Stop* function and operation (p. 280) Indicator symbols Specification ABL fault Emissions system ABS fault Rear fog lamp on Stability system Stability system, sport mode This symbol illuminates when the rear fog lamp is switched on. Right-hand direction indicator The indicator symbols alert the driver that a function is activated, that the system is operating, or that an error or failure has occurred. Symbol Rear fog lamp on Specification ABL fault The symbol illuminates if a fault has arisen in the ABL function (Active Bending Lights). Emissions system If the symbol illuminates after the engine has been started then it may be due to a fault in the car's emissions system. Drive to a workshop for checking. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. ABS fault Stability system A flashing symbol indicates that the stability system is operating. If the symbol illuminates with constant glow then there is a fault in the system. Stability system, sport mode Sport mode allows for a more active driving experience. The system then detects whether the accelerator pedal, steering wheel movements and cornering are more active than in normal driving and then allows controlled skidding of the rear section up to a certain level before it intervenes and stabilises the car. Engine preheater (diesel) This symbol illuminates during engine preheating. Preheating mostly takes place due to low temperature. If this symbol illuminates then the system is not working. The car's regular brake system continues to work, but without the ABS function. Low level in fuel tank Low level in fuel tank 1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the engine. When the symbol illuminates the level in the fuel tank is low, refuel as soon as possible. Information, read display text 2. Restart the engine. Information, read display text Engine preheater (diesel) Main beam On Left-hand direction indicator 3. If the symbol remains illuminated, drive to a workshop to have the ABS system checked. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. 03 When one of the car's systems does not behave as intended, this information symbol illuminates and a text appears on the information display. The message text is cleared with * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. }} 65 03 Instruments and controls || the OK button, see Menu navigation - combined instrument panel (p. 101), or it disappears automatically after a time (time depending on which function is indicated). The information symbol can also illuminate in conjunction with other symbols. Combined instrument cluster meaning of warning symbols The warning symbols alert the driver that an important function is activated, or that a serious error or a serious failure has occurred. Warning symbols NOTE 03 Symbol When a service message is shown, the symbol and message are cleared using the OK button, or disappear automatically after a time. Low oil pressureA Parking brake applied, digital instrument Parking brake applied This symbol illuminates with a constant glow when the parking brake is applied. The symbol is illuminated during application. For more information, see Parking brake (p. 292). Airbags – SRS Both direction indicator symbols flash when the hazard warning flashers are used. Seatbelt reminder If this symbol remains illuminated or illuminates while driving, it means a fault has been detected in the seatbelt buckle, SRS, SIPS, or IC systems. Drive immediately to a workshop to have the system checked. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. Start/Stop Alternator not charging Seatbelt reminder Main beam On Parking brake applied, analogue instrument The symbol illuminates when main beam is on and with main beam flash. Airbags – SRS Left/right-hand direction indicators The symbol shines when the engine is autostopped. Fault in brake system Related information • • 66 Specification engine immediately and check the engine oil level, top up if necessary. If the symbol illuminates and the oil level is normal, contact a workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols (p. 66) • Analogue combined instrument panel overview (p. 60) • Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61) Warning A For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warnings are made via display text; see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337). Low oil pressure If this symbol illuminates during driving then the engine's oil pressure is too low. Stop the This symbol flashes if someone in a front seat has not put on their seatbelt or if someone in a rear seat has taken off their seatbelt. Alternator not charging This symbol illuminates during driving if a fault has occurred in the electrical system. Visit a workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. 03 Instruments and controls Fault in brake system If this symbol illuminates, the brake fluid level may be too low. Stop the car in a safe place and check the level in the brake fluid reservoir; see Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 341). If the brake and ABS symbols illuminate at the same time, there may be a fault in the brake force distribution system. 1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the engine. 2. Restart the engine. • If both symbols extinguish, continue driving. • If the symbols remain illuminated, check the level in the brake fluid reservoir; see Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 341). If the level in the brake fluid reservoir is normal but the symbols are still illuminated, the car can be driven, with great care, to a workshop to have the brake system checked. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo workshop. 2. Read the information on the information display. Implement the action in accordance with the message in the display. Clear the message using the OK button. WARNING If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further before topping up the brake fluid. Reminder – doors not closed The loss of brake fluid must be investigated by a workshop. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. If one of the doors is not closed properly then the information or warning symbol illuminates together with an explanatory image in the information display. Stop the car in a safe place as soon as possible and close the door that is open. WARNING If the BRAKE and ABS symbols are lit at the same time, there is a risk that the rear end will skid during heavy braking. If the car is driven at a speed lower than approx. 7 km/h then the information symbol illuminates. Warning The red warning symbol illuminates when a fault has been indicated which could affect the safety and/or driveability of the car. An explanatory text is shown on the information display at the same time. The symbol remains visible until the fault has been rectified but the text message can be cleared with the OK button; see Menu navigation - combined instrument panel (p. 101). The warning symbol can also illuminate in conjunction with other symbols. Action: 1. Stop in a safe place. Do not drive the car further. 12 03 If the car is driven at a speed higher than approx. 7 km/h then the warning symbol illuminates. If the bonnet12 is not closed properly then the warning symbol illuminates together with an explanatory image in the information display. Stop the car in a safe place as soon as possible and close the bonnet. If the tailgate is not closed properly then the information symbol illuminates together with an explanatory image in the information display. Stop the car in a safe place as soon as possible and close the tailgate. Only cars with alarm*. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 67 03 Instruments and controls || Related information • • Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65) • Analogue combined instrument panel overview (p. 60) • Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61) 03 Outside temperature gauge Trip meter The display for the outside temperature gauge appears in the combined instrument panel. The trip meter display appears in the combined instrument panel. Display for outside temperature gauge, digital instrument panel Display for outside temperature gauge, analogue instrument panel When the temperature lies between +2 °C to -5 °C a snowflake symbol illuminates in the display. This warns of icy roads. If the car has been stationary then the gauge may show a reading that is too high. Related information • Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Trip meter, digital instrument. Display for trip meter13 The two trip meters T1 and T2 are used for measuring short distances. The distance is shown in the display. Turn the left stalk switch thumbwheel to show the required meter. A long press (until the change occurs) on the left-hand stalk switch's RESET button resets the trip meter shown. For more information, see Trip computer - functions (p. 123). Related information • 13 68 Display appearance may differ depending on instrument variant. Combined instrument panel (p. 60) 03 Instruments and controls Clock Related information • The clock display appears in the combined instrument panel. Combined instrument panel (p. 60) 03 1. Locate Settings Time. Clock, digital instrument panel. Display for showing the time14 System options 2. The cursor is located in the first box for Hour: Press OK/MENU - the box is activated. Set the clock 3. Turn TUNE to set the correct hour and press OK/MENU - the box is deactivated. The clock can be adjusted in the menu group MY CAR; for more information see MY CAR menu options (p. 106). 4. Turn TUNE to select the box for Minute (A) and press OK/MENU - the box is activated (B). 5. Turn TUNE to set the correct minute and press OK/MENU - the box is deactivated. 6. Turn TUNE to select the box for OK and press OK/MENU - the setting is complete. The menu option Settings System options Time format selects the 24h or 12h system (AM/PM). 14 The time is shown in the middle of the instrument panel when an analogue instrument panel is fitted. 69 03 Instruments and controls Volvo Sensus Volvo Sensus is the car's operating system, the heart of your personal Volvo experience. It is Sensus that provides information, entertainment and functions to simplify your ownership. 03 With a press on the respective function: RADIO, MEDIA, TEL*, NAV* and CAM* other sources, systems and functions can be activated, e.g. AM, FM1, CD, DVD*, TV*, Bluetooth*, navigation* and park assist camera*. For more information on all functions/ systems, see the respective section in the owner's manual. Overview Volvo Sensus combines and presents many functions in several of the car's systems on the display screen. With Volvo Sensus the car can be personalised by means of an intuitive user interface. Settings can be made in Car settings, Audio and media, Climate control, etc. Centre console control panel. With the centre console buttons and controls or the steering wheel's right-hand keypad* functions can be activated or deactivated and many different settings can be made. With a press on MY CAR all settings related to the driving and control of the car are presented, such as City Safety, Locks and alarm, setting the clock, etc. 70 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Navigation* - NAV, see separate supplement. Audio and media (p. 371) (RADIO, MEDIA, TEL*). Car settings (p. 108) - MY CAR. Climate control system (p. 126). Park assist camera (p. 249) - CAM*. Related information • Licenses (p. 470) 03 Instruments and controls Key positions Insert the key The remote control key can be used to set the vehicle's electrical system in different modes/ levels so that different functions are available; see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). 1. Hold the end of the remote control key with the detachable key blade and insert the key in the ignition switch. 2. Then press the key in the lock up to its end position. IMPORTANT Foreign objects in the ignition switch can impair the function or destroy the lock. Do not press in the remote control key incorrectly turned - Hold the end with the detachable key blade; see Detachable key blade - detaching/attaching (p. 166). Key positions - functions at different levels In order to enable the use of a limited number of functions with the engine switched off, the car's electrical system can be set in 3 different levels (key positions) - 0, I and II - with the remote control key. Throughout this owner's manual these levels are described using the denomination "key positions". 03 The following table shows the functions available in each key position/level. Withdraw the key Push the remote control key, allow it to eject, then pull it out from the ignition switch. Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/inserted. NOTE For cars with the Keyless* function the key does not need to be inserted into the ignition switch but can be stored in e.g. a pocket. For more information on Keyless functions, see Keyless* (p. 168). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 71 03 Instruments and controls || Level 0 Functions Odometer, clock and temperature gauge are illuminated. Electrically operated seats can be adjusted. • Key position 0 - Unlock the car - This means that the car's electrical system is at level 0. • Key position I - With the remote control key fully inserted into the ignition switch15 - Briefly press START/STOP ENGINE. The audio system can be used for a limited time, see Audio and media (p. 371). 03 I II Sun visor for glass roof, power windows, 12 V socket in the passenger compartment, RTI, phone, ventilation fan and windscreen wipers can be used. Several other systems are activated. However, heating in seat cushions and the rear window can only be activated after the engine has been started. This key position consumes a lot of current from the starter battery and should therefore be avoided! 15 16 NOTE To reach level I or II without starting the engine - do not depress the brake/clutch pedal when these key positions are due to be selected. • Key position II - With the remote control key fully inserted into the ignition switch15 - Give a long16 press on START/STOP ENGINE. • Back to key position 0 - To return to key position 0 from position II and I - Briefly press on START/STOP ENGINE. The headlamps come on. Warning/indicator lamps illuminate for 5 seconds. 72 Choosing key position/level Audio system For information on the audio system's functions with remote control key removed, see Audio and media (p. 371). Starting and stopping the engine For information about starting/switching off the engine, see Starting the engine (p. 268). Not necessary for cars with the Keyless* function. Approx. 2 seconds. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Towing For important information about the remote control key during towing, see Towing (p. 308). Related information • Key positions (p. 71) 03 Instruments and controls Seats, front The car's front seats have different setting options for optimum seating comfort. Lowering the front seat backrest* WARNING Adjust the position of the driver's seat before setting off, never while driving. Make sure that the seat is in locked position in order to avoid personal injury in the event of sudden braking or an accident. Adjusting front seat head restraints 03 The passenger seat backrest can be folded forward to make room for long loads. To adjust lumbar support*, turn the wheel17. Move the seat as far back/down as possible. Forward/backward: lift the handle to adjust the distance to the steering wheel and pedals. Check that the seat is locked after changing position. Adjust the backrest to an upright position. To raise/lower the front edge of seat cushion*, pump up/down. Adjust backrest rake, turn the wheel. Raise/lower the seat*, pump up/down. Control panel for power seat*. The height of the front seat head restraints can be adjusted. Adjust the head restraint based on the person's height so that the whole of the back of the head is covered if possible. To adjust the height, the button (see illustration) must be pressed while the restraint is moved up or down. The head restraint can be adjusted in three different positions. 17 Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest and fold it forward. 4. Push the seat forward so that the head restraint "locks" in under the glovebox. Raising takes place in reverse order. WARNING Do not use the space behind the front seat, or the rear seat's centre seat, when the front seat backrest is lowered. Also applies to power seat. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 73 03 Instruments and controls || WARNING Grasp the backrest and make sure that it is properly locked after being folded up in order to avoid personal injury in the event of sudden braking or an accident. Related information 03 • Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 74) • Seats, rear (p. 76) Seats, front - electrically operated Preparations The car's front seats have different setting options for optimum seating comfort. The power seat can be moved forward/backward and up/down. The front edge of the seat cushion can be raised/lowered. The backrest angle can be changed. The seats can be adjusted for a certain time after unlocking the door with the remote control key without the key in the ignition switch. Seat adjustment is normally made in key position I and can always be made when the engine is running. Electrically operated seat* Seat with memory function* Front edge of seat cushion up/down Seat forward/backward and up/down Backrest rake The power front seats have overload protection which is tripped if a seat is blocked by an object. If this happens, go to key position I or 0 and wait a short time before adjusting the seat again. Only one movement (forward/back/up/down) can be made at a time. 74 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The memory function stores settings for the seat and the door mirrors. Store setting Memory button Memory button Memory button Button for storing settings 1. Adjust the seat and the door mirrors. 03 Instruments and controls 2. Hold the button depressed to store settings while depressing one of the memory buttons. Using a stored setting Key memory in remote control key All remote control keys can be used by different drivers to store the settings for the driver's seat and door mirrors18. Hold one of the memory buttons depressed until the seat and the door mirrors stop. If you release the button then the movement of the seat will stop. Emergency stop If the seat accidentally begins to move, press one of the setting buttons for the seat or memory buttons in order to stop the seat. • • For heated seats, see Heated front seats* (p. 133) and Heated rear seat* (p. 133). 18 19 Seats, front (p. 73) Seats, rear (p. 76) WARNING Proceed as follows in order to store the settings and use the key memory*: Heated seats • • 03 Restarting to reach the seat position stored in the key memory is performed by pressing the unlock button on the remote control key. The driver's door must then be open. WARNING Related information The key memory can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Car key memory. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). If the seat accidentally begins to move, press one of the setting buttons for the seat or memory buttons in order to stop the seat. Emergency stop Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do not play with the controls. Check that there are no objects in front of, behind or under the seat during adjustment. Ensure that none of the rear seat passengers is in danger of becoming trapped. has been moved since you locked the car). • Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do not play with the controls. Check that there are no objects in front of, behind or under the seat during adjustment. Ensure that none of the rear seat passengers is in danger of becoming trapped. Adjust the seat as you want it. Lock the car by pressing the lock button on the remote control key that you normally use. This stores the positions of the seat and door mirrors in the remote control key's memory19. Unlock the car (by pressing the unlock button on the same remote control key) and open the driver's door. The driver's seat and door mirrors will automatically adopt the positions that are stored in the remote control key's memory (if the seat Related information • Remote control key - function (p. 162) Only if the car is equipped with power seat with memory and retractable power door mirrors. This setting does not affect settings that have been stored in the power seat's memory function. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 75 03 Instruments and controls Seats, rear The rear seat backrest and the outer seat head restraints can be folded. The centre seat head restraint can be adjusted to suit the height of the passenger. Manual lowering of the outer head restraints, rear seat Head restraint, centre seat, rear • • 03 Pull the locking handle closest to the head restraint to fold the head restraint forward. The head restraint is moved back manually. Adjust the head restraint according to passenger height so that the whole of the back of the head is covered if possible. Slide it up as required. To lower the head restraint again, the button (see illustration) must be pressed while the restraint is carefully moved down. The head restraint can be adjusted in five different positions. NOTE Do not sit in the centre seat with the head restraint in fully lowered position. 76 NOTE The front seats may need to be pushed forwards, and/or the backrests adjusted upwards, in order that the rear backrests can be folded forward fully. WARNING The head restraint must be in locked position after being folded up. Lowering the rear seat backrest IMPORTANT When the backrest is to be folded, the rear seat cup holder must not be open and there must be no objects in the rear seat. Nor may the seat belts be connected. Otherwise there is a risk of damage to the rear seat upholstery. Both sections can be folded separately. If the entire backrest is to be folded then the different sections should be folded separately. 03 Instruments and controls NOTE When the backrest has been raised, the red indicator should no longer be showing. If it is still showing then the backrest is not locked in place. WARNING If the right-hand section is being lowered - release and adjust head restraint for the centre seat, see the earlier section "Head restraint, centre seat, rear". The outer head restraints are lowered automatically when the backrests are lowered. Pull up the backrest's locking handle while folding the backrest forward at the same time. A red indicator on shows that the backthe lock catch rest is no longer locked in place. NOTE When the backrests have been lowered the head restraints must be moved forward slightly so as not to make contact with the seat cushion. Raising takes place in reverse order. Steering wheel The steering wheel can be adjusted in different positions and has controls for horn and cruise control, as well as menu, audio and phone control. Adjusting Check that the backrests and head restraints in the rear seat are locked properly after being folded up. 03 Related information • • Seats, front (p. 73) Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 74) Adjusting the steering wheel. Lever - releasing the steering wheel Possible steering wheel positions The steering wheel can be adjusted for both height and depth: 1. Push the lever forwards to release the steering wheel. 2. Adjust the steering wheel to the position that suits you. 77 03 Instruments and controls || 3. Pull the lever back to fix the steering wheel in place. If the lever is stiff, press the steering wheel lightly at the same time as you push the lever back. Horn WARNING Adjust the steering wheel and fix it before driving away. 03 With speed related power steering* the level of steering force can be adjusted, see Speed related power steering (p. 262). Keypads* Horn. Press the centre of the steering wheel to signal. Keypads in the steering wheel. Cruise control* (p. 194) Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview (p. 404) 78 Light switches The headlamp control activates and adjusts the external lighting. It is also used to adjust display and instrument lighting and mood lighting. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls Overview, light switches Knob positions Position Position Specification Daytime running lightsA when the car's electrical system is in key position II or the engine is running. Main beam flash can be used. Overview, light switches. Thumbwheel for adjusting display and instrument lighting and ambient lighting* Button for rear fog lamp Knob for daytime running lights and parking lamps Thumbwheel20 for headlamp levelling Specification Daytime running lights and position/parking lamps/side marker lamps during the day when the car's electrical system is in key position II or the engine is running. Daytime running lights and position/parking lamps/side marker lamps when the car's electrical system is in key position II or the engine is running. Automatic switching to dipped beam and position/parking lamps/side marker lamps in poor light conditions or when the windscreen wipers or rear fog lamps are activated. Automatic switching to position/parking lamps/side marker lamps when the car is parked. The tunnel detection (p. 82)* function is activated. Main beam flash can be used. 03 The active high beam (p. 83)* function can be used. Main beam can be activated when dipped beam is switched on. Main beam flash can be used. 20 Not available for cars equipped with active Xenon headlamps*. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 79 03 Instruments and controls || Position Specification Dipped beam and position/ parking lamps/side marker lamps. 1. Leave the engine running, or have the car's electrical system in key position I. 2. Roll the thumbwheel up/down to raise/ lower beam alignment. Position/parking lamps Position/parking lamps are switched on with the headlamp control knob. Main beam can be activated. Main beam flash can be used. 03 A Fitted in or under the front bumper. mode is used Volvo recommends that when the car is being driven, as long as traffic situations or weather conditions are unfavourable for the active high beam function*. Instrument lighting Different display and instrument lighting is switched on depending on key position; see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). Thumbwheel positions for different load cases. Only driver Driver and passenger in the front passenger seat The display lighting is automatically subdued in darkness - the sensitivity is set with the thumbwheel. The intensity of the instrument lighting is adjusted with the thumbwheel. Headlamp levelling The load in the car changes the vertical alignment of the headlamp beam, which could dazzle oncoming motorists. Avoid this by adjusting the height of the beam. Lower the beam if the car is heavily laden. 80 Occupants in all seats Occupants in all seats and maximum load in the cargo area Driver and maximum load in the cargo area Cars with active Xenon headlamps* have automatic headlamp levelling and are therefore not equipped with the thumbwheel. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Knob for headlamp control in the position for position/parking lamps. (numTurn the knob to the position for ber plate lighting is switched on at the same time). If the car's electrical system is in key position II or the engine is running then the daytime running lights also switch on. When it is dark outside and the tailgate is opened the rear position/parking lamps illuminate to alert traffic behind. This takes place irrespective of what position the knob is in or what key position the car's electrical system is in. 03 Instruments and controls Related information • • Light switches (p. 78) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) Daytime running lights WARNING This system help to save energy - it cannot determine in all situations when daylight is too weak or sufficiently strong, e.g. in mist and rain. Daytime running lights during the day. DRL The driver is always responsible for ensuring that the car is driven with its lights in a correct state and in accordance with applicable traffic regulations. 03 Related information • Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) Knob for headlamp control in AUTO position. With the knob for headlamp control in position the daytime running lights (Daytime Running Lights - DRL) are activated automatically when the car is driven during daytime. A light sensor on the top of the instrument panel changes from daytime running lights to dipped beam at twilight or when daylight becomes too weak. Changing to dipped beam also takes place if the windscreen wipers or rear fog lamps are activated. 81 03 Instruments and controls Tunnel detection* Main/dipped beam Tunnel detection changes the lighting from daytime running lights to dipped beam when the car is driven into a tunnel. Approx. 20 seconds after the car has left the tunnel, the lighting returns to daytime running lights. 03 The tunnel detection function is available in cars with rain sensor*. The sensor detects the entrance to a tunnel and resets the lighting from daytime running lights to dipped beam. Approx. 20 seconds after the car has left the tunnel, the lighting returns to daytime running lights. If the car is driven into another tunnel within this time period then dipped beam is kept switched on. This prevents frequent changes to the car lighting. Note that the headlamp control's knob must position for tunnel detection remain in to work. Related information • • Main/dipped beam (p. 82) Light switches (p. 78) Main beam Main beam can be activated when the knob 21 or is in position . Activate/deactivate main beam by moving the stalk switch towards the steering wheel to the end position and then releasing. Alternatively, the main beam can be deactivated by a light press of the stalk switch toward the steering wheel. Stalk switch and knob for headlamp control. Position for main beam flash Position for main beam Dipped beam With the knob in position, dipped beam is activated automatically at dusk or when daylight becomes too weak. Dipped beam is also activated automatically if the windscreen wipers or rear foglights are activated. With the knob in position, dipped beam is always switched on when the engine is running or when key position II is active. Main beam flash Move the stalk switch gently towards the steering wheel to the position for main beam 21 82 flash. Main beam comes on until the stalk switch is released. When dipped beam is activated. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. When main beam has been activated the symbol illuminates in the combined instrument panel. Related information • • • Active Xenon headlamps* (p. 84) Active high beam* (p. 83) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) • • Light switches (p. 78) • Tunnel detection* (p. 82) Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern (p. 90) 03 Instruments and controls Active high beam* symbol When AHB is activated the turns white in the instrument's information display. The Active High Beam function detects the headlamp beams of oncoming traffic or the rear lights of vehicles in front, and switches the lighting from main beam to dipped beam. The lighting returns to main beam when the incoming light has stopped. When main beam is activated, the symbol shines blue. Manual operation Active high beam - AHB Active high beam (Active High Beam - AHB) is a function which uses a camera sensor at the top edge of the windscreen to detect the headlamp beams of oncoming traffic or the rear lights of vehicles in front, and then switches from main beam to dipped beam. The function can also take streetlights into account. The lighting returns to main beam about a second after the camera sensor no longer detects the headlamp beams from oncoming traffic or the rear lights from vehicles in front. Activating/deactivating AHB can be activated when the headlamp control's knob is in position (provided that the function has not been deactivated in the menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR menu options (p. 106)). NOTE 03 Keep the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor free from ice, snow, mist and dirt. Stalk switch and knob for headlamp control in AUTO position. Do not stick or attach anything to the windscreen in front of the camera sensor as this may reduce effectiveness or cause one or more of the systems dependent on the camera to stop working. The function can start while driving in the dark when the car's speed is 20 km/h or higher. Activate/deactivate AHB by moving the lefthand stalk switch towards the steering wheel to the end position and then releasing. Deactivation when main beam is on means that the lights are reset directly to dipped beam. Car with analogue combined instrument panel When AHB is activated the symbol illuminates in the instrument's information display. When main beam has been switched on the symbol also illuminates in the combined instrument panel. Car with digital combined instrument panel If the message Active main beam Temporary unavailable Switch manually is shown in the combined instrument panel's information display then you have to switch manually between main and dipped beam. However, the knob for headlamp control can still remain in position . The same applies if the message Windscreen sensors blocked See manual and the symbol symbol goes out when are shown. The these messages are shown. AHB may be temporarily unavailable e.g. in situations with dense fog or heavy rain. When }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 83 03 Instruments and controls || AHB becomes available again, or the windscreen sensors are no longer blocked, the symbol illumessage goes out and the minates. IMPORTANT Examples of when manual switching between main and dipped beam may be required: WARNING 03 AHB is an aid for using the optimum beam pattern when conditions are favourable. The driver always bears responsibility for manually switching between main and dipped beam when traffic situations or weather conditions so require. • • • • • In heavy rain or dense fog • When the traffic ahead has weak lighting • If there are pedestrians on or beside the road • If there are highly reflective objects such as signs in the vicinity of the road • When the lighting from oncoming traffic is obscured by e.g. a crash barrier • When there is traffic on connecting roads • • On the brow of a hill or in a hollow * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Active Xenon headlamps ABL In snow flurries or slush In moonlight When driving in poorly lit built-up areas In sharp bends. Related information 84 Active Xenon headlamps are designed to provide maximum illumination in bends and junctions and so provide increased safety. In freezing rain For more information on the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231). • • Active Xenon headlamps* Main/dipped beam (p. 82) Light switches (p. 78) Headlamp pattern with function deactivated (left) and activated (right) respectively. If the car is equipped with active Xenon headlamps (Active Bending Lights – ABL) then the light from the headlamps follows the steering wheel movement in order to provide maximum lighting in bends and junctions and so provide increased safety. The function is activated automatically when the car is started (provided that it has not been deactivated in the menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106)). In the event of a fault in the function the symbol illuminates in the combined 03 Instruments and controls instrument panel at the same time as the information display shows an explanatory text and a further illuminated symbol. Symbol Display Specification Headlamp system malfunction Service required The system is disengaged. Visit a workshop if the message remains. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. The function is only active in twilight or darkness and only when the car is moving. The function22 can be deactivated/ activated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Light settings Active Bending Lights. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Related information • • • • 22 Main/dipped beam (p. 82) Active high beam* (p. 83) Light switches (p. 78) Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern (p. 90) Rear fog lamp When visibility is reduced by fog the rear fog lamp can be used so that other road users shall notice vehicles in front at an early stage. the headlamp control's knob is turned to or . position NOTE Regulations on the use of rear fog lamps vary from country to country. Related information • • Light switches (p. 78) 03 Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) Button for rear fog lamp. The rear fog lamp can only be switched on when key position II is active or the engine is running and the headlamp control's knob is in or . position Press the button for On/Off. The rear fog lamp indicator symbol in the combined instrument panel and the lamp in the button illuminate when the rear fog lamp is switched on. The rear fog lamp is switched off automatically when the engine is switched off or when Activated on delivery from the factory. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 85 03 Instruments and controls 03 Brake lights Hazard warning flashers The brake light automatically comes on during braking. The hazard warning flashers warn other road users by means of all of the car's direction indicator lamps flashing simultaneously when this function is activated. The brake light is switched on when the brake pedal is depressed. In addition, it is switched on when one of driving support systems Adaptive cruise control (p. 199), City Safety (p. 217) or Collision warning system (p. 223) brakes the car. When the hazard warning flashers are activated, both direction indicator symbols flash in the combined instrument panel. For information on emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers, see Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 291). Related information • Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) Button for hazard warning flashers. Press the button to activate the hazard warning flashers. Both direction indicator symbols in the combined instrument panel flash when the hazard warning flashers are used. The hazard warning flashers are activated automatically when the car has been braked so suddenly that the emergency brake lights have been activated at a speed below 10 km/h. The hazard warning flashers remain on when the car has stopped and are deactivated automatically when the car is driven off 86 again or the button is depressed. For more information on emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers, see Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 291). Related information • Direction indicators (p. 87) 03 Instruments and controls Direction indicators The car's direction indicators are operated with the left-hand stalk switch. The direction indicator lamps flash three times or continuously, depending on how far up or down the stalk switch is moved. Interior lighting Continuous flash sequence Move the stalk switch up or down to the outer position. The stalk switch remains in its position and is moved back manually, or automatically by the steering wheel movement. The passenger compartment lighting is activated/deactivated with the buttons in the controls above the front seats and the rear seat. Direction indicator symbols For direction indicator symbols, see Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65). 03 Related information • • • Hazard warning flashers (p. 86) Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) Controls in roof console for the front reading lamps and passenger compartment lighting. Direction indicators. Reading lamp, left-hand side Short flash sequence Passenger compartment lighting (floor lamps* and ceiling lamps) - On/Off Move the stalk switch up or down to the first position and release. The direction indicator lamps flash three times. The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Light settings Triple indicator. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Auto function for passenger compartment lighting Reading lamp, right-hand side All lighting in the passenger compartment can be switched on and off manually within 30 minutes from when: • the engine has been switched off and the car's electrical system is in key position 0 • the car has been unlocked but the engine has not been started. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 87 03 Instruments and controls || Front reading lamps* The reading lamps are switched on or off by briefly pressing the relevant button in the roof console. Brightness is adjusted by holding the button pressed in. Rear reading lamps* 03 settings Light settings Interior light Floor lights. Select from Off, Low and High. For more information on the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Lighting in the front door storage compartments comes on when the engine starts. Glovebox lighting Vanity mirror lighting The lighting for the vanity mirror (p. 150) is switched on and off respectively when the cover is opened or closed. To replace the lamp, see Lamp replacement vanity mirror lighting (p. 348). The lamps are switched on or off by briefly pressing the relevant button. Brightness is adjusted by holding the button pressed in. Floor lighting as ambient light* To make the interior brighter while driving the floor lighting can be activated at dimmed level. Floor lamp intensity can be changed in the MY CAR menu system under Settings Car 88 • the car is unlocked with the remote control key or key blade, see Remote control key - function (p. 162) or Detachable key blade - unlocking doors (p. 166) • the engine has been switched off and the car's electrical system is in key position 0. Lighting in the front door storage compartments* Glovebox lighting is switched on and off respectively when the lid is opened or closed. Rear reading lamps. The passenger compartment lighting is switched on and remains on for 30 seconds if: Lighting in the cargo area Passenger compartment lighting is switched off when: • • the engine is started the car is locked. The passenger compartment lighting is switched on and off respectively when a side door is opened or closed. It remains switched on for two minutes if one of the doors is open. The lighting in the cargo area is switched on and off respectively when the tailgate is opened or closed. If any lighting is switched on manually and the car is locked then it will be switched off automatically after two minutes. Auto function for passenger compartment lighting Mood lights* The auto function is activated when the lamp in the AUTO button is lit. The passenger compartment lighting is then switched on and off as indicated below. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. When the normal passenger compartment lighting is switched off and the engine is running, an LED illuminates in the front and rear roof console respectively in order to provide a low light and enhance the ambience while driving. The light also makes it easier to see objects in the storage compartments, etc., 03 Instruments and controls when it is dark outside. Light intensity can be changed in the MY CAR menu system under Settings Car settings Light settings Interior light Ambient light. Select from Off, Low and High. This lighting extinguishes when the engine is switched off. The colour of the light can be also set in the MY CAR menu system under Settings Car settings Light settings Interior light Ambient light colours. If you select Temperature, the colour shifts between warm white and cold white depending on the temperature in the car or you can choose between different colour themes. The available colour themes are Frosty White, Toscana White, Ember Gold, Red Sunset, Rainforest, Glacier Blue and Violet Purple. For more information on the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Home safe light duration Approach light duration Home safe lighting consists of dipped beam, parking lamps, lamps in the door mirrors, number plate lighting, interior roof lighting and floor lighting. Approach lighting consists of parking lamps, lamps in the door mirrors, number plate lighting, interior roof lighting and floor lighting. Some of the exterior lighting can be kept switched on to work as home safe lighting after the car has been locked. 1. Remove the remote control key from the ignition switch. 2. Move the left-hand stalk switch toward the steering wheel to the end position and release it. The function can be activated in the same way as with main beam flash; see Main/dipped beam (p. 82). 3. Get out of the car and lock the door. When the function is activated, dipped beam, parking lamps, door mirror lamps, number plate lighting, interior roof lighting and floor lighting are switched on. Approach lighting is switched on with the remote control key, see Remote control key function (p. 162), and is used to switch on the car's lighting at a distance. When the function is activated with the remote control, the parking lamps, door mirror lamps, number plate lighting, interior roof lighting and floor lighting are switched on. 03 The length of time for which the approach lighting should be kept on can be set in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Light settings Approach light duration. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Related information • Home safe light duration (p. 89) The length of time for which the home safe lighting should be kept on can be set in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Light settings Home safe light duration. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Related information • Approach light duration (p. 89) 89 03 Instruments and controls Headlamps - adjusting headlamp pattern Active Xenon headlamps* The light pattern does not need to be adjusted. The headlamp pattern is designed in such a way that oncoming traffic is not dazzled. The headlamp pattern must be adjusted to avoid dazzling oncoming motorists and can be set for right or left-hand traffic. Halogen headlamps Adjusting headlamp pattern The headlamp pattern for halogen headlamps is readjusted by masking the headlamp lens. The headlamp pattern may not be as good. 03 Masking the headlamps G021151 1. Copy the A and B templates for left-hand drive cars or the C and D templates for right-hand drive cars, see the later section "Templates for halogen headlamps": Headlamp pattern, left-hand traffic. • A = LHD Right (left-hand drive, right lens) • • B = LHD Left (left-hand drive, left lens) • D = RHD Left (right-hand drive, left lens) C = RHD Right (right-hand drive, right lens) G021152 2. Transfer the template to a self-adhesive waterproof material and cut it out. 3. Start from the design lines on the headlamp lenses; see the lines in the following figure. Position the self-adhesive templates at the design lines with the help of the illustration. Headlamp pattern, right-hand traffic. 90 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls 03 Upper row: left-hand drive cars, templates A and B. Lower row: right-hand drive cars, templates C and D. }} 91 03 Instruments and controls || Templates for halogen headlamps 03 92 03 Instruments and controls Wipers and washing Wipers and washers clean the windscreen and rear window. The headlamps are cleaned with high-pressure washing. Windscreen wipers23 Intermittent wiping Set the number of sweeps per time unit with the thumbwheel when intermittent wiping is selected. Continuous wiping The wipers sweep at normal speed. IMPORTANT Before activating the wipers during winter ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen in, and that any snow or ice on the windscreen is scraped away. Rain sensor, on/off Thumbwheel sensitivity/frequency Windscreen wipers off Move the stalk switch to position 0 to switch off the windscreen wipers. Single sweep Raise the stalk switch and release to make one sweep. When the rain sensor is activated a lamp in the button illuminates and the rain sensor symbol is shown in the combined instrument panel. Activating and setting the sensitivity The wipers sweep at high speed. Windscreen wipers and windscreen washers. detects on the windscreen. The sensitivity of the rain sensor can be adjusted using the thumbwheel. IMPORTANT Use plenty of washer fluid when the wipers are cleaning the windscreen. The windscreen must be wet when the windscreen wipers are operating. Service position wiper blade For cleaning the windscreen/wiper blades and replacement of wiper blades, see Wiper blades (p. 349) and Car washing (p. 364). Rain sensor* When activating the rain sensor, the car must be running or the remote control key in position I or II while the windscreen wiper stalk switch must be in position 0 or in the position for a single sweep. 03 Activate the rain sensor by pressing the but. The windscreen wipers make one ton sweep. Press the stalk switch up for the wipers to make an extra sweep. Turn the thumbwheel upward for higher sensitivity and downward for lower sensitivity. (An extra sweep is made when the thumbwheel is turned upward.) Deactivate Deactivate the rain sensor by pressing the or move the stalk switch down button to another wiper program. The rain sensor automatically starts the windscreen wipers based on how much water it 23 For replacing the wiper blades and service position wiper blades, see Wiper blades (p. 349). For filling washer fluid, see Washer fluid - filling (p. 351). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. }} 93 03 Instruments and controls || The rain sensor is automatically deactivated when the remote control key is removed from the ignition switch or five minutes after the engine has been switched off. IMPORTANT 03 The windscreen wipers could start and be damaged in an automatic car wash. Switch off the rain sensor while the car is in motion or when the remote control key is in position I or II. The symbol in the combined instrument panel and the light in the button go out. Washing the headlamps and windows Washing the windscreen The windscreen wipers will make several more sweeps and the headlamps are washed once the stalk switch has been released. High-pressure headlamp washing* High-pressure headlamp washing consumes a large quantity of washer fluid. To save fluid, the headlamps are washed automatically at every fifth windscreen wash cycle. Reduced washing Rear window wiper – intermittent wiping If only approx. 1 litre of washer fluid remains in the reservoir and the message that you should fill the washer fluid is shown in the combined instrument panel, then the supply of washer fluid to the headlamps is switched off. This is in order to prioritise cleaning the windscreen and the visibility through it. Rear window wiper – continuous speed Washing function. 94 Wiping and washing the rear window Move the stalk switch toward the steering wheel to start the windscreen and headlamp washers. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Press the stalk switch forward (see the arrow in the illustration above) to initiate rear window washing and wiping. NOTE The rear window wiper is equipped with overheating protection which means that the motor is switched off if it overheats. The rear window wiper works again after a cooling period (30 seconds or longer, depending on the heat in the motor and the outside temperature). 03 Instruments and controls Wiper – reversing Power windows Engaging reverse gear while the windscreen wipers are on initiates intermittent rear window wiping24. The function stops when reverse gear is disengaged. All power windows can be operated using the control panel for the driver's door - the control panels for the other doors operate their respective power window. If the rear window wiper is already on at continuous speed, no change is made. WARNING Check that children or other passengers are not trapped if the windows are closed, even when the remote control key is used. NOTE On cars with rain sensors, the rear wiper is activated during reversing if the sensor is activated and it is raining. Washer fluid - filling (p. 351) Washer fluid - quality and volume (p. 451) 03 WARNING Related information • • WARNING Check that no rear seat passengers are trapped when the windows are closed from the driver's door. Driver's door control panel. Switch for electric child safety locks* and disengaging rear power window buttons; see Child safety locks - electrical activation* (p. 180). If there are children in the car - remember to always switch off the power supply to the power windows by selecting key position 0 and then take the remote control key with you when leaving the car. For information on key positions - see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). Rear window controls Front window controls 24 This function (intermittent wiping when reversing) can be deactivated. Visit a workshop. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 95 03 Instruments and controls || Operating 03 NOTE Operating the power windows. One way to reduce the pulsating wind noise when the rear windows are open is to also open the front windows slightly. Operating without auto Operating without auto Operating with auto Move one of the controls up/down gently. The power windows move up/down as long as the control is held in position. All power windows can be operated using the control panel for the driver's door - the control panels for the other doors can only each operate their respective power window. Only one control panel can be operated at a time. In order for the power windows to be used, the key position must be at least I - see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). The power windows can be operated for a few minutes after the engine has been switched off and after the remote control key has been removed - although not after a door has been opened. Closing of the windows is stopped and the window is opened if anything prevents its 96 movement. It is possible to override the pinch protection when closing has been interrupted, e.g. if there is ice forming. After two successive closing interruptions the pinch protection will be forced and the automatic function deactivated for a short while, now it is possible to close by continually holding the button pulled up. Operating with auto Move one of the controls up/down to the end position and release it. The window runs automatically to its end position. Operating with the remote control key and central locking To remotely operate the power windows from the outside with the remote control key or from inside with central locking, see Remote control key with key blade (p. 159) and Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175). Resetting If the battery is disconnected then the function for automatic opening must be reset so that it can work correctly. 1. Gently raise the front section of the button to raise the window to its end position and hold it there for one second. 2. Release the button briefly. 3. Raise the front section of the button again for one second. WARNING A reset must take place for pinch protection to work. 03 Instruments and controls Door mirrors WARNING The door mirror positions are adjusted with the joystick in the driver's door controls. The mirror on the driver's side is the wideangle type to provide optimal vision. Objects may appear further away than they actually are. Door mirrors Storing the position25 The mirror positions are stored in the key memory when the car has been locked with the remote control key. When the car is unlocked with the same remote control key the mirrors and the driver's seat adopt the stored positions when the driver's door is opened. Door mirror controls. Adjusting 1. Press the L button for the left-hand door mirror or the R button for the right-hand door mirror. The light in the button illuminates. The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Car key memory Personal settings in key memory. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Angling the door mirror when parking25 2. Adjust the position with the joystick in the centre. The door mirror can be angled down for the driver to view the side of the road when parking for example. 3. Press the L or R button again. The light should no longer be illuminated. – Engage reverse gear and press the L or R button. after about 10 seconds, or earlier by pressing the button labelled L or R respectively. Automatic angling of the door mirror when parking25 When reverse gear is engaged the door mirror is automatically angled down so that the driver can see the side of the road when parking for example. When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror automatically returns to its original position after a short time. 03 The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Side mirror settings Tilt left mirror or Tilt right mirror. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Automatic retraction when locking25 When the car is locked/unlocked with the remote control key the door mirrors are automatically retracted/extended. The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Side mirror settings Fold mirrors. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror automatically returns to its original position 25 Only in combination with power seat with memory; see Seats, front - electrically operated (p. 74). }} 97 03 Instruments and controls || Resetting to neutral Mirrors that have been moved out of position by an external force must be reset electrically to the neutral position for electric retracting/ extending to work correctly: Related information • • 1. Retract the mirrors with the L and R buttons. 03 2. Fold them out again with the L and R buttons. Rearview mirror - interior (p. 99) Windows and rearview and door mirrors heating (p. 98) Windows and rearview and door mirrors - heating The defroster is used to quickly remove misting and ice from the windscreen, rear window and door mirrors. Heated windscreen*, rear window and door mirrors 3. Repeat the above procedure as necessary. The mirrors are now reset in neutral position. Retractable power door mirrors* The mirrors can be retracted for parking/driving in narrow spaces: 1. Depress the L and R buttons simultaneously (key position must be at least I). 2. Release them after approximately 1 second. The mirrors automatically stop in the fully retracted position. Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L and R buttons simultaneously. The mirrors automatically stop in the fully extended position. Home safe and approach lighting The lamp on the door mirrors illuminates when approach lighting (p. 89) or home safe lighting (p. 89) is selected. 98 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Heating, windscreen Heating, rear window and door mirrors The function is used to remove ice and misting from the windscreen, rear window and door mirrors. One press of the respective button starts the heating. The light in the button indicates that the function is active. Switch off the heating as soon as the ice/misting is cleared in order not to load the battery unnecessarily. However, the function is switched off automatically after a certain time. 03 Instruments and controls See also Demisting and defrosting the windscreen (p. 136). The door mirrors and rear window are demisted/defrosted automatically if the car is started in an outside temperature lower than +7 °C. Automatic defrosting can be selected in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Climate settings Auto start rear defrost. Select between On or Off. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). Rearview mirror - interior Automatic dimming* The interior rearview mirror can be dimmed with a control in the mirror's lower edge. Alternatively, the rearview mirror dims automatically. Bright light from behind is automatically dimmed by the rearview mirror. The control for manual dimming is not available on mirrors with automatic dimming. Interior rearview mirror The rearview mirror contains two sensors one forward facing and one rearward facing that work together to identify and eliminate dazzling light. The forward facing sensor detects ambient light, while the rearward facing sensor detects the light from vehicle headlights behind. The compass (p. 100) is deactivated when the heated windscreen is activated. When the heated windscreen is deactivated, the compass is reactivated. 03 NOTE If the sensors are obscured by e.g. parking permits, transponders, sun visors or objects in the seats or in the cargo area in such a way that light is prevented from reaching the sensors, then the dimming function of the rearview mirror is reduced. Control for dimming Manual dimming Bright light from behind could be reflected in the rearview mirror and dazzle the driver. Use dimming with the dimming control when lights from behind are distracting: The compass (p. 100) can only be specified for a rearview mirror with automatic dimming. Related information • Door mirrors (p. 97) 1. Use dimming by moving the control in towards the passenger compartment. 2. Return to normal position by moving the control towards the windscreen. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 99 03 Instruments and controls Glass roof* 03 IMPORTANT The glass roof's blind can be operated with the control in the roof console. • Avoid touching the blind because it may then be damaged. The glass roof* is fixed, but the blind can be operated in key position I or II with the control in the roof console. For information on key positions - see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). • Only use the control in the roof console to operate the blind. Compass The rearview mirror contains an integrated display that shows the compass direction in which the front of the car is pointing. Operation Rearview mirror with compass. Automatic opening to end position Manual opening until the button is released Manual closing until the button is released Automatic closing to end position 100 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The upper right-hand corner of the rearview mirror has an integrated display that shows the compass direction in which the front of the car is pointing. Eight different directions are shown with English abbreviations: N (north), NE (north east), E (east), SE (south east), S (south), SW (south west), W (west) and NW (north west). The compass* is activated automatically when the car is started or when key position II is active, see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). To deactivate/activate the compass - press in the button on the rear 03 Instruments and controls side of the mirror using a paper clip for example. Menu navigation - combined instrument panel The compass is deactivated when the heated windscreen is activated. When the heated windscreen is deactivated, the compass is reactivated. The menus shown on the information display in the combined instrument panel (p. 60) are controlled with the left-hand stalk switch. Which menus are shown depends on the key position (p. 71). Calibration 1. Stop the car in a large open area free from steel structures and high-voltage power lines. 2. Start the car. NOTE For the best calibration, switch off all electrical equipment (climate control system, wipers, etc.) and makes sure that all doors are closed. 3. Hold the button on the underside of the rearview mirror depressed approx. 3 seconds. The number of the current magnetic zone is shown. 03 G030295 The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones. The compass is set for the geographic area to which the car was delivered. The compass should be calibrated if the car is moved across several magnetic zones. Proceed as follows: Magnetic zones. 4. Press the button repeatedly until the required magnetic zone (1–15) is shown. See the map of magnetic zones for the compass. 5. Wait until the display returns to showing the character C, or hold the button on the bottom of the rearview mirror depressed for approx. 6 seconds (use e.g. a paper clip) until the character C is shown. Information display (analogue combined instrument panel) and menu navigation controls. 6. Drive slowly in a circle at a speed of no more than 10 km/h until a compass direction is shown in the display, indicating that calibration is complete. Then drive a further 2 circles to fine-tune calibration. 7. Repeat the above procedure as necessary. 101 03 Instruments and controls || 03 Information displays (digital combined instrument panel) and controls for menu navigation. OK - access the menu, acknowledge messages and confirm menu selections. Thumbwheel – browse between menu options. RESET - reset data in the selected trip computer step and go back in the menu structure. If there is a message (p. 103) then it must be acknowledged with OK in order that the menus shall be shown. Related information • • • 26 27 102 Messages - handling (p. 104) Menu overview - analogue combined instrument panel Menu overview - digital combined instrument panel Which menus are shown in the combined instrument panel's information display depends on the key position (p. 71). Which menus are shown in the combined instrument panel's information display depends on the key position (p. 71). Some of the following menu options require the function and hardware to be installed in the car. Some of the following menu options require the function and hardware to be installed in the car. Digital speed Settings* Parking heater* Themes Additional heater* Contrast mode/Colour mode TC options Service status Service status Messages28 Oil level26 Oil level29 Messages (##)27 Parking heater* Related information • Menu navigation - combined instrument panel (p. 101) • Menu overview - digital combined instrument panel (p. 102) • Combined instrument panel (p. 60) Menu overview - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 102) Menu overview - digital combined instrument panel (p. 102) Certain engines. The number of messages is indicated in brackets. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Trip computer reset Related information • Menu navigation - combined instrument panel (p. 101) • Menu overview - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 102) • Combined instrument panel (p. 60) 03 Instruments and controls Messages When a warning, information or indicator symbol illuminates, a corresponding message appears on the information display. Message Specification Stop safelyA Stop and switch off the engine. Serious risk of damage - consult a workshopB. Stop engineA Stop and switch off the engine. Serious risk of damage - consult a workshopB. Message Specification Message Specification Time for regular maintenance Time for regular service contact a workshopB. The timing is determined by the number of kilometres driven, number of months since the last service, engine running time and oil grade. Transmission hot Reduce speed Drive more smoothly or stop the car in a safe manner. Disengage the gear and run the engine at idling speed until the message clearsC. Transmission hot Stop safely Wait for cooling Critical fault. Stop the car immediately in a safe manner and contact a workshopB. Temporarily offA A function has been temporarily switched off and is reset automatically while driving or after starting again. Low battery charge Power save mode The audio system is switched off to save energy. Charge the battery. Maintenance overdue If the service intervals are not followed then the warranty does not cover any damaged parts contact a workshopB. Service urgentA Contact a workshopB to check the car immediately. Transmission Oil change needed Contact a workshopB to check the car as soon as possible. Service requiredA Contact a workshopB to check the car as soon as possible. Transmission Reduced performance See manualA Read the owner's manual. The gearbox cannot handle full capacity. Drive with care until the message clearsC. Book time for maintenance 28 29 Time to book regular service - contact a workshopB. If shown repeatedly contact a workshopB. A B C 03 Part of message, shown together with information on where the problem has arisen. An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. For more messages concerning automatic gearbox. Related information • • Messages - handling (p. 104) Menu navigation - combined instrument panel (p. 101) The number of messages is indicated in brackets. Certain engines. 103 03 Instruments and controls 03 Messages - handling MY CAR MY CAR - operation Use the left-hand stalk switch to acknowledge and browse among messages (p. 103) that are shown in the information display of the combined instrument panel. MY CAR is a menu source that handles many of the car's functions, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. MY CAR is a menu source where many of the car's functions can be handled, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. When a warning, information or indicator symbol illuminates, a corresponding message is shown in the display. An error message is stored in a memory list until the fault has been rectified. Press OK on the left-hand stalk switch to acknowledge30 a message. Scroll through messages with the thumbwheel (p. 101). NOTE If a warning message appears while you are using the trip computer, the message must be read (press OK) before the previous activity can be resumed. Many of the car's features are handled in this menu source, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. Navigation in the menus is carried out using buttons in the centre console or with the steering wheel's right-hand keypad. Certain functions are standard, others are optional - the range also varies depending on the market. Related information • • • MY CAR - operation (p. 104) MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) MY CAR - menu options (p. 106) Related information • Menu overview - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 102) • Menu overview - digital combined instrument panel (p. 102) Centre console controls Centre console controls for menu navigation. Press MY CAR to open the menus under MY CAR. Press OK/MENU to select/tick in the highlighted menu option or to store the selected function in the memory. Turn the TUNE knob to scroll up/down among the menu options. EXIT EXIT functions Depending on the function in which the cursor is located when EXIT is pressed, and at 30 104 A message can also be acknowledged via the thumbwheel or RESET button. 03 Instruments and controls which menu level, one of the following may happen: • • • • • MY CAR - search paths Steering wheel keypad* MY CAR is a menu source that handles many of the car's functions, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. telephone call rejected current function cancelled The current menu level is shown at the top right of the centre console's display screen. The search paths to the menu system's functions are given, e.g. as follows: input characters deleted last selection undone move up in the menu system. Short and long press may produce varying results. A long press takes you to the top menu level (p. 374) (Parent view), from which all car functions/menu sources can be accessed. Settings Car settings Lock settings Doors unlock Driver door, then all. The keypad may vary depending on audio level, see Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372). • • • • The following is an example of how a function can be accessed and adjusted using the steering wheel keypad: Turn the thumbwheel to scroll up/down among the menu options. 1. Press the centre console button MY CAR. Press the thumbwheel to select/tick in the highlighted menu option or to store the selected function in the memory. 2. Scroll to the desired menu, e.g. Settings, with the thumbwheel and then press the thumbwheel - a submenu opens. EXIT (see previous heading "EXIT functions"). 3. Scroll to the desired menu, e.g. Car settings and press the thumbwheel - a submenu opens. Related information MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) MY CAR - menu options (p. 106) 03 4. Scroll to Lock settings and press the thumbwheel - a new submenu opens. 5. Scroll to Doors unlock and press the thumbwheel - a submenu of selectable functions opens. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 105 03 Instruments and controls || 6. Choose between the options All doors and Driver door, then all and press the thumbwheel - a cross is marked in the option's empty box. 7. Exit the programming by backing out of the menus incrementally with short presses on EXIT or with one long press. 03 MY CAR - menu options My V40 MY CAR is a menu source where many of the car's functions can be handled, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. The following options are available first/ uppermost in MY CAR: The procedure is the same for the centre console controls (p. 104): OK/MENU, EXIT and the TUNE knob. Related information • • • • MY CAR (p. 104) My V40 MY CAR - operation (p. 104) MY CAR MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) The display screen shows a grouping of all of the car's driving support systems - these can be activated or deactivated here. MY CAR - menu options (p. 106) • • • • • My V40 Trip statistics DRIVe Support systems Settings Trip statistics MY CAR Trip statistics The screen shows the history as a bar chart with average fuel consumption and average speed, see Trip computer - functions (p. 123). DRIVe MY CAR DRIVe An introduction of Volvo's Start-Stop system is presented here, as well as recommendations for energy-saving driving techniques. 106 03 Instruments and controls • Start/Stop • Eco driving guide For more information - see Start/Stop* (p. 279). Menu level 1 • Volvo On Call, described in a separate manual. Menu level 2 • Information (p. 114) Related information Menu level 3 Driving support systems Menu level 4 Shown here are the 4 first menu levels under MY CAR Settings. Some menus have further submenus - these are then described in detail in their respective sections. • • • • MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - operation (p. 104) MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) MY CAR - search paths (p. 105) 03 When selecting whether a function should be activated/On or deactivated/Off a square is displayed: On: Selected square. Off: Empty square. MY CAR Support systems The display screen shows a summary of the current status of the car's driving support systems. Settings This is how the menus are structured: • Select On/Off with OK - then back out of the menu with EXIT. Menus • • • • • • • Car settings (p. 108) Driving support systems (p. 109) System settings (p. 111) Voice settings (p. 112) Audio settings, see Audio and media general audio settings (p. 377) Climate settings (p. 113) Favourites (p. 376) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 107 03 Instruments and controls MY CAR - Car settings Car settings menu option in the MY CAR menu source handles many of the car's functions, e.g. Car key memory and Lock settings for doors. Car settings 03 Car key memory On See (p. 74) and (p. 97) Keyless entry All doors Any door Both front doors Audible confirmation Off Lock settings Automatic door locking On Off Doors unlock All doors Driver door, then all (p. 162), (p. 168) and (p. 175) (p. 162), (p. 168) and (p. 175) (p. 162), (p. 168) and (p. 175) Reduced Guard Activate once Ask when exiting Side mirror settings (p. 162), (p. 168) and (p. 175) Off Approach light duration (p. 178) and (p. 183) (p. 97) (p. 160) On Off (p. 162) and (p. 89) 30 sec 60 sec 90 sec Home safe light duration Tilt left mirror 30 sec Tilt right mirror 60 sec (p. 89) 90 sec Light settings (p. 87) Triple indicator Floor lights On Ambient light Off Ambient light colours (p. 160) On Unlock confirmation light Fold mirrors Interior light 108 Door lock confirmation light Off Doors on same side On Off (p. 162), (p. 168) and (p. 175) (p. 87) 03 Instruments and controls Temporary LH traffic (p. 90) On Off • • • • • or Temporary RH traffic On • • Off Active bending lights Related information (p. 84) MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109) MY CAR - System options (p. 111) MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) MY CAR - Climate settings (p. 113) MY CAR Information (p. 114) MY CAR - driving support system Driving support systems menu option in the MY CAR menu source handles functions such as e.g. Collision warning system and Lane keeping aid. Driver support systems See Collision Warning (p. 228) Off Warning distance On Normal (p. 77) Short Low Medium Warning sound High Speed in infotainment display On Off (p. 228) Long Off Steering wheel force 03 On (p. 228) On Off (p. 119) Lane Keeping Aid (p. 241) On Off Reset car settings All menus in Car settings are given original factory settings. 109 03 Instruments and controls || On at start-up (p. 241) City Safety On On Off Off Increased sensitivity* (p. 241) BLIS Off Off Assistance alternatives (p. 241) Cross Traffic Alert Off Steering assist only Distance Alert Full function (p. 214) On (p. 188) On Off Driver Alert Off Speed alert (p. 258) On Vibration only Road Sign Information (p. 258) On On 03 (p. 218) (p. 236) On (p. 188) Off On Related information Off DSTC On Off 110 (p. 186) • • • • • * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108) MY CAR - System options (p. 111) MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) • • MY CAR - Climate settings (p. 113) MY CAR Information (p. 114) 03 Instruments and controls MY CAR - System options The system settings menu option in the MY CAR menu source handles functions such as e.g. time and languages. System options See Time (p. 69) The combined instrument panel's clock is adjusted here. Time format Show help text On Voice output volume Off Front park assist volume Explanatory text for the display screen's current content is shown with this option selected. Distance and fuel units MPG (UK) km/l 24 h l/100km Temperature unit On Celsius Off Fahrenheit The display screen's current content fades out after a period of inactivity and is replaced by a blank screen if this option is selected. Rear park assist volume Phone ringing volume (p. 123) MPG (US) 12 h Screen saver Volume levels Selects the unit for the display of outside temperature and setting of the climate control system. (p. 416), (p. 245) and (p. 398) Reset system options 03 All menus in System options are given original factory settings. Related information (p. 135) • • • • • • • • MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108) MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109) MY CAR - System options (p. 111) MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) MY CAR - Climate settings (p. 113) MY CAR Information (p. 114) The current screen content returns if any of the display screen's buttons or controls are actuated. Language Selects language for menu texts. 111 03 Instruments and controls MY CAR - Voice settings Voice settings menu option in the MY CAR menu source manages functions such as Voice tutorial and Command list for voice setting. Voice command list Phone commands Phone Phone call contact Phone dial number Voice settings 03 This menu option + OK provides spoken information about how the system works. Voice training Cancel Voice tutorial The menu options under Phone commands show several examples of available voice commands - only with a Bluetooth®enabled mobile phone installed. For more and detailed information - see Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview (p. 404). The menu options under Navigation commands show several examples of available voice commands in the Navigation system. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. User 2 Navigation go to address General commands Help 112 User 1 Navigation repeat instruction Navigation Voice tutorial Default setting Here there is the option to create a second user profile - an advantage if more than one person shall use the car/system regularly. Default setting restores factory settings. Navigation commands Only in cars with Volvo GPS navigator RTI* - see separate manual. Voice user setting User 1 User 2 With Voice training the voice recognition system is taught to recognise the driver's voice and pronunciation. A number of phrases are presented on the screen for the driver to read aloud. When the system has learnt how the driver talks, the presentation of the phrases stops. Following which e.g. User 1 can be selected in Voice user setting in order that the system shall listen to the right user. 03 Instruments and controls Voice output volume A volume control appears on the screen at which point, proceed as follows: 1. Adjust the volume with the thumbwheel. 2. Test-listen using OK. 3. Use EXIT to store the setting and the menu is switched off. Voice POI list Edit list The number of facilities is extensive and varies depending on market. Maximum 30 favourite facilities can be stored in this list. For more information on Facilities and Voice recognition - see the Navigation system's owner's manual. Related information • • • • • • • MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108) MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109) MY CAR - Climate settings Climate settings menu option in the MY CAR menu source handles functions such as e.g. fan adjustment and recirculation. Climate settings See Automatic blower adjustment (p. 134), (p. 137), (p. 98) and (p. 128) Interior air quality system On Off Reset climate settings Normal High On Off Automatic rear defroster On All menus in Climate settings are given original factory settings. (p. 134), (p. 137), (p. 98) and (p. 128) 03 Related information Low Recirculation timer (p. 134), (p. 137), (p. 98) and (p. 128) (p. 134), (p. 137), (p. 98) and (p. 128) (p. 134), (p. 137), (p. 98) and (p. 128) • • • • • • • MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108) MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109) MY CAR - System options (p. 111) MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) MY CAR Information (p. 114) Off MY CAR - System options (p. 111) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) MY CAR - Climate settings (p. 113) MY CAR Information (p. 114) 113 03 Instruments and controls 03 MY CAR Information Trip computer Information menu option in the MY CAR menu source handles functions such as Number of keys and VIN number. The car's trip computer registers, calculates and displays information. Information See Number of keys (p. 159) VIN number (p. 438) DivX® VOD code (p. 393) Bluetooth software version in car (p. 406) General Checking and settings can be made immediately after the combined instrument panel is automatically illuminated in connection with unlocking. If none of the trip computer's controls are actuated within approx. 30 seconds after the driver's door has been opened then the instrument extinguishes, after which either key position II (p. 71) or engine starting is required in order to operate the trip computer. NOTE Map and software version* If a warning message appears when the trip computer is used then the message must first be acknowledged before the trip computer can be reactivated. Only in cars with Volvo's navigation system* - see separate supplement. • Related information • • • • • • • 114 Acknowledge the message by briefly pressing the indicator stalk OK button. MY CAR (p. 104) MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108) Group menus MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109) The trip computer has two different group menus: MY CAR - System options (p. 111) MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) MY CAR - Climate settings (p. 113) • • Functions Heading in combined instrument panel The trip computer's functions or headings are each listed in an infinite loop. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 115) • Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel (p. 119) • • Trip computer - functions (p. 123) Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124) 03 Instruments and controls Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel The car's trip computer registers, calculates and displays information. Functions Proceed as follows to open and check/adjust functions: 1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of a sequence - "Reset" them first with 2 presses on RESET. 2. Press OK - the loop with all functions opens. 3. Browse through the functions with the thumbwheel and select/confirm with OK. 03 4. Finish by pressing RESET twice after completed checking/ adjustment. The different functions of the trip computer are listed in the following table: Information display and controls. OK - Opens the loop with the trip computer's functions + Activates the selected option. Thumbwheel - Opens the loop with the trip computer's headings + Scrolls through the options. RESET - Undoes, zeroes or backs out of a function after making a selection. }} 115 03 Instruments and controls || Functions Information Digital speed Shows the car's speed digitally in the centre of the combined instrument panel: - km/h • Open with OK, select with the thumbwheel, confirm with OK and go back out with ENTER. mph No display 03 Parking heater* - Direct start For a description of programming the timer, see Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer (p. 141). - Timer 1 - leads to the menu for selecting time. - Timer 2 - leads to the menu for selecting time. Additional heater* For more information, see Additional heater* (p. 143). – Auto On – Off TC options - Distance to empty tank Fuel consumption Average speed - Trip meter T1 and total dist. - Trip meter T2 and total dist. Service status 116 Here you can select/activate the options that you want to be available as selectable headings in the trip computer. The symbols for the items already selected are WHITE with a "tick" - others are GREY and have no "tick": 1. Open the function with OK, scroll through the symbols for the options with the thumbwheel and highlight/stop on the desired symbol. 2. Confirm with OK - the symbol changes colour from GREY to WHITE and is marked with a "tick". 3. Continue to select the function symbols with the thumbwheel or finish with RESET. Shows the number of months and the distance until the next service. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls A Functions Information Oil levelA For more information, see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337). Messages (##) For more information, see Messages (p. 103). Certain engines. Headings One of the headings in the following table can be selected for constant display in the combined instrument panel. Proceed as follows to determine which: 1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of a sequence - "Reset" them first with 2 presses on RESET. 3. Stop on desired heading. 2. Turn the thumbwheel - selectable headings for the trip computer are shown in a loop. Trip computer heading in combined instrument panel Information Trip meter T1 and total dist. • Long press on RESET resets trip meter T1. Trip meter T2 and total dist. • Long press on RESET resets trip meter T2. Distance to empty For more information, see Trip computer (p. 114), "Distance to empty tank". Fuel consumption Current consumption. Average speed • No trip computer information. This option shows a blank display - it also marks the beginning/end of the loop. The combined instrument panel's trip computer can be changed to another option at any time during the journey. Proceed as follows: 03 • Long press on RESET resets Average speed. Turn the thumbwheel - stop on the desired heading. Resetting the trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel Trip meter and Average speed }} 117 03 Instruments and controls || With current trip computer heading - Trip meter T1, Trip meter T2 or Average speed shown in the combined instrument panel: • Give a long press on RESET RESET selected heading is zeroed. Each heading must be zeroed individually. Change unit 03 To change unit (km/miles) for distance and speed - go to MY CAR Settings System options Distance and fuel units, see Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124). Related information 118 • Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel (p. 119) • • Trip computer - functions (p. 123) Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel The car's trip computer registers, calculates and displays information. Functions Proceed as follows to open and check/adjust functions: 1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of a sequence - "Reset" them first with 2 presses on RESET. 2. Press OK - loop with all functions opens. 3. Browse through the functions with the thumbwheel and select/confirm with OK. 03 4. Finish by pressing RESET twice after completed checking/adjustment. The different functions of the trip computer are listed in the following table: Information displays and controls. OK - Opens the loop with the trip computer's functions + Activates the selected option. Thumbwheel - Opens the loop with the trip computer's headings + Scrolls through the options. RESET - Undoes, zeroes or backs out of a function after making a selection. }} 119 03 Instruments and controls || Functions Information Trip computer reset Note that this function does not reset the two trip meters T1 and T2 - see the table under the "Headings" section below. Average Average speed 03 Messages For more information, see Messages (p. 103). Themes The appearance of the combined instrument panel is selected here, see Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61). Settings* Select Auto On or Off. For more information, see Additional heater* (p. 143). Contrast mode/Colour mode Adjusting the combined instrument panel's brightness and colour intensity. Parking heater* For a description of programming the timer, see Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer (p. 141). – Direct start - Symbol Timer 1 - leads to the menu for selecting time. - Symbol Timer 2 - leads to the menu for selecting time. A 120 Service status Shows the number of months and the distance until the next service. Oil levelA For more information, see Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337). Certain engines. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls Headings Three trip computer headings can be displayed simultaneously - one in each "window" (see figure above). play in the combined instrument panel. Proceed as follows to determine which: 1. To ensure that no control is in the middle of a sequence - "Reset" them first with 2 presses on RESET. 2. Turn the thumbwheel - selectable heading combinations are shown in a loop. One of the heading combinations in the following table can be selected for constant dis- 3. Stop on desired heading combination. Heading combinations Information 03 Average Trip meter T1 + Meter reading Average speed • Long press on RESET resets trip meter T1. Instantaneous Trip meter T2 + Meter reading Distance to empty tank • Long press on RESET resets trip meter T2. Instantaneous Meter reading kmh<>mph No trip computer information. The combined instrument panel's heading combination for the trip computer can be changed to another option at any time during the journey. Proceed as follows: • Turn the thumbwheel - stop on the desired heading. Resetting the trip computer - digital combined instrument panel Trip meter Turn with the thumbwheel to the heading combination containing the trip meter to be reset: kmh<>mph - "Digital speed display", see Trip computer - functions (p. 123). This option extinguishes all three trip computer displays - it also marks the beginning/end of the loop. • Give a long press on RESET RESET selected trip meter is zeroed. Change unit To change unit (km/miles) for distance and speed - go to MY CAR Settings System options Distance and fuel units, see Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124). Average speed & Average consumption 1. Select function Trip computer reset and activate with OK. 2. Select one of the following options with the thumbwheel and activate with OK: - l/100 km - km/h - Reset both NOTE In addition to in the trip computer, these units are also changed in Volvo's navigation system*. 3. Finish with RESET. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 121 03 Instruments and controls || Trip meter Turn with the thumbwheel to the heading combination containing the trip meter to be reset: • Give a long press on RESET RESET selected trip meter is zeroed. Related information 03 122 • Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 115) • • Trip computer - functions (p. 123) Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 03 Instruments and controls Trip computer - functions Range - distance to empty tank Change unit The car's trip computer can record, calculate and show information. It describes information such as average consumption and average speed. The trip computer shows the approximate distance that can be driven with the fuel quantity remaining in the tank. To change unit (metric/imperial) for distance and speed - go to MY CAR Settings System options Distance and fuel units, see MY CAR - System options (p. 111). Average Average fuel consumption is calculated from the last resetting. NOTE There may be a slight error in the reading if a fuel-driven heater* has been used. Average speed The average speed is calculated for the driving distance driven since the last reset to zero. Instantaneous. The information for current fuel consumption is updated continuously - approximately once per second. When the car is driven at low speed the consumption is shown per time unit - at a higher speed it is shown related to mileage. Different units (km/miles) can be selected for the display - see the heading "Change unit" further down. 31 No guaranteed range remains when the heading Distance to empty shows "----". • NOTE In which case, refuel as soon as possible. In addition to in the trip computer, these units are also changed in Volvo's navigation system*. The calculation is based on the average fuel consumption over the last 30 km and the remaining driveable fuel quantity. 03 Related information NOTE There may be a slight error in the reading if the driving style has been changed. An economic driving style generally results in a longer driving distance. For more information on how fuel consumption can be influenced, see Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy (p. 20). • Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 115) • Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel (p. 119) • Trip computer - trip statistics* (p. 124) Digital speed display31 The speed is shown in the opposite unit (kmh/mph) of the main instrument panel. If it is calibrated in mph then the trip computer shows the corresponding speed in km/h and vice versa. Only for combined instrument panel "Digital". * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 123 03 Instruments and controls Trip computer - trip statistics* Operation Information is stored about completed trips containing average fuel consumption and average speed, which can be viewed in the centre console's screen as a bar chart. A setting can be defined in the MY CAR menu system: Function MY CAR My V40 Trip statistics: • Start new trip - ENTER is used to delete all previous statistics, back out of the menu by selecting EXIT. • Reset for every driving cycle - highlight 03 the box by selecting ENTER and go back out of the menu by selecting EXIT. With the "Reset for every driving cycle" option highlighted, all statistics are deleted automatically once driving is complete and the car has been stationary for 4 hours. The journey statistics start again from zero the next time the engine is started. Trip statistics32. Each bar symbolises 1 km or 10 km driven distance, depending on the scale selected the bar at the far right shows the value for the current kilometre or 10 km. With the TUNE wheel, the scale of each block can be switched between 1 km and 10 km the cursor at the far right shifts position between up and down depending on the scale selected. 32 124 If a new drive cycle begins before 4 hours have passed, the current period has to be deleted manually first using the "Start new trip" option. See also information on Eco guide (p. 64). Related information • Trip computer - analogue combined instrument panel (p. 115) • Trip computer - digital combined instrument panel (p. 119) • Trip computer - functions (p. 123) The figure is schematic - layout may vary depending on updated software and market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. CLIMATE CONTROL 04 Climate control General information on climate control • Remove misting on the insides of the windows primarily by using the defroster function (p. 136). To reduce the risk of misting, keep the windows clean and use window cleaner. The car is equipped with electronic climate control. The climate control system cools or heats as well as dehumidifies the air in the passenger compartment. • There are two different climate control systems: In warm weather, condensation from the air conditioning may drip under the car. This is normal. • When the engine requires full power, e.g. for full acceleration or driving uphill with a trailer, the air conditioning can be temporarily switched off. There may then be a temporary increase in temperature in the passenger compartment. • With an auto-stopped engine (p. 279) (cars with Start/Stop*), certain equipment has its function temporarily reduced, e.g. the climate control system's air conditioning and fan speed. • Electronic temperature control (ETC) (p. 132) • Electronic climate control (ECC) (p. 131) 04 NOTE The air conditioning system (AC) can be switched off, but to ensure the best possible climate comfort in the passenger compartment and to prevent the windows from misting, it should always be on. Related information To bear in mind: • To ensure that the air conditioning works optimally, the side windows must be closed. • Total airing function (p. 176) opens or closes all side windows simultaneously and can be used for example to quickly air the car during hot weather. • 1 126 Remove ice and snow from the climate control system air intake (the grille between the bonnet and the windscreen). • • • • • • • • Only applies to ECC. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Actual temperature (p. 126) Sensors - climate control (p. 127) Menu settings - climate control (p. 129) Air conditioning (p. 135) Air distribution in the passenger compartment (p. 129) Air cleaning (p. 127) Heated front seats* (p. 133) Heated rear seat* (p. 133) Actual temperature The temperature you select in the passenger compartment corresponds to the physical experience with reference to factors such as air speed, humidity and solar radiation etc. in and around the car. The system includes a sun sensor (p. 127) which detects on which side the sun is shining into the passenger compartment. This means1 that the temperature can differ between the right and left-hand air vents despite the controls being set for the same temperature on both sides. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Temperature control in the passenger compartment (p. 135) 04 Climate control Sensors - climate control Air cleaning The climate control system has a number of sensors to help control the temperature (p. 126) in the car. The interior in a passenger compartment is designed to be pleasant and comfortable, even for people with contact allergies and for asthma sufferers. • The sun sensor is located on the top side of the dashboard. • The temperature sensor for the passenger compartment is located below the climate control panel. • The outside temperature sensor is located in the door mirror. NOTE Do not cover or block the sensors with clothing or other objects. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • • Passenger compartment filter (p. 127) Material in the passenger compartment (p. 129) • Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP) (p. 128)* • Interior Air Quality System (IAQS) (p. 128)* Air cleaning - passenger compartment filter All air entering the car's passenger compartment is cleaned with a filter. The filter must be replaced at regular intervals. Follow the Volvo Service Programme for the recommended replacement intervals. If the car is used in a severely contaminated environment, it may be necessary to replace the filter more often. NOTE There are different types of passenger compartment filter. Make sure that the correct filter is fitted. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) 04 Related information • Air cleaning (p. 127) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 127 04 Climate control Air cleaning - Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)* For more information on CZIP, see the brochure included with the purchase of the car. CZIP comprises a series of modifications that keep the passenger compartment even clearer from allergy and asthma-inducing substances. Related information The following is included: • 04 • • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Air cleaning (p. 127) An enhanced fan function that means that the fan starts when the car is opened with the remote control key. The fan fills the passenger compartment with fresh air. The function starts when required and is disengaged automatically after a time or when one of the passenger compartment doors is opened. If the outside air is contaminated then the air intake is closed in order to shut out hydrocarbons, nitrous oxides and ground-level ozone. The air is recirculated in the passenger compartment. Activate/deactivate the function in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Climate settings Interior air quality system. NOTE The air quality system IAQS (p. 128) is a fully automatic system that cleans the air in the passenger compartment from contaminants such as particles, hydrocarbons, nitrous oxides and ground-level ozone. NOTE To maintain the CZIP standard in cars with CZIP the IAQS filter should be changed after 15 000 km or once per year depending on whichever occurs first. However, up to 75 000 km over 5 years. In cars without CZIP and where the customer does not want to retain the CZIP standard, the IAQS filter must be replaced during a regular service. 128 Air cleaning - IAQS* The air quality system IAQS separates gases and particles to reduce the levels of odours and pollution in the passenger compartment. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The air quality sensor must always be enabled to ensure the best air in the passenger compartment. In a cold climate, automatic recirculation is limited so as to prevent misting. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • • Air cleaning (p. 127) Air cleaning - Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)* (p. 128) 04 Climate control Air cleaning - material Menu settings - climate control Tested materials have been developed in order to minimise the quantity of dust in the passenger compartment and to contribute to making the passenger compartment easier to keep clean. It is possible to activate/deactivate or change the default settings for four of the climate control system's functions via the centre console. The carpets in both the passenger compartment and the cargo area are removable and easy to remove and clean. Use cleaning agents and car care products recommended by Volvo to clean the interior (p. 367). Related information • Air cleaning (p. 127) • • • • Air distribution in the passenger compartment The incoming air is divided between a number of different vents in the passenger compartment. Fan level during automatic climate control (p. 134)*. Recirculation timer (p. 137). Automatic start of rear window defroster (p. 98). Interior air quality system (p. 128)*. More information is available in the description of the menu system (p. 104). The climate control system's functions can be reset to the default settings via the menu system in MY CAR and this is carried out under: Settings Climate settings Reset climate settings. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) 04 Air distribution is fully automatic in AUTO mode*. If necessary it can be controlled manually; see the air distribution table (p. 138). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 129 04 Climate control || Air vents in the dashboard 04 Open Air distribution - defroster windscreen Closed Air distribution - air vent instrument panel Lateral airflow Air distribution - ventilation floor Vertical airflow Aim the vents at the side windows to remove misting. NOTE Remember that small children may be sensitive to air flows and draughts. 130 Air distribution The figure consists of three buttons. When pressing the buttons the corresponding figure is illuminated in the display screen (see figure below) and an arrow in front of each part of the figure shows the air distribution that is selected. For more information, see the air distribution table (p. 138). The selected air distribution is shown in the centre console display screen. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • • Auto-regulation (p. 134) Air distribution - recirculation (p. 137) 04 Climate control Electronic climate control - ECC* ECC (Electronic Climate Control) maintains the temperature selected in the passenger compartment and can be set separately for the driver's side and passenger side. The auto function is used to automatically control temperature, air conditioning, fan speed, recirculation and air distribution. 04 Fan (p. 134) AUTO - Automatic climate control (p. 134) Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), left side Heated windscreen and max. defroster (p. 136)* Rear window and door mirror defrosters (p. 98) Setting, left/right-hand side for temperature control (p. 135) Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), right side Temperature control (p. 135) Air distribution (p. 129) - ventilation floor Recirculation (p. 137) Air distribution - air vent instrument panel AC - Air conditioning on/off (p. 135) Air distribution - defroster windscreen * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 131 04 Climate control Electronic temperature control - ETC The passenger compartment's climate comfort is controlled manually using the ETC (Electronic Temperature Control). 04 Fan (p. 134) Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), left side AC - Air conditioning on/off (p. 135) Heated windscreen and max. defroster* Air distribution (p. 129) - ventilation floor Air distribution - air vent instrument panel Air distribution - defroster windscreen 132 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Rear window and door mirror defrosters (p. 98) Recirculation (p. 137) Electrically heated front seat (p. 133), right side Temperature control (p. 135) 04 Climate control Heated front seats* • The front seat heating has three positions for increasing the comfort for driver and passenger when it is cold. Lowest heat level - one orange field illuminates in the screen. • Switch off the heat - no field illuminates. WARNING Heated rear seat* The heating for the rear seat's outer positions has three positions for increasing the comfort for passengers when it is cold. Heated seats must not be used by people who find it difficult to perceive an increase in temperature due to a lack of sensation or who otherwise have problems operating the controls for the heated seats. Otherwise they may suffer burn injuries. Related information Current heat level is shown in the centre console display screen. • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Heated rear seat* (p. 133) 04 Current heat level is shown in the pushbutton's lamps: Press the button repeatedly in order to activate the function: • Press the button repeatedly in order to activate the function: • Highest heat level - three orange fields illuminate in the centre console's screen (see figure above). • Lower heat level - two orange fields illuminate in the screen. • • • Highest heat level - three lamps illuminate. Lower heat level - two lamps illuminate. Lowest heat level - one lamp illuminates. Switch off the heat - no lamp illuminates. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 133 04 Climate control || WARNING Heated seats must not be used by people who find it difficult to perceive an increase in temperature due to a lack of sensation or who otherwise have problems operating the controls for the heated seats. Otherwise they may suffer burn injuries. Fan Auto-regulation The fan should always be activated in order to avoid misting on the windows. Auto-regulation is only possible in electronic climate control (ECC) (p. 131). The auto function automatically regulates temperature (p. 135), air conditioning (p. 135), fan speed (p. 134), recirculation (p. 137) and air distribution (p. 129). NOTE If the fan is fully switched off then the air conditioning is not engaged - which can cause a risk of misting on the windows. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Heated front seats* (p. 133) ECC* Turn the knob to increase or decrease fan speed, AUTO is disengaged. If AUTO is selected, then the fan speed is regulated automatically (p. 134) - the fan speed previously set is disengaged. 04 ETC Turn the knob to increase or decrease fan speed. If you select one or more manual functions, the other functions continue to be controlled automatically. All manual settings are disengaged when AUTO is pressed. The display screen shows AUTO CLIMATE. Fan speed in automatic mode can be set in the menu system MY CAR under: Settings Climate settings Automatic blower adjustment. Choose between Low, Normal or High: • Low - Automatic fan control. Low airflow is prioritised. • Normal - Automatic fan control. • High - Automatic fan control. A more Related information 134 • General information on climate control (p. 126) • • Electronic climate control - ECC* (p. 131) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Electronic temperature control - ETC (p. 132) intense airflow is prioritised. More information is available in the description of the menu system (p. 104). Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) 04 Climate control Temperature control in the passenger compartment When the car is started, the most recent temperature setting is resumed. NOTE Heating or cooling cannot be hastened by selecting a higher or lower temperature than the actual desired temperature. ECC* The temperatures on the driver and passenger sides can be set independently. Repeatedly press L/R in the button to select the setting for left, right or both sides. Set the temperature using the knob - the selected temperature for either side is displayed in the centre console display. ETC The temperature in the passenger compartment can be adjusted with the knob. Air conditioning The air conditioning cools and dehumidifies incoming air as required. When the lamp in the AC button illuminates, the air conditioning is controlled by the system's automatic function. When the lamp in the AC button is switched off the air conditioning is disconnected. Other functions are still controlled automatically. When the max. defroster function (p. 136) is activated, the air conditioning is switched on automatically so that the air is dehumidified at the maximum setting. 04 Related information Current temperature for each side is shown in the centre console's display screen. • General information on climate control (p. 126) • • Actual temperature (p. 126) • Electronic climate control - ECC* (p. 131) Electronic temperature control - ETC (p. 132) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 135 04 Climate control Demisting and defrosting the windscreen Heated windscreen* and max. defroster are used to quickly remove misting and ice from the windscreen and side windows. For cars without heated windscreens: • Air flows to the windows - symbol (2) illuminates in the screen. • Switch off the function - no symbol illuminates. For cars with heated windscreens: 04 • Start the heating for the symbol (1) illuminates in the screen. • Start the heating for the windscreen2 and air flow to the windows - symbols (1) and (2) illuminate in the screen. • Switch off the function - no symbol illuminates. windscreen2 NOTE Electrically heated windscreen is not available when the engine is auto-stopped (p. 279). The following also takes place when the function is active in order to provide maximum dehumidification in the passenger compartment: • the air conditioning is automatically engaged • recirculation and the air quality system are automatically disengaged. NOTE NOTE The selected setting is shown in the centre console display screen. Electric heating* Heated windscreen and IR window (p. 18) may have an impact on the performance of transponders and other communication equipment. Max. defroster The light in the defroster button illuminates when the function is active. NOTE A triangular area at the end of each side of the windscreen is not electrically heated, where de-icing may take longer. Press the button repeatedly in order to activate the function. 2 136 The compass goes off when the heated windscreen is active. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The noise level increases as the fan is operating at max. When the defroster is switched off the climate control returns to the previous settings. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) 04 Climate control Air distribution - recirculation Select recirculation to shut out bad air, exhaust gases etc. from the passenger compartment, i.e. no outside air is taken into the car when this function is activated. When recirculation is engaged the orange lamp in the button illuminates. IMPORTANT Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Air distribution in the passenger compartment (p. 129) • Air distribution - table (p. 138) 04 If the air in the car recirculates for too long, there is a risk of misting on the insides of the windows. Timer With the timer function activated the system will exit manually activated recirculation mode according to a time that depends on the outside temperature. This reduces the risk of ice, misting and bad air. Activate/deactivate the function in the menu system (p. 104) MY CAR under Settings Climate settings Recirculation timer. NOTE When max. defroster is selected, recirculation is always deactivated. 137 04 Climate control Air distribution - table Three buttons are used to select the distribution (p. 129) of the air. 04 138 Air distribution Use A large amount of hot air flows to the windows. to remove ice and misting quickly. Air to windscreen, via defroster vent, and side windows. Some air flows from the air vents. to prevent misting and icing in a cold and humid climate, (not at too low fan speed to enable this). Airflow to windows and from dashboard air vents. to ensure good comfort in warm, dry weather. Airflow to the head and chest from the dashboard air vents. to ensure efficient cooling in warm weather. 04 Climate control Air distribution Use Air to the floor and windows. Some air flows from the dashboard air vents. to ensure comfortable conditions and good demisting in cold or humid weather. Air to floor and from dashboard air vents. in sunny weather with cool outside temperatures. 04 Air to floor. Some air flows to the dashboard air vents and windows. to direct heat or cold to the floor. Airflow to windows, from dashboard air vents and to the floor. to provide cooler air along the floor or warmer air higher up in cold weather or hot, dry weather. Related information • General information on climate control (p. 126) • Air distribution - recirculation (p. 137) 139 04 Climate control Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* Refuelling Preconditioning prepares the car's heater, engine and passenger compartment before departure so that both wear and energy needs during the journey are reduced. Warming up your car will also extend the driving distance. appears in the display. Acknowledge the message by pressing the indicator stalk (p. 101) OK button once. IMPORTANT Repeated use of the heater in combination with short driving distances may cause low charge level in the starter battery, this can lead to the heater stopping or never starting. In the worst case, engine starting will not be possible. The heater can be started directly (p. 141) or with a timer (p. 141). 04 The heater cannot start if the outside temperature exceeds 15 °C. At –5 °C or lower the maximum running time of the heater is 50 minutes. WARNING Do not use the fuel-driven heater indoors. Exhaust gases are secreted. NOTE When the fuel-driven auxiliary heater is active there may be smoke from underneath the car, which is perfectly normal. Warning label on fuel filler flap. WARNING Fuel which spills out could be ignited. Switch off the fuel-driven auxiliary heater before starting to refuel. Check in the combined instrument panel that the heater is switched off. The heat symbol is shown when it is operating. Parking on a hill If the car is parked on a steep hill, the front of the car should point downhill to ensure that there is a supply of fuel to the fuel-driven heater. Battery and fuel If the battery has insufficient charge or the fuel level is too low, the heater will be switched off automatically and a message 140 The car should be driven for the same time as the heater is used to ensure that the starter battery is recharged adequately to replace the energy consumed by the heater when it is used on a regular basis. The heater is used for a maximum of 50 minutes each time. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - messages (p. 142) • Additional heater* (p. 143) 04 Climate control Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - direct start/ immediate stop Upon direct start of the engine block and passenger compartment heater (p. 140), it will run for 50 minutes. Heating of the passenger compartment will begin as soon as the engine coolant has reached the correct temperature. NOTE The car can be started and driven while the heater is running. 1. Press OK to access the menu. Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer 7. Select the required minute using the thumbwheel. The timer of the engine block and passenger compartment heater (p. 140) is connected to the car's clock. 8. Press OK3 to confirm the setting. Two different times can be selected using the timer. Here, time refers to the time when the car is heated and ready. The car's electronic system calculates when heating should be started based on the outside temperature. NOTE All timer programming will be cleared if the car's clock is reset. 9. Go back in the menu structure using RESET. 10. Select the other time (continue from step 2) or exit the menu with RESET. Starting 1. Press OK to access the menu. 2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking heater and select with OK. 2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking heater and select with OK. Adjusting 4. Exit the menu with RESET. 1. Press OK to access the menu. 3. Scroll forward in the next menu to Direct start/Stop in order to activate/deactivate the heater and select with OK. Switching off 2. Scroll with the thumbwheel (p. 101) to Parking heater and select with OK. A timer-started heater can be switched off manually before the set time has elapsed. Proceed as follows: 4. Exit the menu with RESET. Related information • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer (p. 141) • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - messages (p. 142) 3 3. Select one of the two timers using the thumbwheel and confirm with OK. 1. Press OK to access the menu. 4. Briefly press OK to move to the lit hours setting. 5. Select the required hour using the thumbwheel. 6. Briefly press OK to move to the lit minutes setting. 04 3. Select one of the two timers using the thumbwheel and activate with OK. 2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Parking heater and select with OK. > If a timer is set but not activated, a clock icon is shown next to the set time. 3. Select one of the two timers using the thumbwheel and confirm with OK. Press OK again to activate the timer. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 141 04 Climate control || 4. Deactivate the timer as follows: • • long press on OK or short press on OK to continue in the menu. Then select to stop the timer and confirm with OK. 5. Exit the menu with RESET. Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - messages Symbols and messages regarding the engine block and passenger compartment heater (p. 140) differ depending on whether the combined instrument panel is analogue (p. 60) or digital (p. 61). A timer-started heater can be switched off directly (p. 141). 04 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - messages (p. 142) Display The heater's timer is activated after the remote control key has been removed from the ignition switch and leaving the car the engine and passenger compartment are heated at the set time. When one of the timers is activated the symbol for activated timer illuminates in the information display at the same time as the set time is shown next to the symbol. Symbol for activated timer in analogue combined instrument panel. Symbol for activated timer in digital combined instrument panel. The table shows symbols and display texts that appear. 142 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Specification The heater is switched on and running. When the heater has been activated the heat symbol illuminates in the information display. Related information • Symbol Fuel operated heater stopped Battery saving mode The heater has been stopped by the car's electronics in order to facilitate starting the engine. 04 Climate control Symbol Display Specification Fuel operated heater stopped Low fuel level Setting the heater is not possible due to fuel level being too low - this is in order to facilitate starting the engine as well as approx. 50 km driving. Fuel operated heater Service required Heater not working. Contact a workshop for repair. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. Additional heater* Fuel-driven additional heater* For cars with diesel engines sold in cold climate zones4 an additional heater may be required to obtain the correct operating temperature in the engine and to obtain sufficient heating in the passenger compartment. The car is equipped with either an electric (p. 144) or a fuel-driven additional heater (p. 143). electric additional heater (p. 144) or Related information • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* (p. 140) Related information • 4 5 NOTE fuel-driven additional heater (p. 143)5. A display text clears automatically after a time or after one press on the indicator stalk (p. 101) OK button. • The heater is switched off automatically when the correct temperature is reached or when the engine is switched off. In such instances, the car is equipped with either • • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - direct start/immediate stop (p. 141) The heater starts automatically when extra heat is required when the engine is running. When the auxiliary heater is active there may be smoke from underneath the car, which is perfectly normal. 04 Auto mode or shutdown The additional heater's automatic start sequence can be switched off if required. NOTE Volvo recommends that the fuel-driven additional heater should be switched off for short distances. 1. Before starting the engine: Select key position I (p. 71). 2. Press OK to access the menu. Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* - timer (p. 141) An authorised Volvo dealer has information regarding the geographical areas concerned. For cars equipped with parking heater (p. 140). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 143 04 Climate control || 3. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Additional heater6 or Settings7 and select with OK. 4. Select one of the options ON or OFF using the thumbwheel and confirm with OK. 5. Exit the menu with RESET. NOTE The menu options are only visible in key position I - any adjustments must therefore be made before starting the engine. 04 Related information • 6 7 144 Electric additional heater* The car is equipped with either a fuel-driven (p. 143) or an electric additional heater (p. 143). The heater cannot be controlled manually but is instead activated automatically after the engine has been started in outside temperatures below 9 °C and is switched off after the set passenger compartment temperature has been reached. Related information • Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* (p. 140) Analogue combined instrument panel. Digital combined instrument panel. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* (p. 140) LOADING AND STORAGE 05 Loading and storage Storage spaces Overview of storage spaces in the passenger compartment. 05 146 05 Loading and storage Storage compartment1 in door panel Storage compartment, driver’s side (p. 148) Ticket clip Storage compartment Glovebox (p. 149) Storage compartment, cup holder (p. 148) Jacket holder (p. 148) Cup holder* in rear seat Storage pocket2 Storage compartment, rear seat 05 WARNING Keep loose objects such as mobile phones, cameras, remote controls for accessories, etc. in the glove compartment or other compartments. Otherwise they may injure people in the car in the event of sudden braking or a collision. 1 2 With ice scraper holder on the driver’s side. Not applicable to textile upholstery. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 147 05 Loading and storage Storage compartment driver’s side Jacket holder Tunnel console This storage compartment (p. 146) is located on the driver's side, to the left under the lighting panel. The coat hanger is located on the left-hand side of the passenger seat's head restraint. The tunnel console is located between the front seats. WARNING Do not keep any sharp objects in the compartment, or objects which protrude. The jacket holder is only designed for light clothing. Related information • Storage spaces (p. 146) Storage compartment (e.g. for CDs) and USB*/AUX input under the armrest. 05 Includes cup holder for driver and passenger. (If ashtray and cigarette lighter (p. 149) are specified, then there is a cigarette lighter in the 12 V socket (p. 151) for the front seat and a detachable ashtray in the cup holder.) Related information • • 148 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Storage spaces (p. 146) Tunnel console - armrest (p. 149) 05 Loading and storage Tunnel console - armrest The tunnel console is located between the front seats. When closed, the tunnel console's armrest can be adjusted* longitudinally. Related information • • Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets (p. 151) Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ashtray* (p. 149) Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ashtray* A detachable ashtray is fitted in the cup holder under the armrest. The cigarette lighter is fitted in the 12 V socket (p. 151) for the front seat. The ashtray in the tunnel console (p. 148) is detached by lifting the tray straight up. Activate the lighter by pushing in the button. The button pops out when the lighter is hot. Pull out the lighter and light a cigarette on the heated coils. Glovebox The glovebox is located on the passenger side. The owner's manual and maps can be kept in here for example. There are also holders for pens on the inside of the lid. The glovebox can be locked (p. 176)* using the key blade (p. 166). Related information • • Storage spaces (p. 146) Glovebox - cooling (p. 150) Related information • Storage spaces (p. 146) 05 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 149 05 Loading and storage Glovebox - cooling Inlay mats* Vanity mirror The glovebox (p. 149) can also be used as a cooled area3. Inlay mats collect e.g. rubbish and slush. Volvo supplies specially manufactured inlay mats. The vanity mirror is located on the rear of the sun visor. WARNING Before setting off check that the inlaid mat in the driver area is firmly affixed and secured in the pins in order to avoid getting caught adjacent to and under the pedals. Related information • 05 150 Vanity mirror with lighting. Start cooling by moving the control in towards the passenger compartment to the end position. The light illuminates automatically when the cover is lifted. Switch off the cooling by moving the control forwards to the end position. Related information Cooling is active when the climate control system is active (i.e. when the key is in key position (p. 71) II) or the engine is running. 3 Cleaning the interior (p. 367) Applicable only to cars with ECC. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting (p. 348) 05 Loading and storage Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets The electrical sockets (12 V) are located in the tunnel console's storage compartment and beside the cup holder4. Related information NOTE Optional equipment and accessories - e.g. display screens, music players and mobile phones - which are connected to one of the passenger compartment's 12V electrical sockets could be activated by the climate control system, even when the remote control key has been removed or when the car is locked, for example, when the engine block and passenger compartment heater* is activated at a preset time. • Tunnel console - cigarette lighter and ashtray* (p. 149) • 12 V socket - cargo area (p. 155) For this reason remove the plugs from the electrical sockets for optional equipment or accessories when not in use because the battery could be drained in the event of such an occurrence! 12 V socket in tunnel console, front seat. The electrical sockets can be used for various accessories designed for 12 V, e.g. display screens, music players and mobile phones. For the sockets to supply current, the remote control key must be in at least key position I (p. 71). WARNING Always leave the plug in the socket when the socket is not in use. 4 IMPORTANT 05 Max. power takeoff is 10 A (120 W) in either socket. NOTE The compressor for emergency puncture repair (p. 324) has been tested and approved by Volvo. For information on the use of Volvo's recommended temporary emergency puncture repair (TMK). If ashtray and cigarette lighter are specified then there is no cup holder and adjacent 12 V socket. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 151 05 Loading and storage Loading • Secure all loads to the load retaining eyelets with straps or web lashings. Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The total of the weight of the passengers and all accessories reduces the car's payload by a corresponding weight. For more detailed information on weights, see Weights (p. 441). The tailgate is opened via a button on the lighting panel or the remote control key, see Locking/unlocking tailgate (p. 176). WARNING The car’s driving properties change depending on the weight and positioning of the load. 05 To bear in mind when loading • Position the load firmly against the rear seat's backrest. Note that objects must not prevent the function of the WHIPS system for the front seats if any of the rear seat's backrests is folded down, see WHIPS - seating position (p. 36). 152 • • Centre the load. • Cover sharp edges with something soft to avoid damaging the upholstery. Heavy objects should be placed as low as possible. Avoid placing heavy loads on lowered backrests. WARNING A loose object weighing 20 kg can, in a frontal collision at a speed of 50 km/h, carry the impact of an item weighing 1000 kg. WARNING The protection provided by the inflatable curtain in the headlining may be compromised or eliminated by high loads. • Never load cargo above the backrest. WARNING Always secure the load. Always secure the load. During heavy braking the load may otherwise shift, causing personal injury to the car's occupants. Cover sharp edges and sharp corners with something soft. Switch off the engine and apply the parking brake when loading/unloading long items. Otherwise you may accidentally knock the gear lever or gear selector with the load into a drive position - and the car could then move off. Related information • • • • Load retaining eyelets (p. 153) Cargo net (p. 155) Loading - long load (p. 153) Roof load (p. 153) 05 Loading and storage Loading - long load Roof load Load retaining eyelets To simplify loading in the cargo area, the rear seat backrest can be folded down. The passenger seat backrest can also be folded for an extra long load. The load carriers recommended for roof loads are the ones developed by Volvo. This is in order to avoid damage to the car and in order to achieve the maximum possible safety during a journey. The load retaining eyelets are used to fasten straps in order to anchor items in the cargo area. Folding the passenger seat See (p. 73). Lowering the rear seat backrest Carefully follow the installation instructions supplied with the carriers. See (p. 76). • Load carriers must always be mounted on the aluminium rail. Related information • Check periodically that the load carriers and load are properly secured. Lash the load securely with retaining straps. • Distribute the load evenly over the load carriers. Put the heaviest objects at the bottom. • The size of the area exposed to the wind, and therefore fuel consumption, increase with the size of the load. • Drive gently. Avoid quick acceleration, heavy braking and hard cornering. • Loading (p. 152) WARNING Hard, sharp and/or heavy objects which protrude may cause injury under violent braking. Always secure large and heavy objects with a seatbelt or cargo retaining straps. WARNING The car's centre of gravity and driving characteristics are altered by roof loads. For information about the maximum permitted load on the roof, including load carriers and any space box, see Weights (p. 441). 05 Related information • Loading (p. 152) Related information • Loading (p. 152) 153 05 Loading and storage Loading - bag holder Loading - folding bag holder* The bag holders keep carrier bags in place and prevent them from overturning and spreading their contents around the cargo area. The holder has a capacity of max. 3 kg. A folding bag holder in the floor keeps bags in place and prevents them from overturning and spreading their contents in the cargo area, and can be opened up in three positions. Raising Lift the handle* on the upper floor and fold up the floor. 05 Bag holder Related information • • Loading (p. 152) Loading - folding bag holder* (p. 154) Folding bag holder It can be set to two adjustment positions and one service position, as it is known, where it is fully unfolded. There are also two floor combination variants, one with adjustment positions in a tub under the floor and one with adjustment positions in plastic rails. The raising below shows the adjustment position in a tub under the floor. The load on the central holder is max. 3 kg and max. 10 kg on the outer holder. 154 Move the floor forwards to an appropriate position and place it in the adjustment groove. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 3. In service position, the floor is moved all the way forwards towards the rear seat back and placed in the plastic support in the centre. Related information • • Loading (p. 152) Loading - bag holder (p. 154) 05 Loading and storage 12 V socket - cargo area Cargo net NOTE The electrical socket can be used for various accessories designed for 12 Volts, e.g. display screens, music players and mobile phones. The compressor for temporary emergency puncture repair has been tested and approved by Volvo. For information on the use of Volvo's recommended temporary emergency puncture repair (TMK), see Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324). A cargo net prevents cargo from being thrown forward in the passenger compartment in the event of heavy braking. Related information • Tunnel console - 12 V-sockets (p. 151) The cargo net is fitted into four mounting points. Lower the cover to access the electrical socket. • The socket also provides voltage when the remote control key is not in the ignition switch. IMPORTANT Max. socket current is 10 A (120 W). 05 For safety reasons, the cargo net must always be correctly fastened and secured. The mesh is made of a strong nylon fabric and secured behind the front seat backrests. WARNING Loads in the luggage compartment must be anchored well, and also have a correctly fitted safety net. NOTE Remember that using the electrical socket with the engine switched off involves the risk of discharging the car's battery. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 155 05 Loading and storage || Attaching NOTE The easiest way to fit the safety net is via one of the rear doors. WARNING It is necessary to ensure that the upper securing points of the safety net are fitted correctly and that the puller-straps are secured properly. Damaged nets must not be used. 05 156 1. Unfold the cargo net and make sure that the split upper rod is locked in the extended position. 2. Hook one end of the rod into the roof mounting with the anchoring strap locks turned towards you. 3. Hook the other end of the rod into the roof mounting on the opposite side - the telescopic spring-loaded retaining hooks facilitate alignment. Take care to press forward the rod's retaining hooks for each respective roof mounting's front end position. 4. Hook the cargo net's anchoring straps into the eyes on the rear of the seat slide rails - it is easier if the backrests are straightened and the seats are moved forward slightly. Pay attention to make sure that you do not press the seat/backrest hard against the net when the seat/backrest is moved back again - only adjust until the seat/ backrest makes contact with the net. IMPORTANT If a seat/backrest is pushed backwards hard into the safety net then the net and/or its roof mounts may be damaged. 5. Tension the cargo net with the anchoring straps. 05 Loading and storage Removal and storage The folded cargo net is stored in its bag in the cargo area. Hat shelf The hat shelf can be removed to provide additional cargo space. Hat shelf removal The cargo net can be easily removed and folded up. Release the tension in the net by pressing in the button on the anchoring strap's lock and feeding out part of the strap. Related information • • Loading (p. 152) Load retaining eyelets (p. 153) Undo the hat shelf lifting eyes on both sides. Press in the catch and detach both of the anchoring strap's hooks. Unhook the rod from its roof mounting by pulling back on the rod in the roof mountings' rear end position. Press the rod in any direction so that the hook engages in the rod, which at the same time releases the hook on the other side. 05 Unhook the front edge of the hat shelf and remove it. Related information • • Loading (p. 152) Loading - long load (p. 153) Finally, remove the remaining roof mounting hook from the roof mounting. 4. Break the rod in the centre, fold it together and roll up the net. Insert the net in the storage bag. 157 LOCKS AND ALARM 06 Locks and alarm Remote control key with key blade The remote control key is used to start the car and for locking and unlocking. It contains a detachable key blade (p. 165) made of metal. The visible section is available in two versions so that it is possible to distinguish between the remote control keys. The car is supplied with two remote control keys - standard or withkeyless function (p. 168). They are used to start/switch off the engine and for locking/unlocking. Additional remote control keys can be ordered - up to six can be programmed and used for the same car. Variants WARNING If there are children in the car: Remember to switch off the supply to the power windows by removing the remote control key if the driver leaves the car. Related information • Remote control key - function (p. 162) Remote control key/PCC - losing If you lose a remote control key (p. 159) then a new one can be ordered at a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The remaining remote control keys must be taken to the Volvo workshop. The code of the missing remote control key must be erased from the system as a theft prevention measure. The current number of keys registered to the car can be checked in MY CAR (p. 104) under Information Number of keys. Related information • • Remote control key - function (p. 162) Remote control key - range (p. 163) There are four remote control key variants: • • • • Remote control key, standard1 Remote control key with Keyless start1 Remote control key with Keyless drive1 PCC with Keyless drive 2 06 PCC plus remote control key with keyless function has extended functionality compared to the standard remote control key. 1 2 5-button key 6-button key 159 06 Locks and alarm Remote control key/PCC - key memory* Indication locking/unlocking adjusting The key memory in the remote control key/PCC (p. 159) means that certain settings in the car can be individually adapted for different people. When the car is locked or unlocked using the remote control key (p. 159) the direction indicators confirm that locking/unlocking was correctly performed. The key memory function is available in combination with power seat and power rearview and door mirrors. Settings for door mirrors, driver's seat and steering force can be saved in the key memory. • Locking - one flash and the door mirrors are folded3 in. • Unlocking - two flashes and the door mirrors are folded3 out. Key memory - door mirrors, driver’s seat and steering force The settings are automatically connected to each respective remote control key, see Key memory in remote control key (p. 75) and Speed related power steering (p. 262). 06 When locking the car with the remote key, the combined instrument panel theme setting can be saved to the key, see Digital combined instrument panel - overview (p. 61) and MY CAR - Car settings (p. 108). The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Car key memory. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). NOTE Be aware of the risk of locking the remote control key in the car. When locking, indication is given only if all locks have been locked and all doors are closed. Indication is given when the last door has been closed. Selecting the function Different options for indicating locking/ unlocking with light can be set in the car's menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Search in the menu system MY CAR for Settings Car settings Light settings and select Door lock confirmation light and/or Unlock confirmation light. For remote control keys with Keyless function, see Keyless* (p. 168). 3 160 Only for cars with retractable power door mirrors. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • • Keyless* (p. 168) Lock indicator (p. 161) Alarm indicator (p. 182) 06 Locks and alarm Lock indicator A flashing LED by the windscreen verifies that the car is locked. Remote control key/PCC - Electronic immobiliser The electronic immobiliser is a theft protection system that prevents the vehicle from being started (p. 268) by an unauthorised person. Each remote control key/PCC (p. 159) has a unique code. The car can only be started with the correct remote control key with the correct code. The following error messages in the combined instrument panel's information display are related to the electronic immobiliser: Same LED as alarm indicator (p. 182). NOTE Cars that are not equipped with alarm also have this indicator. Message Specification Insert car key Error when reading the remote control key during starting - Remove the key from the ignition switch, press it in again and make a new start attempt. Car key not found Error reading the remote control key during starting - Try to start again. (Applicable only to cars with Keyless.) Immobiliser Try to start again Related information • Indication locking/unlocking - adjusting (p. 160) If the error persists: Insert the remote control key into the ignition switch and try to start again. Error in immobiliser system during starting. If the error persists: Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. 06 Related information • Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking system (p. 162) • Keyless* (p. 168) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 161 06 Locks and alarm Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking system Remote-controlled immobiliser with tracking system makes it possible to track and locate the car, and to remotely activate the immobiliser to switch off the engine. Remote control key - function The remote control key has functions such as locking and unlocking the doors. Contact your nearest Volvo dealer for more information and assistance with activating the system. Related information • Remote control key with key blade (p. 159) • Remote control key/PCC - Electronic immobiliser (p. 161) Remote control key with PCC* - Personal Car Communicator. Information 5-button remote control key Locking Unlocking Approach light duration 06 Tailgate Panic function Function buttons Locking – Locks the doors and tailgate while the alarm is activated, see Locking/ unlocking - from the outside (p. 173). A long press also closes all windows simultaneously (see also Total airing function (p. 176)). WARNING If windows are closed using the remote control key, check that nobody's hands are trapped. Unlocking (p. 173) - Unlocks the doors and tailgate while the alarm is deactivated. 162 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 06 Locks and alarm A long press also opens all windows simultaneously (see also Total airing function (p. 176)). Related information • Remote control key with key blade (p. 159) The function can be changed from unlocking all doors simultaneously, to unlocking the driver's door only with one press of the button and, after a further press of the button within 10 seconds - unlocking the remaining doors. • PCC* - unique functions (p. 164) The function can be changed in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Lock settings Doors unlock with both the alternatives All doors and Driver door, then all. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Approach light duration (p. 89) - Used to switch on the car's lighting at a distance. Remote control key - range Remote control key (p. 159) functions have a range of about 20 m from the car. If the car does not verify a button being pressed - move closer and try again. NOTE The remote control key functions may be disrupted by surrounding radio waves, buildings, topographical conditions, etc. The car can always be locked/unlocked with the key blade, see Detachable key blade - unlocking doors (p. 166). Related information • Remote control key - function (p. 162) Tailgate (p. 176) - Unlocks and disarms the alarm for the tailgate only. 06 Panic function – Used to attract attention in an emergency. Press and hold the button for at least 3 seconds or press it twice within 3 seconds to activate the direction indicators and the horn. The function can be turned off with the same button once it has been active for at least 5 seconds. Otherwise the function switches off automatically after approx. 3 minutes. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 163 06 Locks and alarm PCC* - unique functions Using the information button Remote control key with PCC has extended functionality compared with remote control key without PCC (p. 159) in the form of an information button and indicator lamps. – Press the information button . > All indicator lamps flash for approximately 7 seconds and the light travels around on the PCC. This indicates that information from the car has been read. If any of the other buttons are pressed during this time then the reading is interrupted. NOTE Remote control key with PCC* - Personal Car Communicator. Green continuous light – the car is locked. If none of the indicator lamps illuminates with repeated use of the information button and in different locations (as well as after 7 seconds and after the light has travelled around on the PCC), contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Yellow continuous light – the car is unlocked. Red continuous light – the alarm has been triggered since the car was locked. Red light flashing alternately in both indicator lamps – The alarm was triggered less than 5 minutes ago. Information button 06 Indicator lamps Indicator lamps display information in accordance with the following illustration: Using the information button enables access to certain information from the car via the indicator lamps. 164 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • PCC* - range (p. 165) 06 Locks and alarm PCC* - range The PCC's range for unlocking and tailgate is approx. 20 m from the car - for other functions up to approx. 100 m. If the car does not verify a button being pressed - move closer and try again. NOTE The information button function may be disrupted by surrounding radio waves, buildings, topographical conditions, etc. Out of PCC range If the PCC is too far away from the car for the information to be read then the status the car was last left in is shown, without the light travelling around on the PCC. If several PCCs are used for the car then it is only the PCC last used for locking/unlocking that shows correct status. Related information • Keyless* - remote control key range (p. 169) • Remote control key - range (p. 163) Detachable key blade A remote control key (p. 159) contains a detachable key blade of metal with which some functions can be activated and some operations carried out. The key blade's unique code is provided by authorised Volvo workshops, which are recommended when ordering new key blades. Key blade functions Using the remote control key's detachable key blade: • the left-hand front door can be opened manually (p. 166) if central locking cannot be activated with the remote control key. • the rear doors' mechanical child safety locks can be activated (p. 179)/deactivated. • the right-hand front door and the rear doors can be locked manually (p. 174), e.g. in the event of power failure. • the glovebox lock* can be opened, see Locking/unlocking - glovebox (p. 176). • the airbag for front passenger seat (PACOS*) can be activated/deactivated (p. 31). NOTE If none of the indicator lamps illuminates with repeated use of the information button and in different locations (as well as after 7 seconds and after the light has travelled around on the PCC), contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 06 165 06 Locks and alarm Detachable key blade - detaching/ attaching Detaching/attaching the detachable key blade (p. 165) is carried out as follows: Removing the key blade Related information • Detachable key blade - unlocking doors (p. 166) • Child safety locks - manual activation (p. 179) • Passenger airbag - activating/deactivating* (p. 31) Detachable key blade - unlocking doors The detachable key blade (p. 165) can be used if the central locking cannot be activated using the remote control key (p. 159) - e.g. if the remote control key's battery is discharged - see Remote control key/PCC - replacing the battery (p. 167). The left-hand front door can be opened as follows: 1. Unlock the left-hand front door with the key blade in the door handle's lock cylinder. For illustration and more information, see Keyless* - unlocking with the key blade (p. 171). Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side. 06 At the same time pull the key blade straight out backwards. Attaching the key blade When the door has been unlocked using the key blade and is opened, the alarm is triggered. Carefully refit the key blade into its location in the remote control key (p. 159). 2. Deactivate the alarm (p. 181) by inserting the remote control key in the ignition switch. 1. Hold the remote control key with the slot pointed up and lower the key blade into its slot. For cars with the Keyless system, see Keyless* - unlocking with the key blade (p. 171). 2. Lightly press the key blade. You should hear a "click" when the key blade is locked in. 166 NOTE * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 06 Locks and alarm Remote control key/PCC - replacing the battery NOTE Turn the remote control key over with the buttons facing up, this is to avoid the batteries falling out when it is opened. The batteries for the remote control key/PCC can be replaced. The batteries for the remote control key/PCC should be replaced if: • IMPORTANT the information symbol is illuminated and the combined instrument panel shows Low battery in remote control. Please change batteries. Avoid touching new batteries and their contact surfaces with your fingers as this may impair their function. and/or • Battery replacement the locks repeatedly do not react to signals from the remote control key within 20 metres from the car. NOTE Opening Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side. At the same time pull the key blade straight out backwards. Insert a 3 mm slot screwdriver in the hole behind the spring-loaded catch and gently prize the remote control key up. Volvo recommends that the batteries to be used in the remote control key/PCC fulfil UN Manual of Test and Criteria, Part III, sub-section 38.3. Batteries fitted in the factory or replaced by an authorised Volvo workshop fulfil the above criteria. Closely study how the battery/batteries are secured on the inside of the cover, with regard to their (+) and (–) sides. 06 Remote control key with 1 battery 1. Carefully prize out the battery. 2. Install a new one with the (+) side down. }} 167 06 Locks and alarm || Remote control key and PCC* with 2 batteries 1. Carefully prize out the batteries. 2. First install one new one with the (+) side up. Keyless* Keyless lock and ignition system is available in two function levels, Keyless drive and Keyless start. 3. Position the white plastic tab in between and finally install a second new battery with the (+) side down. Battery type Use batteries with designation CR2430, 3 V. Assembly 1. Press the remote control key together. 2. Hold the remote control key with the slot pointed up and lower the key blade into its slot. 3. Lightly press the key blade. You should hear a "click" when the key blade is locked in. 06 IMPORTANT Make sure that exhausted batteries are disposed of in a manner which is kind to the environment. Related information 168 • Remote control key with key blade (p. 159) • Remote control key - function (p. 162) For cars with Keyless start function the car can be started (p. 268) without the remote control key in the ignition switch. For cars with Keyless drive function, the car can be locked and unlocked (p. 171) without pressing a button on the remote control key, and also be started without the key being inserted in the ignition lock. The system makes it easier and more convenient to open the car, e.g. when your hands are full. Both of the car's remote control keys have Keyless function. It is possible to order more remote control keys, see Remote control key with key blade (p. 159). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The car's electrical system can be set to three different levels - key position (p. 71) 0, I and II - with the remote control key. Related information • Keyless* - Secure handling of the remote control key (p. 169) • Keyless* - interference to remote control key function (p. 170) 06 Locks and alarm Keyless* - remote control key range5 In order to open a door or the tailgate without pressing a button on the remote control key, a remote control key must be approx. 1.5 m from the car door handle or tailgate. The person who wishes to lock or unlock a door must have the remote control key with him or her. It is not possible to lock or unlock a door if the remote control key is on the opposite side of the car. shows a warning message while sounding an audible reminder at the same time. Keyless* - Secure handling of the remote control key When the remote control key has been returned to the car, the warning message goes off and the audible reminder ceases once either/or: It is important to handle all remote control keys with great care. • • • a door has been opened and closed the remote control key has been inserted in the ignition lock The OK button on the direction indicator stalk. Related information • • If a remote control key with keyless function is left in the car, it is deactivated temporarily when the car is locked. This prevents unauthorised entry. However, if someone breaks into the car and finds the remote control key, it is reactivated. It is therefore important to handle all remote control keys with great care. Keyless* (p. 168) IMPORTANT Keyless* - antenna location (p. 173) When the door has been unlocked using the key blade and is opened, the alarm is triggered. Related information • Keyless* (p. 168) 06 The red rings in the above figure indicate the range covered by the system's antennas. If all remote control keys are removed from the car when the engine is running or key position (p. 71) I or II is active and a door has been opened and then closed, the information display in the combined instrument panel 5 Does not apply to cars with keyless start * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 169 06 Locks and alarm Keyless* - interference to remote control key function Electromagnetic fields and screening can interfere with the Keyless function. NOTE Keyless* - locking Cars with the Keyless-drive system have a touch-sensitive area on the outer handle of the doors and a rubberised button next to the tailgate's rubberised pressure plate. Do not place/store the remote control key with keyless function near a mobile phone or metal object - no closer than 10-15 cm. If interference is experienced nonetheless, use the remote control key (p. 159) and the key blade like a traditional remote control key. Related information • 06 Keyless* (p. 168) Lock the doors and the tailgate by grasping one of the door handles or pressing the smaller of the tailgate's two rubberised buttons - the lock indicator (p. 161) in the windscreen confirms that locking has been completed by starting to flash. All doors and the tailgate must be closed before the car can be locked - otherwise the car is not locked. NOTE In cars with automatic gearbox selectors, the gear selector must be set to the P position; otherwise the car can be neither locked nor alarmed. 170 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • Keyless* (p. 168) Alarm indicator (p. 182) 06 Locks and alarm Keyless* - unlocking6 Unlocking with Keyless-drive takes place when a hand grasps a door handle or the tailgate's rubberised pressure plate is actuated open the door or tailgate as normal. NOTE Keyless* - unlocking with the key blade If central locking cannot be activated with the remote control key, e.g. if the batteries are discharged, then the left-hand front door can be opened using the remote control key's detachable key blade (p. 166). 1. Press the key blade approx. 1 cm straight up into the hole on the underside of the door handle/cover - do not prize. > The plastic cover loosens automatically by means of the torque when the blade is pushed straight up and into the opening. 2. Then insert the key blade in the lock cylinder and unlock the door. The door handles normally register a hand that takes hold of the handle, but with thick gloves on or after a very quick hand movement a second attempt may be required, or with the glove taken off. 3. Refit the plastic cover after unlocking. NOTE Related information • • When the left-hand front door is unlocked using the key blade and is opened, this triggers the alarm (p. 181). It is switched off by inserting the remote control key in the ignition switch, see Alarm - remote control key not working (p. 183). Keyless* (p. 168) Keyless* - locking (p. 170) Hole for key blade - to loosen the cover. Related information To access the lock cylinder, the door handle's plastic cover must be removed - this is also done with the key blade: 6 • Keyless* (p. 168) 06 Does not apply to remote control key with keyless start. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 171 06 Locks and alarm Keyless* - key memory • memory7 The key in the remote control key/PCC means that certain settings in the car can be individually adapted for different persons. Related information • Lock settings for the Keyless-drive function can be adapted in the MY CAR menu system The key memory function is available in combination with power seat* and power rearview and door mirrors. Settings for door mirrors, driver's seat and steering force can be saved in the key memory. Memory function in remote control key with Keyless function For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). After the driver's door has been opened by person A with remote control key A but person B with remote control key B shall drive, the settings can be changed as follows: • Standing by the driver's door, or sitting behind the steering wheel person B presses their remote control key's unlock button, see Remote control key - function (p. 162). • Select one of three possible memories for adjusting the power seat (p. 74) with seat button 1 - 3. • Adjust seat and mirrors (p. 97) manually. 7 172 Keyless* (p. 168) Keyless* - lock settings Lock settings for the Keyless-drive function can be adapted by indicating in the menu system for MY CAR which doors are to be unlocked, under Car settings Lock settings Keyless entry - there select between All doors unlock, Any door, Doors on same side and Both front doors. If several people each with a remote control key (p. 159) approach the car, then the settings for seat and mirrors are implemented for the person who opens the driver's door. 06 Adjust steering force in the menu system MY CAR (p. 108). Only in combination with power driver's seat and power mirrors. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Keyless* (p. 168) 06 Locks and alarm Keyless* - antenna location Locking/unlocking - from the outside WARNING The Keyless system has a number of integrated antennae located around the car. People who have had a pacemaker operation should not come closer than 22 cm to the Keyless system's antennas with their pacemaker. This is to prevent interference between the pacemaker and the Keyless system. Related information • Keyless* (p. 168) Locking/unlocking from the outside is carried out using the remote control key (p. 162). The remote control key can lock/unlock all doors, the tailgate and the fuel filler flap. Different sequences for unlocking can be selected. In order that the lock sequence can be activated, the driver's door must be closed - if any of the other doors or the tailgate is open, then it/they is/are locked and the alarm is activated only when it/they are closed. With the Keyless* system all the doors and tailgate must be closed. NOTE Rear bumper, centre Door handle, left rear Cargo area, central and furthest in under the floor Door handle, right rear Centre console, under the rear section Centre console, under the front section. Be aware of the risk of locking the remote control key in the car. If it is not possible to lock/unlock with the remote control key, the battery may be discharged - lock or unlock the left-hand front door with the detachable key blade (p. 166). 06 NOTE Remember that the alarm is triggered when the door is opened after being unlocked with the key blade - the alarm is switched off when the remote control key is inserted into the ignition switch. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 173 06 Locks and alarm || WARNING Be aware of the risk of being locked in the car when it is locked from the outside using the remote control key - it is then not possible to open any of the doors from the inside with the door controls. For more information, see Deadlocks* (p. 178). Automatic relocking If none of the doors or the tailgate is opened within 2 minutes of unlocking, all are locked again automatically. This function reduces the risk that the car is left unlocked unintentionally. (For cars with alarm, see Alarm (p. 181).) Manual locking of the door The door can be opened from both the outside and the inside. In certain situations the car must be lockable manually, e.g. in the event of power failure. The left-hand front door can be locked with its lock cylinder and the remote control key's detachable key blade (p. 171). Other doors have no lock cylinders and instead have a lock switch on the end of each door which must be depressed using the key blade - they are then mechanically locked/ blocked to prevent them being opened from outside. The doors can still be opened from the inside. The door is blocked against opening from the outside. To return to position A, the inner door handle must be opened. The doors can also be unlocked with the unlock button on the remote control key (p. 159) or with the central locking button on the driver's door. NOTE Related information • Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175) • Remote control key - function (p. 162) 06 • A door's lock reset only locks that particular door - not all doors simultaneously. • A manually locked rear door with activated manual child safety locks (p. 179) cannot be opened from either the outside or the inside. A rear door that is locked in this way can only be unlocked with the remote control key or central locking button. Related information • Manual locking of the door. Not to be mixed up with child safety locks (p. 179). – 174 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Remove the detachable key blade (p. 166) from the remote control key. Insert the key blade in the hole for lock reset and press the key in until the key bottoms, approx. 12 mm. Remote control key/PCC - replacing the battery (p. 167) 06 Locks and alarm Locking/unlocking - from the inside Locking/unlocking can be performed using the driver's door button for central locking. All doors and tailgate (p. 176) can be locked or unlocked simultaneously. With central locking button on both front doors and electric lock button in each rear door: • Car settings Lock settings Automatic door locking. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Illuminated lamp means that only that particular door is locked. When all buttons are illuminated all doors are locked. Unlocking A door can be unlocked from the inside in two different ways: • Press the central locking button Related information • Locking/unlocking - from the outside (p. 173) • Alarm (p. 181) . A long press also opens all the side windows* simultaneously (see also Total airing function (p. 176)). • Central locking • Press one side the other side of the button to lock to unlock. Lamp in lock button When the lamp in the central locking button for the driver's door is illuminated it means that all doors are locked. With central locking button only in the driver's door, other doors have no button: • Illuminated lamp means that all doors are locked. Pull the door handle and open the door the door is unlocked and opened in one operation. Locking • Both front doors must be closed for the central locking to be activated. Press the central locking button - all doors are locked. If any of the rear doors is open, it will lock when it is closed. 06 A long press also closes all the side windows simultaneously (see also Total airing function (p. 176)). Automatic locking The doors and tailgate are locked automatically when the car starts to move. The function can be activated/deactivated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 175 06 Locks and alarm Total airing function Locking/unlocking - glovebox Locking/unlocking - tailgate The total airing function opens or closes all side windows simultaneously and can be used for example to quickly air the car during hot weather. The glovebox (p. 149) can only be locked/ unlocked using the detachable key blade from the remote control key (p. 159). The tailgate can be opened, locked and unlocked in a number of different ways. For information on the key blade, see Detachable key blade - detaching/attaching (p. 166). Rubber plate with electrical contact. Central locking button 06 A long press on the symbol in the central locking button opens all side windows simultaneously. The same procedure on the button closes all side windows simultaneously. Locking the glovebox: Related information • Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175) • Power windows (p. 95) • The tailgate is held closed by an electrical lock. To open: Insert the key blade in the glovebox lock cylinder. 1. Push down gently on the wider of the two rubberised pressure plates under the outer handle - the lock is released. Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise. The keyhole is horizontal in the locked position. 2. Lift the outside handle in order to fully open the tailgate. Pull out the key blade. Unlock by carrying this out in reverse order. Related information • 176 Manual opening Remote control key - function (p. 162) 06 Locks and alarm IMPORTANT The doors remain locked and armed. • Minimal force is required to release the rear hatch lock - just gently press the rubberised panel. The tailgate can be opened in two different ways using the remote control key: • Do not place the lift force on the rubber panel when opening the rear hatch - lift the handle. Using too much force may damage the electrical contacts on the rubber panel. Unlocking with the remote control key Opening the car from inside One press - The boot lid is unlocked, but remains closed - press lightly on the rubberised pressure plate under the outer handle and lift the boot lid. If the tailgate is not opened within 2 minutes then it is relocked and the alarm is re-armed. Two presses - The boot lid is unlocked and the lock is disengaged at which the boot lid opens about a centimetre - lift the outer handle to open. Rain, cold, frost or snow could however prevent the tailgate from disengaging from the lock. Using the remote control key (p. 159) button the alarm for the tailgate can be disarmed* and the tailgate unlocked on its own. The lock indicator (p. 161) on the instrument panel stops flashing in order to show that not all of the car is locked and the alarm's* level and movement sensors and the sensors for opening the tailgate are disconnected. • When the boot lid/tailgate is unlocked with 2 presses or from the car interior, automatic relocking does not take place because the boot lid/tailgate is open - it must be closed manually. After the boot lid/tailgate has been closed it is unlocked and the alarm is not armed - relock it and re-arm the alarm with the remote control key's lock button . To open the tailgate: – NOTE • Unlocking, tailgate Press the lighting panel button (1). > The lock releases and the tailgate opens by a few centimetres. Locking with the remote control key – Press the remote control key (p. 162) but. ton for locking 06 > The lock indicator on the instrument panel starts flashing, which means that the car is locked and the alarm* has been activated. Related information • Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175) • Locking/unlocking - from the outside (p. 173) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 177 06 Locks and alarm Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap Deadlocks* The fuel filler flap is unlocked with the remote button. control key (p. 159) Deadlocks8 The fuel filler flap remains unlocked until the car is locked with the remote control key button. If the car is locked during travel or with the interior buttons, the fuel filler flap will remain unlocked. The fuel filler flap locking logic also follows the locking or unlocking of the keyless-drive and the central locking system. Related information • • Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing (p. 296) Fuel filler flap - manual opening (p. 296) means that all door handles are mechanically disengaged, which prevents doors being opened from the inside. The deadlocks are activated with the remote control key (p. 159) and are set after an approximately 10 second delay after the doors have been locked. NOTE If a door is opened within the delay time then the sequence is interrupted and the alarm is deactivated. The car can only be unlocked from a deadlock state with the remote control key. The front left door can also be unlocked with the detachable key blade (p. 165). WARNING Do not allow anyone to remain in the car without first deactivating the deadlocks in order to avoid the risk of anyone being locked in. 06 Temporary deactivation Active menu options are indicated with a cross. MY CAR OK MENU TUNE knob control EXIT If someone is going to stay in the car but the doors must be locked from the outside, then the deadlocks function can be temporarily switched off. This is carried out as follows: 1. Access the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Reduced Guard (for a detailed description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104)). 8 178 Only in combination with alarm. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 06 Locks and alarm 2. Select Activate once. > The combined instrument panel shows the message Locks and alarm Reduced guard and the deadlocks function is switched off when the car is locked. or – Select Ask when exiting. > Each time the engine is switched off the centre console's screen shows the message Activate Reduced Guard until engine has started again? followed by the alternatives Confirm with OK and Cancel with EXIT. NOTE • Remember that the alarm is activated when the car is locked. • If any of the doors are opened from the inside then the alarm is triggered. Related information • Keyless* - unlocking with the key blade (p. 171) Child safety locks - manual activation The child safety locks prevent children from being able to open a rear door from the inside. The child safety locks are located on the trailing edge of the rear doors and are only accessible when the doors are open. Activate/deactivate child safety locks If the deadlocks function shall be switched off – Press OK/MENU and lock the car. (Note that the alarm's movement and tilt detectors* are switched off at the same time.) > The next time the engine is started, the system is reset to zero and the combined instrument panel shows the message Locks and alarm Full guard at which the deadlocks function and the alarm's movement and tilt detectors are re-engaged. If the locking system shall not be changed – Press EXIT and lock the car. Manual child safety locks. Not to be mixed up with manual door lock (p. 174). – 06 Use the remote control key's detachable key blade (p. 166) to turn the knob. The door is blocked against opening from the inside. The door can be opened from both the outside and the inside. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 179 06 Locks and alarm || NOTE • A door's knob control only blocks that particular door - not both rear doors simultaneously. • Cars with an electric child safety lock do not have a manual child lock. Related information • Child safety locks - electrical activation* (p. 180) • Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175) Child safety locks - electrical activation* The child safety locks prevent children from being able to open a rear door from the inside. Activation The electrical child safety locks can be activated/deactivated in all key positions (p. 71) higher than 0. Activation/deactivation can be performed up to 2 minutes after switching off the engine, provided that no door is opened. 2. Press the button in the driver's door control panel. > The information display shows the message Rear child lock activated and the button's lamp illuminates - the locks are active. When the electric child safety lock is active then the rear: • windows can only be opened with the driver's door control panel • doors cannot be opened from inside. The current setting is stored when the engine is switched off - if the child safety locks are activated at engine shutdown, the function will remain activated the next time the engine is started. Related information 06 Control panel driver's door. 1. Start the engine or choose a key position higher than 0. 180 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Child safety locks - manual activation (p. 179) • Locking/unlocking - from the inside (p. 175) 06 Locks and alarm Alarm The movement sensors trigger an alarm in the event of movement in the passenger compartment - air currents are also registered. For this reason the alarm is triggered if the car is left with a window open or if the passenger compartment heater is used. Activated alarm is triggered if: • a door, the bonnet or the tailgate is opened • a movement is detected in the passenger compartment (if fitted with a movement detector*) • the car is raised or towed away (if fitted with a tilt detector*) • • the battery's cable is disconnected Deactivating a triggered alarm NOTE The alarm is a device that warns in the event of e.g. a break-in in the car. To avoid this: Close the window when leaving the car. If the car's integrated passenger compartment heater (or a portable electric heater) shall be used - direct the airflow from the air vents so that they are not pointing upwards in the passenger compartment. Alternatively, reduced alarm level can be used, Reduced alarm level (p. 183). the siren is disconnected. If there is a fault in the alarm system then the information display in the combined instrument panel shows a message. In which case, contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. – Press the remote control key unlock button or insert the remote control key in the ignition switch. Related information • • Alarm - automatic re-arming (p. 182) Alarm - remote control key not working (p. 183) NOTE Do not attempt to repair or alter components in the alarm system yourself. Any such attempts may affect the terms of the insurance. 06 Arming the alarm – Press the remote control key lock button. Deactivate the alarm – Press the remote control key unlock button. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 181 06 Locks and alarm Alarm indicator Alarm - automatic re-arming Alarm - automatic arming The alarm indicator shows alarm system (p. 181) status. Automatic re-arming of the alarm (p. 181) prevents the car being left with the alarm disarmed unintentionally. In certain countries the alarm (p. 181) is activated after a certain delay if the driver's door was opened and closed but the car was not re-locked. If the car is unlocked with the remote control key (p. 159)(and the alarm is disarmed) but none of the doors or the tailgate is opened within 2 minutes, then the alarm is automatically re-armed. The car is relocked at the same time. Related information • Same LED as lock indicator (p. 161). A red LED on the instrument panel indicates the alarm system's status: 06 182 • • LED not lit – Alarm not armed • The LED flashes rapidly after disarming the alarm (and until the remote control key is inserted in the ignition switch and key position I is selected) – Alarm has been triggered. The LED flashes once every other second – Alarm is armed Alarm - automatic arming (p. 182) Related information • Alarm signals (p. 183) 06 Locks and alarm Alarm - remote control key not working If the alarm (p. 181) cannot be deactivated with the remote control key, e.g. if the key's battery (p. 167) is discharged - the car can be unlocked, disarmed and the engine started as follows: 1. Open the left-hand front door with the detachable key blade (p. 171). > The alarm is triggered, the direction indicators flash and the siren sounds. Alarm signals Reduced alarm level When the alarm (p. 181) is triggered a siren sounds and all direction indicators flash. Reduced guard means that the movement and tilt detectors can be temporarily deactivated. • A siren sounds for 30 seconds or until the alarm is switched off. The siren has its own battery and works independently of the car battery. • The direction indicators flash for 5 minutes or until the alarm is switched off. To avoid accidental triggering of the alarm e.g. if a dog is left in a locked car or during transport on a car train or car ferry - temporarily deactivate the movement and tilt detectors. The procedure is the same as with the temporary disengaging of deadlocks, see Deadlocks* (p. 178). Related information • • Alarm (p. 181) Alarm indicator (p. 182) 06 2. Insert the remote control key in the ignition switch. > The alarm is deactivated. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 183 DRIVER SUPPORT 07 Driver support Stability and traction control system (DSTC) The stability and traction control system, DSTC (Dynamic Stability & Traction Control), helps the driver to avoid skidding and improves the car's traction. The activation of the system during braking may be noticed as a throbbing sound. The car may accelerate slower than expected when the accelerator pedal is depressed. WARNING The stability and traction control system is a supplementary function - it cannot handle all situations in all road conditions. The driver always bears responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely and that applicable road traffic rules and regulations are followed. The system consists of the following functions: • • • • • • • 1 Active Yaw Control Spin Control Traction control system Engine drag control - EDC Corner Traction Control - CTC Driver Steering Recommendation – DSR Active Yaw Control Driver Steering Recommendation – DSR The function checks the driving and brake force of the wheels individually in order to stabilise the car. DSR (Driver Steering Recommendation) helps the driver steer the car in the right direction when there is reduced traction or when the ABS system engages. Spin Control The function reduces engine power if the drive wheels slip against the underlying surface in order to maintain stability and traction. Traction control system The function is active at low speed and transfers power from the driving wheel that is spinning to the one that is not. Engine drag control - EDC EDC (Engine Drag Control) prevents involuntary wheel locking, e.g. after shifting down or engine braking when driving in low gears on slippery road surfaces. Involuntary wheel locking while driving can, amongst other things, impair the driver's ability to steer the car. The primary role of the DSR function is to help the driver steer in the right direction when the car is skidding. DSR engages by applying slight torque to the steering wheel in the direction in which the car should be steered to maintain/achieve maximum possible traction and stabilise the car. Trailer Stability Assist* - TSA1 Trailer stability assist (p. 307) function is to stabilise the car and trailer combination if it begins to snake. For more information, see Driving with a trailer (p. 301). NOTE The function is deactivated if the driver selects Sport mode. Corner Traction Control - CTC CTC compensates for understeer and allows higher than normal acceleration in a bend without wheelspin on the inner wheel, e.g. on an arcing motorway entrance road to quickly reach the prevailing traffic speed. Related information • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - operation (p. 186) • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - symbols and messages (p. 187) 07 Trailer Stability Assist* - TSA Trailer Stability Assist * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 185 07 Driver support Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - operation The stability and traction control system, DSTC (Dynamic Stability & Traction Control), helps the driver to avoid skidding and improves the car's traction. Selection of level - Sport mode The stability and traction control system (DSTC) is always activated - it cannot be switched off. However, the driver can select the Sport mode, which allows for a more active driving experience. In Sport mode the system detects whether the accelerator pedal, steering wheel movements and cornering are more active than in normal driving and then allows controlled skidding with the rear section up to a certain level before it intervenes and stabilises the car. If the driver stops a controlled skid by releasing the accelerator pedal then the DSTC system intervenes and stabilises the car. 07 With Sport mode, maximum traction is obtained if the car has become stuck, or when driving on a loose surface - e.g. sand or deep snow. Proceed as follows to select Sport mode: 1. Press the centre console's MY CAR button and in the display screen's menu system find My V40 DSTC. 186 2. Uncheck the box and back out of the menu system with EXIT. > The system then allows a more sporty driving style. The Sport mode is active until the driver deselects it or until the engine is switched off - after the engine is started the next time the DSTC system is back in its normal mode again. Related information • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185) • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - symbols and messages (p. 187) • MY CAR (p. 104) 07 Driver support Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - symbols and messages helps the driver to avoid skidding and improves the car's traction. The stability and traction control system, DSTC (Dynamic Stability & Traction Control), Table SymbolA Message Specification DSTC Temporarily OFF DSTC system temporarily reduced due to excessive brake disc temperature. - The function is reactivated automatically when the brakes have cooled. DSTC Service required DSTC system disengaged. • • Stop the car in a safe place, switch off the engine and start it again. Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. "Message" There is a message in the combined instrument panel - read it! Constant glow for 2 seconds. System check when the engine is started. Flashing light. DSTC system is being activated. and Sport mode is activated. A The symbols are schematic. 07 Related information • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185) • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - operation (p. 186) 187 07 Driver support Road Sign Information (RSI) WARNING The road sign information function (RSI – Road Sign Information) helps the driver to remember which road signs the car has passed. RSI does not work in all situations but is designed merely as a supplementary aid. The driver always bears ultimate responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely and that applicable road traffic rules and regulations are followed. Road sign information (RSI)* operation The road sign information function (RSI – Road Sign Information) helps the driver to remember which road signs the car has passed. How the function is operated is described below. Related information • Road sign information (RSI)* - operation (p. 188) • Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations (p. 190) Examples of readable speed related2 signs. 07 The road sign information function gives information on current speed, that a motorway or road is starting/ending and when overtaking is prohibited. If both a sign for motorway/road for motorised traffic and a sign showing the maximum permitted speed are passed, RSI decides to show the sign symbol for maximum permitted speed. 2 3 188 Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples. Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Recorded speed information3. When RSI has recorded a road sign with an imposed speed, the combined instrument panel displays the sign as a symbol. Together with the symbol for the current speed limit, a sign showing that overtaking is prohibited may also be displayed where appropriate. 07 Driver support End of restriction or motorway Some speeds are applicable Additional signs only after e.g. a specific disA corresponding road sign is shown in the tance or at a certain time of combined instrument panel for day. The driver's attention approx. 10 seconds in situations where RSI detects a sign that involves the end of a speed limit - or other speed-related information, e.g. end of aismotorway drawn to the situation by . means of a symbol for an Examples of such signs are: additional sign under the End of all restrictions. symbol showing speed. Display of additional information End of motorway. Following which, the sign information is hidden until the next speed-related sign is detected. Examples of additional signs3. Sometimes different speed limits are signposted for the same road - an additional sign then indicates the circumstances under which the different speeds apply. The road section may be particularly susceptible to accidents in rain and/or fog, for example. An additional sign relating to rain is displayed only if the windscreen wipers are in use. The speed applicable on an exit is indicated in certain markets by means of an additional sign containing an arrow. A symbol for additional sign in the form of an empty frame under the combined instrument panel's speed symbol means that the RSI has detected an additional sign with supplementary information for the current speed limit. Setting in MY CAR There are options for RSI in the MY CAR menu system; see MY CAR - driving support system (p. 109). 07 Speed signs linked to this type of additional sign are displayed only if the driver is using the direction indicator. 3 Road signs shown in the combined instrument panel are market-dependent - the illustrations only show a few examples. }} 189 07 Driver support || Road sign information On/Off 5 km/h or more. This warning is given by the symbol showing the applicable maximum speed temporarily flashing when this speed is exceeded. To activate speed warning: • Check the option Speed alert at Settings Car settings Speed alert and go back out by pressing EXIT. Related information The combined instrument panel's speed symbol display can be disabled. To deactivate the RSI function: • Uncheck the option Road Sign Information at Settings Car settings Road Sign Information and go back out by pressing EXIT. • • • Speed warning 07 Road Sign Information (RSI) (p. 188) Road sign information (RSI)* - limitations (p. 190) MY CAR (p. 104) Road sign information (RSI)* limitations The road sign information function (RSI – Road Sign Information) helps the driver to remember which road signs the car has passed. The function has the following limitations. The RSI function's camera sensor has limitations just like the human eye. Find out more about this in the section on the camera sensor limitations (p. 231). Signs which indirectly provide information on a prevailing speed limit, e.g. name signs for towns/districts, are not recorded by the RSI function. Here are some other examples of what can disrupt the function: • • • • • Signs positioned on bends Rotated or damaged signs Concealed or poorly positioned signs Signs completely or partly covered with frost, snow and/or dirt. Related information • • The driver can opt to receive a warning when the applicable speed limit is exceeded by 190 Faded signs * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Road Sign Information (RSI) (p. 188) Road sign information (RSI)* - operation (p. 188) 07 Driver support Speed limiter* A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a preselected/set speed by the speed limiter. Steering wheel keypad and combined instrument panel Digital and Analogue. Related information • • Speed limiter* - getting started (p. 191) Speed limiter - temporary deactivation and standby mode* (p. 193) • Speed limiter* - alarm for speed exceeded (p. 194) • Speed limiter* - deactivation (p. 194) Speed limiter* - getting started A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a preselected/set speed by the speed limiter. Steering wheel keypad and combined instrument panel Digital and Analogue. Speed limiter - On/Off. Speed limiter - On/Off. Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. Standby mode Standby mode Activate and adjust the max. speed. Activate and adjust the max. speed. Selected speed Selected speed Speed limiter active Speed limiter active * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 191 07 Driver support || Switch on and activate When the speed limiter is active, its symbol (6) is shown in combination with a mark (5) by the set maximum speed in the combined instrument panel. Selection and storage of the highest possible speed in the memory can be made both during a journey and while stationary. While driving A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a preselected/set speed by the speed limiter. Related information To change the stored speed: • 1. Press the steering wheel button to switch on the speed limiter. > The symbol (6) for speed limiter illuminates in the combined instrument panel. 2. When the car is moving at the desired highest possible speed: Press one of the steering wheel buttons or until the combined instrument panel shows a mark (5) next to the desired maximum speed. > The speed limiter is then active and the selected max. speed is stored in the memory. 07 When stationary 1. Press the steering wheel button switch on the speed limiter. 192 Speed limiter* - changing speed 2. Scroll with the button until the combined instrument panel shows a mark (5) by the desired maximum speed. > The speed limiter is then active and the selected max. speed is stored in the memory. to * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Speed limiter* (p. 191) • or in Adjust with short presses on the steering wheel keypad - every press gives +/- 5 km/h. The last presses made are stored in the memory. To adjust +/- 1 km/h: • Hold down the button and release it when the combined instrument panel shows a mark next to the desired maximum speed. Related information • Speed limiter* (p. 191) 07 Driver support Speed limiter - temporary deactivation and standby mode* A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a preselected/set speed by the speed limiter. Temporary deactivation - standby mode – To temporarily deactivate the speed limiter and set it in standby mode: – Press . > The combined instrument panel's mark (5) changes colour from GREEN to WHITE (Digital) or from WHITE to GREY (Analogue) and the driver can temporarily exceed the set maximum speed. The speed limiter is automatically reactivated after the accelerator pedal is released and the car's speed is slowed down to below the selected/stored maximum speed - the mark (5) changes colour from WHITE to GREEN (Digital) or GREY to WHITE (Analogue) and the car's maximum speed is again limited. The speed limiter is reactivated with . The mark (5) then one press on changes colour from WHITE to GREEN (Digital) or GREY to WHITE (Analogue) and the car's maximum speed is limited again. Steering wheel keypad and instrument panel Digital and Analogue. Speed limiter - On/Off. Temporary deactivation with the accelerator pedal Depress the accelerator pedal fully. > The combined instrument panel shows the stored maximum speed with a coloured mark (5) and the driver can temporarily exceed the set maximum speed – the mark (5) changes colour from GREEN to WHITE (Digital) or WHITE to GREY (Analogue) during that time. Related information The speed limiter can also be set in standby mode with the accelerator pedal, e.g. for rapidly accelerating the car out of a situation: • Speed limiter* (p. 191) Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. Standby mode 07 Activate and adjust the max. speed. Selected speed Speed limiter active * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 193 07 Driver support Speed limiter* - alarm for speed exceeded A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a pre-selected/set speed by the speed limiter. On steep roads the speed limiter's engine braking effect may be inadequate and the selected maximum speed is exceeded. The driver is alerted about this with an acoustic signal. The signal is active until the driver has slowed to below the selected maximum speed. Speed limiter* - deactivation Cruise control* A (Speed Limiter) can be regarded as a reverse cruise control - the driver regulates the speed using the accelerator pedal but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a preselected/set speed by the speed limiter. The cruise control (CC – Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain an even speed, resulting in more relaxing driving on motorways and long, straight roads with regular traffic flows. To deactivate the speed limiter: – The driver can then use the accelerator pedal to choose a speed without limitation. Related information • Speed limiter* (p. 191) Related information • Speed limiter* (p. 191) 07 4 194 . > The combined instrument panel's (p. 191) symbol for the speed limiter and the mark for the set speed are extinguished. The selected and stored speed are thus deleted from the memory and cannot be resumed with the button. NOTE The alarm is only activated after 5 seconds if the speed has been exceeded by at least 3 km/h provided that none of the buttons or has been depressed during the last half minute. Press the steering wheel button Overview A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The steering wheel buttons and combined instrument panel in cars without speed limiter4. 07 Driver support Cruise control* - managing speed WARNING The cruise control (CC – Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an even speed. It is possible to activate, set or change the speed. The driver must always be observant with regard to the traffic conditions and intervene when the cruise control is not maintaining a suitable speed and/or suitable distance. Activating and setting the speed The driver always bears ultimate responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely. Related information • Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195) Cruise control - On/Off. • Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode (p. 197) Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. • Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198) Standby mode • Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199) The steering wheel buttons and combined instrument panel in cars with speed limiter4. Activate and adjust the speed. The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without speed limiter5. Selected speed (GREY = Standby mode). Cruise control active - WHITE symbol (GREY = Standby mode). 07 4 5 A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 195 07 Driver support || NOTE Cruise Control cannot be enabled at speeds below 30 km/h. Changing the speed • or Adjust with short presses on every press gives +/- 5 km/h. The last presses made are stored in the memory. To adjust +/- 1 km/h: • The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with speed limiter5. To enable cruise control: • Press the steering wheel button > The cruise control symbol (6) in the combined instrument panel for cruise control active changes from GREY to WHITE and shows that the cruise control is in standby mode. A temporary increase in speed with the accelerator pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect the cruise control setting - the car returns to the set speed when the accelerator pedal is released. NOTE If any of the Cruise Control buttons are held depressed for several minutes then it is blocked and deactivated. To be able to reactivate Cruise Control, the car must be stopped and the engine restarted. To activate cruise control: 07 • At the required speed - press the steering wheel button or . > The current speed is stored in the memory and the combined instrument panel's marking (5) illuminates at the selected speed. 5 196 Hold down the button and release it at the required speed. Related information • • Cruise control* (p. 194) Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode (p. 197) A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198) • Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199) 07 Driver support • the gear selector/lever is moved to neutral position N (automatic gearbox) The cruise control (CC – Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an even speed. The function can be temporarily deactivated and set in standby mode. • the driver maintains a speed higher than the set speed for longer than 1 minute. Temporary deactivation - standby mode • • • Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode The driver must then regulate the speed. Related information • The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with speed limiter6. Cruise control* (p. 194) Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195) Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198) Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199) To temporarily disengage cruise control and set it in standby mode: The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without speed limiter6. • Press > The combined instrument panel's marking (5) and symbol (6) change colour from WHITE to GREY. . Automatic standby mode Cruise control is temporarily disengaged and set in standby mode if: • • • • 6 7 wheels lose traction 07 the foot brake is used speed falls below approx. 30 km/h the clutch pedal is depressed for longer than 1 minute7 A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. Disengaging and selecting a higher or lower gear does not involve standby mode. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 197 07 Driver support Cruise control* - resume set speed Related information • • The cruise control (p. 194) (CC – Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an even speed. After temporary deactivation and standby mode (p. 197) it is possible to resume the set speed. • The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with speed limiter8. To reactivate the cruise control from standby mode: The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without speed limiter8. • Press the steering wheel button > The combined instrument panel's marking (5) and symbol (6) change colour from GREY to WHITE and the speed is then set to the last speed stored. . NOTE A marked speed increase may occur once the speed has been resumed by selecting . 07 8 198 A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195) Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode (p. 197) Cruise control* - deactivate (p. 199) 07 Driver support Cruise control* - deactivate Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* The cruise control (CC – Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an even speed. How it is deactivated is described here. The adaptive cruise control (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. The adaptive cruise control provides a more relaxing driving experience on long journeys on motorways and long straight main roads in smooth traffic flows. The steering wheel buttons and display in cars with speed limiter9. The steering wheel buttons and display in cars without speed limiter9. The cruise control is deactivated with a steering wheel button (1) or by switching off the engine - the set speed is deleted from the memory and cannot be resumed with the button. Related information • • • • 9 The driver sets the desired speed (p. 203) and time interval to the car in front. When the radar detector detects a slower vehicle in front of the car, the speed is automatically adapted to that. When the road is clear again the car returns to the selected speed. If the adaptive cruise control is switched off or set to standby mode and the car comes too close to a vehicle in front, then the driver is warned instead by a Distance Alert (p. 214) about the short distance. Cruise control* (p. 194) Cruise control* - managing speed (p. 195) Cruise control* temporary deactivation and standby mode (p. 197) Cruise control* - resume set speed (p. 198) 07 A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 199 07 Driver support || WARNING The driver must always be observant with regard to the traffic conditions and intervene when the adaptive cruise control is not maintaining a suitable speed or suitable distance. The adaptive cruise control cannot handle all traffic, weather and road conditions. Read all the sections about the adaptive cruise control in the owner's manual in order to learn about its limitations, of which the driver should be aware before it is used. The driver always bears responsibility for maintaining the correct distance and speed, even when the adaptive cruise control is being used. IMPORTANT Related information • Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 202) • Adaptive cruise control* - function (p. 200) • Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval (p. 204) • Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode (p. 204) • Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate (p. 206) • Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking another vehicle (p. 205) • Adaptive cruise control* - switch cruise control functionality (p. 208) • Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and action (p. 211) • Adaptive cruise control* - symbols and messages (p. 212) Maintenance of adaptive cruise control components must only be performed at a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. 07 Automatic gearbox Cars with automatic gearbox have enhanced functionality with the adaptive cruise control's Queue Assist (p. 206). 10 200 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may differ depending on car model. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Adaptive cruise control* - function The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. Function overview10. Warning lamp - braking by driver required Steering wheel (p. 77) keypad Radar sensor (p. 209) Adaptive cruise control consists of a cruise control system and a coordinated spacing system. 07 Driver support WARNING Adaptive cruise control is not a collision avoidance system. The driver must intervene if the system does not detect a vehicle in front. The adaptive cruise control does not brake for humans or animals, and not for small vehicles such as bicycles and motorcycles. Nor for oncoming, slow or stationary vehicles and objects. Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at junctions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of water or slush on the road, in heavy rain/snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or on slip roads. The distance to the vehicle ahead is mainly measured by a radar sensor. Cruise control regulates the speed with acceleration and braking. It is normal for the brakes to emit a low sound when they are being used by the adaptive cruise control. WARNING The brake pedal moves when Cruise Control brakes. Do not rest your foot beneath the brake pedal as it may become trapped. The adaptive cruise control aims to follow the vehicle ahead in the same lane according to 11 what the driver set for time interval (p. 204). If the radar sensor cannot see any vehicle in front then the car will instead maintain the cruise control's set speed. This also happens if the speed of the vehicle in front exceeds the cruise control's set speed. does not brake, then cruise control uses the warning lamp and warning sound from the collision warning system (p. 223) in order to alert the driver that immediate intervention is required. NOTE The adaptive cruise control aims to control the speed in a smooth way. In situations that demand sudden braking the driver must brake himself/herself. This applies with large differences in speed, or if the vehicle in front brakes heavily. Due to limitations in the radar sensor (p. 209) braking may come unexpectedly or not at all. The adaptive cruise control can be activated to follow another vehicle at speeds from 30 km/h11 up to 200 km/h. If the speed falls below 30 km/h or if the engine speed becomes too low, the cruise control is set in standby mode at which automatic braking ceases - the driver must then take over himself/herself to maintain a safe distance to the vehicle ahead. Warning lamp - braking by driver required Adaptive cruise control has a braking capacity that is equivalent to more than 40% of the car's braking capacity. If the car needs to be braked more heavily than cruise control capacity and the driver The warning lamp may be difficult to see in strong sunlight or when wearing sunglasses. WARNING Cruise Control warns only of vehicles which the radar sensor has detected. Hence the warning may not be given, or it may be given with a certain delay. Do not wait for a warning without braking when so required. Steep roads and/or heavy load Bear in mind that the adaptive cruise control is primarily intended for use when driving on level road surfaces. It may have difficulty in keeping the correct distance from the vehicle ahead when driving on steep downhill slopes, with a heavy load or with a trailer - in which case, be extra attentive and ready to slow down. 07 Related information • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Queue Assist (p. 206) (in cars with automatic gearbox) can operate in the range of 0-200 km/h. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 201 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - overview Operation of the adaptive cruise control (p. 199) and steering wheel keypad varies depending on whether or not the car is equipped with speed limiter (p. 191)12. Adaptive cruise control with Speed limiter 202 ACC is active at the GREEN symbol (WHITE = standby mode). ACC is active at the GREEN symbol (WHITE = standby mode). Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. Cruise control - On/Off or Standby mode. Standby mode ceases and the stored speed is resumed. Time interval - Increase/decrease. Standby mode Activate and adjust the speed. Time interval - Increase/decrease. (Not used) Activate and adjust the speed. Green marking at stored speed (WHITE = standby mode). Green marking at stored speed (WHITE = standby mode). 12 Time distance Adaptive cruise control without Speed limiter Cruise control - On/Off. 07 Time distance A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Adaptive cruise control* - managing speed (p. 203) • Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval (p. 204) • Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode (p. 204) 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - managing speed At the same time a speed range is marked: The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. • the higher speed with GREEN marking is the preprogrammed speed To enable cruise control: • the lower speed is the speed of the car in front. • Changing the speed -a Press the steering wheel button similar WHITE symbol is illuminated in the combined instrument panel (p. 212) which shows that the cruise control is in standby mode (p. 204). At the required speed - press the steering or . wheel button > The current speed is stored in the memory, the combined instrument panel shows a "magnifying glass" around the selected speed for a second or so and its marking changes from WHITE to GREEN. When this symbol changes colour from WHITE to GREEN, the cruise control is active and the car maintains the stored speed. In certain situations, cruise control cannot be activated. In this case, the combined instrument panel (p. 212) shows Cruise control Unavailable. To change the stored speed: • To activate cruise control: • NOTE If any of the Cruise Control buttons are held depressed for several minutes then it is blocked and deactivated. To be able to reactivate Cruise Control, the car must be stopped and the engine restarted. or Adjust with short presses on every press gives +/- 5 km/h. The last presses made are stored in the memory. If speed is increased using the accelerator pedal prior to pressing the / button, then it is the car's current speed when the button is pressed that is stored in the cruise control. Related information • • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Adaptive cruise control* - overview (p. 202) To adjust +/- 1 km/h: • Hold down the button and release it at the required speed. 07 Only when the symbol shows an image of another vehicle is the distance to the vehicle in front controlled by the cruise control. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 203 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - set time interval The same symbol is also shown when Distance Alert (p. 214) is activated. The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. NOTE Only use the time intervals permitted by local traffic regulations. If Cruise Control does not appear to react when activated, this may be because the time distance to the car in front is preventing an increase in speed. Different time intervals to the vehicle in front can be selected and shown in the combined instrument panel as 1-5 horizontal lines - the more lines the longer the time interval. One line corresponds to approximately 1 second to the vehicle in front, 5 lines approximately 3 seconds. To set/change the time distance: • Turn the steering wheel button set's thumbwheel (or use the / buttons for cars without Speed limiters). The higher the speed the longer the calculated distance in metres for a given time interval. Read more about how you manage the speed (p. 203). • The adaptive cruise control allows the time interval to vary noticeably in certain situations in order to allow the car to follow the vehicle in front smoothly and comfortably. Note that a short time interval only allows the driver a short time to react and take action if any unforeseen traffic problem should arise. 204 The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver to maintain an even speed and a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. The cruise control can be temporarily deactivated and set in standby mode. Temporary deactivation - standby mode with Speed limiter To temporarily disengage adaptive cruise control and set it in standby mode: • * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Press the steering wheel button This symbol and stored speed marking then changes colour from GREEN to WHITE. Related information At low speed, when the distances are short, the adaptive cruise control increases the time interval slightly. 07 Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode Temporary deactivation - standby mode without Speed limiter To temporarily disengage cruise control and set it in standby mode: • Press the steering wheel button Standby mode due to driver intervention The adaptive cruise control is temporarily disengaged and set automatically in standby mode if: 07 Driver support • • the foot brake is used An automatic deactivation can be due to: the clutch pedal is depressed for longer than 1 minute13 • • • • • • • • the gear selector/lever is moved to neutral position N (automatic gearbox) • the driver maintains a speed higher than the set speed for longer than 1 minute. The driver must then regulate the speed. A temporary increase in speed with the accelerator pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not affect the cruise control setting - the car returns to the last stored speed when the accelerator pedal is released. For more information, see the sections Managing speed (p. 203) and Overtaking another vehicle (p. 205). Automatic standby mode The adaptive cruise control is dependent on other systems, e.g. Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185). If any of these systems stop working then cruise control is automatically deactivated. In the event of automatic deactivation a signal will sound and the message Cruise control Cancelled is shown in the combined instrument panel. The driver must then intervene and adapt the speed and distance to the vehicle ahead. 13 14 15 Adaptive cruise control* - overtaking another vehicle the driver opens the door The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead and it can also assist during overtaking. the driver takes off his seatbelt engine speed is too low/high speed has fallen below 30 km/h14 wheels lose traction Read more about the different time intervals (p. 204) to the vehicle in front. brake temperature is high the radar sensor is covered e.g. by wet snow or heavy rain (radar waves blocked). For more information on symbols, messages and their meaning, see section Symbols and messages in the display (p. 212). Resume set speed Adaptive cruise control in standby mode is reactivated with one press on the steering - the speed is then set to the wheel button last stored speed. When the car is following another vehicle and the driver indicates an impending overtaking manoeuvre with the direction indicator15, the adaptive cruise control helps to briefly accelerate the car towards the vehicle in front. This function is active at speeds above 70 km/h. Read more about how you manage the speed (p. 203). WARNING NOTE Be aware that this function can be activated in more situations other than during overtaking, e.g. when a direction indicator is used to indicate a change of lane or exit to another road - the car will then accelerate briefly. A marked speed increase may occur once the speed has been resumed by selecting . Related information • • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and action (p. 211) 07 Related information • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Disengaging and selecting a higher or lower gear does not involve standby mode. Does not apply to a car with Queue Assistant - it can go all the way down to 0 km/h. On left flash only in left-hand-drive car, or right flash in right-hand-drive car. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 205 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - deactivate The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. Keypad with Speed limiter The adaptive cruise control is disengaged with a short press of the steering wheel but. The set speed is cleared and cannot ton button. be resumed with the Keypad without Speed limiter A short press on the steering wheel button sets the adaptive cruise control in standby mode. With a further short press the cruise control is deactivated. The set speed is cleared and cannot be resumed with the button. Related information • 07 206 Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Adaptive Cruise Control* - Queue Assist The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. Queue Assist also provides the adaptive cruise control with enhanced functionality at speeds lower than 30 km/h. In cars with automatic gearbox the adaptive cruise control is supplemented with the Queue Assist function (also referred to as "Queue Assist"). Extended speed range NOTE In order to activate the cruise control the driver's door must be closed and the driver must be wearing the seatbelt. With an automatic gearbox, the adaptive cruise control can follow another vehicle within the range 0-200 km/h. NOTE Activation of the cruise control below 30 km/h requires a vehicle in front within a reasonable distance. Queue Assistant has the following functions: • Extended speed range - also at lower than 30 km/h and at stationary • • Change of target Automatic braking ceases when stationary Note that the lowest programmable speed for the adaptive cruise control is 30 km/h - even though the cruise control is capable of following another vehicle down to a standstill, a lower speed cannot be selected. Learn more about how you manage the speed (p. 199) and different time intervals to the vehicle in front (p. 204). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. For shorter stops in connection with inching in slow traffic or at traffic lights driving is automatically resumed if the stops do not exceed approx. 3 seconds - if it takes longer before the car in front starts moving again then the cruise control is set in standby mode (p. 204) with automatic braking. The driver must then reactivate it in one of the following ways: • Press the steering wheel button . or • Depress the accelerator pedal. > The cruise control will then resume following the vehicle in front. 07 Driver support NOTE WARNING Queue Assist can keep the car stationary for a maximum of 4 minutes - then the brakes release. When the adaptive cruise control is following a vehicle ahead at speeds in excess of 30 km/h and the target is changed from a vehicle ahead to a stationary vehicle, the cruise control will ignore the stationary vehicle and instead select the stored speed. See more information under the header below, "Cessation of automatic braking when stationary". • Change of target fore intervene and brake the car himself in order to maintain its position. IMPORTANT Queue Assist can keep the car stationary for a maximum of 4 minutes - then the brakes release. The driver's attention is drawn to this over several stages, with increasing intensity: The driver must intervene him/herself and brake. 1. Acoustic alarm (pinging) and text message. Automatic standby mode with change of target 2. A warning lamp in the windscreen also starts to flash. The adaptive cruise control is disengaged and set in standby mode: If the target vehicle in front suddenly turns then there may be stationary traffic in front. When the adaptive cruise control is following another vehicle at speeds lower than 30 km/h and changes target from a moving to a stationary vehicle, the cruise control will slow down for the stationary vehicle. • when the speed is below 5 km/h and cruise control is not sure whether the target object is a stationary vehicle or some other object, e.g. a speed bump. • when the speed is below 5 km/h and the vehicle in front turns off so the cruise control no longer has a vehicle to follow. 3. "Stabbing" braking occurs. For more information on symbols, messages and their meaning, see the section Symbols and messages in the display (p. 212). Queue Assist releases the foot brake and is set to standby mode in these situations as well: • the driver puts his/her foot on the brake pedal In the following situations, Queue Assist stops automatic braking at a standstill: • the gear selector is moved to P, N or R position • • • the driver sets the cruise control in standby mode • the parking brake is applied. Termination of automatic braking at a standstill the driver opens the door the driver takes off his seatbelt. This means that the brakes are released and the car will start to roll - the driver must there- 07 }} 207 07 Driver support || Related information • • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Adaptive cruise control* - switch cruise control functionality (p. 208) Adaptive cruise control* - switch cruise control functionality The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. Switch from Adaptive cruise control to Cruise control A button press can be used to deactivate the adaptive element (spacing system) in the adaptive cruise control (p. 199), with the car then only following the set speed. • Hold down the steering wheel button - the combined instrument panel's symto . bol changes from > By these means the cruise control is activated. WARNING The car no longer brakes automatically after switching from ACC to CC - it merely follows the set speed. 07 Switch back from Cruise control to Adaptive cruise control Switch off cruise control with 1-2 presses on . The next time the system is switched on it is the Adaptive cruise control that is activated. 208 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode (p. 204) 07 Driver support Radar sensor Radar sensor - limitations The function of the radar sensor is to detect cars or larger vehicles in the same direction, in the same lane. The radar sensor (p. 209) has certain limitations, due to its limited field of vision, amongst other things. The radar sensor is used by the following functions: The capacity of the radar sensor to detect vehicles in front is reduced significantly: • • Adaptive cruise control* • • Distance Warning* Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Pedestrian Detection* Modification of the radar sensor could result in it being illegal to use. NOTE Keep the surface in front of the radar sensor clean. IMPORTANT In the event of visible damage to the car's grille, or if you suspect that the radar sensor may be damaged: • Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The function may completely or partially disappear - or malfunction - if the grille, the radar sensor or its bracket is damaged or has loosened. Related information • • • • Radar sensor - limitations (p. 209) Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Collision warning system* (p. 223) Distance Warning* (p. 214) if the radar sensor becomes blocked and cannot detect other vehicles e.g. in heavy rain or slush, or if other objects have collected in front of the radar sensor. • if the speed of vehicles in front is significantly different from your own speed. Field of vision The radar sensor has a limited field of vision. In some situations another vehicle is not detected, or the detection is made later than expected. ACC field of vision. Sometimes the radar sensor is late at detecting vehicles at close distances, e.g. a vehicle that drives in between the car and vehicles in front. Small vehicles, such as motorcycles, or vehicles not driving in the centre of the lane can remain undetected. 07 In bends the radar sensor may detect the wrong vehicle or lose a detected vehicle from view. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 209 07 Driver support || WARNING WARNING The driver must always be observant with regard to the traffic conditions and intervene when the adaptive cruise control is not maintaining a suitable speed or suitable distance. Adaptive cruise control is not a collision avoidance system. The driver must intervene if the system does not detect a vehicle in front. The adaptive cruise control does not brake for humans or animals, and not for small vehicles such as bicycles and motorcycles. Nor for oncoming, slow or stationary vehicles and objects. The adaptive cruise control cannot handle all traffic, weather and road conditions. Read all the sections about the adaptive cruise control in the owner's manual in order to learn about its limitations, of which the driver should be aware before it is used. The driver always bears responsibility for maintaining the correct distance and speed, even when the adaptive cruise control is being used. WARNING Accessories or other objects such as auxiliary lamps must not be fitted in front of the grille. Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at junctions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of water or slush on the road, in heavy rain/snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or on slip roads. Related information • • • 07 210 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) Collision warning system* (p. 223) Distance Warning* (p. 214) 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and action The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. If the combined instrument panel shows the message Radar blocked See manual this means that the radar signals from the radar sensor (p. 209) are blocked and that vehicles in front of the car cannot be detected. The following table presents examples of possible causes for a message being shown along with the appropriate action: In turn this means that - apart from Adaptive Cruise Control - Distance Warning (p. 214) and Collision Warning (p. 223) with Auto Brake are not operating either. Cause Action The radar surface in the grille is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the radar surface in the grille from dirt, ice and snow. Heavy rain or snow blocking the radar signals. No action. Sometimes the radar does not work during heavy rain or snowfall. Water or snow from the road surface swirls up and blocks the radar signals. No action. Sometimes the radar does not work on a very wet or snowy road surface. The radar surface has been cleaned but the message remains. Wait. It could take several minutes for the radar to sense that it is no longer blocked. Related information • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) 07 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 211 07 Driver support Adaptive cruise control* - symbols and messages maintain a safe distance from the vehicle ahead. The adaptive cruise control (p. 199) (ACC – Adaptive Cruise Control) helps the driver SymbolA Message Specification The symbol is WHITE Adaptive cruise control is set to Adaptive cruise control* - temporary deactivation, and standby mode (p. 204). The symbol is GREEN The car maintains the stored speed. Standard cruise control is selected manually. DSTC Normal to enable Cruise The adaptive cruise control cannot be activated until DSTC has been set to Normal mode - Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185). Cruise control Cancelled The adaptive cruise control has been deactivated - the driver has to regulate the speed himself. Cruise control Unavailable The adaptive cruise control cannot be activated. This could be due to: • • 07 212 brake temperature is high the radar sensor is blocked by e.g. wet snow or rain. For more information about fault tracing, see the section Adaptive cruise control* - fault tracing and action (p. 211) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support SymbolA Message Radar blocked See manual Specification The adaptive cruise control is temporarily disengaged. • The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if slush has collected in front of the radar sensor. The driver can then choose to switch to normal cruise control Cruise control* (p. 194) (CC) - a text message provides information on appropriate alternatives. Read more about radar sensor limitations (p. 209). Cruise control Service required The adaptive cruise control is disengaged. Press Brake To hold + acoustic alarm + warning light in windscreen + "pulling" brakes The car is at a standstill and the adaptive cruise control will release the foot brake, which is why the car may start rolling soon. • • Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The driver must brake himself/herself. The message remains and the alarm sounds until the driver depresses the brake pedal or uses the accelerator pedal. (Only with Queue Assistant) Below 30 km/h Only following Shown with attempts to activate the adaptive cruise control at speeds below 30 km/h without a vehicle in front within the activation distance (approx. 30 metres). (Only with Queue Assistant) A The symbols are schematic. 07 Related information • Adaptive cruise control (ACC)* (p. 199) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 213 07 Driver support Distance Warning* Distance Warning (Distance Alert) is a function that informs the driver about the time interval to vehicles in front. Distance Warning is active at speeds above 30 km/h and only reacts to vehicles driving in front of the car, in the same direction. No distance information is provided for oncoming, slow or stationary vehicles. NOTE Distance warning is deactivated during the time the adaptive cruise control is active. WARNING tion is handled by the car's menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Distance Alert. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Set time interval Distance warning only reacts if the distance to the vehicle ahead is shorter than the preset value - the speed of the driver's vehicle is not affected. Operation Controls and symbol for time interval. Time interval - Increase/decrease. Time interval - On. Orange-coloured warning 07 lamp16. An orange-coloured warning lamp in the windscreen illuminates with a constant glow if the distance to the vehicle in front is shorter than the set time interval. Press the button in the centre console to switch the function on or off. The function is switched on if one lamp is illuminated in the button. Some combinations of the selected equipment leave no vacant space for a button in the centre console - in which case the func- 16 214 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Different time intervals to the vehicle in front can be selected and shown in the combined instrument panel as 1-5 horizontal lines - the more lines the longer the time interval. One line corresponds to approximately 1 second to the vehicle in front, 5 lines approximately 3 seconds. 07 Driver support The same symbol is also shown when adaptive cruise control (p. 199) is activated. NOTE The higher the speed the longer the calculated distance in metres for a given time interval. The set time interval is also used by the function adaptive cruise control (p. 200). Only use the time intervals permitted by local traffic regulations. Related information • • Distance Alert* - limitations (p. 215) Distance Alert* - symbols and messages (p. 216) Distance Alert* - limitations Related information Distance Warning (Distance Alert) is a function that informs the driver about the distance to vehicles in front. The function, which uses the same radar sensor as the adaptive cruise control (p. 199) and collision warning with auto brake (p. 223), has some limitations. • • Distance Warning* (p. 214) Distance Alert* - symbols and messages (p. 216) NOTE Strong sunlight, reflections or strong variations in light intensity, as well as wearing sunglasses, could mean that the warning light in the windscreen cannot be seen. Poor weather or winding roads could affect the radar sensor's capacity to detect vehicles in front. The size of other vehicles could also affect detection capacity, e.g. motorcycles. This could mean that the warning lamp illuminates at a shorter distance than the setting or that the warning is temporarily absent. Extremely high speeds can also cause the lamp to illuminate at a shorter distance than that set due to limitations in sensor range. For further information on radar sensor limitations, see Radar sensor - limitations (p. 209) and Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228). * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 215 07 Driver support Distance Alert* - symbols and messages Distance Warning (p. 214) (Distance Alert) is a function that informs the driver about the time SymbolA interval to vehicles in front. The function has certain symbols and messages that can be displayed in the combined instrument panel if Message Specification Radar blocked See manual Distance Warning temporarily disengaged. the function is reduced due to its limitations (p. 215). Radar sensor (p. 209) is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if slush has collected in front of the radar sensor. For information, see Radar sensor - limitations (p. 209). Collision warn. Service required A Distance Warning and Collision Warning with Auto Brake (p. 229) fully or partially disengaged. Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The symbols are schematic. 07 216 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support City Safety™ Maintenance and replacement of City Safety™ components must only be performed by a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The City Safety™ function is active at speeds under 50 km/h and it helps the driver by automatically braking the car in the event of imminent risk of collision with vehicles in front, should the driver not react in time by braking and/or steering away. City Safety™ does not engage in all driving situations or traffic, weather or road conditions. City Safety™ does not react to vehicles driving in a different direction from the car, to small vehicles and motorcycles or to people and animals. City Safety™ can prevent collision at a speed difference of less than 15 km/h - at a higher speed difference, it is only possible to reduce collision speed. In order to obtain full brake function, the driver must depress the brake pedal. City Safety™ is designed to be activated as late as possible in order to avoid unnecessary intervention. The driver or passengers normally only notice City Safety™ if a situation arises where the car is extremely close to being in a collision. If the car is also equipped with Collision Warning with Auto Brake (p. 223)* these two systems complement each other. City Safety™ detects the traffic in front of the car with a laser sensor (p. 220) fitted in the top edge of the windscreen. If there is an imminent risk of collision, City Safety™ will automatically brake the car, which may be experienced as sudden braking. WARNING City Safety™ is activated in situations where the driver should have started braking earlier, which is why it cannot help the driver in every situation. City Safety™ must not be used as an excuse for the driver to change his/her driving style. If the driver solely relies on City Safety™ to do the braking, there might be a risk of a collision sooner or later. City Safety™ - function IMPORTANT City Safety™ is a function for helping the driver to avoid a collision when driving in queues, amongst other things, when changes in the traffic ahead, combined with a lapse in attention, could lead to an incident. Never wait for City Safety™ to engage. The driver always bears responsibility for maintaining the proper distance and speed. Related information • • • • • 07 City Safety™ - limitations (p. 219) City Safety™ - function (p. 217) City Safety™ - operation (p. 218) City Safety™ - laser sensor (p. 220) City Safety™ - symbols and messages (p. 222) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 217 07 Driver support || When the function is activated and brakes, the combined instrument panel shows a message (p. 222) to the effect that the function is/has been active. NOTE When City Safety™ brakes, the brake lights come on. City Safety™ - operation City Safety™ is a function for helping the driver to avoid a collision when driving in queues, amongst other things, when changes in the traffic ahead, combined with a lapse in attention, could lead to an incident. On and Off NOTE Related information Laser sensor transmitter and receiver window17. If the speed difference is 4-15 km/h in relation to the vehicle in front then City Safety™ can completely prevent a collision. • • • City Safety™ (p. 217) City Safety™ - operation (p. 218) City Safety™ - limitations (p. 219) City Safety™ activates a short, sharp braking and stops the car in normal circumstances, just behind the vehicle in front. For most drivers this is well outside normal driving style and may be experienced as being uncomfortable. 07 If the difference in speed between the vehicles is greater than 15 km/h then City Safety™ may not prevent the collision on its own. To obtain full brake force, the driver must depress the brake pedal. This could then make it possible to prevent a collision, even at speed differences above 15 km/h. 17 218 The City Safety™ function is always switched on after the engine has been started via key position I and II (p. 71). NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model. In certain situations, it may advisable to disable City Safety™, e.g. where leafy branches could sweep over the bonnet and/or windscreen. After starting the engine City Safety™ can be deactivated as follows: • Using MY CAR on the centre console display screen with its menu system, search and locate Settings Car settings Driver support systems City Safety. Select the Off option. See MY CAR (p. 104) for more information. 07 Driver support However, the function (p. 217) will be enabled the next time the engine is started, regardless of whether the system was enabled or disabled when the engine was switched off. WARNING The laser sensor (p. 220) emits laser light even when City Safety™ is disabled manually. To enable City Safety™ again: • Follow the same procedure as for disabling, but select the On option. Related information • • • City Safety™ (p. 217) City Safety™ - limitations (p. 219) City Safety™ - symbols and messages (p. 222) City Safety™ - limitations The sensor in City Safety™ is designed to detect cars and other large vehicles in front of the car irrespective of whether it is day or night. However, the function has a number of limitations. The sensor has poorer functionality - or none at all - in e.g. heavy snowfall or rain, dense fog, dust storms or white-out situations. Misting, dirt, ice or snow on the windscreen may also disrupt the function. Low-hanging objects, e.g. a flag/pennant for projecting load, or accessories such as auxiliary lamps and bull bars that are higher than the bonnet limit the function. The laser light from the sensor in City Safety™ measures how the light is reflected. The sensor cannot detect objects with low reflection capacity. The rear sections of the vehicle generally reflect the light sufficiently thanks to the number plate and rear light reflectors. City Safety™ is not activated at low speeds under 4 km/h, which is why the system does not intervene in situations where a vehicle in front is being approached very slowly, e.g. when parking. Driver commands are always prioritised, which is why City Safety™ does not intervene in situations where the driver is steering or accelerating in a clear manner, even if a collision is unavoidable. When City Safety™ has prevented a collision with a stationary object the car remains stationary for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car is braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, then speed is reduced to the same speed as that maintained by the vehicle in front. On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops when City Safety™ has stopped the car, unless the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal beforehand. NOTE • Keep the windscreen surface in front of the laser sensor (p. 220) free from ice, snow and dirt. For an illustration of sensor location, see City Safety™ function (p. 217). On slippery road surfaces the braking distance is extended, which may reduce the capacity of City Safety™ to avoid a collision. In such situations the ABS and DSTC systems will provide best possible braking force with maintained stability. • When your own car is reversing, City Safety™ is temporarily deactivated. Do not affix or mount anything on the windscreen in front of the laser sensor • Remove ice and snow from the bonnet - snow and ice must not exceed a height of 5 cm. 07 219 07 Driver support || Fault tracing and action IMPORTANT If the message (p. 222) Windscreen sensors blocked See manual is shown in the combined instrument panel it indicates that the laser sensor is blocked and cannot detect vehicles in front of the car. This means that City Safety™ is not operational. If there are cracks, scratches or stone chips in the windscreen in front of either of the laser sensor's "windows" and they cover a surface of approx. 0.5 x 3.0 mm (or larger), then a workshop must be contacted for replacement of the windscreen an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. For an illustration of sensor location, see City Safety™ - function (p. 217). The Windscreen sensors blocked See manual message is not shown for all situations in which the laser sensor is blocked. The driver must therefore be diligent about keeping the windscreen and area in front of the laser sensor clean. Failure to take action may result in reduced performance for City Safety™. 07 Action The windscreen surface in front of the laser sensor is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the windscreen surface in front of the sensor from dirt, ice and snow. The laser sensor field of vision is blocked. Remove the blocking object. The City Safety™ function includes a sensor which transmits laser light. Contact a qualified workshop in the event of a fault or if the laser sensor needs servicing - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. It is absolutely essential to follow the prescribed instructions when handling the laser sensor. The following two labels relate to the laser sensor: To avoid the risk of failed, deficient or reduced operation for City Safety™, the following also applies: The following table presents possible causes for the message being shown, along with suggestions for appropriate action. Cause City Safety™ - laser sensor • Volvo recommends that you do not repair cracks, scratches or stone chips in the area in front of the laser sensor instead, the whole windscreen should be replaced. • Before replacing a windscreen, contact an authorised Volvo workshop to verify that the correct windscreen is ordered and fitted. • The same type or Volvo-approved windscreen wipers must be fitted during replacement. The upper label in the figure describes the laser beam's classification: • Related information • • • 220 City Safety™ (p. 217) Laser radiation - Do not look into the laser beam with optical instruments Class 1M laser product. City Safety™ - function (p. 217) The lower label in the figure describes the laser beam's physical data: City Safety™ - operation (p. 218) • IEC 60825-1:1993 + A2:2001. Complies with FDA (U.S. Food Administration) 07 Driver support standards for laser product design with the exception of deviations in accordance with "Laser Notice No. 50" from 26 July 2001. Radiation data for the laser sensor WARNING If any of these instructions are not followed then there is a risk of eye injury! • Never look into the laser sensor (which emits spreading invisible laser radiation) at a distance of 100 mm or closer with magnifying optics such as a magnifying glass, microscope, lens or similar optical instruments. • Testing, repair, removal, adjustment and/or replacement of the laser sensor's spare parts must only be carried out by a qualified workshop - we recommend an authorised Volvo workshop. • To avoid exposure to harmful radiation, do not carry out any readjustments or maintenance other than those specified here. • The repairer must follow specially drawn up workshop information for the laser sensor. • Do not remove the laser sensor (this includes removing the lenses). A removed laser sensor fulfils laser class 3B as per standard IEC 60825-1. Laser class 3B is not eye-safe and therefore entails a risk of injury. The following table specifies the laser sensor's physical data. Maximum pulse energy Maximum average output Pulse duration Divergence (horizontal x vertical) 2.64 µJ 45 mW 33 ns 28° × 12° • • The laser sensor must be fitted onto the windscreen before the sensor's connector is plugged in. • The laser sensor transmits a laser light when the remote control key is in key position II (p. 71) even if the engine is switched off. Related information • City Safety™ (p. 217) 07 The laser sensor's connector must be unplugged before removal from the windscreen. 221 07 Driver support City Safety™ - symbols and messages In conjunction with automatic braking by the City Safety (p. 217)™ system, one or more SymbolA symbols (p. 222) may illuminate in the combined instrument panel and a text message may be shown. A text message can be acknowledged by briefly pressing the OK button on the direction indicator stalk. Message Meaning/Action Auto braking by City Safety City Safety™ is braking or has automatically braked. Windscreen sensors blocked See manual The laser sensor is temporarily non-operational because something is blocking it. • Remove the object blocking the sensor and/or clean the windscreen in front of the sensor. Read about the laser sensor's limitations. City Safety Service required City Safety™ is not operational. • A The symbols are schematic. Related information • • 07 222 City Safety™ (p. 217) City Safety™ - function (p. 217) Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. 07 Driver support Collision warning system* "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection is activated in situations where the driver should have started braking earlier, which is why it cannot help the driver in every situation. Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection is designed to be activated as late as possible in order to avoid unnecessary intervention. two variants, depending on how the car is equipped: • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) Level 1 • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) warned18 The driver is merely of occurring obstacles by means of visual and acoustic signals - no automatic braking intervenes, the driver must himself brake. Level 2 The driver is warned of occurring obstacles by means of visual and acoustic signals - the car is braked automatically if the driver himself does not act within a reasonable time. IMPORTANT Maintenance of components included in Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection must only be carried out in a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection may prevent a collision or reduce the collision speed. Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection must not be used as an excuse for the driver to change his/her driving style. If the driver solely relies on Collision Warning with Auto Brake to do the braking, there might be a risk of a collision sooner or later. Two system levels The Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection function is available in 18 Related information • Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) 07 No warning for cyclists with "Level 1". * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 223 07 Driver support Collision warning system* - function 3. Auto Brake20 3 - Auto Brake "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. The collision warning system and City Safety™ (p. 217) complement each other. The automatic brake function is activated last. 1 - Collision warning The driver is first warned of a potentially imminent collision. The collision warning system detects pedestrians, stationary vehicles as well as vehicles driving in the same direction in front of the car. If there is a risk of collision with a pedestrian or a vehicle then the driver's attention is attracted with a flashing red warning signal and an acoustic signal. 2 - Brake support Function overview19. Audio-visual warning signal in the event of a collision risk. Radar sensor20 07 Camera sensor Collision Warning with Auto Brake executes three steps in the following order: 1. Collision warning 2. Brake support20 19 20 224 If the risk of collision has increased further after the collision warning then the brake support is activated. This means that the brake system is prepared for rapid braking by applying the brakes lightly, which may feel like a slight jolt. If the brake pedal is depressed sufficiently quickly then full brake function is implemented. Brake support also reinforces the driver's braking if the system considers that the braking is not sufficient to avoid a collision. NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model. With system Level 2 only. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. If in this situation the driver has not yet started to take evasive action and the risk of collision is imminent then the automatic braking function is deployed - this takes place irrespective of whether or not the driver brakes. Braking then takes place with full brake force in order to reduce collision speed, or with limited brake force if it is sufficient to avoid a collision. For cyclists, the warning and full brake intervention may come very late or simultaneously. 07 Driver support WARNING The collision warning system does not engage in all driving situations or traffic, weather or road conditions. The collision warning system does not react to vehicles or cyclists driving in another direction to the car or to animals. Warning only activated in the event of a high risk for collision. This section "Function" and the section "Limitations" inform about limitations that the driver must be aware of before using the Collision Warning system with Auto Brake. Warnings and brake interventions for pedestrians and cyclists are deactivated at a vehicle speed exceeding 80 km/h. Collision warning system* - cyclist detection Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. Warnings and brake interventions for pedestrians and cyclists do not work in darkness and tunnels - not even when streetlights are lit. The auto-brake function can prevent a collision or reduce collision speed. To ensure full brake performance, the driver should always depress the brake pedal - even when the car auto-brakes. Never wait for a collision warning. The driver is always responsible that the correct distance and speed are maintained even when the collision warning system with auto-brake is used. Optimum examples of what the system interprets as a cyclist - with clear body and bicycle contours, directly from behind and in the car's centre line. Optimal performance of the system requires that the system function that detects a cyclist receives as unambiguous information as possible about the body and bicycle contours this implies the opportunity to identify the bicycle, head, arms, shoulders, legs, upper and lower body combined with a normal human pattern of movement. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 225 07 Driver support || If large parts of the cyclist's body or bicycle are not visible to the function's camera then the system cannot detect a cyclist. • The function's capacity to detect cyclists at dusk and dawn is limited - just like the human eye. • The function's capacity to detect cyclists is deactivated when driving in darkness and tunnels - even when streetlights are lit. • For optimum bicycle detection, the City Safety™ function must be activated, see City Safety™ (p. 217). WARNING Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Cyclist Detection is a means of assistance. The function can only "see" cyclists from behind, who are travelling in the same direction. • • 07 The bicycle must be equipped with a highly visible and approved21 rearwardfacing red reflector, fitted at least 70 cm above the roadway. • The function can only detect cyclists directly from behind and who are travelling in the same direction - not at an angle from behind, not from the side. • Cyclists travelling on the left or right-hand edge of the car's imagined/extended side lines may be detected late or not at all. 21 226 For the function to be able to detect a cyclist, he/she must be an adult and riding a "senior bicycle". The function cannot detect: • all cyclists in all situations and does not see partially obscured cyclists, for example. • cyclists in clothing that obscures the contours of the body or who are approaching from the side. • bicycles that have no rearward-facing red reflector. • bicycles loaded with large objects. The driver is always responsible that the vehicle is driven properly and with a safety distance adapted to the speed. The reflector must fulfil the recommendations and conditions of the traffic authority in the market in question. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) 07 Driver support Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. If large parts of the body are not visible to the camera then the system cannot detect a pedestrian. • Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) In order for a pedestrian to be detected he/she must appear full-length and have a height of at least 80 cm. • • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) The system cannot detect a pedestrian carrying larger items. • • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) The camera sensor's ability to see pedestrians at dusk and dawn is limited - just like the human eye. • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) • The camera sensor's capacity to detect pedestrians is deactivated when driving in darkness and tunnels - even when streetlights are lit. • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) WARNING Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Detection is an assistance tool. Optimal examples of what the system regards as pedestrians with clear body contours. Optimal performance of the system requires that the system function that detects pedestrians receives as unambiguous information as possible about the contours of the body this implies the opportunity to identify the head, arms, shoulders, legs, upper and lower body combined with a normal human pattern of movement. This function cannot detect all pedestrians in all situations and it cannot see e.g. partially obscured pedestrians, people in clothing that hides the contours of the body or pedestrians shorter than 80 cm. • The driver is always responsible that the vehicle is driven properly and with a safety distance adapted to the speed. 07 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 227 07 Driver support Collision warning system* - operation "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. Settings for the collision warning system are made from MY CAR via the centre console's screen and menu system. The warning lamp, see Collision warning system - function (p. 224), is tested every time the engine is started by briefly illuminating the warning lamp's separate points of light if the collision warning system's light and acoustic warnings are activated. Audible signal The warning sound can be activated/deactivated separately: • Warning signals On and Off It is possible to select whether the collision warning system's acoustic and visual warning signals should be switched on or off. When starting the engine, the setting that was selected when the engine was switched off is obtained automatically. NOTE Set warning distance The warning distance regulates the distance at which the visual and acoustic warnings are deployed. • The Brake Support and Auto Brake functions are always activated - they cannot be deactivated. 07 Light and acoustic signals To deactivate the light and acoustic signals: • 228 Locate Settings Car settings Driver support systems Collision Warning - there select to uncheck the box. Select On or Off in the menu system under Settings Car settings Driver support systems Collision Warning Warning sound. Select Long, Normal or Short in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Driver support systems Collision Warning Warning distance The warning distance determines the system's sensitivity. Warning distance Long provides an earlier warning. First test with Long and if this setting produces too many warnings, which could be perceived as irritating in certain situations, then change to warning distance Normal. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Only use warning distance Short in exceptional cases, e.g. for dynamic driving. NOTE When the adaptive cruise control is in use the warning lamp and warning sound will be used by the cruise control even if the collision warning system is switched off. The collision warning system warns the driver in the event of a risk of a collision, but the function cannot shorten driver reaction time. In order for the collision warning system to be effective, always drive with Distance Alert (p. 214) set at time interval 4–5. NOTE Even if the warning distance has been set to Long warnings could be perceived as being late in certain situations, e.g. when there are large differences in speed or if vehicles in front brake heavily. WARNING No automatic system can guarantee 100 % correct function in all situations. Therefore, never test Collision Warning with Auto Brake by driving at people or vehicles - this may cause severe damage and injury and risk lives. 07 Driver support Checking settings The settings required can be controlled on the centre console's screen. Search with the menu system MY CAR under Settings Car settings Driver support systems Collision Warning, MY CAR (p. 104). Maintenance Collision warning system* - general limitations Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) The function has certain limitations - for example, it is not active until approx. 4 km/h.. • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) The collision warning system's visual warning signal may be difficult to notice in the event of strong sunlight, reflections, when sunglasses are being worn or if the driver is not looking straight ahead. The warning sound should therefore always be activated. Camera and radar sensor22. For the sensors to work correctly, they must be kept clear of dirt, ice and snow, and be cleaned regularly with water and car shampoo. On slippery road surfaces the braking distance is extended, which may reduce the capacity to avoid a collision. In such situations the ABS and DSTC (p. 185) systems will provide best possible braking force with maintained stability. 07 NOTE Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will reduce their function and may prevent measurement. 22 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 229 07 Driver support || NOTE WARNING The visual warning signal can be temporarily disengaged in the event of high passenger compartment temperature caused by strong sunlight for example. If this occurs then the warning sound is activated even if it is deactivated in the menu system. Warnings and brake interventions could be implemented late or not at all if the traffic situation or external influences mean that the radar or camera sensor cannot detect a pedestrian, a vehicle or a cyclist in front correctly. • The sensor system has a limited range for pedestrians and cyclists23 - the system can provide effective warnings and brake interventions for them at vehicle speeds up to 50 km/h. For stationary or slow-moving vehicles, warnings and brake interventions are effective at vehicle speeds up to 70 km/h. Warnings may not appear if the distance to the vehicle in front is small or if steering wheel and pedal movements are large, e.g. a very active driving style. Warnings for stationary or slow-moving vehicles could be disengaged due to darkness or poor visibility. Warnings and brake interventions for pedestrians and cyclists are deactivated at vehicle speeds exceeding 80 km/h. The collision warning system uses the same radar sensors as the adaptive cruise control (p. 199). If warnings are perceived as being too frequent or disturbing then the warning distance can be reduced. This then leads to the system providing a warning at a later stage, which reduces the total number of warnings; see Collision warning system - operation (p. 228). 07 23 230 For cyclists, the warning and full brake intervention may come very late or simultaneously. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily deactivated with reverse gear engaged. Collision Warning with Auto Brake is not activated at low speeds - under 4 km/h, which is why the system does not intervene in situations where the car is approaching a vehicle in front very slowly, e.g. when parking. In situations where the driver demonstrates active, aware driving behaviour, a collision warning may be postponed slightly in order to keep unnecessary warnings to a minimum. When Auto Brake has prevented a collision with a stationary object the car remains stationary for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car is braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, then speed is reduced to the same speed as that maintained by the vehicle in front. On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops when Auto Brake has stopped the car, unless the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal beforehand. Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) 07 Driver support • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. The function uses the car's camera sensor, which has certain limitations. The car’s camera sensor is also used - as well as by Collision Warning with Auto Brake - by the functions: • • • • Active high beam (p. 83) Road sign information (p. 188) fog for example. Under such conditions the functions of camera-dependent systems could be significantly reduced or temporarily disengaged. Strong oncoming light, reflections in the carriageway, snow or ice on the road surface, dirty road surfaces or unclear lane markings could also significantly reduce camera sensor function when it is used to scan the carriageway and detect pedestrians and other vehicles. The field of vision of the camera sensor is limited, which is why pedestrians, cyclists and vehicles cannot be detected in some situations, or they are detected later than anticipated. During very high temperatures the camera is temporarily switched off for approx. 15 minutes after the engine is started in order to protect camera functionality. Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 235) Lane Keeping Aid (p. 239). NOTE Keep the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor free from ice, snow, mist and dirt. Do not stick or attach anything to the windscreen in front of the camera sensor as this may reduce effectiveness or cause one or more of the systems dependent on the camera to stop working. The camera sensors have limitations similar to the human eye, i.e. they "see" worse in darkness, heavy snowfall or rain and in thick Fault tracing and action If the display shows the message Windscreen Sensors blocked then this means that the camera sensor is blocked and cannot detect pedestrians, cyclists, vehicles or road markings in front of the car. 07 At the same time, this means that - besides Collision Warning with Auto Brake - the Automatic main/dipped beam dimming, Road Sign Information, Driver Alert Control and Lane * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 231 07 Driver support || Keeping Aid functions will not have full functionality either. The following table presents possible causes for a message being shown along with the appropriate action. 07 232 Cause Action The windscreen surface in front of the camera is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera from dirt, ice and snow. Thick fog, heavy rain or snow means that the camera does not work sufficiently well. No action. At times the camera does not work during heavy rain or snowfall. Cause Action The windscreen surface in front of the camera has been cleaned but the message remains. Wait. It may take several minutes for the camera to measure the visibility. Dirt has appeared between the inside of the windscreen and the camera. Visit a workshop to have the windscreen inside the camera cover cleaned - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) • Collision warning system* - symbols and message (p. 233) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Collision warning system* - symbols and message assist the driver when there is a risk of colliding with a pedestrian, bicycle or vehicle in front that are stationary or moving in the same direction. "Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Cyclist and Pedestrian Detection" is an aid to SymbolA Message Specification Collis'n warning OFF Collision warning system switched off. Shown when the engine is started. The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the OK button. Collision warn. Unavailable The collision warning system cannot be activated. Shown when the driver attempts to activate the function. The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the OK button. Auto braking was activated Auto Brake has been active. Windscreen sensors blocked See manual Camera sensor is temporarily disengaged. The message clears after one press of the OK button. Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example. • A Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor. Radar blocked See manual Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily disengaged. Collision warn. Service required Collision Warning with Auto Brake is fully or partially disengaged. Radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if slush has collected in front of the radar sensor. • 07 Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Symbols are schematic - may vary by market and car model. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 233 07 Driver support || Related information • • Collision warning system* (p. 223) Collision warning system* - function (p. 224) • Collision warning system* - detection of pedestrians (p. 227) • Collision warning system* - cyclist detection (p. 225) • Collision warning system* - operation (p. 228) • Collision warning system* - general limitations (p. 229) • Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) 07 234 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Driver Alert System* Driver Alert Control (DAC)* Driver aid status The Driver Alert System is intended to assist drivers whose driving ability is deteriorating or who are inadvertently leaving the lane they are driving on. DAC is intended to attract the driver's attention when he/she starts to drive less consistently, e.g. if he/she becomes distracted or starts to fall asleep. The Driver Alert System consists of different functions which can either be switched on at the same time or individually: The objective for DAC is to detect slowly deteriorating driving ability and it is primarily intended for major roads. • Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation (p. 236). • Lane keeping assistant - operation (p. 241). A switched-on function is set in standby mode and is not activated automatically until speed exceeds 65 km/h. The function is deactivated again when speed decreases to below 60 km/h. The functions use a camera which is dependent on the lane having side markings painted on each side. WARNING Driver Alert System does not work in all situations but is designed merely as a supplementary aid. The driver always bears ultimate responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely. The current status for all driver aids can be checked in MY CAR (p. 106). Related information • • • Driver Alert Control (DAC)* (p. 235) Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols and messages (p. 237) Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation (p. 236) A camera detects the side markings painted on the carriageway and compares the section of the road with the driver's steering wheel movements. The driver is alerted if the vehicle does not follow the carriageway evenly. 07 In some cases driving ability is not affected despite driver fatigue. In which case there may not be any warning issued for the driver. For this reason it is always important to stop and take a break in the event of any signs of * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 235 07 Driver support || driver fatigue, irrespective of whether or not DAC issues a warning. NOTE Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation Settings for Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 235) are made from the centre console screen and its menu system (p. 104). The function must not be used to extend a period of driving. Always plan breaks at regular intervals, and make sure you are well rested. If the vehicle is being driven erratically, the driver is notified by an acoustic signal plus the text message (p. 237) Driver Alert Time for a break - the linked symbol is illuminated in the combined instrument panel at the same time. The warning is repeated after a time if driving ability does not improve. The warning symbol can go off: Limitation • In some cases the system may issue a warning despite driving ability not deteriorating, for example: • • WARNING An alarm should be taken very seriously, as a sleepy driver is often not aware of his/her own condition. in strong side winds on rutted road surfaces. DAC is not intended for city traffic. NOTE 07 236 • • Driver Alert System* (p. 235) • Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols and messages (p. 237) • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) In the event of an alarm or a feeling of tiredness; stop the car in a safe manner as soon as possible and rest. To set Driver Alert in standby mode: • The camera sensor has certain limitations, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231). Related information Press the left stalk switch OK button. In MY CAR, search for Car settings Driver support systems Driver Alert and check the box - No check in the box means: Standby function disengaged. Driver Alert is activated when speed exceeds 65 km/h and remains active as long as the speed is over 60 km/h. Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation (p. 236) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Studies have shown that it is equally as dangerous to drive while tired as it is under the influence of alcohol. Related information • • • Driver Alert System* (p. 235) Driver Alert Control (DAC)* (p. 235) Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) 07 Driver support Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - symbols and messages instrument panel or in the centre console's screen in different situations. Driver Alert Control - DAC (p. 235) can show symbols and text messages in the combined Combined instrument panel SymbolA Message Specification Driver Alert Time for a break The vehicle has been driven inconsistently - the driver is alerted by an acoustic warning signal + text. Windscreen sensors blocked See manual The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged. Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example. • Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231). Driver Alert system Service required A The system is disengaged. • Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. The symbols are schematic. Display Symbol Message Specification Driver Alert OFF The function is disengaged. Driver Alert Available The function is activated. 07 }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 237 07 Driver support || Symbol Message Specification Driver Alert Standby <65 km/h The function is set in standby mode due to speed being lower than 65 km/h. Driver Alert Unavailable The carriageway does not have clear side markings or the camera sensor is temporarily disengaged. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231). Related information • • Driver Alert System* (p. 235) • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) Driver Alert Control (DAC)* - operation (p. 236) 07 238 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Lane Keeping Aid* Lane keeping assistant - function WARNING The lane keeping assistant is one of the functions in the Driver Alert System - sometimes also referred to as LKA (Lane Keeping Aid). The lane keeping assistant is intended for use on motorways and similar major roads to reduce the risk of the vehicle accidentally leaving its own lane in certain situations. LKA is merely a driver's aid and does not engage in all driving situations or traffic, weather or road conditions. Off & On The driver always bears ultimate responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely and that applicable laws and road traffic regulations are followed. The Lane Keeping Aid is active within the speed interval 65-200 km/h on roads with clearly visible side lines. The function is temporarily deactivated on narrow roads with less than 2.6 metres between the lane side lines. Related information A camera reads the painted side lines of the road/lane. If the car is about to cross a side line, the Lane Keeping Aid actively steers the car back into the lane with slight steering torque in the steering wheel. If the car reaches or passes a side line, the Lane Keeping Aid warns the driver with pulsing vibrations in the steering wheel. • • Driver Alert System* (p. 235) • • Lane keeping assistant - function (p. 239) • Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages (p. 243) Lane keeping assistant - limitations (p. 241) Lane keeping assistant - operation (p. 241) Press the button in the centre console to activate or deactivate the function. The function is switched on if one lamp is illuminated in the button. Some combinations of the selected equipment leave no vacant space for an On/Off button in the centre console - in which case the function is handled instead by the car's menu system MY CAR. Here, proceed as follows: * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 239 07 Driver support || • Select On or Off under Settings settings Lane Keeping Aid. Car For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106). In addition, the following selections can be made in MY CAR: • Warning with vibration in the steering wheel: Vibration only - On or Off. • Active steering: Steering assist only On or Off. Both Warning with vibration in the steering wheel and Active steering: Full function - On or Off. • If the vehicle approaches the left or right side line of the lane and the direction indicator is not activated, the car is steered back into the lane. Warning with vibration in the steering wheel LKA does not engage in sharp inside curves. Active steering The Lane Keeping Aid strives to keep the car within the side lines for the lane. LKA steers and warns with pulsing steering wheel vibrations24. If the vehicle passes a side line, the Lane Keeping Aid warns the driver with pulsing vibrations in the steering wheel. This occurs regardless of whether the car is actively steered back by applying a slight steering torque. 07 LKA intervenes and steers away. 24 240 Dynamic cornering The figure shows 3 pulsing vibrations when the side line is passed. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. In certain cases, the Lane Keeping Aid allows the car to cross side lines without engaging active steering or warning with pulsing vibrations in the steering wheel. Using an adjacent lane for dynamic cornering when there is a clear line of vision is an example of one such case. Related information • • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - limitations (p. 241) • Lane keeping assistant - operation (p. 241) • Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages (p. 243) 07 Driver support Lane keeping assistant - operation Lane keeping assistant - limitations The lane keeping assistant is supplemented with self-explanatory graphics in different situations. Here are some examples: • The Lane Keeping Aid camera sensor is restricted in a similar way to the human eye. For more information, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) and (p. 229). NOTE LKA is temporarily deactivated for as long as the direction indicator is switched on. NOTE LKA intervenes on the right-hand side (marked in red in the figure). The Lane Keeping Aid intervenes and steers away from the side line - this is indicated with: • RED line for the side in question. Related information LKA "sees" and follows the side lines (marked in red in the figure). If the Lane Keeping Aid is active and detects/"sees" the side lines, the LKA symbol indicates this with WHITE lines. • GREY side line – the Lane Keeping Aid does not see a line on that side of the car. • • • • • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) Driver Alert System* (p. 235) Examples of such a situation could be: • • • • • roadworks winter road conditions poor road surface very sporty driving style poor weather with reduced visibility. Hands on the steering wheel Lane keeping assistant - limitations (p. 241) Lane keeping assistant - function (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages (p. 243) In certain demanding situations LKA may find it difficult to assist the driver correctly - in which case it is recommended that LKA is switched off. In order for Lane Keeping Aid to operate, the driver must have his/her hands on the steering wheel. LKA continual monitors this. If hands are not detected on the steering wheel, a text message encouraging the driver to actively steer the car is shown. 07 If the driver does not follow the request to begin steering, the Lane Keeping Aid goes into standby mode and will remain in this mode until the driver begins to steer the car again. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 241 07 Driver support || Related information • • • • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - function (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - operation (p. 241) Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages (p. 243) 07 242 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Lane keeping assistant - symbols and messages the combined instrument panel in combination with an explanatory message - follow the recommendation given if appropriate. In situations where there is no LKA function or it is interrupted, a symbol may be shown in SymbolA Message examples: Message Specification Lane Keeping Aid Unavailable at this speed The Lane Keeping Aid is set to standby mode because the speed is lower than 65 km/h. Lane Keeping Aid Unavailable for current markings The lane does not have clear side lines or the camera sensor is temporarily disengaged. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) and (p. 229). Lane Keeping Aid Available The function scans the lane's side lines. Windscreen sensors blocked See manual The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged. Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example. • Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor. Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see Collision warning system* - camera sensor limitations (p. 231) and (p. 229). A Lane Keeping Aid Service required The system is disengaged. Lane Keeping Aid Interrupted LKA has been set to standby mode. The lines of the LKA symbol indicate when the function is active again. • Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. 07 The table's symbols are schematic. The symbols shown in the combined instrument panel may have a slightly different appearance. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 243 07 Driver support || Related information • • • • Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - limitations (p. 241) Lane keeping assistant - function (p. 239) Lane keeping assistant - operation (p. 241) 07 244 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Park assist syst* Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking. An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the centre console's display screen indicate the distance to the detected obstacle. Parking assistance sound level can be adjusted during the ongoing acoustic signal using the centre console's VOL knob or in the car's menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 104). Park assist syst* - function Related information • Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors (p. 248) • • • • • • Park assist syst* - function (p. 245) Park assist syst* - forward (p. 247) Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 248) The parking assistance system is automatically activated when the engine is started the switch's On/Off lamp is illuminated. If parking assistance is switched off with the button, the lamp goes out. Park assist syst* - backward (p. 247) Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Parking assistance is available in two variants: • • Rear only Both front and rear. NOTE When a towbar is configured with the car's electrical system, the protrusion of the towbar is included when the function measures the parking space. WARNING • Parking assistance does not relinquish the driver's own responsibility during parking. • The sensors have blind spots where obstacles cannot be detected. • Be aware of e.g. people and animals near the car. 07 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 245 07 Driver support || Marked sectors show which of the four sensor(s) detected an obstacle. The closer to the car symbol a selected sector box is, the shorter the distance between the car and a detected obstacle. IMPORTANT Objects e.g. chains, thin glossy poles or low barriers may be in the "signal shadow" and are then temporarily not detected by the sensors - the pulsating tone may then unexpectedly stop instead of changing over to the expected constant tone. The frequency of the signal increases the shorter the distance to an obstacle, in front of or behind the car. Other sound from the audio system is muted automatically. On/Off for the sensors for parking assistance and CTA25. The centre console's display screen shows an overview of the relationship between the car and detected obstacle. The sensors cannot detect high objects, such as projecting loading docks. • When the distance is within 30 cm the tone is constant and the active sensor's field nearest the car is filled in. If the detected obstacle is within the distance for the constant tone both behind and in front of the car, then the tone sounds alternately from the loudspeakers. In such situations, pay extra attention and manoeuvre/reposition the car particularly slowly or stop the current parking manoeuvre - there may be a high risk of damage to vehicles or other objects since the sensors are temporarily unable to function optimally. Related information • • • • • • • 07 Display screen view - showing an obstacle left front and right rear. 25 246 Side warning, CTA (Cross Traffic Alert) (p. 260) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors (p. 248) Park assist syst* - forward (p. 247) Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 248) Park assist syst* - backward (p. 247) Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) 07 Driver support Park assist syst* - backward Park assist syst* - forward NOTE Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking. An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the centre console's display screen indicate the distance to the detected obstacle. When reversing with e.g. a trailer or bike carrier on the towbar - without Volvo genuine trailer wiring - parking assistance may need to be switched off manually in order that the sensors do not react to them. Related information • • • • • • • Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors (p. 248) Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking. An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the centre console's display screen indicate the distance to the detected obstacle. The parking assistance system is automatically activated when the engine is started the switch's On/Off lamp is illuminated. If parking assistance is switched off with the button, the lamp goes out. Park assist syst* - function (p. 245) Park assist syst* - forward (p. 247) Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 248) Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) The distance covered to the rear of the car is about 1.5 metres. The acoustic signal for obstacles behind comes from one of the rear loudspeakers. Rear parking assistance is activated when reverse gear is engaged. When reversing with e.g. a trailer on the towbar, rear parking assistance is switched off automatically - otherwise the sensors would react to the trailer. The distance covered in front of the car is about 0.8 metres. The acoustic signal for obstacles in front comes from one of the front loudspeakers. 07 Front park assist is active up to approx. 10 km/h. The lamp in the button is illuminated in order to indicate that the system is activated. When the speed is below 10 km/h the system is reactivated. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 247 07 Driver support || IMPORTANT When auxiliary lamps are fitted: Remember that these must not obscure the sensors the auxiliary lamps may then be perceived as an obstacle. Related information • • • • • • • Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors (p. 248) Park assist syst* - function (p. 245) Park assist syst* - fault indication Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking. An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the centre console's display screen indicate the distance to the detected obstacle. If the combined instrument panel's information symbol illuminates with a constant glow and the text message Park assist syst Service required is shown, then parking assistance is disengaged. Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 248) Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking. An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the centre console's display screen indicate the distance to the detected obstacle. The sensors for parking assistance must be cleaned regularly to ensure that they work properly. Clean them with water and car shampoo. IMPORTANT Park assist syst* - backward (p. 247) Under some circumstances, the parking sensors can give false warning signals due to external sound sources which emit the same ultrasound frequencies as those with which the system works. Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Examples of such sources include horns, wet tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and exhaust noises from motorcycles etc. Related information 07 • • • • • • • 248 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist syst* - cleaning the sensors (p. 248) Park assist syst* - function (p. 245) Park assist syst* - forward (p. 247) Park assist syst* - backward (p. 247) Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Sensor location, front. 07 Driver support Park assist camera Function and operation The parking camera is an assist system and is activated when reverse gear is engaged (can be changed in the settings menu, see MY CAR - menu options (p. 106)). The camera image is shown on the centre console's screen. NOTE Sensor location, rear. NOTE Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will reduce their function and may prevent measurement. Related information • • • • • • • Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist syst* - function (p. 245) Park assist syst* - forward (p. 247) Park assist syst* - fault indication (p. 248) Park assist syst* - backward (p. 247) Park assist camera (p. 249) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) When a towbar is configured with the car's electrical system, the protrusion of the towbar is included when the function measures the parking space. WARNING • The parking camera is an aid and can never replace the responsibilities of the driver when reversing. • The camera has blind spots where obstacles cannot be detected. • Be aware of people and animals near the car. CAM button location. The camera shows what is behind the car and if something appears from the sides. The camera shows a wide area behind the car and part of the bumper and any towbar. Objects on the screen may appear to tilt slightly - this is normal. NOTE Objects on the display screen may be closer to the car than they appear to be on the screen. 07 If another view is active the parking camera system takes over automatically and the camera image is displayed on the screen. When reverse gear is engaged two unbroken lines are shown graphically which illustrate * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 249 07 Driver support || where the car's rear wheels will roll with the current steering wheel angle, this facilitates tight parking, reversing into tight spaces and for hitching a trailer. The car’s approximate external dimensions are illustrated by means of two dashed lines. These help lines can be switched off in the settings menu. If the car is also equipped with parking assistance sensors* then their information is displayed graphically as coloured fields in order to illustrate the distance to detected obstacles, see Park assist syst* - function (p. 245). The camera is active approx. 5 seconds after reverse gear has been disengaged or until the car's speed exceeds 10 km/h forward or 35 km/h backward. Light conditions The camera image is adjusted automatically according to prevailing light conditions. Because of this, the image may vary slightly in brightness and quality. Poor light conditions can result in a slightly reduced image quality. NOTE Keep the camera lens clear of dirt, snow and ice to ensure optimum function. This is particularly important in poor light. Park assist lines ment, which shows the driver the path the car will take when it turns. NOTE • When reversing with a trailer which is not connected electrically to the car, the lines on the display show the route the car will take - not the trailer. • The screen shows no lines when a trailer is connected electrically to the car's electrical system. • The parking camera is deactivated automatically when towing a trailer if a Volvo genuine trailer cable is used. IMPORTANT Remember that the display only shows the area behind the car - so pay attention to the sides and front of the car when turning the steering while reversing. 07 Examples of how the park assist lines can be displayed for the driver. Camera location next to the opening handle. 250 The lines on the screen are projected as if they were at ground level behind the car and are directly related to steering wheel move- * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support Boundary lines Different lines in the system. Boundary line, free reversing zone "Wheel tracks" The dashed line (1) frames in a zone up to about 1.5 m back from the bumper. It is also the limit of the car's most protruding parts, such as door mirrors and corners - also during turning. The wide "wheel tracks" (2) between the side lines indicate where the wheels will roll and can extend about 3.2 m back from the bumper if no obstacle is in the way. Cars with reversing sensors* Related information • • • • Park assist camera - settings (p. 252) Park assist camera - limitations (p. 252) Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Coloured areas (x 4 - one per sensor) show distance. If the car is also equipped with parking assistance sensors (see Park assist syst* - function (p. 245)) the distance indication will be more precise and the coloured areas show which of the 4 sensors is/are registering an obstacle. Colour / paint Distance (metres) Light yellow 0,7–1,5 Yellow 0,5–0,7 Orange 0,3–0,5 Red 0–0,3 07 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 251 07 Driver support Park assist camera - settings The parking camera is an assist system and is activated when reverse gear is engaged. • • • Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park assist camera - limitations Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) The parking camera is an assist system and is activated when reverse gear is engaged. MY CAR (p. 104) Press OK/MENU when a camera view is shown. Make the settings as desired. NOTE Bicycle racks or other accessories mounted on the back of the car may obscure the line of sight of the camera. Miscellaneous • The default setting is that the camera is activated when reverse gear is engaged. • One press on CAM activates the camera even if reverse gear is not engaged. • Change between normal and zoomed image by turning TUNE or by pressing CAM. Towbar The camera can be used to advantage when hitching a trailer. A help line for the towbar's intended "course" towards the trailer can be shown in the display - just as for the "wheel tracks". • 07 The towbar can be zoomed in for precision manoeuvring with one press on CAM. Pressing again gives normal view. The towbar's park assist line is activated in the menu system MY CAR where a selection can be made between displaying the "wheel tracks" or towbar course - both options cannot be displayed simultaneously. Related information • • 252 Park assist camera (p. 249) Park assist camera - limitations (p. 252) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. To bear in mind Pay attention to the possibility that, even if it only looks like a relatively small part of the image is obscured, it could be a relatively large sector that is hidden from view. Obstacles could thereby go undetected until they are very close to the car. • Keep the camera lens free from dirt, ice and snow. • Clean the camera lens regularly with lukewarm water and car shampoo - take care not to scratch the lens. Related information • • • • Park assist camera (p. 249) Park assist camera - settings (p. 252) Park assist syst* (p. 245) Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) 07 Driver support Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function WARNING The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot) helps the driver to park by first checking whether a space is sufficiently large and then turning the steering wheel and steering the car into the space. The combined instrument panel uses symbols, graphics and text when elements are to be executed. PAP does not work in all situations but is designed merely as a supplementary aid. The driver always has the final responsibility for driving the vehicle in a safe manner and for paying attention to the surroundings and other road users approaching or passing during parking. The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot) helps the driver to park by first checking whether a space is sufficiently large and then turning the steering wheel and steering the car into the space. The combined instrument panel uses symbols, graphics and text when elements are to be executed. NOTE Related information The PAP function measures the space and turns the steering wheel - the driver's task is to follow the combined instrument panel's instructions and select the gear (reverse/forward), control the speed, brake and stop. • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations (p. 256) • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - function (p. 253) • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation (p. 254) • Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols and messages (p. 257) PAP can be activated if the following criteria are met once the engine has been started: • Park assist camera (p. 249) • The functions DSTC or ABS must not intervene during an ongoing PAP function - these can be activated due to e.g. steep and slippery surfaces, see the sections on Foot brake (p. 289) and Stability and traction control system (p. 185) for more information. • • Trailers must not be connected to the car. The On/Off button is on the centre console. NOTE When a towbar is configured with the car's electrical system, the protrusion of the towbar is included when the function measures the parking space. 07 The speed must be below 50 km/h. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 253 07 Driver support || Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - operation The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot) helps the driver to park by first checking whether a space is sufficiently large and then turning the steering wheel and steering the car into the space. The driver is instructed about how PAP works by means of simple, clear instructions in the combined instrument panel - using both graphics and text graphics and text message (p. 257). Principle for PAP. The PAP function parks the car using the following steps: 1. The function searches for a parking space and measures it (A & B (p. 254)). During measurement, speed must not exceed 30 km/h. 2. The car is steered into the space while reversing (C & D (p. 255)). NOTE Remember that certain steering wheel positions may obstruct the combined instrument panel's instructions when you turn it during the parking manoeuvre. 1 - Searching and checking measurements 3. The car is straightened up in the space by driving back and forth (E & F (p. 255)). Related information 07 254 • • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Park assist camera (p. 249) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. The PAP function searches for a parking space and checks whether it is big enough. Proceed as follows: 1. Activate PAP by pressing this button and do not drive faster than 30 km/h. 2. Keep an eye on the combined instrument panel and be prepared to stop the car when the graphics and text message so request. 3. Stop the car when the graphics and text so request. NOTE PAP searches the area for a parking space, displays instructions and guides the car in on its passenger side. But if required the car can also be parked on the driver's side of the street: • Activate the direction indicator for the driver's side - the car is then parked on that side of the street instead. 07 Driver support 2 - Reversing in NOTE • During the Reversing step, PAP will steer the car into the parking space. Proceed as follows: Keep your hands away from the steering wheel when the PAP function is activated. • Make sure that the steering wheel is not hindered in any way and can rotate freely. • To achieve optimum results - wait until the steering wheel is fully turned before starting to drive backward/ forward. 3 - Straightening up 1. Engage first gear or D position, wait until the steering wheel has been turned, then drive slowly forwards. 2. Stop the car when the graphics and text message so request. 3. Engage reverse gear and drive backwards slowly until the graphics and text message tell you to stop. The function is disengaged automatically when parking is complete, and the graphics and text message show that parking is complete. It may be necessary for the driver to correct the positioning. Only the driver can determine whether the car is properly parked. IMPORTANT The warning distance is shorter when the sensors are used by Active Park Assist compared with when Park Assist uses the sensors. 1. Check that the area behind the car is clear, then engage reverse gear. 2. Reverse slowly and carefully without touching the steering wheel - and no faster than approx. 7 km/h. Related information 3. Keep an eye on the combined instrument panel and be prepared to stop the car when the graphics and text message so request. • • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Park assist camera (p. 249) When the car has reversed into the parking space, it must be straightened up and stopped. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 255 07 Driver support Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* - limitations Under certain circumstances, PAP is unable to find parking spaces - one reason for this may be the fact that there is interference with the sensors from external sound sources which emit the same ultrasound frequencies as those with which the system works. The PAP sequence is stopped: Examples of such sources include horns, wet tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and exhaust noises from motorcycles etc. • if the car is driven too quickly - above 7 km/h • • if the driver touches the steering wheel if the ABS or DSTC function is enabled e.g. if a wheel loses grip on a slippery road surface. A text message indicates where the PAP sequence was stopped. NOTE Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors will reduce their function and may prevent measurement. To bear in mind The driver should bear in mind that the Park Assist Pilot is an aid – not an infallible, fullyautomatic function. The driver must therefore be prepared to intervene. There are also details to bear in mind while parking, e.g.: • PAP starts out from the current location of the parked vehicles - if they are inappropriately parked then the car's tyres and wheel rims may be damaged against kerbs. • PAP is designed for parking on straight streets, not sharp curves or bends. For this reason, make sure the car is parallel to the parking space when PAP measures the space. 07 • 26 256 tem to drive as close to the side of the road as possible where you intend to park. IMPORTANT The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot) helps the driver to park by first checking whether a space is sufficiently large and then turning the steering wheel and steering the car into the space. The combined instrument panel uses symbols, graphics and text when elements are to be executed. It is not always possible to find parking spaces on narrow streets since there is not enough space for manoeuvring. In such parking situations, it helps the sys- "Approved tyres" refers to tyres of the same type and make as those fitted new on delivery from the factory. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Bear in mind that the front of the car may swing out towards oncoming traffic while being parked. • Objects situated higher than the detection areas of the sensors are not included when calculations are made for the parking manoeuvre. This may cause PAP to swing into the parking space too early, and hence such parking pockets should be avoided. • The driver is responsible for determining whether the space selected by PAP is suitable for parking. • Use approved tyres26 with the correct tyre pressure - this affects the ability of PAP to park the car. • Heavy rain or snow may cause the system to measure the parking space incorrectly. • Do not use PAP if snow chains or a spare wheel are fitted. • Do not use PAP if loaded objects are protruding from the car. 07 Driver support IMPORTANT The PAP system's parameters may need to be updated when changing to another approved wheel rim size involving changed tyre circumference. Consult a workshop an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Maintenance Active Park Assist (PAP)* - symbols and messages BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) The Park Assist Pilot (PAP – Park Assist Pilot) helps the driver to park by first checking whether a space is sufficiently large and then turning the steering wheel and steering the car into the space. The combined instrument panel uses symbols, graphics and text when elements are to be executed. The combined instrument panel can show different combinations of symbols and text with varying content - sometimes with a selfexplanatory piece of advice on appropriate action. If a message says that the Park Assist Pilot is disengaged, contact with an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Related information • The PAP sensors are located in the bumpers - 6 front and 4 rear. Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) is a function designed for providing support for the driver when driving in dense traffic on roads with several lanes in the same direction. BLIS is a driver's aid intended to provide a warning about: • • vehicles in the car's blind spot quickly approaching vehicles in the left and right lanes closest to the car. WARNING BLIS is a supplementary aid and does not work in all situations. BLIS is no substitute for a safe driving style and the use of rearview and door mirrors. BLIS can never replace the driver's responsibility and attention - it is always the driver's responsibility to change lanes in a safe manner. For the PAP function to work correctly, its sensors must be cleaned (p. 248) regularly with water and car shampoo - these are the same sensors as are used by parking assistance (p. 245). 07 Related information • • Park Assist Pilot (PAP)* (p. 253) Park assist camera (p. 249) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 257 07 Driver support || Overview Maintenance BLIS - operation BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) is a function designed for providing support for the driver when driving in dense traffic on roads with several lanes in the same direction. Activate/deactivate BLIS BLIS is activated when the engine is started. This is confirmed by the indicator lamps in the door panels flashing once. Position of the BLIS lamp27. Indicator lamp BLIS symbol NOTE The lamp illuminates on the side of the car where the system has detected the vehicle. If the car is overtaken on both sides at the same time then both lamps illuminate. Sensor location. The sensors for the BLIS functions are located inside the rear wing/bumper on each side of the car. • To ensure optimal functionality, the areas in front of the sensors must be kept clean. Related information • • BLIS - operation (p. 258) Button for activating/deactivating. CTA (Cross Traffic Alert)* (p. 260) The BLIS function can be deactivated/activated by pressing the BLIS button on the centre console. 07 Some combinations of the selected equipment leave no vacant space for a button in the centre console - in which case the func- 27 258 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 07 Driver support tion is handled by the car's menu system MY CAR28: The BLIS function is active at speeds above approx. 10 km/h. • The system is designed to react when: Select On or Off at Settings settings BLIS. Car When BLIS is deactivated/activated the lamp in the button goes out/illuminates and the combined instrument panel confirms the change with a text message. The door panel indicator lamps flash once upon activation. To extinguish the message: • Press the left stalk switch OK button. or • Wait approx. 5 seconds – the message extinguishes. • • IMPORTANT Repair of the BLIS and CTA functions' components or repainting the bumpers must only be performed by a workshop an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. the vehicle is overtaken by other vehicles another vehicle is quickly approaching the vehicle. When BLIS detects a vehicle in zone 1 or a quickly approaching vehicle in zone 2, the door panel BLIS lamp illuminates with a constant glow. If the driver activates the direction indicator on the same side as the warning in this situation then the BLIS lamp will change from a constant glow to flashing with a more intense light. Related information • BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) (p. 257) • BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages (p. 262) WARNING When BLIS operates BLIS does not work in sharp bends. BLIS does not work when the car is being reversed. Limitations • Principle for BLIS: 1. Zone in blind spot. 2. Zone for quickly approaching vehicle. 28 Dirt, ice and snow covering sensors can reduce functionality and make it impossible to provide warnings. BLIS cannot detect hazards if it is covered. • Do not affix any objects, tape or labels in the area of the sensors. • BLIS is deactivated when a trailer is connected to the car's electrical system. 07 For information about the menu system - My car - menu option (p. 106). 259 07 Driver support CTA (Cross Traffic Alert)* CTA (Cross Traffic Alert) is a driver aid intended to warn about crossing traffic when the car is reversing. CTA is a supplement to BLIS (p. 257). Activate/deactivate CTA CTA is activated when the engine is started. This is confirmed by the indicator lamps in the door panels flashing once. In cars equipped with parking assistance (p. 245), the CTA function can be deactivated/ activated with the parking assistance On/Off button. CTA function is then deactivated. BLIS remains activated. WARNING CTA is a supplementary aid and does not work in all situations. CTA is no substitute for a safe driving style and the use of rearview and door mirrors. CTA can never replace the driver's responsibility and attention - it is always the driver's responsibility to reverse in a safe manner. When CTA operates CTA is primarily designed to detect vehicles. In favourable conditions, it may also be able to detect smaller objects, such as cyclists and pedestrians. CTA is only active during reversing and is activated automatically when reverse is selected at the gearbox. • If CTA detects something approaching from the side, an acoustic warning signal sounds. The signal comes from either the left or the right speaker depending on which direction the approaching object is coming from. • CTA also warns by illuminating the BLIS lamps. • An additional warning is provided in the form of an illuminated icon in the display screen's PAS graphics (p. 245). Limitations CTA does not perform optimally in all situations, but has a certain limitation - for example, the CTA sensors cannot "see" through other parked vehicles or obstructing objects. 07 On/Off for parking assistance and CTA sensors. Principle for CTA. CTA itself can be deactivated in the MY CAR menu system as follows: CTA supplements the BLIS function by being able to see crossing traffic from the side during reversing, such as when reversing out of a parking space. • 260 Go to Settings Car settings BLIS Cross Traffic Alert and deselect. The * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Here are some examples of when CTA's "field of vision" may be limited from the beginning and approaching vehicles cannot therefore be detected until they are very close: 07 Driver support vehicle/object that is blocking, at which the blind sector rapidly decreases. Maintenance Examples of further limitations: The car is parked deep inside a parking slot. Blind CTA sector. Sector where CTA can detect/"see". • Dirt, ice and snow covering sensors can reduce functionality and make it impossible to provide warnings. CTA cannot detect hazards if it is covered. • Do not affix any objects, tape or labels in the area of the sensors. • CTA is deactivated when a trailer is connected to the car’s electrical system. IMPORTANT Repair of the BLIS and CTA functions' components or repainting the bumpers must only be performed by a workshop an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Sensor location. The sensors for the CTA functions are located inside the rear wing/bumper on each side of the car. • To ensure optimal functionality, the areas in front of the sensors must be kept clean. Related information • BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) (p. 257) • BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages (p. 262) 07 In an angled parking slot CTA can be completely "blind" on one side. However, when the driver is slowly reversing the car, the angle is changed in relation to the 261 07 Driver support BLIS and CTA - symbols and messages In situations where the BLIS (p. 257) and CTA (p. 260) functions fail or are interrupted, the combined instrument panel may show a symbol, supplemented by an explanatory message - follow any recommendation given. Related information • BLIS (Blind Spot Information System) (p. 257) • CTA (Cross Traffic Alert)* (p. 260) Message examples: 07 262 Message Specification CTA OFF CTA has been deactivated manually. BLIS is active. BLIS and CTA OFF Trailer attached BLIS and CTA are temporarily disabled because a trailer is connected to the car’s electrical system. BLIS and CTA Service required BLIS and CTA are not working. • Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. A text message can be acknowledged by briefly pressing the OK button on the direction indicator stalk. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Speed related power steering Speed related power steering causes the steering wheel force to increase with the speed of the car in order to give the driver enhanced sensitivity. The steering is firmer and more immediate on motorways. Steering is light and requires no extra effort when parking and at low speed. The driver can choose between three different levels of steering force for road responsiveness or steering sensitivity. Go to the menu system MY CAR and locate Settings Car settings Steering wheel force and select Low, Medium or High. This menu is not accessible when the car is moving. Related information • MY CAR (p. 104) STARTING AND DRIVING 08 Starting and driving Alcolock* Alcolock* - functions and operation Alcolock1 The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. Before the engine can be started the driver must take a breath test that verifies that he/she is not under the influence of alcohol. Alcolock calibration takes place in accordance with each market's limit value in force for driving legally. Alcolock2 The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. Functions WARNING The Alcolock is an aid and does not exempt the driver from responsibility. It is always the responsibility of the driver to be sober and to drive the car safely. Alcolock indicator lamp (4) shows battery status: Indicator lamp (4) Battery status Green flashing Charging in progress Green Fully charged Yellow Semi-charged Red Discharged - fit the charger in the holder or connect the power supply cable from the glovebox. Related information • Alcolock* - functions and operation (p. 264) Nozzle for breath test. • • • Alcolock* - to bear in mind (p. 266) Switch. • Alcolock* - symbols and messages (p. 268) Alcolock* - storage (p. 265) Transmission button. Alcolock* - before starting the engine (p. 265) Lamp for battery status. Lamp for result of breath test. Lamp indicates ready for breath test. Operation Battery 08 1 2 264 NOTE Store the Alcolock in its holder. This will keep the built-in battery fully charged and the Alcolock is activated automatically when the car is opened. Also called Alcoguard. Also called Alcoguard. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Alcolock* (p. 264) 08 Starting and driving Alcolock* - storage Alcolock3 Alcolock* - before starting the engine Alcolock4 The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. Store the Alcolock in its holder. Release the handheld unit by depressing it slightly in its holder and releasing it - it then springs out and can be removed from the holder. The Alcolock is activated automatically and is then ready for use when the car is opened. 1. When the indicator lamp (6) is green the Alcolock is ready for use. 2. Withdraw the Alcolock from its holder. If the Alcolock is outside the car when it is unlocked then it must first be activated with the switch (2). 3. Fold up the nozzle (1), take a deep breath and blow with an even pressure until a "click" is heard after approx. 5 seconds. The result will be one of the alternatives in the following table Result after breath test. 4. If no message is shown then the transmission to the car may have failed - in which case, press the button (3) to transmit the result to the car manually. 5. Fold down the nozzle and refit the Alcolock in its holder. Nozzle for breath test. Handheld unit storage and charging station. Switch. • Replace the handheld unit in the holder by pushing it in until it engages. Transmission button. • Store the handheld unit in the holder this provides it with the best protection and keeps its batteries fully charged. Lamp for battery status. Related information • 3 4 6. Start the engine following an approved breath test within 5 minutes - otherwise it must be repeated. Lamp for result of breath test. Lamp indicates ready for breath test. Alcolock* (p. 264) 08 Also called Alcoguard. Also called Alcoguard. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 265 08 Starting and driving || Result after breath test Indicator lamp (5) + Display text Specification Green lamp + Alcoguard Approved test Start the engine - no alcohol content measured. Yellow lamp + Alcoguard Approved test Engine starting possible - measured alcohol content is above 0.1 promille but below the limit value in forceA. Red lamp + Disapproved test Wait 1 minute A Alcolock* - to bear in mind Alcolock5 The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. In order to obtain correct function and as accurate a measurement result as possible: • Avoid eating or drinking approx. 5 minutes before the breath test. • Avoid excess windscreen washing - the alcohol in the washer fluid may result in an incorrect measurement result. Change of driver Engine starting not possible - measured alcohol content is above the limit value in forceA. NOTE 08 Related information • 5 6 266 Alcolock* (p. 264) Also called Alcoguard. An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Lamp for result of breath test. Lamp indicates ready for breath test. In order to ensure that a new breath test is carried out in the event of a change of driver depress the switch (2) and the send button (3) simultaneously for approx. 3 seconds. At which point the car returns to start inhibition mode and a new approved breath test is required before starting the engine. Calibration and service The Alcolock must be checked and calibrated at a workshop6 every 12 months. 30 days before recalibration is necessary the combined instrument panel shows the message Alcoguard Calibr. required. If calibration is not carried out within these 30 days then normal engine starting will be blocked only starting with the Bypass function will then be possible, see the following heading "Emergency situation". Limit values vary from country to country. Find out what applies in your country. See also Alcolock* - to bear in mind (p. 266) After a completed period of driving, the engine can be restarted within 30 minutes without a new breath test. Lamp for battery status. Nozzle for breath test. Switch. Transmission button. The message can be cleared by pressing the send button (3) once. Otherwise it goes out on its own after approx. 2 minutes but then reappears each time the engine is started only recalibration at a workshop6 can clear the message permanently. 08 Starting and driving Cold or hot weather NOTE The colder the weather the longer it takes before the Alcolock is ready for use: Temperature (ºC) Maximum heating time (seconds) +10 to +85 10 -5 to +10 60 -40 to -5 180 At temperatures below -20 ºC or above +60 ºC the Alcolock requires additional power supply. The combined instrument panel shows Alcoguard insert power cable. In which case, connect the power supply cable from the glovebox and wait until indicator lamp (6) is green. In extremely cold weather the heating time can be reduced by taking the Alcolock indoors. Emergency situation In the event of an emergency situation or the Alcolock is out of order, it is possible to bypass the Alcolock in order to drive the car. All activation with bypass is logged and saved in a memory; see Recording data (p. 17). After the Bypass function has been activated the combined instrument panel shows Alcoguard Bypass enabled the whole time while driving and can only be reset by a workshop6. The Bypass function can be tested without the error message being logged - in which case, carry out all the steps without starting the car. The error message is cleared when the car is locked. This function can be activated several times. The error message shown during driving can only be cleared at a workshop6. Activating the Emergency function • Depress and hold the left-hand stalk switch OK button and the button for hazard warning flashers simultaneously for approx. 5 seconds - the combined instrument panel shows Alcoguard Bypass enabled and the engine can be started. This function can be used once, after which a reset must be made at a workshop6. Related information • Alcolock* (p. 264) When the Alcolock is installed, either the Bypass or Emergency function is selected as the bypassing option. This setting can be changed afterwards at a workshop6. Activating the Bypass function • Depress and hold the left-hand stalk switch OK button and the button for hazard warning flashers simultaneously for approx. 5 seconds - the combined instrument panel first shows Bypass activated Wait 1 minute and then Alcoguard Bypass enabled - after which the engine can be started. 08 6 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 267 08 Starting and driving Alcolock* - symbols and messages Alcolock7 The function of the is to prevent the car from being driven by individuals under the influence of alcohol. In addition to the previously described messages related to how the alcolock works before starting the engine (p. 265) the following can also be displayed: Display text Meaning/Action Alcoguard Restart possible The engine has been switched off for less than 30 minutes - engine starting possible without new test. Alcoguard Service required Contact a workshopA. Alcoguard No signal Transmission failed send manually with button (3) or take a new breath test. Alcoguard Invalid test Test failed - take a new breath test. Alcoguard Blow longer Blowing too short - blow for longer. Display text Meaning/Action Alcoguard Blow softer Blowing too hard - blow more gently. Alcoguard Blow harder Blowing too weak - blow harder. Alcoguard wait Preheating Heating not finished wait for text Alcoguard Blow 5 seconds. A 268 The engine is started and switched off using the remote control key and the START/STOP ENGINE button. An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Related information • 08 7 Starting the engine Also called Alcoguard. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Alcolock* (p. 264) Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/inserted. and START/STOP ENGINE button. 08 Starting and driving IMPORTANT Do not press in the remote control key incorrectly turned - Hold the end with the detachable key blade; see Detachable key blade - detaching/attaching (p. 166) 1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition switch and press it in to its end position. Note that if the car is equipped with Alcolock* then a breath test must first be approved before the engine can be started. For more information on the Alcolock, see Alcolock* (p. 264). 2. Hold the clutch pedal fully depressed8. (For cars with automatic gearbox Depress the brake pedal.) 3. Press the START/STOP ENGINE button and then release it. The starter motor works until the engine is started or until its overheating protection triggers. IMPORTANT If the engine fails to start after 3 attempts wait for 3 minutes before making a further attempt. Starting capacity increases if the battery is allowed to recover. Related information WARNING Always remove the remote control key from the ignition switch when leaving the car, and make sure that the key position is 0 - in particular if there are children in the car. For information on how this works, see Key positions (p. 71). • Key positions (p. 71) NOTE The idling speed can be noticeably higher than normal for certain engine types during cold starting. This is done in order that the emissions system can reach normal operating temperature as quickly as possible, which minimises exhaust emissions and protects the environment. Keyless drive* Follow steps 2–3 for keyless(p. 168) starting of petrol and diesel engines. NOTE A prerequisite for the engine to start is that one of the car's remote control keys with the Keyless drive function is in the passenger compartment or cargo area. WARNING Never remove the remote control key from the car while driving or during towing. 8 08 If the car is moving then it is enough to press the START/STOP ENGINE button to start the car. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 269 08 Starting and driving Switching off the engine Steering lock Jump starting The engine is switched off using the START/ STOP ENGINE button. The steering lock makes steering difficult if the car is e.g. taken unlawfully. To switch off the engine: Function If the starter battery (p. 351) is discharged then the car can be started with current from another battery. • Press the START/STOP ENGINE button - the engine stops. • If the car has an automatic gearbox and the gear selector is not in a position P or if the car is moving - Press twice or hold the START/STOP ENGINE button depressed until the engine stops. Related information • Key positions (p. 71) • The steering lock locks when the driver's door is opened after the engine has been switched off. • The steering lock unlocks when the remote control key is in the ignition switch9 and the START/STOP ENGINE button is depressed. A mechanical noise can be perceived when the steering lock unlocks or locks. Related information • • • Starting the engine (p. 268) Key positions (p. 71) Steering wheel (p. 77) When jump starting the car, the following steps are recommended to avoid short circuits or other damage: 1. Insert the remote control key in key position (p. 71) 0. 2. Check that the donor battery has a voltage of 12 V. 3. If the donor battery is installed in another car - switch off the donor car's engine and make sure that the two cars do not touch each other. 08 9 270 Cars with Keyless drive must have a remote control key inside the passenger compartment. 08 Starting and driving 4. Connect one of the red jump lead's clamps to the donor battery's positive terminal (1). 11. Start the engine in the car with the discharged battery. IMPORTANT IMPORTANT Connect the start cable carefully to avoid short circuits with other components in the engine compartment. 5. Open the clips on the front cover of the battery in your car and remove the cover. 6. Connect the red jump lead's other clamp onto the car's positive terminal (2). Do not use the connections when attempting to start, as there is a risk of sparking. 12. Remove the jump leads in reverse order first the black and then the red. > Make sure that none of the black jump lead's clamps comes into contact with the battery's positive terminal or the clamp connected to the red jump lead! 7. Connect one of the black jump lead's clamps to the donor battery's negative terminal (3). WARNING • The battery can generate oxyhydrogen gas, which is highly explosive. A spark can be formed if a jump lead is connected incorrectly, and this can be enough for the battery to explode. • The battery contains sulphuric acid, which can cause serious burns. • If sulphuric acid comes into contact with eyes, skin or clothing, flush with large quantities of water. If acid splashes into the eyes - seek medical attention immediately. 8. Connect the other clamp to a grounding point, e.g. right-hand engine mounting at the top, the outer screw head (4). 9. Check that the jump lead clamps are affixed securely so that there are no sparks during the starting procedure. 10. Start the engine of the "donor car" and allow it to run a few minutes at a speed slightly higher than idle approx. 1500 rpm. Related information • Starting the engine (p. 268) Gearboxes There are two main types of gearbox - Manual and Automatic. • • Manual gearbox (p. 272) Automatic gearbox - Geartronic (p. 273) and Powershift (p. 276) IMPORTANT To prevent damage to any drive system components, the working temperature of the gearbox is checked. If there is a risk of overheating, a warning symbol in the combined instrument panel lights up and a text message is shown. Follow the recommendation given in the text message. 08 271 08 Starting and driving Manual gearbox Reverse gear inhibitor Gear shift indicator* The function of the gearbox is to change the gear ratio depending on speed and power requirements. The reverse gear inhibitor hinders the possibility of mistakenly attempting to engage reverse gear during normal forward travel. The gear shift indicator notifies the driver when it is appropriate to engage the next higher or lower gear in order to obtain the lowest possible fuel consumption. • • Follow the gearing pattern printed on the gear lever and start from neutral position, N then depress the gear lever before moving it to R position. Engage reverse gear only when the car is stationary. Related information • • Gearing pattern. Look at the actual gearshift pattern imprinted on the gear lever. • Depress the clutch pedal fully during each gear change. • Take your foot off the clutch pedal between gear changes. WARNING 08 272 Always apply the parking brake when parking on a slope - leaving the car in gear is not sufficient to hold the car in all situations. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Gearboxes (p. 271) Transmission fluid - grade and volume (p. 450) An essential detail in connection with environmental driving is to drive in the right gear and to change gear in plenty of time. An indicator is available as an aid on certain variants - GSI (Gear Shift Indicator) - which notifies the driver when it is appropriate to engage the next higher or lower gear in order to obtain the lowest possible fuel consumption. However, taking into consideration characteristics such as performance and vibration-free running, it may be advantageous to change gear at a higher engine speed. The framed number indicates the current gear. Manual gearbox Gear shift indicator for manual gearbox. Only one marker is illuminated at a time - it is illuminated in the centre only during normal driving. When gearing up/down as recommended, the upper one is illuminated at +" or the lower at "-", marked red in the illustration. 08 Starting and driving Automatic gearbox Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* Gear positions Automatic gear positions are indicated on the right of the combined instrument panel. (Only one marker is illuminated at a time - the one showing the current gear selector position.) An automatic gearbox with Geartronic differs from an Automatic gearbox - Powershift (p. 276), in that it has a hydraulic torque converter that transfers power from engine to gearbox. It has two different gear modes Automatic and Manual. Symbol "S" for Sport mode is ORANGE when the mode is active. P – Parking position Select P when starting the engine or when the car is parked. Combined instrument panel "Digital" with gear shift indicator. With "Analogue" combined instrument panel, the gear positions and indicator arrows are displayed in its centre. Related information • Manual gearbox (p. 272) • In order to be able to move the gear selector from P-position, the brake pedal must first be depressed firmly. The gearbox is mechanically blocked when the P position is engaged. Apply the parking brake as well, as a precaution - , see Parking brake (p. 292). D: Automatic gear positions. +/–: Manual gear positions. S: Sport mode*.10 The combined instrument panel shows the position of the gear selector using the following indications: P, R, N, D, S*, 1, 2, 3 etc. NOTE The gear selector must be in P position to allow the car to be locked and alarmed. IMPORTANT The car must be stationary when position P is selected. 10 08 The gear lever's gearshift pattern varies depending on engine option. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 273 08 Starting and driving || WARNING Always apply the parking brake when parking on a slope - the automatic transmission in P is not sufficient to hold the car in all situations. R – Reverse The car must be stationary when position R is selected. N – Neutral No gear is engaged and the engine can be started. Apply the parking brake if the car is stationary with the gear selector in position N. D – Drive D is the normal driving position. Shifting up and down takes place automatically based on the level of acceleration and speed. The car must be stationary when the gear selector is moved to position D from position R. etc. are displayed in a box which corresponds to the gear that has just been selected. • Move the lever forwards towards + (plus) to change up a gear and release the lever, which returns to its neutral position between "+" and "–". or • Pull the lever back towards "–" (minus) to change down a gear and release it. The manual gearshift mode "+/-" can be selected at any time while driving. Geartronic automatically shifts down if the driver allows the speed to decrease lower than a level suitable for the selected gear, in order to avoid jerking and stalling. To return to automatic driving mode: • Move the lever to the side to the end position at D. Geartronic – Manual gear positions (+/-) The driver can also change gear manually using the Geartronic automatic gearbox. The car engine-brakes when the accelerator pedal is released. 08 The manual gear position is reached by moving the lever to the side from position D to the end position at "+/-". The combined instrument panel's symbol "+/-" changes colour from WHITE to ORANGE and the digits 1, 2, 3 11 274 NOTE f the gearbox has a Sport programme then the gearbox will only become manual after the lever has been moved forwards or backwards in its "+/-" position. The combined instrument panel then shifts the indication from S to show which of the gears 1, 2, 3 etc. is engaged. If the car has Sport mode* then "S" is shown first. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Geartronic - Sport mode (S) The Sport programme provides sportier characteristics and allows higher engine speed for the gears. At the same time it responds more quickly to acceleration. During active driving, the use of a lower gear is prioritised, leading to a delayed upshift. To activate Sport mode: • Move the gear selector to the side from D position to the end position at "+S–" - the combined instrument panel changes indication from D to S. Sport mode can be selected at any time while driving. Geartronic - Winter mode It can be easier to pull away on slippery roads if 3rd gear is engaged manually. 1. Depress the brake pedal and move the gear selector from D position to the end position at "+/–" - the combined instrument panel shifts the indication from D to the figure 111. 2. Scroll up to gear 3 by pushing the lever forward towards "+" (plus) twice - the combined instrument panel shifts the indication from 1 to 3. 3. Release the brake and accelerate carefully. 08 Starting and driving The gearbox "winter mode" means that the car moves off with a lower engine speed and reduced engine power on the drive wheels. Kick-down Related information • • Automatic gearbox - Powershift* (p. 276) Transmission fluid - grade and volume (p. 450) When the accelerator pedal is pressed all the way to the floor (beyond the position normally regarded as full acceleration) a lower gear is immediately engaged. This is known as kickdown. If the accelerator is released from the kickdown position, the gearbox automatically changes up. Kick-down is used when maximum acceleration is needed, such as for overtaking. Safety function To prevent overrevving the engine, the gearbox control program has a protective downshift inhibitor which prevents the kick-down function. Geartronic does not permit downshifting/ kick-down which would result in an engine speed high enough to damage the engine. Nothing happens if the driver still tries to shift down in this way at high engine speed – the original gear remains engaged. When kick-down is activated the car can change one or more gears at a time depending on engine speed. The car changes up when the engine reaches its maximum speed in order to prevent damage to the engine. 08 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 275 08 Starting and driving Automatic gearbox - Powershift* An automatic gearbox with Powershift differs from an automatic gearbox with Geartronic (p. 273), in that it has double mechanical clutch discs. D: Automatic gear positions. +/–: Manual gear positions. S: Sport mode*.12 The Powershift automatic gearbox transmits the motive force from the engine to the drive wheels with double mechanical clutch discs, as opposed to Geartronic which instead uses a conventional hydraulic torque converter. 08 Powershift transmission operates in the same way and has similar controls and functions as the Geartronic automatic transmission. One exception is Geartronic's Winter mode, see Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273). 12 276 Powershift enables driving away on a slippery road surface if 2nd gear is engaged manually instead of 3rd gear (Geartronic). Powershift or Geartronic The model with Powershift transmission should not be towed as it is dependent on the engine running in order to receive sufficient lubrication. If towing still has to take place, the route must be as short as possible and then with very low speed. In the event of uncertainty as to whether or not the car is equipped with Powershift transmission, this can be verified by checking the designation on the gearbox label under the bonnet - see Type designations (p. 438). The designation ”MPS6” means that it is Powershift transmission - otherwise it is Geartronic automatic transmission. To bear in mind panel shows a message. The transmission can also overheat during slow driving in queues (10 km/h or slower) on an uphill gradient, or with a trailer hitched. The transmission cools down when the car is stationary, with foot brake depressed and the engine running at idling speed. Overheating during slow driving in queues can be avoided by driving in stages: • Stop the car and wait with your foot on the brake pedal until there is a moderate distance to the traffic ahead, drive forward a short distance, and then wait another moment with your foot on the brake pedal. IMPORTANT Use the foot brake to hold the car stationary on an uphill gradient - do not hold the car with the accelerator pedal. The gearbox could then overheat. The transmission's double clutch has overload protection that is activated if it becomes too hot, e.g. if the car is held stationary with the accelerator pedal on an uphill gradient for a long time. For important information regarding Powershift transmission, see Towing (p. 308). Overheated transmission causes the car to shake and vibrate, and the warning symbol illuminates and the combined instrument In some situations the combined instrument panel may show a text message at the same time as a symbol is illuminated. The gear lever's gearshift pattern varies depending on engine option. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Text message and action 08 Starting and driving Symbol A Message Driving characteristics Action Transm. overheat brake to hold Difficulty in maintaining even speed at constant engine speed. Transmission overheated. Keep the car stationary using the foot brake.A Transm. overheat park safely Significant pulling in the car's traction. Transmission overheated. Park the car immediately in a safe manner.A Transm. cooling let engine run No drive due to overheated gearbox. Transmission overheated. For fastest cooling: Run the engine at idling speed with the gear lever in the N or P position until the message clears. For fastest cooling: run the engine at idling speed with the gear lever in the N or P position, until the message clears. The table shows three steps with an increased degree of seriousness should the transmission become too hot. In parallel with the text message, the driver is also advised that the car's electronics are temporarily changing the driving characteristics. Follow the instructions in the text message where appropriate. NOTE The examples in the table are no indication of the car being defective, but show that a safety function has been activated with a view to preventing damage to any of the car's components. Related information WARNING If a warning symbol combined with the text Transm. overheat park safely is ignored then the heat in the gearbox may become so high that the power transmission between engine and gearbox is temporarily halted in order to prevent the clutch from malfunctioning - the car then loses drive and is stationary until gearbox temperature has cooled to an acceptable level. • • Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) Transmission fluid - grade and volume (p. 450) For more possible text messages with their respective proposals for solutions concerning automatic gearbox, see Messages (p. 103). A text message extinguishes automatically after the action has been carried out or after one press on the indicator stalk OK button. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 277 08 Starting and driving • Gear selector inhibitor There are two different types of gear selector inhibitor - mechanical and automatic. Keep your foot on the brake pedal when moving the gear selector to another position. Deactivate automatic gear selector inhibitor Electric gear inhibitor – Shiftlock Parking position (P) Mechanical gear selector inhibitor To be able to move the gear selector from P to other gear positions, the brake pedal must be depressed and the remote control key must be in position II. G021351 Shiftlock – Neutral (N) The gear selector can be moved forward and back freely between N and D. Other positions are locked with a latch that is released with the inhibitor button on the gear selector. If the gear selector is in the N position and the car has been stationary for at least 3 seconds (irrespective of whether the engine is running) then the gear selector is locked. To be able to move the gear selector from N to another gear position the brake pedal must be depressed and the remote control key must be in key position II (p. 71). If the car cannot be driven, e.g. due to a flat battery, the gear selector must be moved from the P position so that the car can be moved. Lift out the contoured insert in the compartment behind the centre console and locate a spring-loaded button in the bottom of the compartment. With the inhibitor button depressed the lever can be moved forwards or backwards between P, R, N and D. Press and hold the button. Move the gear selector from the P position and release the button. Automatic gear selector inhibitor 08 278 The automatic gearbox has special safety systems: 4. Refit the storage compartment insert. Parking position (P) Related information Stationary car with engine running: * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • • Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) Automatic gearbox - Powershift* (p. 276) 08 Starting and driving Hill start assist (HSA)* Start/Stop* The foot brake can be released before setting off or reversing uphill - the HSA (Hill Start Assist) function means that the car does not roll backwards. Some engine and gearbox combinations come fitted with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights - the engine is then switched off temporarily and restarts automatically when the journey is due to continue. The function means that the pedal pressure in the brake system remains for several seconds while the driver's foot is moved from brake pedal to accelerator pedal. The temporary braking effect releases after several seconds or when the driver accelerates. Related information • Starting the engine (p. 268) Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corporation's core values and it influences all of our operations. This target orientation has resulted in several separate energy-saving functions of which Start/Stop is one, all with the collective task of reducing fuel consumption, which in turn helps to reduce exhaust emissions. General information about Start/Stop The Start/Stop function gives the driver the opportunity for a more active environmentally conscious way of driving the car by means of being able to allow the engine to stop automatically, whenever appropriate. Manual or Automatic Note that there are differences in the Start/Stop function depending on whether the gearbox is manual or automatic. Related information • Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) • • • Starting the engine (p. 268) • Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) • Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) The engine is switched off - it becomes quieter and cleaner... * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 279 08 Starting and driving Start/Stop* - function and operation Conditions Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. The Start/Stop function is activated automatically when the engine is started with the key. Start/StopThe function is activated automatically when the engine is started with the key. The driver is made aware of the function by the function's On/Off button symbol lighting up in the combined instrument panel and the On/Off button lamp illuminating. A Auto-starting the engine A Declutch, set the gear lever in neutral position and release the clutch pedal - the engine stops automatically. M Stop the car with the foot brake and then keep your foot on the pedal - the engine stops automatically. A The following is required for the engine to auto-stop: 08 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. M/ AA With the gear lever in neutral position: M 2. Engage a suitable gear and drive. The following option is also available on a downhill gradient: In some cases the engine stops automatically before the car is completely stationary. Auto-stopping the engine Conditions 1. Depress the clutch pedal or press the accelerator pedal the engine starts. M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. All of the car's normal systems such as lighting, radio, etc. work as normal even with an engine that has stopped automatically, except that some equipment may have the function temporarily reduced, e.g. the climate control system's fan speed or extremely high volume on the audio system. 280 M/A M Release the foot brake and let the car move off - the engine starts automatically when the speed exceeds normal walking pace. The combined instrument panel's symbols for the Start/Stop function illuminate as verification and reminder that the engine has stopped automatically. Release the foot pressure on the foot brake - the engine starts automatically and the journey can continue. A A M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. Deactivating the Start/Stop function In certain situations, it may advisable to temporarily switch off the automatic Start/Stop function - this is carried out with a push of this button. 08 Starting and driving Disengaged function is indicated by the combined instrument panel's Start/Stop symbols and the button's lamp extinguishing. The Start/Stop function is disengaged until it is reactivated with the button or until the next time the engine is started with the key. • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. Although the Start/Stop function is activated, the engine does not always stop automatically. The engine does not auto-stop if: M/ AA the car has not achieved approx. 5 km/h (= fast walking pace) first after a key start or the last autostop. M +A the driver has opened the seatbelt's buckle. M +A the capacity of the starter battery is below the minimum permissible level. M +A the engine does not have normal operating temperature. M +A Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) outside temperature is below freezing point or above approx. 30 °C. M +A Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) the windscreen's electric heating is activated. M +A The foot brake can also be released on an uphill slope to auto-start the engine - the HSA (p. 279) (Hill Start Assist) function prevents the car from rolling backwards. HSA means that the pressure in the brake system remains temporarily available while the driver moves his/her foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal for driving off with the engine auto-stopped. The temporary braking effect releases after a couple of seconds or when the driver accelerates. Related information • Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) Conditions Start assistance HSA • • • • • Start/Stop* (p. 279) Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 281 08 Starting and driving || 08 282 Conditions M/ AA Conditions the environment in the passenger compartment differs from the preset valuesB - indicated by the ventilation fan running at a high speed. M +A adaptive cruise control Queue Assist is activated. A the driver’s door has been opened with the gear selector in D position. A the car is reversed. M +A A the starter battery's temperature is below freezing point or too high. M +A the gear selector is moved out of the D position to S positionC or "+/-". the driver makes greater steering wheel movements. M +A the exhaust system's particulate filter is full - the temporarily disengaged Start/Stop function is reactivated once an automatic cleaning cycle has been performed (see Diesel particle filter (p. 299)). M +A the road is very steep. M +A • a trailer is connected electrically to the car’s electrical system. M +A Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) the atmospheric air pressure is less than equivalent to 1500-2400 metres above sea level the current air pressure varies with the prevailing weather conditions. M +A • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) A B C M/ AA M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. Car with ECC. Sport mode. Related information • • • • • * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. An auto-stopped engine may restart in certain cases without the driver having decided that the journey should continue. In the following cases the engine also starts automatically if the driver has not depressed the clutch pedal (manual gearbox) or takes his/her foot off the brake pedal (automatic gearbox): Start/Stop* (p. 279) Conditions M/AA Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) Misting forms on the windows. M+A The environment in the passenger compartment deviates from the preset valuesB. M+A The outside temperature falls below freezing point or exceeds approx. 30 °C. M+A There is a temporarily high current take-off or starter battery capacity drops below the lowest permissible level. M+A Repeated pumping of the brake pedal. M+A Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) 08 Starting and driving M/AA • Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) The car starts to roll - faster than the equivalent normal walking pace. M • Start/Stop* - the engine does not auto-start Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • The driver's seatbelt buckle is opened with the gear selector in D or N position. A Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. The engine does not always auto-start after having autostopped. Steering wheel movements. A The gear selector is moved from the D position to "+/-" or R. A The driver’s door is opened with the gear selector in D position. A Conditions A B • • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) Start/Stop* (p. 279) In the following cases the engine does not auto-start after having auto-stopped: M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. Car with ECC. WARNING Do not open the bonnet when the engine has stopped automatically - the engine may suddenly start automatically. First switch off the engine as normal using the START/STOP ENGINE button before opening the bonnet. Related information • Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) • • Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) Conditions M/ AA A gear is engaged without declutching - a display text prompts the driver to set the gear lever in neutral position in order to enable automatic starting. M The driver is unrestrained, the gear selector is in P position and the driver’s door is open - a normal engine start must take place. A A M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. Related information • • • • Start/Stop* (p. 279) Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) Starting the engine (p. 268) 08 Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 283 08 Starting and driving • Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. In the event that a start-up fails and the engine stops, proceed in accordance with the below: • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) 1. Depress the clutch pedal again - the engine starts automatically. Start/Stop* - settings Some engine and gearbox combinations are equipped with a Start and Stop function which engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or waiting at traffic lights. The car's MY CAR (p. 104) menu system contains an introduction of Volvo's Start-Stop system, as well as recommendations for energy-saving driving techniques. 2. In certain cases the gear lever must be set in neutral position. The combined instrument panel then shows the text Put gear in neutral. Related information • • • • • 08 284 Start/Stop* (p. 279) Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) • Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) • Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • • • • Start/Stop* (p. 279) Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) 08 Starting and driving • Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Start/Stop* - symbols and messages (p. 286) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) 08 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 285 08 Starting and driving Start/Stop* - symbols and messages Text message The Start/Stop function can show text messages on the information display. In combination with this indicator lamp the Start/Stop function may display text messages in the combined instrument panel for certain situations. Symbol Message Info/Action M/AA Engine in Auto Start Illuminates for a few seconds after Start/Stop has been activated. M+A Eco DRIVe OFF Illuminates for a few seconds after Start/Stop has been switched off. M+A Auto Start/Stop Service required Start/Stop is not operational. Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. M+A Engine management system An automatic function check is carried out. M+A Autostart Engine running + acoustic signal Activated if the driver's door is opened with auto-stopped engine. M+A Engine in Auto Start The engine is ready to start automatically - waiting for the brake or clutch pedal to be depressed. M Press Start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button. M Depress clutch pedal to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the clutch pedal to be depressed. M 08 286 For some of them there is a recommended action that should be performed. The following table shows some examples. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 Starting and driving Symbol A Message Info/Action Depress brake pedal to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the brake pedal to be depressed. M Press brake and clutch to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the brake or clutch pedal to be depressed. M Put gear in neutral to start Gear is engaged without declutching - disengage and set the gear lever in neutral position. M Engine in Auto Start The engine is ready to start automatically - waiting for the brake pedal to be released. A Select P or N to start Start/Stop has been deactivated - move the gear selector to N or P position and start the engine as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button. A Press Start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button and the gear selector in P or N. A M/AA M = Manual gearbox, A = Automatic gearbox. If a message does not go out following completion of the action then a workshop should be contacted - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. • • • Related information • Start/Stop* - the engine auto-starts (p. 282) • Start/Stop* - the engine does not stop (p. 281) • • Start/Stop* (p. 279) Start/Stop* - function and operation (p. 280) Starting the engine (p. 268) Start/Stop* - settings (p. 284) Start/Stop* - the engine does not autostart (p. 283) • Start/Stop* - involuntary engine stoppage manual gearbox (p. 284) • Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 287 08 Starting and driving All Wheel Drive (AWD)* Hill Descent Control (HDC) All Wheel Drive (AWD – All Wheel Drive) means that the car is driven by all four wheels. All-wheel drive is always engaged. HDC can be compared to an automatic engine brake. When you release the accelerator on downhill gradients the car is normally braked by means of the engine striving for low engine idling speeds, so-called engine braking. But the steeper the road and the more load there is in the car, the faster the car rolls despite engine braking. In order to then reduce speed the driver has to assist using the footbrake. WARNING HDC does not work in all situations but is designed merely as a supplementary aid. The driver always bears ultimate responsibility for ensuring that the vehicle is driven safely. Function General AWD principle13. The power is automatically distributed between the front and rear wheels. An electronically controlled clutch system distributes the power to the wheels that have the best grip on the current road surface. This provides the best traction and prevents wheel spin. Under normal driving conditions, the majority of power is transmitted to the front wheels. All-wheel drive improves driving safety in rain, snow and icy conditions. The function makes it possible to increase/ reduce speed on steep downhill gradients, with a foot only on the accelerator pedal, without using the footbrake. The sensitivity of the accelerator pedal decreases and becomes more precise by means of the full actuation of the pedal being restricted to adjusting engine speed within a limited range. The brake system brakes itself and provides the car with a low and even speed, so allowing the driver to fully focus on steering. HDC is particularly helpful on steep gradients with an uneven road surface and slippery sections. E.g. when launching a boat on a trailer from a ramp. 08 13 288 The figure is schematic - details may vary depending on market and model. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. HDC is engaged or disengaged using a switch on the centre console. An indicator lamp in the button illuminates when the function is switched on. When HDC is working normally the combined instrument panel's symbol illuminates combined with the text message Hill descent control ON. 08 Starting and driving The function only operates in first gear position and in reverse gear. For an automatic gearbox, gear position 1 must be selected, which is shown with the figure 1 in the combined instrument panel; see Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273). NOTE HDC cannot be activated on an automatic gearbox in position D. Operation HDC allows the car to roll at a maximum of 10 km/h forwards with engine braking and 7 km/h backwards. However, any speed within the gear's speed register can be selected using the accelerator pedal. When the accelerator pedal is released, the car is braked quickly to 10 or 7 km/h respectively, irrespective of the hill's gradient and without the need for the footbrake. The brake lights come on automatically when the function is operating. The driver can brake or stop the car at any time by using the footbrake. HDC is deactivated: • with the on/off button on the centre console • if a gear higher than 1 is selected on a manual gearbox • if a gear higher than 1 is selected on an automatic gearbox, or if the gear selector is moved to position D. The function can be disengaged at any time. If it takes place on a steep downhill gradient then the braking effect will not release directly, but slowly instead. NOTE With HDC activated you may experience a delay between acceleration pedal activation and engine response. Foot brake The foot brake is used to reduce the car's speed while driving. The car is equipped with two brake circuits. If one brake circuit is damaged then this will mean that the brakes engage at a deeper level and harder pressure on the pedal is needed to produce the normal braking effect. The driver's brake pedal pressure is assisted by a brake servo. WARNING The brake servo only works when the engine is running. If the brake is used when the engine is switched off then the pedal will feel stiff and more force must be used to brake the car. In very hilly terrain or when driving with a heavy load the brakes can be relieved by using engine braking. Engine braking is most efficiently used if the same gear is used downhill as up. For more general information on heavy loads on the car, see Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446). Cleaning the brake discs Coatings of dirt and water on the brake discs may result in delayed brake function. This * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 289 08 Starting and driving || delay is minimised by cleaning the brake linings. Manual cleaning is advisable with wet road surfaces, prior to long-stay parking and after the car has been washed. Carry this out by braking gently during a short period while en route. Maintenance To keep the car as safe and reliable as possible, follow the Volvo service intervals as specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet. IMPORTANT The wear on the brake system's components must be checked regularly. Contact a workshop for information about the procedure or engage a workshop to carry out the inspection - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Symbols in the combined instrument panel Symbol Specification Constant glow – Check the brake fluid level. If the level is low, fill with brake fluid and check for the cause of the brake fluid loss. Constant glow for 2 seconds when the engine is started automatic function check. WARNING If and illuminate at the same time, there may be a fault in the brake system. If the level in the brake fluid reservoir is normal at this stage, drive carefully to the nearest workshop and have the brake system checked - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further before topping up the brake fluid. The reason for the loss of brake fluid must be investigated. 08 290 Related information • • Parking brake (p. 292) Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 291) • Foot brake - emergency brake assistance (p. 291) • Foot brake - anti-lock braking system (p. 291) 08 Starting and driving Foot brake - anti-lock braking system The anti-lock braking system, ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), prevents the wheels from locking up during braking. The function allows steering ability to be maintained, and it is easier to swerve to avoid a hazard for example. Vibration may be felt in the brake pedal when this is engaged and this is normal. A short test of the ABS system is made automatically after the engine has been started when the driver releases the brake pedal. A further automatic test of the ABS system may be made when the car reaches 10 km/h. The test may be experienced as pulses in the brake pedal. Related information • • • • Foot brake (p. 289) Parking brake (p. 292) Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers Emergency brake lights are activated to alert vehicles behind about sudden braking. The function means that the brake light flashes instead of - as in normal braking - shining with a constant glow. Emergency brake lights are activated at speeds above 50 km/h if the ABS system is working and/or in the event of sudden braking. After the car's speed has been slowed below 10 km/h the brake light returns from flashing to the normal constant glow - while at the same time the Hazard warning flashers are activated, and they flash until the driver accelerates the car to at least 20 km/h or they are deactivated with their button. Related information Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 291) • • • Foot brake - emergency brake assistance (p. 291) • Foot brake (p. 289) Parking brake (p. 292) Foot brake - emergency brake assistance (p. 291) Foot brake - anti-lock braking system (p. 291) Foot brake - emergency brake assistance Emergency brake assistance EBA (Emergency Brake Assist) helps to increase the braking force and so reduce the braking distance. EBA detects the driver's braking style and increases the braking force when necessary. The brake force can be reinforced up to the level when the ABS system is engaged. The EBA function is interrupted when the pressure on the brake pedal is reduced. NOTE When EBA is activated the brake pedal lowers slightly more than usual, depress (hold) the brake pedal as long as necessary. If the brake pedal is released then all braking ceases. Related information • • • • Foot brake (p. 289) Parking brake (p. 292) Foot brake - emergency brake lights and automatic hazard warning flashers (p. 291) Foot brake - anti-lock braking system (p. 291) 08 291 08 Starting and driving Parking brake The parking brake holds the car stationary, when the driver's seat is empty, by mechanically locking/blocking two wheels. 2. Pull the lever firmly. > The combined instrument panel warning symbol comes on. NOTE WARNING Always apply the parking brake when parking on a slope - leaving the car in gear, or in P if it has automatic transmission, is not sufficient to hold the car in all situations. - The combined instrument panel's warning symbol illuminates regardless of whether the parking brake is applied slightly or fully. 3. Release the foot brake pedal and make sure that the car is at a standstill position. 4. If the vehicle moves then the parking brake lever must be applied at least a little more firmly. • When parking the vehicle, always engage 1st gear (for manual gearbox) or put the gear selector in position P (for automatic gearbox). Parking on a hill If the car is parked facing uphill: Combined instrument panel warning symbol. Applying the parking brake 1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly. • Turn the wheels away from the kerb. If the car is parked facing downhill: • Turn the wheels towards the kerb. Disengaging the parking brake 1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly. 08 292 2. Pull the lever up slightly, press the button, release the lever and release the button. > The combined instrument panel warning symbol goes off. If the driver forgets to release the parking brake – in addition to the illuminated warning lamp – a pinging sound combined with a message in the combined instrument panel alerts the driver of this when the car's speed exceeds 10 km/h. Related information • Foot brake (p. 289) 08 Starting and driving Driving in water IMPORTANT Fording means that the car is driven through a water-covered roadway. Fording must be carried out with great caution. Engine damage can occur if water enters the air filter. In depths greater than 30 cm, water could enter the transmission. This reduces the lubricating ability of the oils and shortens the service life of these systems. The car can be driven through water at a maximum depth of 30 cm at a maximum speed of 10 km/h. Extra caution should be exercised when passing through flowing water. During driving in water, maintain a low speed and do not stop the car. When the water has been passed, depress the brake pedal lightly and check that full brake function is achieved. Water and mud for example can make the brake linings wet resulting in delayed brake function. • • Clean the electric contacts of the electric engine block heater and trailer coupling after driving in water and mud. Do not let the car stand with water over the sills for any long period of time - this could cause electrical malfunctions. In the event of the engine stalling in water, do not try restart - tow the car from the water to a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Risk of engine breakdown. Overheating Under special conditions, for example hard driving in hilly terrain and hot climate, there is a risk that the engine and drive system may overheat - in particular with a heavy load. For information about overheating when driving with a trailer, see Driving with a trailer (p. 301). • Remove any auxiliary lamps from in front of the grille when driving in hot climates. • If the temperature in the engine's cooling system is too high then a warning symbol is illuminated and a text message High engine temp Stop safely is shown in the combined instrument panel's information display - stop the car in a safe way and allow the engine to run at idling speed for several minutes in order to cool down. • If the text message High engine temp Stop engine or Coolant level low, Stop engine is shown then the engine must be switched off after stopping the car. • In the event of overheating in the gearbox a built-in protection function is activated, which is indicated in the combined instrument panel with a warning symbol and the text message Transmission hot Reduce speed or Transmission hot Stop safely - follow the recommendation given and lower the speed and stop the car in a safe way and allow the engine to run at idling speed for a few minutes in order to allow the gearbox to cool down. Related information • • Recovery (p. 310) Towing (p. 308) 08 293 08 Starting and driving || • • If the car overheats, the air conditioning may be switched off temporarily. Do not turn the engine off immediately you stop after a hard drive. Driving with open tailgate Overload - starter battery When driving with the tailgate open, toxic exhaust fumes can be sucked into the car through the cargo area. The electrical functions in the car load the starter battery to varying degrees. Avoid using the key position II when the engine is switched off. Instead use the I mode - which uses less power, see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). WARNING NOTE Do not drive with an open tailgate! Toxic exhaust fumes could be drawn into the car through the cargo area. It is normal for the engine's cooling fan to operate for a time after the engine has been switched off. Related information • Driving with a trailer - manual gearbox (p. 302) • Driving with a trailer - automatic gearbox (p. 302) Related information • Loading (p. 152) Also, be aware of different accessories that load the electrical system. Do not use functions which use a lot of power when the engine is switched off. Examples of such functions are: • • • • ventilation fan headlamps windscreen wiper audio system (high volume). If the battery voltage is low the information display shows the text Low battery Power save mode. The energy-saving function then shuts down certain functions or reduces certain functions such as the ventilation fan and/or audio system. – 08 Related information • 294 In which case, charge the starter battery by starting the engine and then running it for at least 15 minutes - battery charging is more effective during driving than running the engine at idling speed while stationary. Starter battery (p. 351) 08 Starting and driving Before a long journey Winter driving Before a long journey, it makes good sense to go through the following points: For winter driving it is important to perform certain checks in order to ensure that the car can be driven safely. • Check that the engine is working normally and that fuel consumption (p. 454) is normal. • Make sure that there are no leaks (fuel, oil or other fluid). • • Check all bulbs and tyre tread depths. Check the following in particular before the cold season: Carrying a warning triangle (p. 323) is a legal requirement in certain countries. Related information • • • Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337) Spare wheel* (p. 317) Lamp replacement (p. 342) • Use washer fluid (p. 351) to avoid ice forming in the washer fluid reservoir. To achieve optimum roadholding Volvo recommends using winter tyres on all wheels if there is a risk of snow or ice. To bear in mind: • places great demands on the battery and its capacity is reduced by the cold. The engine coolant (p. 449) must contain at least 50% glycol. This mixture protects the engine against frost erosion down to approximately –35 °C. To achieve optimum antifreeze protection, different types of glycol must not be mixed. • The fuel tank must be kept filled to prevent condensation. • Engine oil viscosity is important. Oils with lower viscosity (thinner oils) facilitate starting in cold weather and also reduce fuel consumption while the engine is cold. For more information on suitable oils, see Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446). NOTE The use of winter tyres is a legal requirement in certain countries. Studded tyres are not permitted in all countries. Slippery driving conditions Practise driving on slippery surfaces under controlled conditions to learn how the car reacts. IMPORTANT Low viscosity oil must not be used for hard driving or in hot weather. • The condition of the battery and charge level must be inspected. Cold weather * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 08 295 08 Starting and driving Fuel filler flap - Opening/closing Fuel filler flap - manual opening Filling up with fuel The fuel filler flap can be opened/closed as follows: The fuel filler flap can be opened manually when it cannot be opened from outside. The fuel tank is fitted with a coverless fuel filler system. Filling is carried out as follows: Opening/closing the fuel filler flap Open the fuel filler flap by slightly pressing in the rear part of the hatch. Take out the flap. Close the flap after fuelling. For a description of locking and unlocking the fuel filler flap, see Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap (p. 178). The fuel filler flap's lock logic also follows Keyless drive and the locking and unlocking of the central locking. Related information 08 296 • Filling up with fuel (p. 296) Open/remove the side hatch in the cargo area (same side as fuel filler flap). • Open the fuel filler flap (p. 296). See also Fuel filler flap - manual opening (p. 296). Carefully pull the line back in a straight line. The flap can now be opened from outside. • Insert the pump nozzle in the fuel filler opening. Take care to insert the nozzle properly into the filler pipe. The filler pipe consists of two opening covers. The nozzle must be pushed past both covers before refuelling is started. • Do not overfill the tank but fill until the pump nozzle cuts out. IMPORTANT Pull the wire gently - minimal force is required to disengage the hatch lock. Related information • • Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap (p. 178) Filling up with fuel (p. 296) NOTE Excess fuel in the tank can overflow in hot weather. 08 Starting and driving NOTE Avoid spilling by waiting approximately 5-8 seconds before carefully removing the nozzle once refuelling is complete. Related information • Filling with fuel - with a fuel can (p. 299) Fuel - handling IMPORTANT Fuel of a lower quality than that recommended by Volvo must not be used as engine power and fuel consumption is negatively affected. Mixtures of various fuel types or use of fuels which are not recommended will invalidate Volvo's guarantees and any supplementary service agreements; this is applicable to all engines. WARNING Always avoid inhaling fuel vapour and fuel splashing in the eyes. NOTE Extreme weather conditions, driving with a trailer or driving at high altitudes in combination with fuel grade are factors that could affect the car's performance. In the event of fuel in the eyes, remove any contact lenses and rinse the eyes in plenty of water for at least 15 minutes and seek medical attention. Never swallow fuel. Fuels such as petrol and diesel are highly toxic and could cause permanent injury or be fatal if swallowed. Seek medical attention immediately if fuel has been swallowed. Related information • • Economical driving (p. 300) Economical driving (p. 300) WARNING Fuel which spills onto the ground can be ignited. Switch off the fuel-driven heater before starting to refuel. Never carry an activated mobile phone when refuelling. The ring signal could cause spark build-up and ignite petrol fumes, leading to fire and injury. 08 297 08 Starting and driving Fuel - petrol Fuel - diesel Petrol is used as fuel. Diesel is used as fuel. Petrol must fulfil the EN 228 standard. Most engines can be run with octane ratings of 95 and 98 RON. Only in exceptional cases should 91 RON be used. Only use diesel fuel from well-known producers. Never use diesel of dubious quality. Diesel should fulfil the EN 590 or JIS K2204 standards. Diesel engines are sensitive to contaminants in the fuel, such as excessively high volumes of sulphur particles for example. • • 95 RON can be used for normal driving. 98 RON is recommended for optimum performance and minimum fuel consumption. When driving in temperatures above +38 °C, fuel with the highest possible octane rating is recommended for optimum performance and fuel economy. IMPORTANT • Use only unleaded petrol to avoid damaging the catalytic converter. • Do not use any additives which have not been recommended by Volvo. Related information • • • Filling up with fuel (p. 296) The risk of condensation in the fuel tank is reduced if the tank is kept well filled. When refuelling, check that the area around the fuel filler pipe is clean. Avoid spilling fuel onto the paintwork. Wash off any spillage with detergent and water. IMPORTANT Only ever use fuel that fulfils the European diesel standard. The sulphur content must be a maximum of 50 ppm. 08 14 298 Economical driving (p. 300) Fuel - handling (p. 297) At low temperatures (-6 °C to -40 °C), a paraffin precipitate may form in the diesel fuel, which may lead to ignition problems. Special diesel fuel designed for low temperatures around freezing point is available from the major oil companies. This fuel is less viscous at low temperatures and reduces the risk of paraffin precipitate. Diesel fuel may contain a certain amount of FAME, but further amounts must not be added. IMPORTANT Diesel type fuels that must not be used: • • • • Special additives Marine diesel fuel Heating oil FAME14 (Fatty Acid Methyl Ester) and vegetable oil. These fuels do not fulfil the requirements in accordance with Volvo recommendations and generate increased wear and engine damage that is not covered by the Volvo warranty. Empty tank The design of the fuel system in a diesel engine means that if the vehicle runs out of fuel, the tank may need to be vented in the workshop in order to restart the engine after fuelling. Once the engine has stopped due to fuel starvation, the fuel system needs a few moments to carry out a check. Do this before starting the engine, once the fuel tank has been filled with diesel: 1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition switch and push it in to the end position, see Key positions (p. 71). 2. Press the START button without depressing the brake and/or clutch pedal. 08 Starting and driving 3. Wait approx. 1 minute. Filling with fuel - with a fuel can Diesel particle filter (DPF) 4. To start the engine: Depress the brake and/or clutch pedal and then press the START button again. When filling with fuel (p. 296) from a fuel can, use the funnel located under the floor hatch in the cargo area. Diesel cars are equipped with a particle filter, which results in more efficient emission control. Take care to insert the funnel properly into the filler pipe. The filler pipe consists of two opening covers. The funnel must be pushed past both covers before filling is started. The particles in the exhaust gases are collected in the filter during normal driving. Socalled "regeneration" is started in order to burn away the particles and empty the filter. This requires the engine to have reached normal operating temperature. NOTE Before filling with fuel in the event of fuel shortage: • Stop the car on as flat/level ground as possible - if the car is tilting there is a risk of air pockets in the fuel supply. Draining condensation from the fuel filter The fuel filter separates condensation from the fuel. Condensation can disrupt engine operation. The fuel filter must be drained at the intervals specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet or if you suspect that the car has been filled with contaminated fuel, see Volvo service programme (p. 332). IMPORTANT Certain special additives remove the water separation in the fuel filter. Related information • • • Diesel particle filter (DPF) (p. 299) Fuel - handling (p. 297) Related information • • Locking/unlocking - fuel filler flap (p. 178) Fuel filler flap - manual opening (p. 296) Filter regeneration takes place automatically and normally takes 10-20 minutes. It may take a little longer at a low average speed. Fuel consumption may increase slightly during regeneration. Regeneration in cold weather If the car is frequently driven short distances in cold weather then the engine does not reach normal operating temperature. This means that regeneration of the diesel particle filter does not take place and the filter is not emptied. When the filter has become approximately 80% full of particles, a yellow warning triangle is shown in the combined instrument panel, and the message Soot filter full See manual is shown in the information display. Start regeneration of the filter by driving the car until the engine reaches normal operating temperature, preferably on a main road or 08 Economical driving (p. 300) 299 08 Starting and driving || motorway. The car should then be driven for approximately 20 minutes more. NOTE The following may arise during regeneration: Economical driving Driving economically means driving smoothly while thinking ahead and adjusting your driving style and speed to the prevailing conditions. • a smaller reduction of engine power may be noticed temporarily • • Avoid driving with open windows. • fuel consumption may increase temporarily • • a smell of burning may arise. Avoid sudden unnecessary acceleration and heavy braking. • Drive with the correct air pressure in the tyres and check it regularly - select ECO tyre pressure for best results, see Tyres approved tyre pressures (p. 457). • Drive in the highest gear possible, adapted to the current traffic situation and road - lower engine speeds result in lower fuel consumption. Use the gear shift indicator (p. 272)15. • Remove unnecessary items from the car the greater the load the higher the fuel consumption. • Use engine braking to slow down, when it can take place without risk to other road users. • Choice of tyres can affect fuel consumption - seek advice on suitable tyres from a dealer. • A roof load and ski box increase air resistance, leading to higher fuel consumption When regeneration is complete the warning text is cleared automatically. Use the parking heater* in cold weather so that the engine reaches normal operating temperature more quickly. IMPORTANT If the filter is completely filled with particles, it may be difficult to start the engine and the filter is non-functional. Then there is a risk that the filter will need to be replaced. Related information 08 • • 15 300 Fuel - diesel (p. 298) Economical driving (p. 300) Manual gearbox * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Do not use winter tyres when the winter season is over. - remove the load carriers when not in use. • Do not run the engine to operating temperature at idling speed, but rather drive with a light load as soon as possible - a cold engine consumes more fuel than a warm one. • High speed results in increased fuel consumption - the wind resistance increases with speed. For more information, see Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy (p. 20) and Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions (p. 454). WARNING Never switch off the engine while moving, such as downhill, this deactivates important systems such as the power steering and brake servo. 08 Starting and driving Driving with a trailer When driving with a trailer there are a number of important points to think about regarding e.g. the towing bracket, the trailer and how the load is positioned in the trailer. Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The total of the weight of the passengers and all accessories, e.g. towbar, reduces the car's payload by corresponding weights (p. 441). If the towing bracket is mounted by Volvo, then the car is delivered with the necessary equipment for driving with a trailer. • The car's towing bracket must be of an approved type. • If the towbar is retrofitted, check with your Volvo dealer that the car is fully equipped for driving with a trailer. • Distribute the load on the trailer so that the weight on the towing bracket complies with the specified maximum towball load. • Increase the tyre pressure to the recommended air pressure (p. 322) for a full load. • The engine is loaded more heavily than usual when driving with a trailer. • Do not tow a heavy trailer when the car is brand new. Wait until it has been driven at least 1000 km. • The brakes are loaded much more than usual on long and steep downhill slopes. Downshift to a lower gear and adjust your speed. • For safety reasons, the maximum permitted speed for the car when coupled with a trailer should not be exceeded. Follow the regulations in force for the permitted speeds and weights. • Maintain a low speed when driving with a trailer up long, steep ascents. • Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines of more than 12 %. maximum permissible weight). When the car is stationary the rear of the car lowers slightly, which is normal. Trailer weights For information on Volvo's permitted trailer weights, see Towing capacity and towball load (p. 442). NOTE The stated maximum permitted trailer weights are those permitted by Volvo. The maximum permitted speed for a car with a trailer attached is 100 km/h. National vehicle regulations may further restrict the trailer weight and speed. Towbars can be certified for higher towing weights than the car can actually tow. Trailer cable An adapter is required if the car's towing bracket has a 13 pin connector and the trailer has a 7 pin connector. Use an adapter cable approved by Volvo. Make sure the cable does not drag on the ground. Direction indicators and brake lights on the trailer If any of the trailer's lamps for direction indicators are broken, the symbol for direction indicators in the combined instrument panel flashes faster than normal and the information display shows the text Bulb fail - Ind. signal trailer. If any of the trailer's lamps for the brake light are broken then the Bulb fail - Stop lamp trailer text is shown. WARNING Follow the stated recommendations for trailer weights. Otherwise, the car and trailer may be difficult to control in the event of sudden movement and braking. Related information • • Towing bracket (p. 303) Lamp replacement (p. 342) 08 Level control* The rear shock absorbers maintain a constant height irrespective of the car's load (up to the * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 301 08 Starting and driving Driving with a trailer - manual gearbox When driving with a trailer (p. 301) in hilly terrain in a hot climate there may be a risk of overheating. • Do not run the engine at higher revolutions than 4500 rpm (diesel engines: 3500 rpm) - otherwise the oil temperature may become too high. Driving with a trailer - automatic gearbox When driving with a trailer in hilly terrain in a hot climate there may be a risk of overheating. • An automatic gearbox selects the optimum gear related to load and engine speed. • In the event of overheating, a warning symbol is illuminated in the combined instrument panel and a text message is shown in the information display - follow the recommendation given. Diesel engine 5-cyl • In the event of a risk of overheating the optimal speed for the engine is 2300-3000 rpm for optimal circulation of the coolant. Related information • Steep inclines • Do not lock the automatic transmission in a higher gear than the engine "can cope with" - it is not always a good idea to drive at a high gear with low engine revolutions. Manual gearbox (p. 272) IMPORTANT See also the specific information on slow driving with a trailer for cars with automatic gearbox - Powershift (p. 276). Parking on a hill 1. Depress the foot brake. 2. Activate the parking brake. 08 3. Move the gear selector to position P. 4. Release the foot brake. 302 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Move the gear selector to park position P when parking an automatic car with a hitched trailer. Always use the parking brake. • Block the wheels with chocks when parking a car with hitched trailer on a hill. Starting on a hill 1. Depress the foot brake. 2. Move the gear selector to driving position D. 3. Release the parking brake. 4. Release the foot brake and start driving off. Related information • • Automatic gearbox - Geartronic* (p. 273) Automatic gearbox - Powershift* (p. 276) 08 Starting and driving Towing bracket NOTE A towing bracket means that it is possible to e.g. tow a trailer behind the car. If the car is equipped with a detachable towbar, the installation instructions for the loose section must be followed carefully, see Detachable towbar - attachment/removal (p. 304). WARNING When a hitch with a vibration damper is used, the towball must not be lubricated. Detachable towbar - storage Store the detachable towbar in the cargo area. Related information • • • Driving with a trailer (p. 301) Detachable towbar - specifications (p. 304) Detachable towbar - storage (p. 303) If the car is fitted with a Volvo detachable towbar: • Follow the installation instructions carefully. • The detachable section must be locked with the key before setting off. • Check that the indicator window shows green. The storage location for the removable towbar. IMPORTANT Always remove the detachable towbar after use and store it in the designated location in the car. Important checks • The towbar's towball must be cleaned and greased regularly. WARNING The moving parts of the detachable towbar must not be lubricated/oiled. This may reduce safety. Related information • Detachable towbar - specifications (p. 304) • Detachable towbar - attachment/removal (p. 304) • Driving with a trailer (p. 301) 08 303 08 Starting and driving Detachable towbar - specifications Detachable towbar - attachment/ removal Specifications for detachable towbar. The attachment/removal of the detachable towbar is performed in the following way: Dimensions, mounting points (mm) A 887 B 73 C 881 D 441 E 109 F 306 G Side member H Ball centre Related information 08 304 • Detachable towbar - attachment/removal (p. 304) • • Detachable towbar - storage (p. 303) Driving with a trailer (p. 301) Remove the protective cover by first pressing in the catch and then pulling the cover straight back . G021487 G021485 Attaching Ensure that the mechanism is in the unlocked position by turning the key clockwise. The indicator window must show red. The indicator window must show green. G021494 G021490 G021488 08 Starting and driving Check that the towball section is secure by pulling it up, down and back. WARNING Insert the towball section until you hear a click. G000000 G021489 If the towball is not fitted correctly then it must be detached and reattached in accordance with the previous instructions. Turn the key anticlockwise to locked position. Remove the key from the lock. IMPORTANT Only grease in the ball for the towball hitch, the remainder of the towbar must be clean and dry. 08 }} 305 08 Starting and driving G021495 || Safety cable. WARNING Related information • • Take care to secure the trailer's safety cable in the intended bracket. • Removal of detachable towbar Turn the locking wheel down fully, until it comes to a stop. Hold it in this position while pulling the towball rearward and upward. WARNING Insert the key and turn it clockwise to the unlocked position. 08 306 Push the protective cover until it snaps tight. Push in the locking wheel and turn it until you hear a click. anticlockwise Secure the detachable towbar safely if it is stored in the car, see Detachable towbar storage (p. 303). Detachable towbar - storage (p. 303) Detachable towbar - specifications (p. 304) Driving with a trailer (p. 301) 08 Starting and driving Trailer Stability Assist - TSA The trailer stability assist TSA (Trailer Stability Assist) function is to stabilise the car and trailer combination if it begins to snake. The TSA function is part of the DSTC system (Dynamic Stability and Traction Control), see Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185). Function The snaking phenomenon can occur with any car/trailer combination. Snaking normally occurs at high speeds. But, there is a risk of it occurring at lower speeds (70-90 km/h) if the trailer is overloaded or the load is improperly distributed, e.g. too far back. In order for snaking to occur, there must be a triggering factor, e.g.: • Car with trailer subjected to a sudden and powerful side wind. • Car with trailer drives on an uneven road surface or in a pothole. • Sweeping steering wheel movements. Operation If snaking has started, it could be difficult or even impossible to suppress. This makes the car/trailer combination difficult to control and there is a risk that you could, for example, end up in the wrong lane or leave the carriageway. TSA system continually monitors car movements, particularly lateral movements. If snaking is detected, the front wheels are individually braked. This serves to stabilise the car/trailer combination. This is often enough to help the driver regain control of the car. Related information • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - symbols and messages (p. 187) • Stability and traction control system (DSTC) - operation (p. 186) If snaking is not eliminated the first time the TSA system comes into action, the car/trailer combination is braked with all wheels and engine power is reduced. Once snaking has been gradually suppressed and the car/trailer combination is once again stable, the TSA system stops regulating and the driver once again has full control of the car. Miscellaneous The TSA system can engage within the speed interval 65-160 km/h. NOTE TSA function is switched off if the driver selects Sport mode, see Stability and traction control system (DSTC) (p. 185). TSA may fail to engage if the driver uses severe steering wheel movements to try to rectify the snaking because in such a situation the TSA system cannot determine whether it is the trailer or the driver that is causing the snaking. The DSTC symbol in the combined instrument panel flashes when the TSA system is working. 08 307 08 Starting and driving Towing WARNING During towing, one vehicle is towed by another vehicle using a tow rope. The brake servo and power steering do not work when the engine is switched off - the brake pedal needs to be depressed about 5 times more heavily and the steering is considerably heavier than normal. Find out the statutory maximum speed limit for towing before towing begins. 1. Unlock the steering lock (p. 270) by inserting the remote control key in the ignition switch and giving a long press on the START/STOP ENGINE button - key position (p. 71) II is activated. 2. The remote control key must remain in the ignition switch while the car is being towed. Manual gearbox Prior to towing: – Note that the car must always be towed with the wheels rolling forward. • WARNING 08 308 • The remote control key must be in key position II - in position I all airbags are deactivated. • Never remove the remote control key from the ignition switch when the car is being towed. IMPORTANT Avoid towing. IMPORTANT 4. Be prepared to brake to stop. Check that the steering lock is unlocked before towing. In the event of uncertainty as to whether or not the car is equipped with Powershift transmission, this can be verified by checking the type designation (p. 438) on the transmission's label under the bonnet. The designation ”MPS6” means that it is Powershift – transmission otherwise it is Geartronic automatic transmission. Automatic gearbox Geartronic 3. Keep the towline taut when the towing vehicle reduces speed by holding your foot gently pressed on the brake pedal thereby avoiding unnecessary jerking. • Move gear lever into neutral and release the parking brake. lubrication. If towing still has to take place, the route must be as short as possible and then with very low speed. Do not tow cars with automatic transmission at speeds higher than 80 km/h or for distances in excess of 80 km. Follow the speeds that are permitted in accordance with local traffic regulations. Prior to towing: – Move the gear selector to position N and release the parking brake. Automatic gearbox Powershift The model with Powershift transmission should not be towed as it is dependent on the engine running in order to receive sufficient • However, the car can be towed for a short distance at low speed to move it from a dangerous position - not further than 10 km and not faster than 10 km/h. Note that the car must always be towed with the wheels rolling forward. • In the event of moving a longer distance than 10 km, the car must be transported with the drive wheels raised from the road - professional recovery is recommended. Prior to towing: – Move the gear selector to position N and release the parking brake. 08 Starting and driving Jump starting Towing eye Do not tow the car to bump start the engine. Use a donor battery if the battery is discharged and the engine does not start, see Jump starting (p. 270). The towing eye is screwed into a threaded socket behind a cover on the right-hand side of the bumper, front or rear. IMPORTANT The catalytic converter may be damaged during attempts to tow-start the engine. Related information • Towing eye (p. 309) Attaching the towing eye Take out the towing eye that is located under the floor hatch in the cargo area. NOTE To access the towing eye/wheel wrench in the foam block: • Version 1: Lift the emergency puncture repair kit compressor unit (point 5) to access the wheel wrench. Lift out the bottle of sealant (point 6) to access the towing eye. • Version 2: Lift the emergency puncture repair kit compressor unit (point 5) to access the towing eye. The wheel wrench is located underneath the jack. 08 309 08 Starting and driving || The cover for the towing eye's attachment point is available in two variants which must be opened in the following way: • • Open the rear bumper's recess using a coin or similar inserted in the recess, carefully turning it outwards. Then turn out the cover completely and remove it. The front bumper's recess has a marking along one side or in a corner: Press the marking with a finger and fold out the opposite side/corner at the same time - the cover turns around its axis and can then be removed. Screw the towing eye right in up to its flange. Turn in the towing eye firmly e.g. using the wheel wrench. Recovery Recovery means that the vehicle is transported away by means of another vehicle. Call a recovery service for recovery assistance. The towing eye may be used to pull the car up onto a recovery vehicle with a flatbed platform. The car's position and ground clearance determine whether it is possible. If the slope of the recovery vehicle's ramp is too steep, or if the ground clearance under the car is inadequate, then the car may be damaged if you try to pull it up using the towing eye. Raise the car using the recovery vehicle's lifting device if necessary. IMPORTANT The towing eye is unscrewed after use. Place the towing eye back in its position. Note that the car must always be transported with the wheels rolling forward. Finish by refitting the cover onto the bumper. • IMPORTANT The towing eye is only designed for towing on roads - not for pulling the car unstuck or out of a ditch. Call a recovery service for recovery assistance. 08 Related information • • 310 Towing (p. 308) Recovery (p. 310) An all-wheel drive car (AWD) with raised front suspension must not be towed at speeds above 70 km/h. It should not be towed further than 50 km. Related information • Towing (p. 308) WHEELS AND TYRES 09 Wheels and tyres 09 Tyres - direction of rotation NOTE Tyres with a tread pattern which are designed to only turn in one direction have the direction of rotation marked with an arrow. Make sure that both pairs of wheels have the same type and dimension, and also the same make. Follow the recommended tyre pressure (p. 322) specified in the tyre pressure table. Related information G021778 • • • • The arrow shows the tyre's direction of rotation. The tyre must always rotate in the same direction throughout its lifespan. Tyres should only be switched between front and rear positions, never between left and right-hand sides, or vice versa. If the tyres are fitted incorrectly, the car's braking characteristics and capacity to force rain and slush out of the way are adversely affected. Tyres with the greatest tread depth should always be fitted to the rear of the car (to decrease the risk of skidding). 312 Tyres - dimensions (p. 316) Tyres - speed ratings (p. 317) Tyres - maintenance (p. 312) Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 314) Tyres - maintenance Amongst other things, the function of the tyres is to provide grip on the road surface, dampen vibration and protect the wheel from wear. Driving characteristics Tyres greatly affect the car's driving characteristics. The type of tyre, dimensions, tyre pressure and speed rating are important for how the car performs. Tyre age All tyres older than 6 years old should be checked by an expert even if they seem undamaged. Tyres age and decompose, even if they are hardly ever or never used. The function can therefore be affected. This applies to all tyres that are stored for future use. Examples of external signs which indicate that the tyre is unsuitable for use are cracks or discoloration. 09 Wheels and tyres New tyres Tyres are perishable. After a few years they begin to harden at the same time as the friction capacity/characteristics gradually deteriorate. For this reason, aim to get as fresh tyres as possible when you replace them. This is especially important with regard to winter tyres. The last four digits in the sequence mean the week and year of manufacture. This is the tyre's DOT marking (Department of Transportation), and this is stated with four digits, for example 1510. The tyre in the figure was manufactured in week 15 of 2010. Summer and winter tyres When summer and winter wheels are changed the wheels should be marked with which side of the car they were mounted on, for example L for left and R for right. Wear and maintenance Correct tyre pressure (p. 322) results in more even wear. Driving style, tyre pressure, climate and road condition affect how quickly your tyres age and wear. To avoid differences in tread depth and to prevent wear patterns (p. 314) arising, the front and rear wheels can be switched with each other. A suitable distance for the first change is approx. 5000 km and then at 10000 km intervals. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop for checking if you are uncertain about tread depth. If significant differences in wear (>1 mm difference in tread depth) between tyres have already occurred, the least worn tyres must always be placed on the rear. Understeer is normally easier to correct than oversteer, and leads to the car continuing forwards in a straight line rather than having the rear end skidding to one side, resulting in possible complete loss of control over the car. This is why it is important for the rear wheels never to lose grip before the front wheels. Related information • • • 09 Tyres - dimensions (p. 316) Tyres - speed ratings (p. 317) Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 312) Wheels must be stored lying down or hanging up - never standing up. WARNING A damaged tyre may lead to loss of control over the car. 313 09 Wheels and tyres 09 Tyres - tread wear indicators Wheel bolts Locking wheel bolts* A tread wear indicator shows the status of the tyre's tread. Wheel bolts are used to fasten the wheels at the hubs and are available in different versions. Locking wheel bolts can be used on both aluminium and steel rims. Under the cargo area floor there is space for the sleeve for the lockable wheel bolts. Related information G021829 • Tread wear indicators. • • Related information • • • • 314 Low wheel bolt Tread wear indicators are narrow treadless bands across the width of the tread. On the side of the tyre are the letters TWI (Tread Wear Indicator). When the tyre's tread depth is down to 1.6 mm, the tread depth will be level in height with the tread wear indicators. Change to new tyres as soon as possible. Remember that tyres with little tread depth provide very poor grip in rain and snow. Tyres - speed ratings (p. 317) Tyres - air pressure (p. 322) Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 312) High wheel bolt Locking wheel bolts Tightening torque Type 1 wheel bolt (steel rim): 110 Nm Type 2 wheel bolt (aluminium rim): 130 Nm Type 3 Lockable wheel bolt (steel/ aluminium rim): 110 Nm Only use rims that are tested and approved by Volvo and which are Volvo genuine accessories. Check the torque with a torque wrench. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Wheel and wheel rim dimensions (p. 316) 09 Wheels and tyres Jack Winter tyres Using snow chains A jack is used to raise the car, e.g. when changing the tyres. Winter tyres are tyres that are adapted for winter road conditions. The original jack should only be used for changing to the spare wheel. The jack's thread must always be well greased. Winter tyres Snow chains may only be used on the front wheels (also applies to all-wheel drive cars). Never drive faster than 50 km/h with snow chains. Avoid driving on bare ground as this wears out both the snow chains and tyres. Related information • • Warning triangle (p. 323) Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Volvo recommends winter tyres with particular dimensions. Tyre dimensions are dependent on engine variant. When driving on winter tyres, the correct type of tyres must be fitted to all four wheels. WARNING Use Volvo genuine snow chains or equivalent chains designed for the car model, and tyre and rim dimensions. In the event of uncertainty Volvo recommends that you consult an authorised Volvo workshop. The wrong snow chains may cause serious damage to your car and lead to an accident. NOTE Volvo recommends that you consult a Volvo dealer about which wheel rim and tyre types are most suitable. Studded tyres Studded winter tyres should be run in gently for 500-1000 km so the studs settle properly into the tyres. This gives the tyre, and especially the studs, a longer service life. 09 Related information • Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 319) NOTE The legal provisions for the use of studded tyres vary from country to country. Tread depth Road conditions with ice, slush and low temperatures place considerably higher demands on tyres than summer conditions. Volvo therefore recommends not to drive on winter tyres that have a tread depth of less than4 mm. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 315 09 Wheels and tyres 09 Wheel and wheel rim dimensions Tyres - dimensions Tyres - load index Wheel and rim dimensions are designated in accordance with the examples in the table below. The car's wheels, tyres and rims have a certain dimension, see the examples in the table below. Load index indicates a tyre's ability to carry a certain load. Wheels (rims) have a designation of dimensions, for example: 7Jx16x50. The dimensions are stated on all car tyres. Example of designation:215/55R16 97W. 7 Rim width in inches 205 Tyre width (mm) J Rim flange profile 50 16 Rim diameter in inches Ratio between tyre wall height and tyre width (%) 50 Off-set in mm (distance from wheel centre to wheel contact surface against the hub) R Radial ply 17 Rim diameter in inches (") 93 Codes for the maximum permitted tyre load, load index (p. 316) (LI) W Speed rating for maximum permitted speed, speed rating (p. 317) (SS). (In this case 270 km/h). Related information • Wheel bolts (p. 314) Related information • • • 316 Tyres - air pressure (p. 322) Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 312) Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 314) Each tyre has a certain capacity to carry a load, a load index (LI). The car's weight determines the load capacity required of the tyres. Related information • • • • Tyres - dimensions (p. 316) Tyres - speed ratings (p. 317) Tyres - air pressure (p. 322) Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 314) 09 Wheels and tyres Tyres - speed ratings WARNING Each tyre can withstand a certain maximum speed and therefore belongs to a particular speed rating (SS - Speed Symbol). Tyre speed class must at least correspond with the car's top speed. Minimum speed rating is indicated in the speed rating table below. The only exception to these conditions is winter tyres (p. 315) (both those with metal studs and those without), where a lower speed rating may be used. If such a tyre is chosen, the car must not be driven faster than the speed rating of the tyre (for example, class Q can be driven at a maximum of 160 km/h). Traffic regulations determine how fast a car can be driven, not the speed rating of the tyres. NOTE The car must be fitted with tyres which have the same or a higher load index (p. 316) (LI) and speed rating (SS) than specified. If a tyre with too low a load index or speed rating is used, it may overheat. Related information • • • Tyres - dimensions (p. 316) Tyres - air pressure (p. 322) Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 312) Spare wheel* A spare wheel is only intended for use temporarily and must be replaced by an normal wheel as soon as possible. The car's handling may be altered by the use of a spare wheel. The spare wheel is smaller than the normal wheel. The car's ground clearance is affected accordingly. Pay attention to high kerbs and do not machine wash the car. If the spare wheel is fitted on the front axle, you cannot use snow chains at the same time. On allwheel drive cars the drive on the rear axle can be disconnected. The spare wheel must not be repaired. The correct tyre pressure for the spare wheel is stated in the tyre pressure table, Tyres - air pressure (p. 322). The maximum permitted speed is specified in the table. Q 160 km/h (used only on winter tyres) T 190 km/h H 210 km/h V 240 km/h W 270 km/h Y 300 km/h 09 A spare wheel (Temporary spare) is used to temporarily replace a punctured normal wheel. IMPORTANT • Never drive faster than 80 km/h with a spare wheel on the car. • The car must never be driven fitted with more than one "Temporary Spare" wheel. Related information • Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 319) • Changing wheels - fitting the spare wheel* (p. 320) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 317 09 Wheels and tyres 09 • • • • Changing wheels - taking out the spare wheel* (p. 318) Changing wheels - taking out the spare wheel* Jack (p. 315) The spare wheel* plus jack* and wheel wrench* are stored under the floor in the cargo area. Warning triangle (p. 323) Wheel bolts (p. 314) 5. Take hold of the far end of the spare wheel, then lift. Push the spare wheel forwards slightly and lift it out of the storage compartment. 6. Remove the wheel wrench, the jack and the towing eye from the foam block. NOTE The jack must be lifted out in order to access the towing eye. Related information 1. Lift the rear edge of the luggage compartment floor (or on models with a jointed luggage compartment floor, take hold of the luggage compartment floor handle, lift and move the rear part of the floor forwards). 2. Lift out the storage compartment* (only models with a jointed cargo area floor). 3. Lift out the lower floor (models with a jointed luggage compartment floor only). 4. Undo the attaching screw and lift out the foam block containing the jack and tools. 318 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 319) • Changing wheels - fitting the spare wheel* (p. 320) • • • • Jack (p. 315) Spare wheel* (p. 317) Warning triangle (p. 323) Wheel bolts (p. 314) 09 Wheels and tyres Changing wheels - removing wheels The car's wheels can be changed for e.g. winter wheels/winter tyres. Set up the warning triangle if a wheel must be replaced at a busy location. The car and jack* must be on a firm horizontal surface. 1. Apply the parking brake and engage reverse gear, or position P if the car has an automatic gearbox. 3. Place chocks in front of and behind the wheels which will remain on the ground. Use heavy wooden blocks or large stones for example. 5. Screw together the towing eye with the wheel wrench* until the stop position as shown in the following illustration. 09 4. Cars with steel rims have removable wheel covers. Use the removal tool to hook in and pull off any full-wheel wheel covers. Alternatively, the wheel covers can be pulled away by hand. WARNING Check that the jack is not damaged, that the threads are thoroughly lubricated and that it is free from dirt. NOTE Volvo recommends only using the jack* that belongs to the car model in question, which is indicated on the jack's label. The decal also indicates the jack's maximum lift capacity at a specified lifting height. The wheel wrench and towing eye. IMPORTANT The towing eye must be screwed into all threads in the wheel bolt wrench. 6. Loosen the wheel bolts ½-1 turn anticlockwise with the wheel wrench. 2. Take out the wheel to be fitted (summer tyre, winter tyre or spare wheel) as well as the tools. If it is a spare wheel being fitted then there is a package in its location containing gloves and a plastic bag for the punctured wheel. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 319 09 Wheels and tyres 09 || WARNING WARNING Never position anything between the ground and the jack, nor between the jack and the car's jacking point. Never crawl under the car when it is raised on the jack. 7. There are two jacking points on each side of the car. Park the car such that passengers have the car, or ideally a crash barrier, between themselves and the roadway. Passengers must leave the car when it is raised on the jack. NOTE The car's regular jack is designed only for use occasionally and for a short time, such as when changing a wheel with a punctured tyre, switching between summer tyres and winter tyres, etc. Only the jack belonging to the specific model is to be used to jack up the car. If the car is to be jacked up more often, or for a longer time than is required just to change a wheel, use of a garage jack is recommended. In this instance, follow the instructions for use that come with the equipment. IMPORTANT The ground under the jack must be firm, smooth and level. 8. Wind up the jack so that the flange in the bodywork ends up in the notch in the head of the jack. 9. Lift the car so that the wheel is free. Remove the wheel bolts and lift off the wheel. 320 Changing wheels - fitting the spare wheel* It is important that the procedure for fitting the spare wheel is carried out correctly. Fitting 1. Clean the contact surfaces between wheel and hub. 2. Put on the wheel. Tighten the wheel bolts thoroughly. 3. Lower the car so that the wheels cannot rotate. Related information • Changing wheels - fitting the spare wheel* (p. 320) • Changing wheels - taking out the spare wheel* (p. 318) • • • • Jack (p. 315) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Spare wheel* (p. 317) Warning triangle (p. 323) Wheel bolts (p. 314) 4. Tighten the wheel bolts crosswise. It is important that the wheel bolts are tightened with the correct tightening torque. Check the torque with a torque wrench. 09 Wheels and tyres Putting back the jack* and tools 5. 3. If the spare wheel has been used, then the punctured wheel can be placed in the plastic bag contained in the package with the gloves. Place the foam block back in the storage compartment and tighten the mounting screw to the floor of the storage compartment. 09 If the spare wheel has not been used, place the foam block in the spare wheel and place the spare wheel back in the storage compartment. Tighten the attaching screw to the floor of the storage compartment. Refit any full wheel covers. NOTE The wheel cover outlet for the valve must be positioned over the valve on the wheel rim during fitting. The tools and jack must be returned to their correct places in the foam block after use. 1. Unscrew the towing eye from the wheel bolt wrench. 2. Put back any tools that have been used in the relevant compartments in the foam block in the following order: • towing eye/funnel/torx wrench/socket for locking wheel bolts/tool for wheel covers • jack (must be cranked to the correct height so that it fits into the foam block's compartment, the handle above the foot and down in the groove in the foam block) • socket wrench (above the jack). 4. Return the detachable towbar. NOTE • After a tyre has been inflated, always refit the dust cap in order to avoid damage to the valve from gravel, dirt, etc. • Only use plastic dust caps. Metal dust caps can rust and become difficult to unscrew. IMPORTANT The tools and jack* must be stored in the intended location in the car's cargo area when not in use. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 321 09 Wheels and tyres || Related information Tyres - air pressure • Changing wheels - taking out the spare wheel* (p. 318) • Tyres can have different air pressures which are measured in bar. Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 319) Check the air pressure in the tyres • • • • Jack (p. 315) Spare wheel* (p. 317) Warning triangle (p. 323) Wheel bolts (p. 314) The air pressure (p. 457) for the tyres must be checked every month. Check air pressure with cold tyres. "Cold tyres" means the tyres are the same temperature as the ambient temperature. After several few kilometres of driving, the tyres warm up and the pressure increases. Inadequate tyre pressure increases fuel consumption, shortens tyre lifespan and impairs the car's roadholding. Driving on tyres with tyre pressure that is too low could result in the tyres overheating and being damaged. Tyre pressure affects travelling comfort, road noise and steering characteristics. NOTE Tyre pressure decreases over time, this is a natural phenomenon. Tyre pressure also varies depending on ambient temperature. Tyre pressure label G021830 09 The tyre pressure label on the driver's side door pillar (between front and rear door) shows which pressures the tyres should have at different loads and speed conditions. This is also specified in the tyre pressure table. • Tyre pressures for the car's recommended tyre dimension (p. 316) • ECO pressure results in improved fuel economy (p. 300) NOTE Temperature differences change the tyre pressure. Fuel economy, ECO pressure In order to obtain optimum fuel economy at speeds below 160 km/h an ECO pressure is recommended (applies to both full and light load - see the tyre pressure table (p. 457)). 322 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 09 Wheels and tyres Related information • • • • Tyres - speed ratings (p. 317) Warning triangle Tyres - direction of rotation (p. 312) The warning triangle is used to warn other road users of a stationary vehicle. Tyres - maintenance (p. 312) Storage and folding up Tyres - tread wear indicators (p. 314) Lift the floor hatch (or push the rear part of the luggage compartment floor forwards in models with a jointed floor and then lift the lower floor) and remove the warning triangle. 09 Take the warning triangle from the case, fold out and assemble the two loose sides. Fold out the warning triangle's support legs. Follow the regulations for the use of a warning triangle. Position the warning triangle in a suitable place with regard to traffic. Ensure the warning triangle and its case are properly secured in the cargo area after use. Related information • Spare wheel* (p. 317) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 323 09 Wheels and tyres 09 First aid kit* Emergency puncture repair* The first aid box contains first aid equipment. Emergency puncture repair, the emergency puncture repair kit* (TMK - Temporary Mobility Kit), is used to seal a puncture and check and adjust the air pressure. The emergency puncture repair kit consists of a compressor and a bottle of sealant. The sealing works as a temporary repair. The sealing fluid bottle must be replaced before its expiration date and after use. The sealing fluid effectively seals tyres punctured in the tread. NOTE A case containing first aid equipment is located on the left-hand side of the cargo area. The emergency puncture repair kit is only intended for sealing tyres with a puncture in the tread. The emergency puncture repair kit has limited capacity to seal tyres which have punctures in the wall. Do not seal tyres with the emergency puncture repair kit if they have larger slits, cracks or similar damage. Connect the compressor to one of the car's 12 V sockets. Choose the socket that is nearest to the punctured tyre. NOTE The compressor for temporary emergency puncture repair has been tested and approved by Volvo. 324 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Emergency puncture repair* - operation (p. 326) • Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking (p. 328) • Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 326) 09 Wheels and tyres Emergency puncture repair kit* location 5. Lift the TMK compressor unit straight up. 6. To access the bottle of sealant, it must be pushed to the left until it can be lifted out of the foam block. Emergency puncture repair kit (TMK - Temporary Mobility Kit) is used to seal a puncture and check and adjust the air pressure. NOTE Location of the emergency puncture repair kit To access the towing eye/wheel wrench in the foam block: • Version 1: Lift the emergency puncture repair kit compressor unit (point 5) to access the wheel wrench. Lift out the bottle of sealant (point 6) to access the towing eye. • Version 2: Lift the emergency puncture repair kit compressor unit (point 5) to access the towing eye. The wheel wrench is located underneath the jack. Version 2. Set up the warning triangle if a tyre is being sealed in a trafficked location. The warning triangle and emergency puncture repair kit are located under the floor in the cargo area. Version 1. 09 1. Lift the rear edge of the luggage compartment floor (or on models with a jointed luggage compartment floor, take hold of the luggage compartment floor handle, lift and move the rear part of the floor forwards). After use, hook the belt back onto the left side. 2. Lift out the storage compartment (optional extra) - models with a jointed luggage compartment floor only. Version 2: The belt must be in the fork on the rear part of the foam block. 3. Lift out the lower floor (models with a jointed luggage compartment floor only). • Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 326) 4. Unhook the elastic part of the belt over the TMK compressor unit on the left side. • Emergency puncture repair kit* - sealant (p. 330) • Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Version 1: The belt must be pulled behind the foam block (not above). Related information * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 325 09 Wheels and tyres 09 Emergency puncture repair kit* overview Emergency puncture repair kit (TMK - Temporary Mobility Kit) is used to seal a puncture and check and adjust the air pressure. Related information • Emergency puncture repair kit* - location (p. 325) • Emergency puncture repair kit* - sealant (p. 330) • • Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Emergency puncture repair* - stowing components (p. 330) Emergency puncture repair* operation Emergency puncture repair, the emergency puncture repair kit* (TMK - Temporary Mobility Kit), is used to seal a puncture and check and adjust the air pressure. Emergency puncture repair Label, maximum permitted speed Switch Cable Bottle holder (orange cap) Protective cap Pressure reducing valve Air hose Bottle holder with sealant Pressure gauge 326 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. For information on the function of the parts, see Emergency puncture repair kit. 09 Wheels and tyres 1. Detach the label for maximum permitted speed (which is fitted on one side of the compressor) and affix it to the steering wheel. WARNING You should not drive faster than 80 km/h after the emergency tyre repair kit has been used. Volvo recommends that you visit an authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance is 200 km). The staff there can determine whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if it needs to be replaced. WARNING The sealing fluid can irritate the skin. In the case of contact with skin, wash away the fluid with soap and water. 2. Check that the switch is in position 0 and locate the cable and the air hose. 4. Screw the bottle into its holder. WARNING Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped with a reverse catch to prevent leakage. 5. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw in the air hose valve connection to the bottom of the thread on the tyre's air valve. 6. Plug the cable into the 12 V socket and start the car. WARNING Do not leave children in the car without supervision when the engine is running. 7. Flick the switch to position I. 09 WARNING Never stand next to the tyre when the compressor is running. If cracks or unevenness arise then the compressor must be switched off immediately. The journey should not be continued. Contacting an authorised tyre centre is recommended. NOTE When the compressor starts, the pressure can increase up to 6 bar but the pressure drops after approximately 30 seconds. 8. Inflate the tyre for 7 minutes. IMPORTANT Risk of overheating. The compressor must not run for more than 10 minutes. NOTE Do not break the bottle's seal before use. The seal is broken automatically when the bottle is screwed in. 3. Unscrew the orange cap and unscrew the bottle's stopper. }} 327 09 Wheels and tyres 09 || 9. Switch off the compressor to check the pressure on the pressure gauge. Minimum pressure is 1.8 bar and maximum 3.5 bar. (Release air with the pressure reducing valve if the tyre pressure is too high.) WARNING If the pressure is below 1.8 bar then the hole in the tyre is too big. The journey should not be continued. Contacting an authorised tyre centre is recommended. Emergency puncture repair* rechecking Emergency puncture repair (p. 324), in which the emergency puncture repair kit (p. 326)* (TMK - Temporary Mobility Kit), is used to seal a puncture and check and adjust the air pressure. Check tyre pressure 1. Connect the tyre sealing equipment again. 11. Detach the hose from the tyre valve and fit the valve cap. 12. As soon as possible, drive approximately 3 km at a maximum speed of 80 km/h so that the sealing fluid can seal the tyre. Related information 328 Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking (p. 328) • Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 326) • Emergency puncture repair* - stowing components (p. 330) 3. Make sure the compressor is switched off. Detach the air hose and cable. Refit the dust cap. 4. Fold the hose into the box and leave the bottle where it is. Place TMK in the cargo area. 2. Read the tyre pressure on the pressure gauge. 10. Switch off the compressor and unplug the cable from the 12 V socket. • • WARNING Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped with a reverse catch to prevent leakage. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. NOTE • If it is below 1.3 bar then the tyre is insufficiently sealed. The journey should not be continued. Contact a tyre centre. • After a tyre has been inflated, always refit the dust cap in order to avoid damage to the valve from gravel, dirt, etc. • If the tyre pressure is higher than 1.3 bar, the tyre must be inflated to the pressure specified in accordance with the tyre pressure table (p. 457) (1 bar = 100 kPa). Release air using the pressure reducing valve if the tyre pressure is too high. • Only use plastic dust caps. Metal dust caps can rust and become difficult to unscrew. NOTE The sealing fluid bottle and the hose must be replaced after use. Volvo recommends that this replacement is performed by an authorised Volvo workshop. WARNING Check the tyre pressure regularly. 09 Wheels and tyres Volvo recommends that you drive to the nearest authorised Volvo workshop for the replacement/repair of the damaged tyre. Advise the workshop that the tyre contains sealing fluid. WARNING You should not drive faster than 80 km/h after the emergency tyre repair kit has been used. Volvo recommends that you visit an authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance is 200 km). The staff there can determine whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if it needs to be replaced. Related information • Emergency puncture repair* - operation (p. 326) • Emergency puncture repair* - stowing components (p. 330) Inflating tyres with the emergency puncture repair kit* IMPORTANT The car's original tyres can be inflated using the compressor in the emergency puncture repair kit. 1. The compressor must be switched off. Make sure that the switch is in position 0 and locate the cable and air hose. 2. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw in the air hose valve connection to the bottom of the thread on the tyre's air valve. 09 Risk of overheating. The compressor must not run for more than 10 minutes. 5. Inflate the tyre to the pressure specified in accordance with the tyre pressure table. (Release air using the pressure reducing valve if the tyre pressure is too high.) 6. Switch off the compressor. Detach the air hose and cable. 7. Refit the dust cap. Related information WARNING Inhaling car exhaust fumes could result in danger to life. Never leave the engine running in sealed areas or areas that lack sufficient ventilation. • • Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 326) WARNING Do not leave children in the car without supervision when the engine is running. 3. Connect the cable to one of the car's 12 V sockets and start the car. 4. Start the compressor by flicking the switch to position I. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 329 09 Wheels and tyres 09 Emergency puncture repair* - stowing components Emergency puncture repair kit* sealant After using the puncture repair kit, the components returned to their correct places in the foam block. The container (bottle) with the emergency puncture repair kit (p. 326) contains sealant and it can be replaced. Replace the bottle when the expiration date has passed. Treat the old bottle as environmentally hazardous waste. WARNING Version 1. The components are fitted in the foam block in the following order: 1. Towing eye/socket wrench 2. Bottle (pressed in from the side) 3. TMK kit 4. Funnel 5. Jack 6. Torx wrench 7. Towbar 330 Version 2. The bottle contains 1.2-Ethanol and natural rubber-latex. The components are fitted in the foam block in the following order: Harmful if ingested. Could result in allergic reaction in the event of skin contact. 1. Socket wrench Avoid contact with the skin and eyes. 2. Towing eye Store out of the reach of children. 3. Bottle 4. TMK kit 5. Jack Related information • • Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Emergency puncture repair* - operation (p. 326) • Emergency puncture repair* - rechecking (p. 328) • Emergency puncture repair kit* - overview (p. 326) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • • Emergency puncture repair* (p. 324) Emergency puncture repair kit* - location (p. 325) MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE 10 Maintenance and service Volvo service programme 10 To keep the car as safe and reliable as possible, follow the Volvo service programme as specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Volvo recommends engaging an authorised Volvo workshop to perform the service and maintenance work. Volvo workshops have the personnel, special tools and service literature to guarantee the highest quality of service. IMPORTANT For the Volvo warranty to apply, check and follow the instructions in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Related information • 332 Climate control system - fault tracing and repair (p. 341) 10 Maintenance and service Raising the car When raising the car it is important that the jack or lifting arms are fitted in the intended points on the car's underbody. NOTE 10 Volvo recommends only using the jack that belongs to the car model in question. If a jack is selected other than the one recommended by Volvo, follow the instructions supplied with the equipment. }} 333 10 Maintenance and service || 10 Jacking points (arrows) for the jack that belongs to the car and lifting points (marked in red). If the car is raised with a front workshop jack then it must be positioned under one of the two lifting points furthest in under the car. If the car is raised with a rear workshop jack then it must be positioned under one of the lifting points. Ensure that the workshop jack is positioned so that the car cannot slide off the jack. Always use axle stands or similar. If the car is raised with a two-pillar workshop lift then the front and rear lifting arms can be positioned under the outer lifting points (jacking points). Alternatively, the inner lifting points can be used at the front. Related information • 334 Changing wheels - removing wheels (p. 319) 10 Maintenance and service Bonnet - opening and closing Move the catch to the left and open the bonnet. (The catch hook is located between the headlamp and grille, see illustration.) The bonnet can be opened when the handle in the passenger compartment has been turned clockwise and the lock by the grille has been moved to the left. Engine compartment - overview The overview shows normal checking points. 10 WARNING Check that the bonnet locks properly when closed. Related information • • Engine compartment - checking (p. 336) Engine compartment - overview (p. 335) The handle for bonnet opening is always on the left-hand side. The appearance of the engine compartment may differ depending on engine variant. Coolant expansion tank Filling washer fluid Radiator Engine oil dipstick1 Filling engine oil Turn the handle about 20-25 degrees clockwise. You will hear when the catch releases. Reservoir for brake and clutch fluid (located on the driver's side) Starter battery Relay and fuse box Air filter 1 Engines with electronic oil level sensor do not have a dipstick (5-cyl. diesel). 335 10 Maintenance and service || WARNING The ignition system has very high voltage and output. The voltage in the ignition system is highly dangerous. The car's electrical system must always be in key position 0 when work is being performed in the engine compartment; see Key positions functions at different levels (p. 71). 10 Do not touch the spark plugs or ignition coil when the car's electrical system is in key position II or when the engine is hot. Engine compartment - checking Engine oil - general Some oils and fluids should be checked at regular intervals. An approved engine oil must be used in order that the recommended service intervals can be applied. Regular checking Check the following oils and fluids at regular intervals, e.g. when refuelling: • • • Washer fluid WARNING Related information • • Coolant Engine oil Bonnet - opening and closing (p. 335) Remember that the radiator fan (located at the front of the engine compartment, behind the radiator) may start automatically some after the engine has been switched off. Engine compartment - checking (p. 336) Always have the engine cleaned by a workshop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is hot. Related information • • • • • 336 Bonnet - opening and closing (p. 335) Engine compartment - overview (p. 335) Coolant - level (p. 340) Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337) Washer fluid - filling (p. 351) Volvo recommends: 10 Maintenance and service When driving under adverse conditions, see Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446). IMPORTANT In order to fulfil the requirements for the engine's service intervals all engines are filled with a specially adapted synthetic engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil has been made very carefully with regard to service life, starting characteristics, fuel consumption and environmental impact. An approved engine oil must be used in order that the recommended service intervals can be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of oil for both filling and oil change, otherwise you will risk affecting service life, starting characteristics, fuel consumption and environmental impact. texts. Certain variants have both systems. Contact a Volvo dealer for more information. Change the engine oil and oil filter in accordance with the intervals specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Engine oil - checking and filling Depending on engine variant the oil level is checked with the dipstick or the electronic oil level sensor. 10 Using oil of a higher than specified grade is permitted. If the car is driven in adverse conditions, Volvo recommends using an oil of a higher grade; see Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446). For filling capacities, see Engine oil - grade and volume (p. 447). Related information • Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337) Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all warranty liability if engine oil of the prescribed grade and viscosity is not used. Volvo recommends that oil changes are carried out at an authorised Volvo workshop. Volvo uses different systems for warning of low/high oil level or low/high oil pressure. Certain engine variants have an oil pressure sensor, and then the combined instrument panel's warning symbol for low oil pressure is used. Other variants have an oil level sensor, when the driver is informed via the instrument's warning symbol and display 337 10 Maintenance and service || 6. If required, check the level again, do it after driving a short distance. Then repeat steps 1-4. Engine with oil dipstick2 WARNING 10 G021737 Never fill above the MAX mark. The level should never be above MAX or below MIN as this could lead to engine damage. Dipstick and filler pipe. Checking the oil level in a new car is especially important before the first scheduled oil change. Volvo recommends checking the oil level every 2 500 km. The most accurate measurements are made on a cold engine before starting. The measurement will be inaccurate if taken immediately after the engine is switched off. The dipstick will indicate that the level is too low because the oil has not had time to flow down into the oil sump. 2 3 4 338 The oil level must be between the MIN and MAX marks. Measurement and filling if required 1. Ensure that the car is level. After switching off the engine it is important to wait 5 minutes to allow the oil time to run back to the sump. WARNING Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold due to the risk of fire. Engine with electronic oil level sensor3 2. Pull up and wipe the dipstick. 3. Re-insert the dipstick. 4. Pull it out and check the level. 5. If the level is close to MIN then 0.5 litres should be added. If the level is significantly below, then an additional amount is required. Only applies to petrol and 4-cyl. diesel. Only applies to 5-cyl. diesel. Engines with electronic oil level sensor do not have a dipstick (5-cyl. diesel). Filler pipe4. 10 Maintenance and service You do not need to take action with respect to the engine oil level before a message is shown in the combined instrument panel's information display, see following figure. IMPORTANT In the event of the message Oil level low Refill 0.5 litre, only fill with 0.5 litres. 2. Rotate the thumbwheel on the left-hand stalk switch to position Oil level. > You will then see information displayed about the engine oil level. NOTE 10 The oil level is only detected by the system during driving. The system cannot directly detect changes when the oil is filled or drained. The car must be driven about 30 km before the oil level display is correct. WARNING Message and graph in the display. The left-hand display shows the digital combined instrument panel and the right-hand the analogue. Message Engine oil level On certain cars, the oil level can be checked using the electronic oil level gauge with the thumbwheel when the engine is switched off. WARNING If the message Oil service required is shown, visit a workshop. The oil level may be too high. Do not fill more oil if filling level (3) or (4) appears as shown in the illustration below. The level must never be above MAX or below MIN, as this could lead to engine damage. WARNING Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold due to the risk of fire. The figures 1-4 represent filling level. Do not fill more oil if filling level (3) or (4) is shown. The recommended filling level is 4. Message and graph in the display. The left-hand display shows the digital combined instrument panel and the righthand the analogue. Related information • Engine oil - general (p. 336) Measuring the oil level If the oil level needs to be checked then it should be carried out in accordance with the sequence below. 1. Activate key position II; see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). 339 10 Maintenance and service Coolant - level 10 The coolant cools the internal combustion engine to the correct operating temperature. The heat that is transferred from the engine to the coolant can be used to heat the passenger compartment. The coolant level must lie between the MIN and MAX marks on the expansion tank. Checking the level and topping up WARNING Coolant can be very hot. If the coolant requires topping up when the engine is at operating temperature, unscrew the expansion tank cap slowly to gently release the overpressure. For capacities and for standards regarding water quality; see Coolant - grade and volume (p. 449). IMPORTANT • A high content of chlorine, chlorides and other salts may cause corrosion in the cooling system. • Always use coolant with anti-corrosion agent as recommended by Volvo. • Ensure that the coolant mixture is 50% water and 50% coolant. • Mix the coolant with approved quality tap water. In the event of any doubt about water quality, used ready-mixed coolant in accordance with Volvo recommendations. • When changing coolant/replacing cooling system components, flush the cooling system clean with approved quality tap water or flush with readymixed coolant. • The engine must only be run with a well-filled cooling system. Otherwise, temperatures that are too high may occur resulting in the risk of damage (cracks) in the cylinder head. Check the coolant regularly The level must lie between the MIN and MAX marks on the expansion tank. If the system is not filled sufficiently, high temperatures could occur, causing a risk of damage to the engine. When topping up the coolant, follow the instructions on the packaging. It is important that the mixture of coolant concentrate and water is correct for the prevailing weather conditions. Never top up with water only. The risk of freezing increases with both too little and too much coolant concentrate. 340 10 Maintenance and service Brake and clutch fluid - level Filling Brake and clutch fluid level should be between the reservoir MIN and MAX marks. The air conditioning system must only be serviced and repaired by an authorised workshop. Checking the level Brake and clutch fluid have a common reservoir. The level must be between the MIN and MAX marks that are visible inside the reservoir. Check the level regularly. WARNING If the brake fluid is below the MIN level in the brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further before topping up the brake fluid. Volvo recommends that the reason for the loss of brake fluid is investigated by an authorised Volvo workshop. 10 Troubleshooting and repair The air conditioning system contains fluorescent tracing agents. Use ultraviolet light when looking for leaks. Change the brake fluid every other year or at every other regular service. For capacities and recommended brake fluid grade, see Brake fluid - grade and volume (p. 451). The fluid should be changed annually on cars driven in conditions requiring hard, frequent braking, such as driving in mountains or tropical climates with high humidity. Climate control system - fault tracing and repair Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop. The fluid reservoir is located on the driver's side. WARNING Unscrew the reservoir cap and fill the fluid. The level must be between the MIN and MAX marks, which are located on the inside of the reservoir. IMPORTANT Do not forget to refit the cap. The air conditioning system contains pressurised refrigerant R134a. This system must only be serviced and repaired by an authorised workshop. Related information • Volvo service programme (p. 332) 341 10 Maintenance and service Lamp replacement 10 Lamp replacement can be carried out for bulbs. When replacing LED and Xenon lamps, please refer to a workshop. The bulbs are specified (p. 348). The following list contains locations of bulbs and other light sources that are specialised, such as LED5 lamps, or are unsuitable for changing for some other reason, except at a workshop: • • • • • • • • • • • 5 6 342 Active Xenon headlamps - ABL (Xenon lamps) Position/parking lamps front6 Daytime running lights6 Side direction indicators, door mirrors6 Approach lighting, door mirrors Interior and cargo area lighting Glovebox lighting Position/parking lamps rear WARNING WARNING The car’s electrical system must be in key position 0 when replacing bulbs; see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). IMPORTANT Never touch the glass part of the bulbs with your fingers. Grease from your fingers is vaporised by the heat, coating the reflector and then causing damage. Side marker lamps, rear Brake light above the rear windscreen Number plate lighting. LED (Light Emitting Diode) Certain variants NOTE On cars with Xenon headlamps, the replacement of Xenon lamps must be carried out at a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Working with Xenon lamps demands extreme caution because the headlamp is equipped with a high voltage unit. NOTE If an error message remains after the broken bulb has been replaced then we recommend that you visit an authorised Volvo workshop. Outside lighting such as headlamps, fog lamps and rear lamps may temporarily have condensation on the inside of the lens. This is normal, all exterior lighting is designed to withstand this. Condensation is normally vented out of the lamp housing when the lamp has been switched on for a time. Related information • • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) • Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) • Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting (p. 348) 10 Maintenance and service Lamp replacement - location of front lamps The overview shows the location of the lamps at the front. Lamp replacement - headlamps 5. All of the headlamp bulbs are replaced via the engine compartment. First loosen and remove the whole headlamp. Press down the catch. Unplug the connector. Place the headlamp on a soft surface so as not to scratch the lens. 10 IMPORTANT Do not pull the electrical cable, only the connector. 6. Replace the relevant bulb as instructed. The headlamp must be fitted and the contact fitted correctly before switching on the lights or switching key position. Related information Position/parking lamps (p. 345) (LED in Xenon headlamps) Main beam in Xenon headlamps (p. 344) / Extra main beam in Xenon headlamps (p. 345) Dipped beam in halogen headlamps (p. 344) / Xenon lamps in Xenon headlamps (p. 342) Indicator (p. 345) Daytime running lights (p. 346) (LED* or bulb depending on variant) Related information • • Lamp replacement (p. 342) 1. • • Lift out the bonnet stop. 2. Loosen the screw with a Torx tool, size T30. 3. Turn the locking pin anticlockwise. Pull out the locking pin. 4. Lamp replacement (p. 342) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) • Lamp replacement - cover for main/ dipped beam bulbs (p. 344) • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Release the headlamp by alternately tilting and pulling it out. IMPORTANT Take care when lifting out the headlamp so as not to damage any parts. Lamps - specifications (p. 348) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 343 10 Maintenance and service Lamp replacement - cover for main/ dipped beam bulbs 10 Main/dipped beam bulbs are accessed by releasing the headlamp's larger cover. Lamp replacement - dipped beam Lamp replacement - main beam The dipped beam bulb is fitted inside the headlamp's larger cover. The main beam bulb is fitted inside the headlamp's larger cover. NOTE NOTE Applies to cars with halogen headlamps. 1. Applies to cars with halogen headlamps. Press the hooks together. Angle out the cover. 2. Replace the relevant bulb as instructed. Related information • • • • Lamp replacement - headlamps (p. 343) 1. Detach the headlamp (p. 343). 1. Detach the headlamp (p. 343). 2. Undo the cover (p. 344). 2. Undo the cover (p. 344). 3. 3. Lamp replacement - dipped beam (p. 344) Lamp replacement - main beam (p. 344) Lamp replacement - extra main beam (p. 345) Press the bulb holder upwards until it releases. Pull out the bulb holder. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • 344 Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise. Pull out the bulb holder. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) 10 Maintenance and service Lamp replacement - extra main beam The extra main beam bulb is fitted inside the headlamp's larger cover. NOTE Lamp replacement - direction indicators front Lamp replacement - position/parking lamps front The direction indicator lamp is fitted inside the headlamp's smaller cover. The position/parking lamp bulb holder is located on the side of the headlamp. NOTE Applies to cars with Xenon headlamps*. 10 Not applicable to cars with Xenon headlamps* as these are equipped with LED lamps. 1. Detach the headlamp (p. 343). 1. Detach the headlamp (p. 343). 2. Undo the cover. 3. Push in the catch. 2. Undo the cover (p. 344). 3. Press the bulb holder upwards until it detaches. Pull out the bulb holder. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Pull out the bulb holder. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. 1. Detach the headlamp (p. 343). 2. Related information • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise. Pull out the bulb holder. 3. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 345 10 Maintenance and service 10 Lamp replacement - daytime running lights Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps The daytime running light bulb is fitted inside the bumper's cover. The overview shows the location of the lamps at the rear. NOTE Lamp replacement - direction indicators rear, brake lights and reversing lamp Direction indicators rear, brake lights and reversing lamp are replaced from inside the cargo area. Only applies to daytime running lights with bulbs. Brake light (LED) Position/parking lights (LED) 1. Remove the hatch in the upholstery (1) on the same side as the defective bulb. 2. 1. Undo the cover. Side marker lamps (LED) 2. Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise. Indicator (p. 346) Reversing lamp (p. 346) Pull out the bulb holder. 3. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • 346 Brake lights (p. 346) Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Fog lamps (p. 347) Related information • • Lamp replacement (p. 342) Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Press the catch sideways. Pull out the bulb holder. 3. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in and turning anticlockwise. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. 10 Maintenance and service Related information • Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Lamp replacement - rear fog lamp Turn the bulb holder anticlockwise. The fog lamp bulb is fitted in the bumper's bulb holder. Pull out the bulb holder. 3. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. 10 Related information • Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Insert (approx.20 mm) a blunt, knife-like object, e.g. a table knife, at the triangle. Carefully prise until the lug releases. IMPORTANT Take care not to damage any parts. 347 10 Maintenance and service Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting 10 The vanity mirror's lamps are fitted inside the lamp lenses. Lamps - specifications Lighting 1. Insert a screwdriver under the lamp lens and gently prize up the lug on the edge. 2. Carefully detach and lift aside the lamp lens. 3. Using needle-nose pliers, pull the bulb straight out to the side. Do not squeeze too hard with the pliers. Otherwise, the bulb glass could break. 4. Replace the bulb and put back the parts in reverse order. Related information • 348 Lamps - specifications (p. 348) Lighting The specifications apply to bulbs. When replacing LED and Xenon lamps, please refer to a workshop. [W]A Type Dipped beamB 55 H7 LL Main beamB 65 H9 Additional main beamC 55 H7 LL Front direction indicators 21 HY21W Position/parking lamps frontB 5 W5W LL Daytime running lightsD 19 PW19W Side direction indicators, door mirrorsD 5 WY5W LL Direction indicators, rear 21 PY21W LL Brake lights 21 P21W LL Reversing lamp 21 P21W LL [W]A Type Rear fog lamp 21 H21W LL Vanity mirror lighting 1,2 T5 Socket W2x4.6d A B C D Watt Cars with halogen headlamps Cars with Xenon headlamps Certain variants Related information • • Lamp replacement (p. 342) Lamp replacement - location of front lamps (p. 343) • Lamp replacement - location of rear lamps (p. 346) • Lamp replacement - vanity mirror lighting (p. 348) 10 Maintenance and service Wiper blades The wiper blades sweep water away from the windscreen and rear window. Together with the washer fluid they clean the windows and ensure visibility for driving. The windscreen wiper blades must be in service position when they are to be replaced. Service position IMPORTANT Before placing the wiper blades in the service position, make sure that they are not frozen down. 1. Place the remote control key in the ignition lock7 and briefly press the START/ STOP ENGINE button to set the car's electrical system to key position I. For detailed information on key positions, see Key positions - functions at different levels (p. 71). IMPORTANT If the wiper arms in the service position have been folded up from the windscreen, they must be folded back down onto the windscreen before the wipers are allowed to return to their starting position. This is to avoid scraping the paint on the bonnet. 10 Replacing the wiper blades 2. Briefly press the START/STOP ENGINE button again to set the car’s electrical system in key position 0. Wiper blades in service position. In order to make replacement possible, to clean or lift the wiper blades (for scraping off ice from the windscreen, for example), they must be in service position. 7 Not necessary in cars with Keyless function. 3. Within 3 seconds, move the right stalk switch up and hold it in position for approx. 1 second. > The wipers then move to standing straight up. The wipers return to their starting position when you briefly press the START/STOP ENGINE button to set the car’s electrical system to key position I (or when the car is started). }} 349 10 Maintenance and service || Replacing the wiper blades, rear window Fold up the wiper arm when it is in service position. Press the button located on the wiper blade mounting and pull straight out parallel with the wiper arm. Slide in the new wiper blade until a "click" is heard. Check that the blade is firmly installed. 4. Fold the wiper arm back towards the windscreen. The wipers return from service position to their starting position when you briefly press the START/STOP ENGINE button to set the car’s electrical system to key position I (or when the car is started). G021763 10 NOTE The wiper blades are different lengths. The blade on the driver's side is longer than on the passenger side. WARNING If the car is equipped with airbag Pedestrian Airbag then Volvo recommends that genuine wiper arms are used and that you only use genuine parts for them. 1. Fold out the wiper arm. 2. Grip the inner section of the blade (by the arrow). 3. Turn anticlockwise to use the blade's end position against the wiper arm as a lever to detach the blade more easily. 4. Press the new wiper blade into position. Check that it is firmly installed. 5. Lower the wiper arm. Cleaning For cleaning wiper blades and windscreen, see Car washing (p. 364). 350 10 Maintenance and service IMPORTANT Check the blades regularly. Neglected maintenance shortens the service life of the wiper blades. Washer fluid - filling Starter battery Washer fluid is used for cleaning the headlamps and windows. Washer fluid with antifreeze must be used during winter. The service life and function of the battery is influenced by factors such as the number of starts, discharging, driving style, driving conditions, climatic conditions etc. Related information • 10 The starter battery is a traditional 12 V battery. Washer fluid - filling (p. 351) • Never disconnect the battery when the engine is running. • Check that the cables to the battery are correctly connected and properly tightened. WARNING • The battery can generate oxyhydrogen gas, which is highly explosive. A spark can be formed if a jump lead is connected incorrectly, and this can be enough for the battery to explode. • The battery contains sulphuric acid, which can cause serious burns. • If sulphuric acid comes into contact with eyes, skin or clothing, flush with large quantities of water. If acid splashes into the eyes - seek medical attention immediately. The windscreen and headlamp washers share a common reservoir. IMPORTANT Use washer fluid with antifreeze during the winter to avoid freezing in the pump, reservoir and hoses. For capacities, see Washer fluid - quality and volume (p. 451). Related information • Wiper blades (p. 349) IMPORTANT Only a traditional battery charger should ever be used when charging the battery. 351 10 Maintenance and service || IMPORTANT 10 NOTE If the following instruction is not observed then the energy saving function for infotainment system may be temporarily disengaged, and/or the message in the combined instrument panel's information display about the starter battery's state of charge may be temporarily inapplicable, following the connection of an external battery or battery charger: The life of the battery is shortened if it becomes discharged repeatedly. The life of the battery is affected by several factors, including driving conditions and climate. Battery starting capacity decreases gradually with time and therefore needs to be recharged if the car is not used for a longer time or when it is only driven short distances. Extreme cold further limits starting capacity. • The negative battery terminal on the car's starter battery must never be used for connecting an external battery or battery charger - only the car chassis may be used as the grounding point. See Jump starting (p. 270) for a description of how the cable clamps must be attached. To maintain the battery in good condition, at least 15 minutes of driving/week is recommended or that the battery is connected to a battery charger with automatic trickle charging. Battery - symbols There are information and warning symbols on the battery. Symbols on the battery Use protective goggles. Further information is available in the owner's manual. A battery that is kept fully charged has a maximum service life. Related information • • • Store the battery out of the reach of children. Battery - symbols (p. 352) Starter battery - replacement (p. 353) Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) The battery contains corrosive acid. 352 10 Maintenance and service Avoid sparks and naked flames. Risk of explosion. Must be taken for recycling. Starter battery - replacement Battery - Start/Stop The starter battery should be replaced by an authorised workshop. Cars with Start/Stop function, in addition to the starter battery, are equipped with a support battery. The starter battery is a traditional 12 V battery. Start/Stop Volvo recommends that you allow an authorised workshop to replace the batteries - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. For more information on the car's starter battery, see Jump starting (p. 270). Cars with the Start/Stop function are equipped with two 12 V batteries - one extra powerful starter battery and one support battery that helps during the Start/Stop function's starting sequence. For more information on the Start/Stop function, see Start/Stop* (p. 279). For more information on the car's starter battery, see Jump starting (p. 270) and Starter battery - specification (p. 459). Battery NOTE An expended battery must be recycled in an environmentally safe manner as it contains lead. Related information • • 10 Starter battery (p. 351) Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) A B C D Start Support Cold start capacityA, CCA (A) Starter battery - specification (p. 459) 120C SizeB, L×W×H (mm) 278×175×190C 150×90×106C 315×175×190D 150×90×130D Capacity (Ah) 70C 8C 80D 10D 180D According to EN standard. Largest possible size. Manual gearbox. Automatic gearbox. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 353 10 Maintenance and service || IMPORTANT Location of the batteries When replacing the starter battery in a car with the Start/Stop function, batteries of the correct type must be installed, EFB8 for manual gearbox and AGM9 for automatic gearbox. 10 • NOTE • The higher the current take-off in the car (extra cooling/heating, etc.) the more the batteries must be charged = increased fuel consumption. • When the capacity of the battery has fallen below the lowest permissible level then the Start/Stop function is disengaged. Temporarily reduced Start/Stop function due to high current take-off means: • The engine starts automatically10 without the driver depressing the clutch pedal (manual gearbox). • The engine starts automatically without the driver lifting his/her foot off the foot brake pedal (automatic gearbox). 8 9 10 11 354 IMPORTANT If the following instruction is not observed then the Start/Stop function may temporarily cease to work after the connection of an external battery or battery charger: (1) Starter battery11 (2) Support battery The support battery normally requires no more service than the normal starter battery. A workshop should be contacted in the event of questions or problems - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. Enhanced Flooded Battery Absorbed Glass Mat Automatic starting can only take place if the gear lever is in neutral position. See Starter battery (p. 351) for a detailed description of the starter battery. The negative battery terminal on the car's starter battery must never be used for connecting an external battery or battery charger - only the car chassis may be used as the grounding point. See Jump starting (p. 270) for a description of how the cable clamps must be attached. 10 Maintenance and service NOTE If the battery has become so discharged that everything is "black" and in principle the car does not have all the normal electrical functions and the engine is subsequently started using an external battery or battery charger, then the Start/Stop function will be activated. It will then be possible for the engine to be auto-stopped but in the event of an auto-stop the Start/Stop function may fail to auto-start the engine due to inadequate capacity in the battery. The battery must first be charged in order to ensure a successful auto-start after an auto-stop. At an outside temperature of +15 °C the battery needs to be charged for at least 1 hour. At a lower outside temperature a charging time of 3-4 hours is recommended. The recommendation is that the battery is charged using an external battery charger. If this is not possible then the recommendation is to temporarily deactivate the Start/Stop function until the battery has been adequately recharged. For more information on charging the starter battery, see Starter battery (p. 351). Related information • Battery - symbols (p. 352) Fuses - general Location, fuse boxes All electrical functions and components are protected by a number of fuses in order to protect the car's electrical system from damage by short circuiting or overloading. 10 If an electrical component or function does not work, it may be because the component's fuse was temporarily overloaded and failed. If the same fuse fails repeatedly then there is a fault in the circuit. Volvo recommends that you visit an authorised Volvo workshop for checking. Changing 1. Look in the fuse diagram to locate the fuse. Fuse box locations in a left-hand drive car. In a right-hand drive car the fuse box under the glovebox changes sides. 2. Pull out the fuse and check from the side to see whether the curved wire has blown. Engine compartment 3. If this is the case, replace it with a new fuse of the same colour and amperage. Below right front seat WARNING Never use a foreign object or a fuse with an amperage higher than that specified when replacing a fuse. This could cause significant damage to the electrical system and possibly lead to fire. Under the glovebox Related information • • • Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 356) Fuses - under glovebox (p. 359) Fuses - under right front seat (p. 362) 355 10 Maintenance and service Fuses - in engine compartment 10 Fuses in the engine compartment protect engine and brake functions, amongst other things. On the inside of the cover there are tweezers that facilitate the procedure for the removal and fitting of fuses. The fuse box also provides space for several spare fuses. Replacing fuses The fuses can be accessed following the removal of the cover fitted on the starter battery and the cover for the electrical distribution unit. 356 Removing the covers Fold out the locking catches that are fitted on the sides of the cover on the starter battery. Lift the cover straight up. 10 Maintenance and service Positions The label on the inside of the cover shows the positions of the fuses. • • Fuses 7-18 are of "JCASE" type and should be replaced by a workshop12. Fuses 19-45 and 47-48 are of "Mini Fuse" type. A Central electronic module, reference voltage, support battery 5 Horn 15 Brake lights 5 Function A – – Fold out the locking catch that is fitted on the side of the electrical distribution unit. ABS pump 40 Light switches 5 ABS valves 30 Internal relay coils 5 Rotate the cover upward until the lock lugs (1) are released. Headlamp washers* 20 40 12 V socket, tunnel console front 15 Ventilation fan Transmission control module 15 Solenoid clutch A/C (petrol, 4-cyl. diesel) 15 – 12 V socket, tunnel console rear 15 40 Climate sensor*; air intake throttle motors 10 Engine control module (5-cyl.) 5 Power seat, right* 20 – Primary fuse for fuses 32-36 – Electric windscreen, right side* Fold the cover toward the engine to access the fuses. Refitting the covers Reinstall the parts in reverse order. 12 Function – – 30 – Electric windscreen, left side* 40 Parking heater* 20 Windscreen wipers 20 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. 10 }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 357 10 Maintenance and service || 10 358 Function A Function A Function A Relay coil in cooling fan relay (4-cyl., 5-cyl. diesel); Lambdasonds (4-cyl. petrol); Mass air flow meter (diesel), Bypass valve, EGR cooling (diesel); Regulator valve, fuel flow (5-cyl. diesel); Regulator valve, fuel pressure (5-cyl. diesel) 10 Valves (4-cyl. petrol); Solenoids (4-cyl. petrol); Injectors (5-cyl. petrol); Lambda-sond (5-cyl. diesel); Crankcase ventilation heater (5-cyl. diesel) 10 Charging point, support battery – – – Ignition coils (petrol) 10 15 Relay coil in cooling fan relay (5-cyl. petrol); Lambda-sonds (5-cyl. petrol) 20 Diesel filter heater; Glow plug control module (5-cyl. diesel) Engine control module (4-cyl.) 10 Oil pump, automatic gearbox (5-cyl.); Mass air flow sensor (petrol); EVAP valve (4-cyl. petrol); Valves (5-cyl. petrol); Solenoids (5-cyl. petrol); Crankcase ventilation heater (5-cyl. petrol); Control motor, turbo (4-cyl. diesel); Regulator valve, fuel flow (4-cyl. diesel); Control module, radiator roller cover (4-cyl. diesel); Solenoid, piston cooling (5cyl. diesel); Turbo control valve (5-cyl. diesel); Oil level sensor (5-cyl. diesel); Solenoid clutch A/C (5-cyl.) 10 Engine control module (5-cyl.); Throttle unit (5-cyl. petrol) 15 ABS 5 Engine control module; Transmission control module; Airbags 10 Light height control* 10 Electric control servo 5 Central electronic module 15 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. – – – – Collision warning 5 Accelerator pedal sensor 5 Coolant pump (when no parking heater is available) Related information • • Fuses - under glovebox (p. 359) Fuses - under right front seat (p. 362) 10 10 Maintenance and service Fuses - under glovebox Fuses under the glovebox protect the airbag and passenger compartment lighting functions, amongst other things. On the inside of the cover for the fuse box in the engine compartment there are tweezers that facilitate the procedure for the removal and fitting of fuses. The fuse box in the engine compartment also provides space for several spare fuses. Replacing fuses The fuses can be accessed when a protective cover has been removed from the fuse box. 10 Cover removal Take hold of the recess and pull until the locking lugs in the lower edge of the cover are released from the fuse box. Remove the cover. NOTE A relatively large amount of tensile force is required to release the locking lugs at the top edge of the cover from the electrical distribution unit. }} 359 10 Maintenance and service || Cover refitting 10 A Function A Rear window wiper 15 Climate panel 10 Interior lighting, Roof console for front reading lamps and passenger compartment lighting 5 Steering wheel module 7,5 Interior lighting; Power seats* Siren*; Data link connector OBDII 5 10 Main beam 15 Blind, glass roof* 10 – Rain sensor*; Dimming, interior rearview mirror*; Moisture sensor* 5 Reversing lamp 10 Guide in the lower lugs. 20 Turn the cover upwards until the upper lugs engage. Collision warning* 5 Windscreen wipersC; Rear windscreen wiperC – – Immobiliser 5 Reserve position 1, constant voltage 15 Reserve position 2, constant voltage 20 Movement sensor alarm*; Remote receiver 5 Windscreen wipersD; Rear windscreen wiperD 20 Central locking system, fuel filler flapE 10 Unlocking, tailgateF 10 NOTE Make sure that the upper locking lugs are seated properly in the grooves of the electrical distribution unit. Positions The fuses are of "Mini Fuse" type. Function A Fuel pump 20 – 360 Function – * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Unlocking, tailgateA 10 – – Reserve position 3, constant voltage 5 Steering lock 15 Combined instrument panel 5 Central locking system, fuel filler flapB 10 – 10 Maintenance and service Function A B C D E F A Electric additional heater*; Button seat heating rear* 7,5 Airbags; Pedestrian airbag 10 Reserve position 4, constant voltage 7,5 – – – – 10 See also fuse 84. See also fuse 83. See also fuse 82. See also fuse 77. See also fuse 70. See also fuse 65. Related information • • Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 356) Fuses - under right front seat (p. 362) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 361 10 Maintenance and service Fuses - under right front seat 10 Fuses under the right-hand front seat protect infotainment and trailer functions, amongst other things. On the inside of the cover for the fuse box in the engine compartment there are tweezers that facilitate the procedure for the removal and fitting of fuses. The fuse box in the engine compartment also provides space for several spare fuses. Positions • Fuses 24-28 are of "JCASE" type and should be replaced by a workshop13. • Fuses 1-23 and 29-46 are of "Mini Fuse" type. 13 362 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Function A Function A – – Control panel, left rear door 25 25 Keyless* 10 Control panel, right rear door Door handle (Keyless*) 5 – Control panel, left front door 25 Power seat left* Control panel, right front door 25 – – 20 – 10 Maintenance and service Function A Function A Function A Internal relay coil 5 – – – – Audio control unit (amplifier)* 5 BLIS* 5 – – – – Parking assistance* 5 Telematics*; Bluetooth* 5 Parking camera* 5 Audio; Infotainment control unit 15 – – Digital radio*; TV* 10 – – 12 V socket, cargo area 15 Seat heating (driver's side) 15 15 – – Seat heating (passenger side) – – – – – – – – – – – – – – Seat heating, rear right* 15 Trailer socket 2* 20 Seat heating, rear left* 15 Primary fuse for fuses 12-16: Infotainment 40 AWD control module* 15 – – Trailer socket 1* 40 Rear window defroster 30 – – – – – – 10 Related information • • Fuses - in engine compartment (p. 356) Fuses - under glovebox (p. 359) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 363 10 Maintenance and service Car washing 10 WARNING The car should be washed as soon as it becomes dirty. Wash the car in a car wash with oil separator. Use car shampoo. Always have the engine cleaned by a workshop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is hot. Do not use any strong solvents. Washing by hand • • • • IMPORTANT Remove bird droppings from the paintwork as soon as possible. Bird droppings contain chemicals that affect and discolour paintwork very quickly. An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended for the removal of any discoloration. Dirty headlamps have impaired functionality. Clean them regularly, when refuelling for example. Do not use any corrosive cleaning agents but use water and a non-scratching sponge instead. Hose down the underbody. Rinse the entire car until the dissolved dirt has been removed so as to reduce the risk of scratches from washing. Do not spray directly onto the locks. NOTE Outside lighting such as headlamps, fog lamps and rear lamps may temporarily have condensation on the inside of the lens. This is normal, all exterior lighting is designed to withstand this. Condensation is normally vented out of the lamp housing when the lamp has been switched on for a time. If necessary, use cold degreasing agent on very dirty surfaces. Note that in this case, the surfaces must not be hot from the sun! • Wash using a sponge, car shampoo and plenty of lukewarm water. • Clean the wiper blades with a lukewarm soap solution or car shampoo. • Dry the car using a clean, soft chamois or a water scraper. If you avoid allowing drops of water to dry in strong sunlight, you reduce the risk of water drying stains which may need to be polished out. Wiper blades Asphalt, dust and salt residue on wiper blades, as well as insects, ice etc. on the windscreen, impair the service life of wiper blades. For cleaning: – 364 NOTE Wash the wiper blades and windscreen regularly with lukewarm soap solution or car shampoo. Set the wiper blades to the service position; see Wiper blades (p. 349). Automatic car washes An automatic car wash is a simple and quick way of washing the car, but it cannot reach everywhere. Handwashing the car is recommended for achieving optimum results. NOTE The car must only be washed by hand over the first few months. This is because the paint is more delicate when it is new. High-pressure washing When using high-pressure washing, use sweeping movements and make sure that the nozzle does not come closer than 30 cm to the surface of the car (the distance applies to all exterior parts). Do not spray directly onto the locks. 10 Maintenance and service Testing the brakes IMPORTANT Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic and rubber. WARNING Always test the brakes after washing the car, including the parking brake, to ensure that moisture and corrosion do not attack the brake linings and reduce braking performance. Lightly depress the brake pedal now and then when driving long distances in rain or slush. The heat from the friction causes the brake linings to warm up and dry. Do the same thing after starting in very damp or cold weather. Exterior plastic, rubber and trim components A special cleaning agent available from Volvo dealers is recommended for the cleaning and care of coloured plastic parts, rubber and trim components, such as glossy trim mouldings. When using such a cleaning agent the instructions must be followed carefully. When using degreasant on plastic and rubber, only rub with light pressure if it is necessary. Use a soft washing sponge. Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear away or damage the glossy surface layer. Polishing agent that contains abrasive must not be used. Rims Only use rim cleaning agent recommended by Volvo. Strong rim cleaning agents can damage the surface and cause stains on chrome-plated aluminium rims. Related information • • • Polishing and waxing (p. 365) Cleaning the interior (p. 367) Water and dirt-repellent coating (p. 366) Polishing and waxing Polish and wax the car if the paintwork is dull or to give the paintwork extra protection. The car does not need to be polished until it is at least one year old. However, the car can be waxed during this time. Do not polish or wax the car in direct sunlight. 10 Wash and dry the car thoroughly before you begin polishing or waxing. Clean off asphalt and tar stains using tar remover or white spirit. More stubborn stains can be removed using fine rubbing paste designed for car paintwork. Polish first with a polish and then wax with liquid or solid wax. Follow the instructions on the packaging carefully. Many preparations contain both polish and wax. IMPORTANT Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic and rubber. When using degreasant on plastic and rubber, only rub with light pressure if it is necessary. Use a soft washing sponge. Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear away or damage the glossy surface layer. Polishing agent that contains abrasive must not be used. 365 10 Maintenance and service || IMPORTANT Only paint treatment recommended by Volvo should be used. Other treatment such as preserving, sealing, protection, lustre sealing or similar could damage the paintwork. Paintwork damage caused by such treatments is not covered by Volvo warranty. 10 Related information • Car washing (p. 364) Water and dirt-repellent coating Rustproofing The windows are treated with a surface coating that improves visibility in difficult weather conditions. The car received a thorough and complete rustproofing at the factory. Parts of the body are made of galvanised sheet metal. The underbody is protected by a wear-resistant anti-corrosion compound. A thin, penetrating rustproofing fluid was sprayed into the exposed members, cavities, closed sections and side doors. Water and dirt-repellent coating* There is natural wear of the waterrepellent coating. Maintenance: • Never use products such as car wax, degreaser or similar on glass surfaces as this could ruin their water-repellent properties. • Take care when cleaning so as not to damage the glass surface. • To avoid damaging glass surfaces when removing ice – only use plastic ice scrapers. • Treatment with a special finishing agent available from Volvo dealers is recommended in order to maintain the waterrepellent properties. This should be used first after three years and then each year. IMPORTANT Do not use a metal ice scraper to remove ice from the windows. Use the heating to remove ice from the door mirrors; see Windows and rearview and door mirrors heating (p. 98). Related information • 366 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Car washing (p. 364) Inspection and maintenance Dirt and road salt can lead to corrosion so it is important to keep the car clean. The car's rustproofing needs to be checked regularly and touched-up if necessary in order for it to be maintained. Under normal conditions the rustproofing does not require treatment for approximately 12 years. After this period, it should be treated at three-year intervals. Volvo recommends that you engage an authorised Volvo workshop for assistance if the car needs further treatment. Related information • Paint damage (p. 368) 10 Maintenance and service Cleaning the interior Only use cleaning agents and car care products recommended by Volvo. Clean regularly and follow the instructions included with the car care product. Vacuuming is important prior to using cleaning agents. Carpets and cargo area Remove inlaid carpets for separate cleaning of the floor carpet and the inlaid carpets. Use a vacuum cleaner to remove dust and dirt. Each inlay mat is secured with pins. – Take hold of the inlay mat at each pin and lift the mat straight up. Fit the inlay mat in place by pressing it in at each pin. WARNING Before setting off check that the inlaid mat in the driver area is firmly affixed and secured in the pins in order to avoid getting caught adjacent to and under the pedals. A special textile cleaner is recommended for stains on the floor mat after vacuuming. Floor mats should be cleaned with agents recommended by your Volvo dealer! Stains on fabric upholstery and roof upholstery A special fabric cleaning agent, available from authorised Volvo dealers, is recommended to avoid impairing the fire retardant qualities of the upholstery. IMPORTANT Sharp objects and Velcro may damage the fabric upholstery. IMPORTANT • • with the instructions, preserves the leather's protective coating. After a period of use the natural appearance of the leather will nevertheless emerge, depending more or less on the surface texture of the leather. This is a natural maturing of the leather and shows that it is a natural product. To achieve best results Volvo recommends cleaning and the application of protective cream once to four times per year (or more if necessary). The Volvo Leather Care kit is available from your Volvo dealer. IMPORTANT Certain items of coloured clothing (for example, jeans and suede garments) may stain the upholstery. • Never use strong solvents. Such products may damage fabric, vinyl and leather upholstery. Certain items of coloured clothing (for example, jeans and suede garments) may stain the upholstery. • Never use strong solvents. Such products may damage fabric, vinyl and leather upholstery. Stains on leather upholstery 10 Volvo's leather upholstery is treated to preserve its original appearance. Washing instructions for leather upholstery Leather upholstery ages and acquires a beautiful patina over time. The leather is refined and processed so that it retains its natural characteristics. It is given a protective coating, but regular cleaning is required in order to maintain both characteristics and appearance. Volvo offers a comprehensive product for the cleaning and treatment of leather upholstery which, when used in accordance 1. Pour the leather cleaner on the dampened sponge and squeeze out a strong foam. 2. Work the dirt away with gentle circular movements. 3. Dab accurately with the sponge on the stains. Allow the sponge to absorb the stain. Do not rub. }} 367 10 Maintenance and service || 4. Wipe off with soft paper or a cloth and allow the leather to dry completely. 10 Protective treatment of leather upholstery 1. Pour a small amount of the protective cream on the felted cloth and massage in a thin layer of cream with gentle circular movements on the leather. 2. Allow the leather to dry for 20 minutes before use. The leather has now been given improved protection against stains and improved UV protection. Washing instructions for the leather steering wheel • Remove dirt and dust with a soft premoistened sponge and neutral soap. • Leather needs to breathe. Never cover the leather steering wheel with protective plastic. • Use natural oils. Volvo's leather care agents are recommended for best results. If the steering wheel has stains: Group 1 (ink, wine, coffee, milk, sweat and blood) – 368 Use a soft cloth or sponge. Mix a 5% ammonia solution. (For blood stains, use a solution of 2 dl water and 25g salt.) Group 2 (fats, oils, sauces and chocolate) Paint damage 1. Same procedure as for group 1. Paint is an important part of the car's rustproofing and should therefore be checked regularly. The most common types of paintwork damage are stone chips, scratches, and marks on the edges of wings, doors and bumpers. 2. Polish with an absorbent paper or cloth. Group 3 (dry dirt, dust) 1. Use a soft brush to remove the dirt. 2. Same procedure as for group 1. Touching up minor paintwork damage Stains on interior plastic parts, metal parts and wood parts To avoid the onset of rust, damaged paintwork should be rectified immediately. A fibrillated fibre or microfibre cloth, lightly moistened with water, available from Volvo dealers, is recommended for cleaning interior parts and surfaces. Materials Do not scrape or rub stains. Never use strong stain removers. A special cleaning agent available from Volvo dealers can be used for more difficult cleaning. Seatbelts Use water and a synthetic detergent. A special textile cleaning agent is available from your Volvo dealer. Make sure the seatbelt is dry before allowing it to retract. Related information • Car washing (p. 364) 10 Maintenance and service • primer14 - a special adhesive primer in a spray can is available for e.g. plasticcoated bumpers • basecoat and clearcoat - available in spray cans or as touch-up pens/sticks15 • • Repair minor paintwork damage such as stone chips and scratches 2. Before painting, gentle polishing using a very fine polishing agent may be carried out locally if required (e.g. if there are any uneven edges). The surface is cleaned thoroughly and left to dry. masking tape fine sand paper14. G021832 Colour code 4. For scratches, proceed as above, but mask around the damaged area to protect the undamaged paintwork. NOTE Before work is begun, the car must be clean and dry and at a temperature above 15 °C. If the stone chip has not penetrated down to the meal and an undamaged layer of paint remains in place, fill in with basecoat and clearcoat as soon as the surface has been cleaned. 1. Apply a piece of masking tape over the damaged surface. Then remove the tape to remove any loose paint. Code for the car's colour It is important that the correct colour is used. For product label location, see Type designations (p. 438). 14 15 10 3. Stir the primer well and apply using a fine brush, a matchstick or similar. Finish off with a basecoat and clearcoat once the primer has dried. If the damage is down to the metal, use of a primer is appropriate. In the event of damage to a plastic surface, an adhesive primer should be used to give better results - spray into the lid of the spray can and brush on thinly. Related information • Rustproofing (p. 366) If required. Follow the instructions that are included with the package for the touch-up pen/stick. 369 AUDIO AND MEDIA 11 Audio and media Audio and media The audio and media system consists of radio (p. 379), media player (p. 390), TV (p. 421)* as well as the option to communicate with mobile phone (p. 403) *. Information is presented on a 5 or 7-inch* screen in the upper section of the centre console. Functions can be controlled via buttons in the steering wheel, in the centre console below the screen or via a remote control (p. 425) *. If the audio and media system is active when the engine is switched off then it is automatically activated the next time the key is inserted into key position I (p. 71) or higher, and it continues with the same source (e.g. radio) as before the engine was switched off (the driver's door must be closed on cars with Keyless systems*). The audio and media system can be used for 15 minutes at a time without the remote control key being in the ignition switch by pressing the On/Off button. When the car is being started the audio and media system is switched off temporarily and continues when the engine has started. 1 Audyssey MultEQ1 NOTE Remove the remote control key from the ignition switch if the audio and media system is being used when the engine is switched off. This is to avoid discharging the battery unnecessarily. Dolby Digital, Dolby Pro Logic1 11 The Audyssey MultEQ system has been used in the development and tuning of the sound to ensure a world-class sound experience. Related information • • Made under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby Digital, Dolby Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. Audio and media - overview (p. 372) Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • • • Audio and media - audio settings (p. 376) Picture settings (p. 394) Favourites (p. 376) Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 371 11 Audio and media Audio and media - overview Overview of the audio and media system's associated parts. Audio and media - operating the system The audio and media system is controlled from the centre console and partly from the steering wheel buttons. The information is presented on the screen in the upper section of the centre console. 11 AUX2 and USB3 inputs for external audio sources (e.g. iPod®) Steering wheel keypad (with*/without thumbwheel). display screen. The display screen is available in two sizes: 5 and 7-inch. The manual shows a 7-inch display screen. Control panel in centre console Related information • • 2 3 372 Audio and media (p. 371) Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) Applicable to Performance only Not applicable to Performance * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 11 Audio and media Scroll/fast forward/search - A short press scrolls among tracks, preset radio stations4 or chapters5. A long press fast forwards through disc tracks or searches for the next available radio station. SOUND - press for access to audio settings (bass, treble, etc.). For more information, see general audio settings (p. 377). VOL - raise or lower volume. ON/OFF/MUTE - short press starts the system and long press (until the screen is off) switches off. Note that the whole of the Sensus system (including navigation * and phone functions*) starts/switches off at the same time. Briefly press to mute the sound (MUTE) or restore the sound if it had been switched off. Disc insert and eject slot. Disc eject. Main sources - press to select the main source (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA). Last active source is shown (e.g. FM1). A new source view is selected if the main source button is pressed while in RADIO or MEDIA. If you are in TEL* or NAV* and press the main source 4 5 6 7 button then a shortcut menu is shown with commonly used menu options. Preset buttons, input of numbers and letters. OK/MENU - press the thumbwheel in the steering wheel or the button in the centre console to accept a menu selection. If OK/ MENU is pressed while in the normal view, a menu for the selected source opens (e.g. RADIO or MEDIA). Arrow to the right of the screen is shown when there are underlying menus. FAV – shortcut to a favourite setting. The button can be programmed for a commonly used function in AM, FM, etc. For more information, see favourites (p. 376)). TUNE - turn the thumbwheel in the steering wheel or the knob in the centre console to scroll among tracks/folders, radio and TV* stations, phone contacts* or to navigate among choices on the display screen. Voice recognition7 - press to activate voice recognition (for mobile phone and navigation system connected via Bluetooth®*). EXIT - short press leads upwards in the menu system, interrupts current function, interrupts/rejects phone calls or erases entered characters. Long press leads to normal view, or if you are in normal view to the highest menu level (main source view), from where you can reach the same main source buttons located in the centre console (7). MUTE6 - press to switch off the radio/ media audio or restore the audio if it has been switched off. 11 Related information • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) • Audio and media (p. 371) INFO - If more information than can be shown on the screen is available, press the INFO button to see the remaining information. Does not apply to DAB. Only applies to DVD discs. Cars without navigation. Cars with navigation*. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 373 11 Audio and media Audio and media - menu navigation The audio and media system is controlled from the centre console and partly from the steering wheel buttons. The information is presented on the screen in the upper section of the centre console. 11 The example shows navigation to different functions when a disc is played back. (1) Main source button, (2) Normal view, (3) Shortcut/source menu, (4) Quick menu, (5) Source menu 374 11 Audio and media Select main source by pressing a main source button (1) (RADIO, MEDIA, TEL). To navigate through the source menus, use the controls TUNE, OK/MENU, EXIT or the main source button (1). To view available functions, see Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428). NOTE If the car is equipped with a steering wheel keypad with a thumbwheel*, these can be used instead of the controls in the centre console (TUNE, OK/MENU, EXIT), Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372). Quick menu - fast mode when TUNE is turned, e.g. for changing disc tracks, radio station, etc. Source menu - for menu navigation (accessed by pressing OK/MENU). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) 11 Menus and views in the display screen The appearance depends on the source, equipment in the car, settings, etc. Main source button - press to switch the main source or to show the Shortcut/Source menu in the active source. Normal view - normal mode for the source. Shortcut/Source menu - shows commonly used menu options in the main sources, e.g. TEL and MEDIA (accessed by pressing the active source's main source button (1)). 375 11 Audio and media Favourites 11 Save frequently used functions as favourites. Possible functions that can be saved are within radio, media, reversing camera and menu source MY CAR where many of the car's functions are handled, e.g. setting the clock, door mirrors and locks. The function is then accessed easily by pressing the FAV button. • • • • • • DISC Audio and media - audio settings USB* The audio system is pre-calibrated for optimal sound reproduction, but can be adapted to your needs. iPod* Bluetooth* AUX TV* It is also possible to select and store a favourite for MY CAR, CAM* and NAV*. Favourites can also be selected and stored under MY CAR. For more information on the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Related information • Save as favourite (p. 419) Setting for optimal sound reproduction The audio system is pre-calibrated for optimum sound reproduction by means of digital signal processing. This calibration takes into account loudspeakers, amplifiers, passenger compartment acoustics, listener position etc. for each combination of car model and audio system. There is a also a dynamic calibration that takes into account the position of the volume control, radio reception and vehicle speed. The controls explained in these operating instructions, e.g. Bass, Treble and Equalizer, are only intended for the user to be able to adapt the sound reproduction according to personal taste. The FAV button can be used to store functions that are used frequently so that the function can be started simply by pressing FAV. You can select a favourite (e.g. Equalizer) for each function as follows: In RADIO mode: • • • AM FM1/FM2 DAB1*/DAB2* In MEDIA mode: 376 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) • Audio and media - advanced audio settings (p. 377) • Setting the audio profile (p. 378) 11 Audio and media Audio and media - general audio settings General audio settings for the audio and media system. Press SOUND to access the audio settings menu (Bass, Treble, etc.). Scroll forward with SOUND or OK/MENU to your selection (e.g. Treble). Adjust the setting by turning TUNE and save the setting with OK/MENU. Continue pressing SOUND or OK/MENU to access other options: • Surround8 - Can be set to the On/Off position. When On is selected, the system selects the setting for optimal sound reproduction. Normally DPLII and then appear in the display screen. If the recording is made with Dolby Digital technology then playback will take place with this setting, then appears in the display screen. When Off is selected, 3channel stereo is available. • Subwoofer*8 - Bass speaker level. • DPL II centre level3 channel centre Audio and media - advanced audio settings level8 - Volume for centre speaker. • DPL II surround level8, 9 – Level for surround. Adapt the audio settings for radio and media according to your wishes. The following functions can be adapted: Related information • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) • • Audio and media - audio settings (p. 376) Audio and media - advanced audio settings (p. 377) • • • • Setting the equaliser (p. 378) Setting the audio profile (p. 378) Setting the audio volume and automatic volume control (p. 378) 11 Setting the audio volume for external audio source (p. 398) Related information • • Audio and media - audio settings (p. 376) Audio and media - general audio settings (p. 377) • Bass - Bass level. • Treble - Treble level. • Fader – Balance between the front and rear speakers. • Balance – Balance between the left and right-hand speakers. 8 9 Only Premium Sound Multimedia. Only when Surround is activated. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 377 11 Audio and media Setting the equaliser equaliser10 Set the and adjust the volume separately for different radio frequencies or TV. 1. Press OK/MENU to access Audio settings and select Equalizer. 11 2. Select wavelength by turning TUNE and confirm with OK/MENU. 3. Adjust the audio settings by turning TUNE and confirm with OK/MENU. Continue in the same way with other wavelengths you want to change. 4. When you have finished with audio settings, press EXIT to confirm and return to normal view. Related information • Audio and media - advanced audio settings (p. 377) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 10 378 Not applicable to Performance Setting the audio profile Set the audio profile and optimise your audio experience in accordance with your needs. The sound experience can be optimised for the driver's seat, both front seats or the rear seat. If there are passengers in both the front and rear seats then the option recommended is; both front seats. The options can be selected under Audio settings Sound stage. Related information • • Audio and media - audio settings (p. 376) Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Setting the audio volume and automatic volume control Set the audio compensation for excessive noise in the passenger compartment. The audio system compensates for disrupting noises in the passenger compartment by increasing the volume in relation to the speed of the car. The compensation level can be set to low, medium, high or off. Select the level under Audio settings Volume compensation. Related information • Audio and media - advanced audio settings (p. 377) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 11 Audio and media Radio It is possible to listen to the AM and FM radio frequencies and, also in certain cases, digital radio (DAB) (p. 388)*. • • • • • • • • • Navigation in channel group list (Ensemble) (p. 389) Radio stations as presets (p. 381) Scan radio frequencies (p. 387) Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio tuning The radio automatically compiles a radio station list11 of the strongest FM stations whose signals it is currently receiving. It is possible to activate automatic or manual radio tuning. Radio text (p. 386) NOTE DAB to DAB link (p. 389) The reception is dependent both on how good the signal strength and signal quality are. The transmission may be disturbed by various factors such as tall buildings or the transmitter being far away. Coverage level can also vary depending on where in the country you are located. Digital radio* (DAB) - frequencies (p. 389) Digital radio* (DAB) - subchannel (p. 390) Digital radio* (DAB) - resetting (p. 390) Related information Controls for radio functions. For operating the radio, see Operating the system (p. 372) and Menu navigation (p. 374). • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) 11 Related information • • • Automatic radio tuning (p. 380) Manual radio tuning (p. 381) Radio station list (p. 380) AM/FM radio • • • • • • Radio tuning (p. 379) Radio stations as presets (p. 381) Scan radio frequencies (p. 387) RDS functions (p. 382) Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio text (p. 386) Digital radio* (DAB) • • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) (p. 388) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 379 11 Audio and media Automatic radio tuning Radio station list Searches for the next/previous available station. The radio automatically compiles a radio station list12 of the strongest FM stations whose signals it is currently receiving. This enables you to find a station when you drive into an area where you do not know the radio stations and their frequencies. 1. Press RADIO, turn TUNE until the desired wavelength (AM, FM1 etc.) is shown, press OK/MENU. 11 2. Hold in / in the centre console (or in the steering wheel keypad*). The radio searches for the next/previous available station. Related information • Radio tuning (p. 379) NOTE To go to the list and select a station: 1. Select the desired wavelength (FM1 or FM2). 2. Turn TUNE one step in either direction. This displays the list of all stations in the area. The currently tuned station is indicated with enlarged text in the list. 3. Turn TUNE again in either direction to select a station from the list. 4. Confirm your choice by pressing OK/ MENU. • The list only shows the frequencies of stations that are currently being received, not a complete list of all radio frequencies on the selected wavelength. • If the signal from the currently received station is weak, this may prevent the radio from updating the station list. If this occurs, press the INFO button (while the station list is shown in the display screen) in order to change to manual tuning and set a frequency. If the station list is no longer shown, turn TUNE one step in either direction to show the list again, and press INFO to switch. The list disappears from the display screen after a few seconds. If the station list is no longer shown, turn TUNE one step in either direction and press the INFO button in the centre console to change to manual tuning (or to return from manual tuning to the function for "Station list"). Related information • 11 12 380 Does not apply to Performance. Does not apply to Performance. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Radio tuning (p. 379) 11 Audio and media Manual radio tuning NOTE The radio automatically compiles a radio station list13, but it is possible to perform radio tuning manually. The preset from the factory is that the radio automatically searches for the stations in the area where you are driving (see section "Radio station list"). The preset from the factory is that the radio shows the station list of the strongest stations in the area when you turn TUNE (see the section Radio station list (p. 380)). When the radio station list is shown, press the INFO button in the centre console to change to manual tuning. This allows you to select a frequency from the list of all available radio frequencies in the selected wavelength. In other words, if turn TUNE one step in a manual search the frequency is changed from e.g. 93.3 to 93.4 MHz, etc. But if you have changed over to manual tuning (by pressing the INFO button in the centre console when the station list was shown), then the radio remains set in the function for manual tuning the next time you switch on the radio. To change back to the function for "Radio station list", turn TUNE one step (to show the complete list of stations) and press the button INFO. Note that if you press INFO when the station list is not shown then INFO is activated. For more information on this function, see Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372). To manually select a station: 1. Press the RADIO button, turn TUNE until the required frequency band (AM, FM1 etc.) is displayed, press OK/MENU. 2. Turn TUNE to select a frequency. Radio stations as presets Frequently used radio stations are optimally saved as presets in order to facilitate simple activation. 11 Preset buttons. AM/FM radio Related information • Radio tuning (p. 379) 10 presets can be stored per wavelength (AM, FM1 etc.). The stored presets are selected using the preset buttons. 1. Tune into a station, see Radio tuning (p. 379). 13 Does not apply to Performance. 381 11 Audio and media || 2. Hold in one of the preset buttons for a few seconds, the sound disappears during this time and returns when the station is stored. The preset button can now be used. 11 A list of pre-selected channels can be shown in the display screen14. The function is activated/deactivated in FM/AM mode under FM menu Show presets or AM menu Show presets. Digital radio (DAB) vated/deactivated in DAB mode under DAB menu Show presets. NOTE The audio system's DAB system does not support all functions in the DAB standard. Related information • • Radio tuning (p. 379) Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 10 station presets can be stored per wavelength. DAB has 2 memories for presets: DAB1 and DAB2. Storage of presets is performed by means of a long press on the desired preset button, for more information see AM/FM radio above. The stored presets are selected using the preset buttons. A preset contains one channel but no subchannels. If a subchannel is being played and a preset is saved then only the main channel is registered. This is because subchannels are temporary. At the next attempt to retrieve the preset, the channel which contained the subchannel will be played. The preset is not dependent on the channel list. A list of pre-selected channels can be shown in the display screen14. The function is acti- 14 382 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. RDS functions With RDS the radio can automatically change to the strongest transmitter. RDS provides the facility to receive e.g. traffic information (TP) and to search for certain programme types (PTY). RDS (Radio Data System) links FM transmitters into a network. An FM transmitter in such a network sends information that gives an RDS radio the following functions: • Automatically switches to a stronger transmitter if reception in the area is poor. • Searches for programme type, such as traffic information or news. • Receives text information on current radio programme. NOTE Some radio stations do not use RDS or only selected parts of its functionality. If a required programme type is located the radio can switch stations interrupting the audio source currently in use. For example, if the CD player is in use, it is paused. The interrupting transmission is played back at a preset volume, see Volume control for interrupting radio programme types (PTY) (p. 386). The radio returns to the previous audio 11 Audio and media source and volume when the set programme type is no longer broadcast. Alarms in the event of accidents and disasters The programme functions alarm (ALARM!), traffic information (TP), news (NEWS), and programme types (PTY) interrupt one another in order of priority, where alarm has the highest priority and programme types has the lowest. For additional settings of programming interruptions (EON Distant and EON Local), see Enhanced Other Networks (EON) (p. 384). Press EXIT to return to the interrupted audio source, press the OK/MENU to clear the message. This function is used to warn of serious accidents and catastrophes. The message ALARM! appears on the display screen when an alarm message is transmitted. Related information Traffic information (TP) This function allows traffic information that is broadcast within a set radio station's RDS network to break through. The alarm cannot be temporarily interrupted or deactivated. The symbol TP shows that the function is activated. If the preset station can send traffic information then this is shown by TP glowing brightly in the display screen, otherwise TP will be grey. Related information – • RDS functions (p. 382) Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu TP. TP from selected station/all stations • Alarms in the event of accidents and disasters (p. 383) • • • • • • • The radio can only interrupt for traffic information from the selected station or all stations within the RDS network. Traffic information (TP) (p. 383) – Enhanced Other Networks (EON) (p. 384) Traffic information (TP) (p. 383) News broadcasts (p. 384) Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio text (p. 386) 11 Go in FM mode to FM menu Advanced settings Set TP favourite to change. Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) Automatic radio frequency update (AF) (p. 386) • Regional radio programmes (REG) (p. 387) • Resetting RDS functions (p. 387) 383 11 Audio and media 11 Enhanced Other Networks (EON) News broadcasts Radio programme types (PTY) EON is useful in urban areas with many regional radio stations. It allows the distance between the car and the radio station transmitter to determine when programme functions should interrupt the current audio source. This function allows news broadcasts within a set radio station's RDS network to break through. The PTY function can be used to select one or more radio programme types, such as Pop Music and Serious Classical Music. After selecting a programme type, navigation only takes place within the channels that are broadcasting that type. – Activate/deactivate in FM mode by selecting one of the options under FM menu Advanced settings EON: • Local – interrupts only if the radio station transmitter is close. • Distant15 – interrupts if the station transmitter is far away, even if there is a lot of static. The symbol NEWS shows that the function is active. – News from selected station/all stations The radio can only interrupt for news from the selected station or all stations in the RDS network. – Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu News settings News. Go in FM mode to FM menu News settings Set news favourite to change. Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) PTY can be selected for FM and DAB radio. The PTY symbol is shown in the display screen when the function is active. This function allows programme types broadcast within a set station's RDS network to break through. PTY for FM radio 1. Activate in FM mode by first selecting the programme types under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Select PTY. 2. Then the PTY function must be activated under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Receive traffic bulletins from other networks. Deactivation of the PTY function is performed in FM mode under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Receive traffic bulletins from other networks. Selected programme types (PTY) are not reset. 15 384 Factory settings. 11 Audio and media Resetting and removing PTY are performed under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Select PTY Clear all. PTY for DAB radio Programme type is selected in DAB mode under DAB menu PTY filtering. Exit this mode as follows: – Press EXIT. > An indicator is shown in the display screen when PTY is activated. In some cases DAB radio will exit PTY mode, see DAB to DAB link (p. 389). Searching radio programme types (PTY) This function searches the whole frequency band for the selected radio programme type. 1. In FM mode select one or more PTY under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Select PTY. 2. Go to FM menu PTY settings Advanced settings Seek PTY. Show radio programme types (PTY) Some radio stations broadcast information about programme type and programme category. The current station's radio programme type, e.g. Pop Music and Serious Classical Music, can be shown in the display screen. PTY can be selected for FM and DAB radio. Show radio programme type for FM radio – To finish searching, press EXIT. – Related information To continue searching for another broadcast of the selected programme types, press on or . • Searching radio programme types (PTY) (p. 385) • Show radio programme types (PTY) (p. 385) • • Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) • Volume control for interrupting radio programme types (PTY) (p. 386) • RDS functions (p. 382) • RDS functions (p. 382) Related information Show radio programme types (PTY) (p. 385) 11 Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu Advanced settings PTY settings Show PTY text. Show radio programme type for DAB radio Activate/deactivate in DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced settings Show PTY text. Related information • • Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) • RDS functions (p. 382) Searching radio programme types (PTY) (p. 385) 385 11 Audio and media Volume control for interrupting radio programme types (PTY) 11 The interrupting programme types, e.g. NEWS or TP, are heard at the volume selected for each respective programme type. If the volume level is adjusted during the programme interruption, the new level is saved until the next programme interruption. Related information • Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio text Certain RDS stations transmit information on programme content, artists etc. This information is shown in the display screen16. Radio text can be shown for FM and DAB radio. Radio text for FM radio – Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu Show radio text. Activate/deactivate in DAB mode under DAB menu Show radio text. Only one of the functions "Show radio text" and "Show presets" can be activated at a time. If one of them is activated when the other is already activated, then the previously activated function is deactivated automatically. Both functions can be deactivated. Related information • • 386 Only cars with 7-inch screen The function selects the strongest transmitter for the set radio station. In order to find a strong transmitter the function may, in exceptional cases, need to search the entire FM wavelength. – Radio text for DAB radio NOTE 16 Automatic radio frequency update (AF) RDS functions (p. 382) Radio stations as presets (p. 381) Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu Advanced settings Alternative frequency. Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) 11 Audio and media Regional radio programmes (REG) Scan radio frequencies Resetting RDS functions This function causes the radio to continue with a regional radio transmitter even if its signal strength is low. The function automatically searches for available radio channels and takes into account any programme type filtering (PTY). All radio settings can be reset to the original factory settings. The symbol REG shows that the function is active. When a station is found, it is played for approx. 10 seconds before scanning is resumed. When a station is playing back it is saved as a preset in the usual way, see Radio stations as presets (p. 381). – Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM menu Advanced settings REG. Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) – – The reset is carried out in FM mode under FM menu Advanced settings Reset all FM settings. Related information • RDS functions (p. 382) 11 To start scanning go in FM/AM/DAB* mode to FM menu Scan, AM menu Scan or DAB menu Scan. NOTE Scanning stops if a station is saved. Scanning can also be selected in DAB-PTY mode. In which case only channels of the pre-selected programme type are played. Related information • • Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio stations as presets (p. 381) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 387 11 Audio and media Digital radio* (DAB) • DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) is a digital broadcasting system for radio. The car supports DAB, DAB+ and DMB. NOTE Coverage for DAB is not available in all locations. If there is no coverage then the message No reception is shown in the display screen. 11 Service and Ensemble • Service - Channel, radio channel (only audio services are supported by the system). • Ensemble - A collection of radio channels on the same frequency. Related information 388 • Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) (p. 388) • Navigation in channel group list (Ensemble) (p. 389) • • • • • • • • Radio (p. 379) Radio stations as presets (p. 381) Scan radio frequencies (p. 387) Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Radio text (p. 386) DAB to DAB link (p. 389) Digital radio* (DAB) - frequencies (p. 389) Digital radio* (DAB) - subchannel (p. 390) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Digital radio* (DAB) - resetting (p. 390) Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) Storage of channel groups (Ensemble learn) for digital radio (DAB). When the vehicle is moved to a new broadcasting area, programming of existing channel groups in the area may be necessary. Programming of channel groups creates an updated list of all available channel groups. The list is not updated automatically. Programming is carried out in the menu system in DAB mode under DAB menu Ensemble learn. Programming can also take place as follows: 1. Turn TUNE one step in either direction. > Ensemble learn is shown in the list of available channel groups. 2. Press OK/MENU. > New programming is started. Programming can be cancelled with EXIT. Related information • • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) Navigation in channel group list (Ensemble) (p. 389) 11 Audio and media Navigation in channel group list (Ensemble) Navigation in the channel group list (Ensemble) for digital radio (DAB). To navigate in and access the channel group list turn TUNE. The name of the Ensemble is shown in the upper part of the display screen. When switching to the new Ensemble the name changes to the new one. • Service - Shows channels irrespective of the channel group to which they are allocated. The list can also be filtered using the selection of programme type (PTY filtering), see Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384). Related information • Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn) (p. 388) • • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) 17 DAB to DAB link Digital radio* (DAB) - frequencies DAB to DAB linking means that the DAB radio can go from one channel with poor or no reception to the same channel in another channel group with better reception. DAB can be transmitted on two wavelengths17. There may be a certain delay when changing channel group. There may be a period of silence between the current channel no longer being available to the new channel becoming available. The function can be activated/deactivated in DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced settings DAB linking. Related information • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) • Band III - covers most areas. • LBand - available only in a few areas. By selecting for example Band III on its own, channel programming takes place more quickly than if both Band III and LBand have been selected. It is not certain that all channel groups will be found. Wavelength selection does not affect the stored memories. 11 Wavelengths can be deactivated/activated in DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced settings DAB band. Related information • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) Radio programme types (PTY) (p. 384) Not all areas/countries use both wavelengths. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 389 11 Audio and media 11 Digital radio* (DAB) - subchannel Digital radio* (DAB) - resetting Media player Secondary components are usually named subchannels. These are temporary and can contain e.g. translations of the main programme into other languages. All DAB settings can be reset to the original factory settings. The media player can playback audio and video from CD/DVD* (p. 391) discs and externally connected audio sources via AUX/USB* (p. 395) input, or wirelessly stream (p. 398) audio files from external devices using Bluetooth®. Certain media players can show TV (p. 421)* and have the option to communicate with a mobile phone (p. 403)* via Bluetooth®. If one or more subchannels are broadcast symbol is shown to the left of the then the channel name in the display screen. A subchannel is indicated by the - symbol appearing to the left of the channel name in the display screen. Press – The reset is carried out in DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced settings Reset all DAB settings. Related information • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) to access the subchannels. Subchannels can only be accessed on the selected main channel and not on any other channel without selecting it. Display of subchannels can be deactivated/ activated in DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced settings Sub channels Related information • Digital radio* (DAB) (p. 388) Controls for the media player. For operating the media player, see Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) and Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374). Related information • • 390 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Audio and media (p. 371) Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 413) 11 Audio and media • • Remote control* (p. 425) CD/DVD* Fast forward/reverse Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394) The media player can playback pre-recorded and burned CD/DVD18 discs. It is possible to fast forward/rewind audio and video files.19 The media player supports and can play the following main types of discs and files: / depressed in Hold the button for order to fast forward/rewind audio or video files forward/backward. • • • • Pre-recorded CD discs (CD Audio). Burned CD discs with audio and/or video files18. Pre-recorded DVD video discs18. Burned DVD discs18 with audio and/or video files. For more information about the supported formats, see Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394). 11 Related information Related information 18 19 Audio files are fast forwarded/rewound at one speed, while video files can be fast forwarded/rewound at several speeds. Repeatedly / to increase the press the buttons fast forward/rewind speed for video files. Release the button to return to viewing at normal speed. • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) • • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Only applies to CD/DVD* discs, USB and iPod®. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 391 11 Audio and media Random selection of disc track or audio file Playback and navigation of DVD video discs This function plays the tracks/audio files in random order20. When playing back a DVD video disc21 a disc menu may appear on the display screen. The disc menu gives access to additional functions and settings, such as selecting subtitles, language and scene selection. To listen to the tracks/audio files in random order for the selected source: 1. Press OK/MENU 11 2. Turn TUNE to Random 3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate the function. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) • Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) Navigation in the DVD video disc's menu For basic playback and navigation, see Operating the system, page (p. 372). See below for a more detailed description. NOTE A video film is only shown when the car is stationary. When the car is moving at a speed of over about 8 km/h no picture is shown and No visual media available while driving appears on the display screen, although the audio is heard during this time. The picture is shown again as soon as the car's speed falls below about 6 km/h. Navigation in the DVD video disc's menu is performed using the number keys in the centre console as illustrated above. Changing chapter or title Turn TUNE to access the list of chapters and navigate through them (if the film is being played back then it is paused). Press OK/ MENU to select the chapter, this also leads back to the original position (if the film was being played back then it is restarted). Press EXIT to access the title list. Titles are selected in the title list by turning TUNE and the selection is confirmed with OK/MENU, this also leads back to the chapter list. Press OK/MENU to activate the 20 21 392 Does not apply to DVD video discs. For externally connected audio sources via the AUX/USB input this only applies to USB and iPod®. Not supported by all mobile phones. Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 11 Audio and media selection and return to the start position. Use EXIT to cancel the selection and this leads back to the original position (without any selection being made). The chapter can also be changed by pressing on / on the centre console or the steering wheel keypad*. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) • Camera angle for playback of DVD video discs (p. 393) • Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files (p. 420) • • • Fast forward/reverse (p. 391) • 22 23 DivX® Video On Demand Camera angle for playback of DVD video discs If the DVD video disc supports it, the function can be used to choose from which camera position a particular scene should be shown22. Go in disc mode to Disc menu settings Angle. Advanced Related information The media player can be registered in order to play DivX VOD23 type files from burned discs or USB. The code for registration can be found in the menu system MY CAR Settings Information DivX® VOD code. For general information on menus, see under MY CAR, see MY CAR - operation (p. 104). • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) For more information visit www.divx.com/ vod. • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) Scan disc track or audio file (p. 421) • Random selection of disc track or audio file (p. 392) Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files (p. 420) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394) 11 Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 393 11 Audio and media Picture settings Media player - compatible file formats You can adjust the display settings (when the car is stationary) for brightness and contrast24. The media player can play back a variety of file types and is compatible with the formats in the following tables. 1. Press OK/MENU and select Image settings, confirm with OK/MENU. 2. Turn TUNE to the adjustment option and confirm with OK/MENU. 11 Compatible file formats for CD/DVD* discs Audio format Video Dual format, double-sided discs (DVD Plus, CD-DVD format) are thicker than regular CD discs and therefore playback cannot be guaranteed and malfunction may arise. To return to the settings list, press the OK/ MENU or EXIT. The picture settings can be reset to factory settings with the Reset option. If a CD contains a mixture of MP3 and CDDA tracks, all MP3s will be ignored. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) Audio formatA CD audio, mp3, wma • Audio and media (p. 371) Audio formatB CD audio, mp3, wma, aac, m4a Video formatC CD video, DVD video, divx, avi, asf A B C 394 Audio and video files in the following table are supported by the system for playback via the USB connection. NOTE 3. Adjust the setting by turning TUNE and confirm with OK/MENU. 24 Compatible file formats via USB connection Applies to Performance. Does not apply to Performance. Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. A formatA mp3, wma, aac, m4a divx, avi, asf Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Related information • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) • Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files (p. 420) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) 11 Audio and media External audio source via AUX/USB* input An external audio source, e.g. an iPod® or MP3 player, can be connected to the audio system. USB memory MP3 player To facilitate the use of a USB memory stick, only store music files on it. It takes a lot longer for the system to load storage media that contains anything other than compatible music files. Many MP3 players have their own file systems that are not supported by the audio system. For use in the system, an MP3 player must be set in USB Removable device/ Mass Storage Device mode. iPod® NOTE The system supports mobile media compliant with USB 2.0 and the FAT32 file system and can handle 1000 folders with a maximum of 254 subfolders/files in every folder. The top level, which can handle up to 1000 subfolders/files, is an exception to this. An iPod® is charged and supplied with power by the USB connection* via the player's connection cable. NOTE The system only supports the playback of audio files from iPod®. NOTE An audio source connected to the USB input can be operated25 using the car's audio controls. A device connected via the AUX input cannot be controlled via the car. There is a recess in the right-hand rear edge of the tunnel console where cables can be routed so that the hatch can be closed without cables being pinched. An iPod® or MP3 player with rechargeable batteries is recharged (when the ignition is on or the engine is running) if the device is plugged into the USB connection. 25 11 NOTE When using a longer model USB memory stick the use of a USB adapter cable is recommended. This is to avoid mechanical wear to the USB input and the connected USB memory stick. When an iPod® is used as audio source, the car's infotainment system has a menu structure that is similar to the iPod® player's own menu structure. USB hub Related information It is possible to connect a USB hub to the USB connection and thereby connect multiple USB devices simultaneously. Selection of USB device is made in USB mode under USB menu Select USB device. • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting an external audio source via AUX/USB* input (p. 396) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) Only applies to the media source connected via the USB connection. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 395 11 Audio and media Connecting an external audio source via AUX/USB* input An external audio source, e.g. an iPod® or MP3 player, can be connected to the audio system via any of the connections in the centre console. The text Reading USB is shown in the display screen when the system is loading the storage media's file structure. Depending on the file structure and number of files there may be some delay before loading is finished. NOTE The system supports most iPod® models produced in 2005 or later. 11 NOTE To prevent damage to the USB connection, this is shut off if the USB connection is short-circuited or if a connected USB unit is taking too much power (this may happen if the unit connected does not meet the USB standard). The USB connection is reactivated automatically the next time the ignition is turned on, unless the fault persists. Connection points for external audio sources. To connect the audio source: 1. Press MEDIA, turn TUNE to the required sound source USB, iPod or AUX, press OK/MENU. > If USB is selected then Connect USB is shown in the display screen. Related information • External audio source via AUX/USB* input (p. 395) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) 2. Connect your audio source to one of the connections in the centre console's storage compartment (see previous illustration). 26 27 396 Only applies to USB and iPod®. Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Playback and navigation of external audio source Playback and navigation of external audio source26 For basic playback and navigation, see Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372). See below for a more detailed description. , video Audio files have the symbol and folders files27 have the symbol . have the symbol When playback of a file is complete the playback of the other files (of the same type) in 11 Audio and media that particular folder continues. Change28 of folder takes place automatically when all the files in the current folder have been played back. The system automatically detects and changes setting when a device containing only audio files or only video files is connected to the USB port and then it plays back these files. However, the system does not change setting if a device containing a mixture of audio and video files is connected to the USB port, but instead the player continues to play back the previous file type. Search function26 The keypad on the control panel in the centre console can be used to find a filename in the current folder. The search function is accessed either by turning TUNE (to access the folder structure) or by pressing one of the letter keys. As a letter or character in a search string is entered you get closer to your search target. Start playback of a file by pressing OK/ MENU. Repeat folder29 This function makes it possible to play files in a folder over and over again. When the last 28 26 29 30 file has been played out, playback of the first file starts again. • DivX® Video On Demand (p. 393) 1. Press OK/MENU 2. Turn TUNE to Repeat folder 3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate the function. Pause When the volume is reduced entirely or MUTE is pressed, the media player is paused. When the volume is increased or MUTE is pressed again, the media player starts. It is also possible to pause via the menu system30, press OK/MENU, select Play/Pause. 11 Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting an external audio source via AUX/USB* input (p. 396) • External audio source via AUX/USB* input (p. 395) • • • Fast forward/reverse (p. 391) • Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394) Scan disc track or audio file (p. 421) Random selection of disc track or audio file (p. 392) If Repeat folder is activated then this does not take place. Only applies to USB and iPod®. Only applies to USB. Does not apply to iPod® * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 397 11 Audio and media Setting the audio volume for external audio source Set the volume for external audio player. If the volume is too high or too low then the quality of the sound may deteriorate. 11 Related information • Audio and media - advanced audio settings (p. 377) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) If an external audio source (e.g. an MP3 player or iPod®) is connected to the AUX input then the audio source that is connected can have a different volume than the audio system's internal volume (e.g. radio). Correct this by adjusting the volume of the input: Media Bluetooth®* The car's media player (p. 390) is equipped with Bluetooth®31 and can wirelessly play streaming audio files from external devices with Bluetooth®, such as mobile phones and PDAs. 1. Press the MEDIA button and turn TUNE to AUX and wait a few seconds or press OK/MENU. 2. Press OK/MENU and then turn TUNE to AUX input volume. Confirm with OK/ MENU. 3. Turn TUNE to adjust the volume for the AUX input. NOTE If the external audio source's volume is too high or too low, the quality of the sound may deteriorate. The audio quality may also be impaired if the player is charged while the infotainment system is in AUX mode. In which case, avoid charging the player via the 12 V socket. 31 398 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Media Bluetooth® functions, controls overview. The device must first be registered and connected to the car (p. 400). Navigation and control of the audio can be carried out via the centre console buttons or via the steering wheel keypad*. In some external devices it is also possible to change tracks from the device. To play back the audio the car's media player must first be set in Bluetooth mode. 11 Audio and media When a mobile phone is connected to the car, it is also possible to remotely control a selection of the mobile phone's functions, see Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403). Switch between the main sources TEL and MEDIA to operate each one's functions. NOTE The Bluetooth® media player must support the Audio/Video Remote Control Profile (AVRCP) and Advanced Audio Distribution Profile (A2DP). The player should use AVRCP version 1.3, A2DP 1.2. Otherwise some functions may not work. Not all mobile phones and external media players available in the market are fully compatible with the Bluetooth® function in the car's media player. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo dealer or visit www.volvocars.com for information on compatible phones and external media players. NOTE The car's media player can only play the audio files via the Bluetooth® function. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) • • Scan disc track or audio file (p. 421) Random selection of disc track or audio file (p. 392) Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device The car is equipped with Bluetooth®32 and can wirelessly communicate with other Bluetooth® devices after registration and connection (p. 400). A maximum of ten Bluetooth® devices can be registered. Registration is performed once per device. After registration the device no longer needs to be activated as visible/ searchable. 11 When the Bluetooth® function is active and the last device connected is in range it is connected automatically to the car. When the car searches for the last device connected its name is shown in the display screen. To connect to another device, press EXIT and select change device (p. 402). When the Bluetooth® device is out of range of the car it is automatically disconnected. It is also possible to manually disconnect (p. 402) a device. If you want to deregister a Bluetooth® device from the car, select Removing a Bluetooth®* device (p. 403). The car will then not locate the device automatically. It is possible to have two Bluetooth® devices connected simultaneously. One phone and one media device, which it is possible to switch between (p. 402). It is also possible to * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 399 11 Audio and media || call with the phone and simultaneously stream audio files. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) 11 Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Registering a Bluetooth®* device Bluetooth® It is possible to have two devices connected simultaneously. One phone and one media device, which it is possible to switch between. It is also possible to call with the phone and simultaneously stream audio files. A maximum of ten Bluetooth® devices can be registered. Registration is performed once per device. After registration the device no longer needs to be activated as visible/ searchable. although it starts from the main source MEDIA. There are two possible ways of connecting devices, either search for the external device from the car, or search for the car from the external device. If one option does not work then try with the other. If you are not already in the normal view for the phone, press TEL in the centre console. NOTE If the phone's operating system is updated then it is possible that the registration of the phone is interrupted. In which case, disconnect the phone, see Removing a Bluetooth®* device (p. 403) and then reconnect it, see Registering a Bluetooth®* device (p. 400). Example of normal view for phone. Connecting an external device takes place in different ways depending on whether or not the device has been connected previously. The connection options below presume that this is the first time the device is being connected (registered) and that no other device is connected. The connection options show the connection of a phone. Connecting a media device (p. 398) is performed in the same way 32 400 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Alternative 1 - search for the external device via the car's menu system 1. Make the external device searchable/visible via Bluetooth®, see the external device's manual or www.volvocars.com. 11 Audio and media 2. Press OK/MENU and follow the instructions on the display screen. > The external device is now connected to the car and can be controlled from the car. If connection failed, press EXIT twice and connect the device as described under Alternative 2. Alternative 2 - Search for the car with the Bluetooth® function of the external device. 1. Make the car searchable/visible via Bluetooth®. Turn TUNE to Phone settings, confirm with OK/MENU, select Discoverable and confirm with OK/ MENU. 2. Select My Volvo Car on the screen of the external device and follow the instructions. 3. Enter a PIN code in the external device and then select to connect. 4. Press OK/MENU and enter the same PIN code via the car keypad in the centre console. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) Automatic connection of Bluetooth®* device When a Bluetooth® device is registered (p. 400) in the car the last external device connected is connected automatically when it is within range. When the Bluetooth® function is active and the last device connected is in range it is connected automatically. When the car searches for the last device connected its name is shown in the display screen. If the last connected device is not available then the system will try to connect an earlier device. 11 To connect to another device, press EXIT, select to connect a new device (p. 400) or change to another already registered device (p. 402). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) Once the external device is connected, its Bluetooth® name appears on the car's display screen and the unit can be controlled from the car. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 401 11 Audio and media Changing to another Bluetooth®* device It is possible to change from a connected device to another one if there are several devices in the car. The device must first have been registered (p. 402)) to the car. Changing media device 11 2. Press TEL and then select Change phone. > The car searches for previously connected devices. The external devices detected are specified with their respective Bluetooth® name in the display screen. 1. Check that the external device is searchable/visible via Bluetooth®, see the manual for the external device. 3. Select the device to be connected. > Connection of the external device takes place. 2. Press MEDIA, select Bluetooth and then Change device. > The car searches for previously connected devices. The external devices detected are specified with their respective Bluetooth® name in the display screen. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) 3. Select the device to be connected. > Connection of the external device takes place. Changing phone 1. Check that the external device is searchable/visible via Bluetooth®, see the manual for the external device. 33 402 Only Keyless Drive. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Disconnecting the Bluetooth®* device When the Bluetooth® device is out of range of the car it is automatically disconnected. It is also possible to disconnect a phone manually. When the mobile phone has been disconnected an ongoing call can be continued by using the mobile phone's built-in microphone and speaker. The handsfree function is deactivated when the engine is switched off and the door is opened33. If you want to deregister a Bluetooth® device from the car, select Remove Bluetooth® device (p. 403). The car will then not locate the device automatically. Manual disconnection of phone The phone can be manually disconnected in phone mode under Phone menu Disconnect phone. NOTE Even when your mobile phone has been manually disconnected, some mobile phones may automatically couple up to the last handsfree unit connected, e.g. when a new call begins. 11 Audio and media Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) • • Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Removing a Bluetooth®* device Bluetooth® handsfree phone Bluetooth®* If you do not want a device registered to the car any longer then it is possible to remove (deregister) it from the car. The car will then not locate the device automatically. Removing a media device Press MEDIA, select Bluetooth Bluetooth device. Remove Removing a phone Press TEL, select Phone menu Bluetooth device. Remove Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) • • Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) A mobile phone equipped with Bluetooth® can be connected wirelessly to the car34. The device must first be registered and connected to the car (p. 400). The audio and media system works as handsfree, with the option to remote control a selection of the mobile phone's functions via the centre console buttons or via the steering wheel keypad*. The mobile phone can be operated by its own keys irrespective of whether or not it is connected. 11 When another Bluetooth® device is connected to the car, it is also possible to use the media device, see Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398). Switch between the main sources TEL and MEDIA to operate each one's functions. NOTE Only a selection of mobile phones are fully compatible with the handsfree function. Volvo recommends that you seek assistance from an authorised Volvo dealer for information on compatible phones. Activate A short press on TEL activates/searches last connected phone. If a phone is already connected, and TEL is pressed, a shortcut menu is shown with commonly used menu options 34 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 403 11 Audio and media || for the phone. The symbol indicates that a phone is connected. Bluetooth®* handsfree phone overview To call System overview for Bluetooth®* handsfree phone. 1. Make sure that the symbol appears at the top of the display screen and that the handsfree function is in phone mode. 11 Making and receiving calls Making and receiving calls and functions for making and receiving calls. Incoming call – 2. Dial either the desired number or the speed dial number (p. 411). Or in normal view turn TUNE to the right to access the phone book, and to the left for the call register for all calls. For information on the phone book, see Phone book (p. 406). Refuse or end with EXIT. Automatic answer The automatic answer function means that calls are accepted automatically. – 3. Press OK/MENU. The call is interrupted with EXIT. Related information 404 • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview (p. 404) • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) • • Making and receiving calls (p. 404) • Bluetooth® version information (p. 406) Bluetooth® handsfree phone - audio settings (p. 405) Press OK/MENU to answer the call, even if the audio system is in e.g. RADIO or MEDIA mode. System overview Mobile phone Microphone Steering wheel keypad Control panel in centre console Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) Activate/deactivate in phone mode under Phone menu Call options Auto answer. In call menu Press OK/MENU during an ongoing call to access the following functions: • Mute - audio system microphone is muted. • Mobile phone - the call is transferred from handsfree to the mobile phone. For some mobile phones the connection is interrupted. This is normal. The handsfree function asks if you want to reconnect. • Dial number - option to call a third party using the number keys (current call set in standby). 11 Audio and media Call lists The call lists are copied to the handsfree function at each new connection and are then updated during the connection. In normal view, turn to the left with TUNE to see the call register for All calls . In phone mode it is possible to see all the call lists under Phone menu All calls: • • • • • All calls Missed calls Answered calls Dialled calls Call duration NOTE Certain mobile phones show a list of the last dialled numbers in reverse order. Voice mailbox In normal view a speed dial number for the voice mailbox can be programmed in and then accessed later via a long press on 1. Voice mailbox number is changed in phone mode under Phone menu Call options Voicemail number Change number. If there is no number stored then this menu can be reached with one long press on 1. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling a contact (p. 418) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling from the call register (p. 418) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - calling the voice mailbox (p. 418) • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) • Bluetooth® It is possible to adjust the call volume, audio system volume and ring signal volume, and change the ring tone. Phone call volume The phone call volume can only be changed during a call. Use the steering wheel keypad* or turn the VOL control. 11 Audio system volume handsfree phone - audio settings (p. 405) Phone book (p. 406) Bluetooth® handsfree phone - audio settings Providing there is no ongoing call taking place, the audio system volume is controlled as usual by turning VOL. If an audio source is active during an incoming call then it can be muted automatically. Activate/deactivate in phone mode under Phone menu Phone settings Sounds and volume Mute radio/media. Ring volume In phone mode go to Phone menu Phone settings Sounds and volume Ring volume and adjust by turning VOL. Press OK/MENU to hear the audio volume. Press EXIT to save. Ring signals The handsfree function has integrated ring signals that can be selected in phone mode under Phone menu Phone settings * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 405 11 Audio and media || Sounds and volume signal 1 etc. Ring signals Ring NOTE For some mobile phones, the ringtone on the phone connected will not be switched off when one of the inbuilt signals for the handsfree system is used. 11 In order to select the connected phone's ring signal35, go in phone mode to Phone menu Phone settings Sounds and volume Ring signals Mobile phone ring signal. Bluetooth® version information Show the car's current Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) version. The car's current Bluetooth® version can be seen in Bluetooth mode under Bluetooth menu Bluetooth software version in car. Phone book There are two phone books. These are merged into one in the car and are displayed as a single phone book in the car. • The car downloads the mobile phone's phone book and only displays this phone book when the mobile phone from which this phone book was downloaded is connected. • The car also has a built-in phone book. This contains all the contacts stored in the car irrespective of which phone was connected when saving them. These contacts are visible for all users, regardless of the mobile phone that is connected to the car. If a contact is saved in the car then is shown in front of the the symbol contact in the phone book. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Related information • Bluetooth® Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) NOTE Changes made from the car to a record in the mobile phone's telephone book will result in a new record in the car's telephone book, i.e. changes will not be saved to the phone. From the car, this will now look like you have double records, with different icons. Note also that when a shortcut number is saved or a change to a contact is made, this will result in a new record in the car's phone book. 35 406 Not supported by all mobile phones. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 11 Audio and media All use of the phone book requires that the symbol appears at the top of the display screen and that the handsfree function is in phone mode. The audio and media system stores a copy of each registered mobile phone's phone book. The phone book can be copied automatically to the audio and media system during each connection. – Activate/deactivate the function in phone mode under Phone menu Phone settings Download phone book. If the phone book contains a ringing caller's contact information then this is shown in the display screen. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) • Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) • • Phone book - new contact (p. 410) • Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) • • Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Phone book - quick search for contacts In normal view turn TUNE to the right to show a list of contacts. Turn TUNE to select and press OK/MENU to call. Under the name of the contact is the phone number that is selected by default. If the symbol > appears to the right of the contact then there are several phone numbers stored for the contact. Press OK/MENU to show the numbers. Change and dial a number other than that selected by default by turning TUNE. Press OK/MENU to dial. 11 Search the list of contacts via the centre console's keypad, enter the start of the contact's name, see Character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) for the function of the buttons. The list of contacts can also be accessed from normal view by pressing and holding the button on the centre console's keypad with the letter that the contact searched for starts with. For example, a long press on the button for 6 gives instant access to that part of the list where the contacts with the letter M are located. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) 407 11 Audio and media 11 • • Phone book (p. 406) • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) • • Phone book - new contact (p. 410) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) Space . , - ? @ : ; / ( ) 1 • • • Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) ABCÅÄÆÀÇ2 Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) Phone book - character table keypad in centre console Key GHIÌ4 JKL5 MNOΚØÑÒ6 PQRSΤ7 TUVÜÙ8 WXYZ9 Shift between upper and lower case letter. 408 #* Function DEFÈΔ3 Function +0pw Character table of possible characters for use in the phone book. Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Key Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) • • Phone book (p. 406) • • • • • Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) Phone book - new contact (p. 410) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) 11 Audio and media Phone book - searching for contacts Searching for contacts in the phone book. NOTE There is no text wheel for High Performance, so TUNE cannot be used there to input characters: only the digit and letter buttons on the control panel in the centre console can be used for this. 123/ABC Change between letters and numbers with OK/MENU. More Change to special characters with OK/MENU. Leads to the phone book (3). Turn TUNE to select a contact, press OK/MENU to see the saved numbers and other information. 1. Turn36 TUNE to the desired letter, press OK/MENU to confirm. The number and letter buttons on the control panel in the centre console can also be used. Search contacts using the text wheel. Character list Changing the input mode (see table below) Phone book 2. Continue with the next letter and so on. The result of the search is shown in the phone book (3). A short press on EXIT deletes an input character. A long press on EXIT will clear all entered characters. 3. To change the input mode to numbers or special characters, or to go to the phone book, turn TUNE to one of the options (see explanation in the table below) in the list for changing the input mode (2), press OK/MENU. By pressing a number key in the centre console when the text wheel is shown (see illustration above), a new character list (1) appears in the display screen. Continue repeatedly pressing the number key to the desired letter and then release. Continue with the next letter and so on. When a button is depressed the entry is confirmed when another button is depressed. To search for or edit a contact, go in phone mode to Phone menu Phone book Search. 11 To enter a number, hold in the corresponding number key. Related information 36 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) }} 409 11 Audio and media • • Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - new contact Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) Create new contact in the phone book. • Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) • • 11 • • • 2. Turn37 TUNE to the desired letter, press OK/MENU to confirm. The number and letter buttons on the control panel in the centre console can also be used. Phone book - new contact (p. 410) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) 3. Continue with the next letter and so on. The name entered is shown in the input field (2) in the display screen. Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Entering letters for New contact. Changing the input mode (see table below) Input field New contacts can be added in phone mode under Phone menu Phone book New contact. NOTE There is no text wheel for High Performance, so TUNE cannot be used there to input characters: only the digit and letter buttons on the control panel in the centre console can be used for this. 37 410 1. When the Name row is selected, press OK/MENU to reach the input mode (illustration above). Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. 4. To change the input mode to numbers, special characters, change between uppercase/lowercase letters, etc., turn TUNE to one of the options (see explanation in the table below) in the list (1) and then press OK/MENU. When the name has been fully entered, select OK in the list on the display screen (1) and press OK/MENU. Now continue with the telephone number in the same way as above. When the telephone number has been entered, press OK/MENU and select a telephone number type (Mobile phone, Home, Work or General). Press OK/MENU to confirm. When all details have been filled in, select Save contact in the menu to save the contact. 11 Audio and media 123/ABC Change between letters and numbers with OK/MENU. More Change to special characters with OK/MENU. OK Save and go back to Add contact with OK/MENU. Change between uppercase and lowercase letters with OK/ MENU. Press OK/MENU, the cursor moves to the input field (2) at the top of the display screen. The cursor can now be moved, with TUNE, to the appropriate place to e.g. insert new letters or delete with EXIT. To be able to insert new letters first go back to the input mode, by pressing OK/MENU. Related information • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) • Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) • • • Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Phone book - speed dial numbers Store as speed dial number in order to easily dial a number or a contact. Use phone mode to add speed dial numbers under Phone menu Phone book Speed dial. Dialling with speed dial numbers can be performed in phone mode using the number keys on the keypad in the centre console, by pressing a number key and then pressing OK/MENU. If there is no contact stored on the speed dial number then an option is shown to save a contact to the selected speed dial number. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) • • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) • • • • Phone book - new contact (p. 410) • Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) 11 Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book - memory status (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) 411 11 Audio and media 11 Phone book - receiving a vCard Phone book - memory status Phone book - clearing Receiving electronic business cards (vCard) to the car's phone book. See phone book memory status. Clear the car's built-in phone book (p. 406). Memory status of the car's phone book and the connected mobile phone's phone book can be seen in phone mode under Phone menu Phone book Memory status. The car's phone book can be deleted, this is carried out in phone mode under Phone menu Phone book Clear phone book. It is possible to receive a vCard to the car's phone book from other mobile phones (other than the one currently connected to the car). In order to allow this the car is set to visible mode for Bluetooth®. The function is activated in phone mode under Phone menu Phone book Receive vCard. Related information 412 • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) NOTE Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Deleting the car's telephone book only deletes contacts in the car's telephone book. Contacts in the mobile phone's phone book are not deleted. Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) • Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) • • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) Phone book - new contact (p. 410) • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) • • Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) • • • Phone book - new contact (p. 410) • • Phone book - character table keypad in centre console (p. 408) Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) • Phone book - searching for contacts (p. 409) Phone book - new contact (p. 410) • • Phone book - memory status (p. 412) • • • • Phone book - receiving a vCard (p. 412) Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Phone book - clearing (p. 412) Phone book (p. 406) Phone book - quick search for contacts (p. 407) Phone book - speed dial numbers (p. 411) Phone book - memory status (p. 412) 11 Audio and media Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone The driver always holds overall responsibility for driving the vehicle in a safe manner and complying with all applicable rules of the road. Voice recognition38 allows the driver to voiceactivate certain functions in a Bluetooth®-connected mobile phone or in Volvo's navigation system. NOTE • • The information in this section describes the use of voice commands to control a mobile phone connected using Bluetooth®. For detailed information on using a Bluetooth®-connected mobile phone, see Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403). The Volvo navigation system has a separate supplement which contains more information on voice recognition and voice commands to control the system. The voice recognition system allows the driver to voice-activate certain functions of a Bluetooth®-connected mobile phone and in Volvo's navigation system, while the driver can keep his/her hands on the wheel at the same time. The input data are in dialogue form with spoken commands from the user and verbal replies from the system. The voice recognition system uses the same microphone as the Bluetooth® handsfree system (see Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview (p. 404)) and the voice recognition system's replies come via the car's speakers. Voice commands offer convenience and help the driver to avoid being distracted, and instead concentrate on driving and focus attention on the road and traffic conditions. 38 Getting started with voice recognition WARNING 11 Steering wheel keypad. Button for voice recognition Before voice commands to a mobile phone can be used the mobile phone must be paired and connected via Bluetooth® handsfree. If a telephone command is given and no mobile phone is paired, then the system will provide information about this. For information on pairing and connecting a mobile phone, see Registering a Bluetooth®* device (p. 400). • Press the button for voice recognition (1) in order to activate the system and initiate a dialogue with voice commands. The system will then display commonly used commands in the display screen in the centre console. Only applies to vehicles equipped with Volvo's navigation system. }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 413 11 Audio and media || Keep the following things in mind when you use the voice recognition system: 11 • For a command - speak after the tone, with normal voice at normal speed. • Do not speak while the system is replying (the system cannot understand commands during this time). • The car's doors and windows must be closed. • Avoid background noise in the passenger compartment. • Connecting and disconnecting a Bluetooth®* device (p. 399) • Language options for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 414) • Help functions for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 415) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - user setting and voice volume (p. 416) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) Language options for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone Possible language options for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone are selected in the menu system for MY CAR, see MY CAR Voice settings (p. 112). NOTE If the driver is unsure of which command to use, he (she) can say "Help" - the system then responds with a few different commands which can be used in the current situation. Voice commands can be disabled by: • • • • saying "Cancel" not speaking a long press on the steering wheel button for Voice recognition Press EXIT or another main source button (e.g. MEDIA). Related information 414 • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Bluetooth®* handsfree phone - overview (p. 404) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Language list. Voice recognition is not possible for all languages. Languages available for voice recognition are marked with an icon in the lan. Changing the language is perguage list formed in the menu system MY CAR, see MY CAR (p. 104). 11 Audio and media Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 413) • MY CAR - Voice settings (p. 112) Help functions for voice recognition* control of a mobile phone Help functions are available to help you become familiar with the system and the facility to teach the voice recognition system your voice and your accent. • • Instructions: A function that helps you become familiar with the system and the procedure for giving commands. Voice training: A function that enables the voice recognition system to learn to know your voice and your accent. The function provides an opportunity to voice train two user profiles. The help functions can be accessed by pressing the MY CAR button on the control panel in the centre console and then turning TUNE to the desired menu option. Instructions The instructions can be started in two ways: NOTE This instruction and voice training can only be started when the car is parked. • Press the button for voice recognition (p. 372) and say "Voice tutorial". • Activate the instructions in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Voice settings Voice tutorial. For a descrip- tion of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). The instructions are divided into 3 lessons, which take around 5 minutes in total to complete. The system starts with the first lesson. To skip a lesson and go to the next one, press the button for voice recognition and say "Next". Go back to the previous lesson by saying "Previous". 11 Exit the instructions by means of a long press on the button for voice recognition. Voice training The system displays up to fifteen phrases for you to say. Voice training can be started in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Voice settings Voice training. Select between User 1 or User 2. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). After voice training has been completed, remember to set your user profile under Voice user setting. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 413) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 415 11 Audio and media Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - user setting and voice volume Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands User profile and voice volume can be set in the MY CAR menu system. It is possible to use voice recognition to control the mobile phone with predefined voice commands. • 11 • User setting - Two user profiles can be set, the function is activated in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Voice settings Voice user setting. Select between User 1 or User 2. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Voice output volume - Can be changed in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Voice settings Voice output volume. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 413) The driver initiates a dialogue with voice commands by pressing the button for voice recognition (p. 413). Once a dialogue has been started, commonly used commands will be shown in the display screen. Greyed-out text or text within brackets is not included in the spoken command. When the driver becomes accustomed to the system, he/she can speed up the command dialogue and skip the prompts from the system, by briefly pressing the button for voice recognition. Commands can be given in several ways The command "Phone call contact" can be pronounced as e.g.: • "Phone > Call contact" - Say "Phone", wait for the system's reply, and then continue by saying "Call contact." or • 416 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. "Phone call contact" - Say the whole command in one sequence. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone (p. 413) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - quick commands (p. 417) • Voice guidance* control of a mobile phone - dialling a number (p. 417) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling from the call register (p. 418) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling a contact (p. 418) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - calling the voice mailbox (p. 418) 11 Audio and media • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - quick commands Voice guidance* control of a mobile phone - dialling a number Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone can be performed with a number of predefined quick commands. How to describe a number to control a mobile phone using voice recognition. Quick commands for the phone can be found in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Voice settings Voice command list Phone commands and General commands. For a description of the menu system, see MY CAR (p. 104). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) The system understands the numbers 0 (zero) to 9 (nine). These numbers can be pronounced individually, in groups of several numbers at a time, or the whole number all at once. Numbers greater than 9 (nine) cannot be handled by the system, e.g. 10 (ten) or 11 (eleven) are not possible. You can also change the number by saying the commands "Correct" (which deletes the last spoken group of numbers) or "Delete" (which deletes the whole spoken phone number). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) 11 The following is an example of a dialogue with voice commands. The system's reply will vary depending on the situation. The user starts the dialogue by saying: Phone > call number or Phone call number System reply Number? User action Start saying the numbers (as individual units, i.e. six-eight-seven, etc.) in the phone number. If you say several numbers and pause, the system will repeat them, and then say "Continue". Continue to say the numbers. When finished, finish the command by saying "Call". * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 417 11 Audio and media 11 Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling from the call register Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - dialling a contact Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - calling the voice mailbox Use voice recognition with the mobile phone to dial from the call register. Use voice recognition with the mobile phone to dial a contact. Use voice recognition with a mobile phone to call the voice mailbox. The following dialogue allows you to make a phone call from one of your mobile phone's call registers. The following dialogue allows you to call your pre-defined contacts in the mobile phone. or The following dialogue allows you to call your voice mailbox to check if you have received any messages. The phone number for your voice mailbox must be registered in the Bluetooth® function, see Making and receiving calls (p. 404). Phone call contact The user starts the dialogue by saying: Continue by responding to the system's prompts. Phone > call voice mailbox Consider the following when you call a contact: Phone call voice mailbox The user starts the dialogue by saying: Phone > call from the call register or Phone call from the call register Continue by responding to the system's prompts. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) The user starts the dialogue by saying: Phone > call contact • • If there are several contacts with similar names, they will be presented in the screen in the numbered rows and the system prompts you to select a row number. If there are more rows in the list than can be displayed simultaneously, saying "Down" allows you to scroll down in the list (and saying "Up" allows you to scroll up in the list). Related information 418 • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. or Continue by responding to the system's prompts. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Voice recognition* control of a mobile phone - voice commands (p. 416) 11 Audio and media Save as favourite Save frequently used functions as favourites. The function can then be started easily by pressing the FAVbutton. To save a function as a favourite: 1. Select a main source (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA). 2. Select a wavelength or source (AM, Disc, etc.). 3. Press and hold the FAV button until the "favourites menu" is shown. 4. Turn TUNE to select an option from the list and press OK/MENU to save. > When the main source (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA) is active the stored function is available via a short press on FAV. Related information • Favourites (p. 376) Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc For basic playback and navigation, see Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372). See below for a more detailed description. NOTE Starting playback of a disc Press the MEDIA button, turn TUNE until Disc is displayed, press OK/MENU. If there is a disc in the media player then the disc starts playing back automatically, otherwise Insert disc is shown in the display screen. Then insert a disc, with text side up. The disc starts to play back automatically. A video film is only shown when the car is stationary. When the car is moving at a speed of over about 8 km/h no picture is shown and No visual media available while driving appears on the display screen, although the audio is heard during this time. The picture is shown again as soon as the car's speed falls below about 6 km/h. If a disc with audio/video files is inserted into the player then the disc's folder structure needs to be loaded. Depending on the quality of the disc and the quantity of information there may be a certain delay before playback starts. Some audio files that are copy-protected by record companies or privately copied audio files cannot be loaded by the player. Disc eject 11 NOTE Related information Press the eject button (p. 372) to eject the disc. A disc remains in the ejected position for about 12 seconds, after which it is inserted back into the player for safety reasons. Pause in playback (pause) When the volume is reduced entirely or MUTE is pressed, the media player is paused. When 39 the volume is increased or MUTE is pressed again, the media player starts. It is also possible to pause via the menu system39, press OK/MENU, select Play/Pause. • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files (p. 420) • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) • • Fast forward/reverse (p. 391) Scan disc track or audio file (p. 421) Does not apply to CD Audio * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 419 11 Audio and media • Random selection of disc track or audio file (p. 392) • Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394) Playback and navigation of burned discs with audio/video files40. NOTE A video film is only shown when the car is stationary. When the car is moving at a speed of over about 8 km/h no picture is shown and No visual media available while driving appears on the display screen, although the audio is heard during this time. The picture is shown again as soon as the car's speed falls below about 6 km/h. 11 NOTE Some audio files that are copy-protected by record companies or privately copied audio files cannot be loaded by the player. 40 41 420 changes setting when a disc containing only audio files or only video files is loaded into the media player and then plays back these files. However, the system does not change setting if a disc containing a mixture of audio and video files is loaded into the media player, but instead the player continues to play back the previous file type. Repeat folder This function makes it possible to play files in a folder over and over again. When the last file has been played out, playback of the first file starts again. 1. Press OK/MENU 2. Turn TUNE to Repeat folder 3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate the function. Related information • Audio files have the symbol , video and folders files40 have the symbol . have the symbol Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) When playback of a file is complete the playback of the other files (of the same type) in that particular folder continues. Change41 of folder takes place automatically when all the files in the current folder have been played back. The system automatically detects and • Playback and navigation of DVD video discs (p. 392) • • • Fast forward/reverse (p. 391) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. If Repeat folder is activated then this does not take place. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Scan disc track or audio file (p. 421) Random selection of disc track or audio file (p. 392) 11 Audio and media • • Media player - compatible file formats (p. 394) DivX® Video On Demand (p. 393) Scan disc track or audio file TV* This function play backs the first ten seconds of each disc track/audio file42. The TV picture is only shown when the car is stationary. When the car is moving at a speed over approx. 6 km/h the picture disappears, although the audio is heard during this time. The picture reappears when the car has stopped. To scan selected source: 1. Press OK/MENU 2. Turn TUNE to Scan > The first 10 seconds of each disc track or audio file are played. 11 3. Cancel the scan with EXIT, the disc track or audio file being played back will continue playing. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Playback and navigation of CD/DVD* disc (p. 419) • Playback and navigation of external audio source (p. 396) • Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) TV functions, control overview. NOTE This system only supports TV broadcasts in the countries that broadcast in MPEG-2 or MPEG-4 format and follow the DVB-T standard. The system does not support analogue broadcasts. 42 Does not apply to DVD video discs. For externally connected audio sources via the AUX/USB input this only applies to USB and iPod®. Not supported by all mobile phones. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 421 11 Audio and media || NOTE The TV picture is only shown when the car is stationary. When the car is moving at a speed over about 6 km/h the picture disappears, No visual media available while driving appears on the display screen, although the audio is heard during this time. The picture reappears when the car has stopped. 11 • Turn TUNE, a list of all available channels in the area is shown. If any of these channels is already saved as a preset then its preset number is shown to the right of the channel name. Continue turning TUNE to reach the desired channel and press OK/ MENU. • • By pressing the preset buttons (0-9). Via a short press on the / buttons the next available channel in the area is shown. NOTE The reception is dependent both on how good the signal strength and signal quality are. The transmission may be disturbed by various factors such as tall buildings or the TV transmitter being far away. Coverage level can also vary depending on where in the country you are located. IMPORTANT NOTE If the car has been moved within the country, for example, from one city to another, it is not certain that the presets are available at the new location as the frequency range may have changed. Then do another search and save a new preset list; see Save available TV channels as presets (p. 423). A TV licence is required for this product in some countries. Watch TV – Press MEDIA, turn TUNE until TV is shown in the display, press OK/MENU. > A search starts and after a short while the most recently used channel is shown. NOTE If no reception is available on the preset buttons, it may be because the car is at a location other than where the scan of TV channels was run, for example, if the car was driven from Germany to France. A new selection of country and a new search may then need to be carried out. Changing channel It is possible to change channel as follows: 422 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Searching TV* channels/Preset list (p. 423) • • • • • TV* - channel management (p. 423) Information about the current TV* programme (p. 424) Teletext* (p. 424) Picture settings (p. 394) Reception of TV* channel is lost. (p. 425) 11 Audio and media Searching TV* channels/Preset list After a search of TV channels the available channels are saved in a preset list. 1. Press TV mode on OK/MENU. 2. Turn TUNE to TV menu and press OK/ MENU. 3. Turn TUNE to Select country and press OK/MENU. > If one or more countries have previously been selected then they are shown in a list. 4. Turn TUNE to either Other countries or one of the previously selected countries. Press OK/MENU. > A list of all available countries is shown. 5. Turn TUNE to the desired country (e.g. Sweden) and press OK/MENU. > An automatic scan for available TV channels starts, this scan takes a little while. During this time the figure for each channel found and added as a preset is shown. When the scan is complete a message is shown and the picture is shown. A preset list (max. 30 presets) has now been created and is available. To change channel, see TV* (p. 421). The scan and preset storage can be cancelled with EXIT. TV* - channel management Related information • • • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) TV* (p. 421) TV* - channel management (p. 423) The preset list can be edited. You can change the order of the channels that are shown in the preset list. A TV channel can have more than one place in the preset list. The TV channel positions can also vary in the preset list. To change the order in the preset list, go in TV mode to TV menu Reorganise presets. 11 1. Turn TUNE to the channel you want to move in the list and confirm with OK/ MENU. > The selected channel is highlighted. 2. Turn TUNE to the new location in the list and confirm with OK/MENU. > The channels change places with each other. After the preset channels (max. 30) come all the other channels available in the area. It is possible to move a channel up to a place in the preset list. Save the available TV channels as presets If the car has been moved within the country, for example, from one city to another, it is not certain that the presets are available at the new location as the frequency range may have changed. In which case, carry out another scan and save a new preset list. 1. Press TV mode on OK/MENU. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 423 11 Audio and media || 2. Turn TUNE to TV menu and press OK/ MENU. 11 Information about the current TV* programme 3. Turn TUNE to Autostore and press OK/ MENU. > An automatic scan for available TV channels starts, this scan takes a little while. During this time the figure for each channel found and added as a preset is shown. When the scan is complete a message is shown and the picture is shown. A preset list (max. 30 presets) has now been created and is available. To change channel, see TV* (p. 421). Press the INFO button (p. 372) in order to display information about the current programme, the next programme and its start time. Scanning the TV channels Related information This function automatically scans through the frequency range for all channels available in the area where you are. When a channel is found, it is shown for approx. 10 seconds before scanning is resumed. Scanning is stopped with EXIT, then the channel that you just watched continues to be shown. Scanning does not affect the preset list. If the INFO button is pressed once more then additional information on the current programme can sometimes be displayed, such as start and end times and a brief description of the current programme. To return to the TV picture, wait several seconds or press EXIT. • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • TV* (p. 421) Activate scanning in TV mode under TV menu Scan. Related information • • • 424 Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) TV* (p. 421) Searching TV* channels/Preset list (p. 423) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Teletext* It is possible to look at Teletext. Proceed as follows: 1. Press the control. button on the remote 2. Enter the page number (3 digits) with the number keys (0-9) to select page. > The page is shown automatically. Enter new page number, or press the remote / to go to the next control buttons page. Return to TV screen with EXIT or by pressing the button on the remote control. It is also possible to control the teletext with the coloured buttons on the remote control. Related information • • • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) TV* (p. 421) Remote control* (p. 425) 11 Audio and media Reception of TV* channel is lost. Remote control* If the reception for the TV channel that is being shown disappears then the picture will freeze. When the reception returns the display starts again. The remote control can be used for all functions in the audio and media system. The remote control's buttons have similar functions as the buttons on the centre console or the steering wheel keypad. If the reception for the TV channel that is being shown disappears then the picture will freeze. Shortly after this a message appears informing that the reception has been lost for the current TV channel, and a new search for the channel continues. When the reception returns the display of the TV channel starts immediately. It is possible to change channel at any time when the message is shown. 11 If the message Reception lost, searching is shown then this is because the system has detected that there is no reception for all TV channels. One possible reason may be that a border has been crossed and that the system is set to the wrong country. In which case, change to the right country in accordance with Searching TV* channels/Preset list (p. (p. 423)). Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • TV* (p. 421) Corresponds to TUNE in the centre console. When using the remote control, first press the to position F. remote control's button * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 425 11 Audio and media || Then aim the remote control at the IR receiver, which is located to the right of the INFO button (p. 372) in the centre console. Remote control* - functions Possible functions to be controlled using the remote control*. WARNING Keep loose objects such as mobile phones, cameras, remote controls for accessories, etc. in the glove compartment or other compartments. Otherwise they may injure people in the car in the event of sudden braking or a collision. 11 NOTE Do not expose the remote control to direct sunlight (e.g. on the instrument panel) otherwise problems may arise with the batteries. Related information • • • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) Remote control* - functions (p. 426) Remote control* - battery replacement (p. 427) Key Confirm selection or go to the menu system for the selected source Change to navigation* Volume, decrease Change to radio source (AM, FM1 etc.) Change to Bluetooth® handsfree* Scroll/fast rewind, change track/ song. Play/pause Stop Menu To previous, cancels function, deletes input characters * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Navigate right/left F = Front display screen Change to media source (Disc, TV* etc.) Function Navigate up/down Function Scroll/fast forward, change track/song 426 Key Volume, increase 0-9 Preset channels, number and letter input Shortcuts for favourite setting Information about the current programme, song, etc. Also used when there is more information available than can be shown in the display screen Selection of language for soundtrack Subtitles, selection of language for text Teletext*, On/Off 11 Audio and media Related information • Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) • Remote control* (p. 425) Remote control* - battery replacement NOTE Be sure to dispose of the exhausted batteries in an environmentally safe manner. How to replace the batteries in the remote control for the audio and media system Related information NOTE • Battery life is normally 1-4 years and depends on how much the remote control is used. Remote control* (p. 425) 11 The remote control is powered by four batteries of the AA/LR6 type. Take along extra batteries for a long journey. 1. Push down the catch on the battery cover and slide the battery cover in the direction of the infrared lens. 2. Remove the used batteries, turn the new batteries in accordance with the symbols in the battery compartment and fit them. 3. Refit the cover. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 427 11 Audio and media Audio and media - menu overview Menu overview - AM Overview of possible options and settings in the audio and media system. Overview of possible options and settings for AM radio. RADIO 11 • • • Main menu AM See page Menu overview - FM (p. 429) Show presets (p. 381) Menu overview - Digital radio (DAB)* (p. 429) See footnote A Menu overview - AM (p. 428) Scan (p. 387) Menu overview - CD Audio (p. 431) Audio settings (p. 377) Main overview - CD/DVD Data (p. 430) See footnote B MEDIA • • • • • • • • Menu overview - DVD Video (p. 431) Sound stage Menu overview - iPod (p. 432) Menu overview - USB (p. 433) Equalizer Menu overview - AUX (p. 434) Volume compensation Menu overview - Bluetooth handsfree (p. 434) • 428 Audio and media - operating the system (p. 372) Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) (p. 378) See footnote D Menu overview - TV (p. 435) Reset all audio settings Related information • (p. 378) See footnote C Menu overview - Media Bluetooth (p. 433) TEL • Related information A B C D (p. 378) (p. 377) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. The menu options for audio settings are the same for all audio sources. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 11 Audio and media Menu overview - FM Reset all FM settings Overview of possible options and settings for FM radio. Main menu FM1/FM2 TP Audio settings See page Sound stage (p. 383) (p. 387) (p. 377) (p. 378) Menu overview - Digital radio (DAB)* Overview of possible options and settings for DAB radio*. Main menu DAB1*/DAB2* See page Ensemble learn (p. 388) PTY filtering (p. 384) See footnote B Show radio text (p. 386) Equalizer Show presets See footnote (p. 381) See footnote C A Scan (p. 387) News settings (p. 384) Advanced settings REG Alternative frequency EON Set TP favourite PTY settings Volume compensation Reset all audio settings A (p. 387) (p. 378) B C Turn off PTY filtering Show radio text (p. 385) (p. 377) Show presets (p. 381) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. A Scan (p. 387) Advanced settings (p. 386) Related information • DAB linking (p. 384) Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) DAB band (p. 383) (p. 384) (p. 384) (p. 378) See footnote 11 Sub channels Show PTY text (p. 389) (p. 389) (p. 390) (p. 384) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 429 11 Audio and media || Reset all DAB settings Audio settings Sound stage (p. 390) (p. 377) (p. 378) See footnote B 11 Equalizer Reset all audio settings A B C CD/DVDA Main menu (Disc menu) Play (p. 378) See footnote C Volume compensation Main overview - CD/DVD Data (p. 378) (p. 377) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Related information • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Data (p. 419) Pause Stop (p. 419) Random (p. 392) Repeat folder (p. 420) Change subtitles (p. 419) Change audio track (p. 419) Scan (p. 421) Audio settings (p. 377) Sound stage Equalizer See footnote C 430 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Reset all audio settings See page (p. 378) See footnote B 43 Volume compensation Overview of possible options and settings for CD/DVD43 Data. (p. 378) A B C (p. 378) (p. 377) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Related information • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 11 Audio and media Menu overview - CD Audio Menu overview - DVD Video Overview of possible options and settings for CD Audio. Overview of possible options and settings for DVD44 Video. Main menu CD Audio (Disc menu) See page Main menu (Disc menu) Random (p. 392) DVD disc menu (p. 392) Scan (p. 421) Play/Pause/Continue (p. 392) Audio settings (p. 377) Stop (p. 392) (p. 378) Subtitles (p. 392) Audio tracks (p. 392) Sound stage See footnote A Equalizer See footnote Video Reset all audio settings See page A Press OK/MENU when a video file is being played back or TV* is being shown in order to access the pop-up menu. Advanced settings Reset all audio settings (p. 378) (p. 377) Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Angle DivX® VOD code Audio settings Sound stage • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Equalizer Source menu (p. 374) See footnote 11 B (p. 392) C DVD disc TOP menuC (p. 392) (p. 377) (p. 378) A B C Related information See page (p. 394) DVD disc menu (p. 393) (p. 377) Image settings See footnote (p. 393) (p. 378) Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Pop-up menuA*video and TV* B Volume compensation A B (p. 378) DVDA Volume compensation Only applies when playing back videos or displaying TV. What is shown in the pop-up menu for the source menu depends on what is being played back or displayed, it can be e.g. CD/DVD data menu or USB menu. Only applies to DVD video discs. (p. 378) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 431 11 Audio and media || Related information • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Menu overview - iPod Related information Overview of possible options and settings for iPod®45. 11 Main menu iPodA See page Random (p. 392) Scan (p. 421) Audio settings (p. 377) Sound stage (p. 378) See footnote B Equalizer (p. 378) See footnote C Volume compensation Reset all audio settings A B C 44 45 432 Does not apply to Performance. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. (p. 378) (p. 377) • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) 11 Audio and media Menu overview - USB Equalizer Overview of possible options and settings for USB46. Main menu USBA See page Play (p. 396) See footnote C Volume compensation Reset all audio settings Pause Stop (p. 396) Random (p. 392) Repeat folder (p. 396) Select USB device (p. 395) Change subtitles (p. 396) Change audio track (p. 396) Scan (p. 421) Audio settings (p. 377) Sound stage (p. 378) (p. 378) A B C (p. 378) (p. 377) Does not apply to Performance. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Related information • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Menu overview - Media Bluetooth Overview of possible options and settings for Media Bluetooth®47. Main menu Media BluetoothA See page Random (p. 392) Change device (p. 402) Remove Bluetooth device (p. 403) Scan (p. 421) Bluetooth software version in car (p. 406) Audio settings (p. 377) Sound stage 11 (p. 378) See footnote B Equalizer (p. 378) See footnote C See footnote B 46 47 Does not apply to Performance. Does not apply to Performance. 433 11 Audio and media || Volume compensation Reset all audio settings 11 A B C (p. 378) (p. 377) Menu overview - AUX Menu overview - Bluetooth handsfree Overview of possible options and settings for AUX. Overview of possible options and settings for Bluetooth® handsfree48. Does not apply to Performance. Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Main menu AUX See page AUX input volume (p. 398) Audio settings (p. 377) Related information • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Sound stage (p. 378) See footnote A Equalizer Reset all audio settings A B See page All calls (p. 404) All calls Missed calls (p. 378) Answered calls See footnote B Volume compensation Main menu Bluetooth® handsfreeA (Phone menu) (p. 378) Dialled calls (p. 377) Call duration Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. Phone book Search Related information 48 434 Does not apply to Performance. • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) New contact • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Speed dials (p. 404) (p. 404) (p. 404) (p. 404) (p. 404) (p. 406) (p. 409) (p. 410) (p. 411) 11 Audio and media Receive vCard Memory status Clear phone book Change phone Remove Bluetooth device (p. 412) Voicemail number Disconnect phone (p. 412) (p. 412) A (p. 404) (p. 402) Menu overview - TV Overview of possible options and settings for TV*. Does not apply to Performance. Related information Sounds and volume See page Select country (p. 423) (p. 402) • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) Reorganise presets (p. 423) (p. 403) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) Autostore (p. 423) Scan (p. 423) Audio settings (p. 377) Phone settings Discoverable Main menu TV* (p. 400) (p. 405) Sound stage 11 (p. 378) See footnote A Download phone book Bluetooth software version in car (p. 406) Equalizer (p. 406) See footnote B Volume compensation Call options Auto answer (p. 378) Reset all audio settings (p. 404) A B (p. 378) (p. 377) Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia. Does not apply to Performance. * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 435 11 Audio and media || Pop-up menuA*video and TV* Press OK/MENU when a video file is being played back or TV* is being shown in order to access the pop-up menu. 11 See page Image settings (p. 394) Source menu (p. 374) See footnote B DVD disc menu See footnote DVD disc TOP menuC A B C (p. 392) C (p. 392) Only applies when playing back videos or displaying TV. What is shown in the pop-up menu for the source menu depends on what is being played back or displayed, it can be e.g. CD/DVD data menu or USB menu. Only applies to DVD video discs. Related information 436 • Audio and media - menu overview (p. 428) • Audio and media - menu navigation (p. 374) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. SPECIFICATIONS 12 Specifications Type designations Label location 12 438 Type designation, vehicle identification number, etc., i.e. information unique to the car, can be read on a label in the car. 12 Specifications Knowing the car's type designation, vehicle identification and engine numbers can facilitate all contact with an authorised Volvo dealer regarding the car and when ordering spare parts and accessories. Type designation, vehicle identification number, maximum permissible weights, codes for colour and upholstery and type approval number. The label is visible when the right rear door is opened. Label for A/C system. Label for parking heater. NOTE It is not intended that the decals illustrated in the owner's manual should be exact replicas of those in the car. They are included to show their approximate appearance and location in the car. The information that applies to your particular car is available on the respective decals for your car. Related information • • Weights (p. 441) Engine specifications (p. 445) 12 Engine code and engine serial number. Label for engine oil. Gearbox type designation and serial number. Manual gearbox Automatic gearbox Car's identification number. (VIN Vehicle Identification Number) Further information on the car is presented in the registration document. 439 12 Specifications Dimensions Measurement of car length, height, etc. can be read in the table. 12 440 Dimensions mm A Wheelbase 2646 B Length 4370 C Load length, floor, folded rear seat D Load length, floor E Height F Load height Dimensions G H Front track Rear track 1508 684 1458 532 mm Load width, floor J Width mm 1552A K Width including door mirrors 2041 1547B L Width including folded-in door mirrors 1857 1540A 1535B I Dimensions 960 1802 A B Offset 50 mm. Offset 52.5 mm. 12 Specifications Weights WARNING Max. gross vehicle weight, etc. can be read on a label in the car. The car's driving characteristics change depending on how heavily it is loaded and how the load is distributed. Kerb weight includes the driver, the fuel tank 90% full and all fluids. The weight of passengers and accessories, and towball load (p. 442) (when a trailer is hitched) influence the load capacity and are not included in the kerb weight. Permitted max. load = Gross vehicle weight Kerb weight. 12 NOTE The documented kerb weight applies to cars in the standard version - i.e. a car without extra equipment or accessories. This means that for every accessory added the loading capacity of the car is reduced correspondingly by the weight of the accessory. Examples of accessories that reduce loading capacity are the Kinetic/Momentum/ Summum equipment levels, as well as other accessories such as Towbar, Load carrier, Space box, Audio system, Auxiliary lamps, GPS, Fuel-driven heater, Safety grille, Carpets, Luggage cover, Power seats, etc. Weighing the car is a certain way of ascertaining the kerb weight of your own particular car. For information on label location, see Type designations (p. 438). Max. gross vehicle weight Max. train weight (car+trailer) Max. front axle load Max. rear axle load Equipment level Max. load: See registration document. Max. roof load: 75 kg. Related information • Towing capacity and towball load (p. 442) 441 12 Specifications Towing capacity and towball load Towing capacity and towball load for driving with a trailer can be read in the tables. Max. weight braked trailer 12 A 442 Engine Engine codeA Gearbox Max. weight braked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg) T4 B4164T Manual, B6 1300 75 T4 B4164T Automatic, MPS6 1500 75 T4 B5204T8 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T4 AWD B5204T8 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 B5204T9 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 AWD B5204T9 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 B5254T12 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 AWD B5254T12 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 B5254T14 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 T5 AWD B5254T14 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 D2 D4162T Manual, B6 1300 75 D2 D4162T Automatic, MPS6 1300 75 D3 D5204T6 Manual, M66 1500 75 D3 D5204T6 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 D4 D5204T4 Manual, M66 1500 75 D4 D5204T4 Automatic, TF-80SD 1500 75 Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 438). 12 Specifications Max. weight unbraked trailer A Engine Engine codeA Gearbox Max. weight unbraked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg) T4 B4164T Manual, B6 650 50 T4 B4164T Automatic, MPS6 700 50 T4 B5204T8 Automatic, TF-80SD 700 50 T4 AWD B5204T8 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 T5 B5204T9 Automatic, TF-80SD 700 50 T5 AWD B5204T9 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 T5 B5254T12 Automatic, TF-80SD 700 50 T5 AWD B5254T12 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 T5 B5254T14 Automatic, TF-80SD 700 50 T5 AWD B5254T14 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 D2 D4162T Manual, B6 650 50 D2 D4162T Automatic, MPS6 700 50 D3 D5204T6 Manual, M66 700 50 D3 D5204T6 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 D4 D5204T4 Manual, M66 700 50 D4 D5204T4 Automatic, TF-80SD 750 50 12 Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 438). }} 443 12 Specifications || Related information • • • 12 444 Weights (p. 441) Driving with a trailer (p. 301) Trailer Stability Assist - TSA (p. 307) 12 Specifications Engine specifications Engine specifications (output etc.) for each respective engine alternative can be read in the table. NOTE Not all engines are available in all markets. Engine Engine codeA Output (kW/rpm) Output (hp/rpm) Torque (Nm/ rpm) No. of cylinders Bore (mm) Stroke (mm) Swept volume (litres) Compression ratio T4 B4164T 132/5700 180/5700 240/1600–5000 4 79 81,4 1,596 10,0:1 T4 B5204T8 132/5000 180/5000 300/2700–4000 5 81,0 77 1,984 10.5:1 T5 B5204T9 157/6000 213/6000 300/2700–5000 5 81,0 77 1,984 10.5:1 T5 B5254T12 187/5400 254/5400 360/1800–4200 5 83 92,3 2,497 9.5:1 T5 B5254T14 183/5400 249/5400 360/1800–4200 5 83 92,3 2,497 9.5:1 D2 D4162T 84/3600 115/3600 270/1750-2500 4 75 88,3 1,560 16,0:1 D3 D5204T6 110/3500 150/3500 350/1500-2750 5 81,0 77 1,984 16,5:1 D4 D5204T4 130/3500 177/3500 400/1750-2750 5 81,0 77 1,984 16,5:1 A 12 Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 438). Related information • • Coolant - grade and volume (p. 449) Engine oil - grade and volume (p. 447) 445 12 Specifications Engine oil - adverse driving conditions Related information • • Adverse driving conditions can lead to abnormally high oil temperature or oil consumption. Below are some examples of adverse driving conditions. Check the oil level (p. 337), more frequently for long journeys: 12 • • • • towing a caravan or trailer in mountainous regions at high speeds in temperatures colder than -30 °C or hotter than +40 °C The above also apply to shorter driving distances at low temperatures. Choose a fully synthetic engine oil for adverse driving conditions. It provides extra protection for the engine. Volvo recommends: IMPORTANT In order to fulfil the requirements for the engine's service intervals all engines are filled with a specially adapted synthetic engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil has been made very carefully with regard to service life, starting characteristics, fuel consumption and environmental impact. An approved engine oil must be used in order that the recommended service intervals can be applied. Only use a prescribed grade of oil for both filling and oil change, otherwise you will risk affecting service life, starting characteristics, fuel consumption and environmental impact. Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all warranty liability if engine oil of the prescribed grade and viscosity is not used. Volvo recommends that oil changes are carried out at an authorised Volvo workshop. 446 Engine oil - grade and volume (p. 447) Engine oil - general (p. 336) 12 Specifications Engine oil - grade and volume Recommended engine oil grade and volume for each respective engine alternative can be read in the table. Volvo recommends: 12 Engine Engine codeA Oil grade Volume, incl. oil filter (litres) Certified and factory-filled oil: Oil grade WSS-M2C925-A T4 B4164T options for service: Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 approx. 4.1 Viscosity: SAE 5W–30 Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 D2 D4162T Viscosity: SAE 5W–30 approx. 3.8 When driving under adverse conditions, use ACEA A5/B5 SAE 0W-30. D3 D4 D5204T6 Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 approx. 5.9 D5204T4 Viscosity: SAE 0W–30 approx. 5.9 }} 447 12 Specifications || Engine Engine codeA Oil grade Volume, incl. oil filter (litres) B5204T8 Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 approx 5.5 T5 B5204T9 Viscosity: SAE 0W–30 approx 5.5 T5 B5254T12 approx 5.5 T5 B5254T14 approx 5.5 T4 A Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 438). Related information 12 448 • Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446) • Engine oil - checking and filling (p. 337) 12 Specifications Coolant - grade and volume Approved coolant volume for each respective engine alternative can be read in the table. Prescribed grade: Coolant recommended by Volvo mixed with 50% water1, see the packaging. EngineA Volume (litres) T4 B4164T 7,0 D2 D4162T 10,0 D3 D5204T6 D4 D5204T4 T4 B5204T8 T5 B5204T9 T5 B5254T12 T5 B5254T14 12 8,0 8,0 Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine; see Type designations (p. 438). A Related information • 1 Coolant - level (p. 340) Water quality must fulfil the standard STD 1285.1. 449 12 Specifications Transmission fluid - grade and volume The prescribed transmission fluid and volume for each respective gearbox alternative can be read in the table. Manual gearbox Manual gearbox Volume (litres) B6 1,6 M66 1,9 Prescribed transmission fluid BOT 350M3 Automatic gearbox 12 Automatic gearbox Prescribed transmission fluid TF-80SD 7,0 AW1 MPS6 7.3 BOT 341 NOTE Under normal driving conditions, the gearbox oil does not need to be changed during its service life. However, it may be necessary under adverse driving conditions. Related information 450 Volume (litres) • Engine oil - adverse driving conditions (p. 446) • Type designations (p. 438) 12 Specifications Brake fluid - grade and volume Washer fluid - quality and volume The medium in a hydraulic brake system is called brake fluid, and it is used to transfer force from e.g. a brake pedal via a master brake cylinder to one or more slave cylinders, which in turn act on a mechanical brake. Washer fluid is used, together with windscreen and rear window wipers (p. 93) to keep the car's windows and headlamps clean and ensure visibility when driving. Prescribed grade: DOT 4 Volume: 0.6 litres Related information • Brake and clutch fluid - level (p. 341) Prescribed grade: Washer fluid recommended by Volvo - with frost protection during cold weather and below freezing point. Volume: • • Cars with headlamp washing: 5.5 litres. Cars without headlamp washing: 3.2 litres. 12 Related information • • Washer fluid - filling (p. 351) Wiper blades (p. 349) 451 12 Specifications Fuel tank - volume Fuel tank volume for each respective engine alternative can be read in the table. Engine 4-cylinder petrol Volume (litres) approx 62 Prescribed grade Petrol: Fuel - petrol (p. 298) 5-cylinder petrol (FWD) 12 5-cylinder petrol (AWD) approx. 57 4-cylinder diesel approx 52 5-cylinder diesel approx 60 Related information • • 452 Filling up with fuel (p. 296) Engine specifications (p. 445) Diesel: Fuel - diesel (p. 298) 12 Specifications Air conditioning, fluid - volume and grade The prescribed grade and volume of fluids in the air conditioning system can be read in the table. Fluid Compressor oil Coolant WARNING The air conditioning system contains pressurised refrigerant R134a. This system must only be serviced and repaired by an authorised workshop. Volume (litres) Prescribed grade 0,11 PAG oil 0,65 kg R134a 12 Related information • Climate control system - fault tracing and repair (p. 341) 453 12 Specifications Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions Fuel consumption in a vehicle is measured in litres per 100 km and CO2 emissions in grams per km. T4 (B4164T) 164 7,0 109 4,7 129 5,5 T4 (B4164T) 184 7.9 120 5.1 143 6.1 T4 AWD (B5204T8) 259 11.1 146 6.3 187 8,0 T5 (B5204T9) 243 10,4 135 5.8 174 7,5 T5 AWD (B5204T9) 259 11.1 146 6.3 187 8,0 T5 (B5254T12) 259 11.1 138 5.9 182 7.8 T5 AWD (B5254T12) 270 11,6 150 6.4 194 8.3 D2 (D4162T) 110 4,2 93 3,5 99 3,8 12 454 12 Specifications D2 (D4162T) 118 4,5 103 3.9 108 4.1 D3 (D5204T6) 140 5,3 103 3.9 117 4,4 D3 (D5204T6) 178 6,8 114 4,3 137 5,2 D4 (D5204T4) 140 5,3 103 3.9 117 4,4 D4 (D5204T4) 178 6,8 114 4,3 137 5,2 Explanation Extra-urban driving gram/km Combined driving litre/100 km Urban driving 2 Fuel consumption and emission values in the table above are based on specific EU cycles2, that apply to cars with kerb weight in the 12 basic version and without extra equipment. The car's weight may increase depending on equipment. This, as well as how heavily the car is loaded, increases fuel consumption and carbon dioxide emissions. See information about Weights (p. 441). Official fuel consumption figures are based on two standardised driving cycles in a laboratory environment ("EU driving cycles") all in accordance with EU Regulation no 692/2008 and 715/2007 (Euro 5 / Euro 6) and UN ECE Regulation no 101. The regulations cover the driving cycles for city driving and driving on main roads. - City driving - the measurement starts with cold starting the engine. The driving is simulated. - Driving on main roads - the car is accelerated and braked at speeds between 0-120 km/h. The driving is simulated. - Cars with manual transmission are started in 2nd gear. The value for combined driving, which is reported in the table, is a combination of city driving and driving on main roads, in accordance with legal requirements. CO2 emissions - the exhaust gases are collected in order to calculate the carbon dioxide emissions during the two driving cycles. These are then analysed and give the value for CO2 emissions. }} 455 12 Specifications || There are several reasons for increased fuel consumption compared with the table's values. Examples of this are: • • • • 12 NOTE Extreme weather conditions, driving with a trailer or driving at high altitudes in combination with fuel grade are factors that could affect the car's performance. The driver's driving style. If the customer has specified wheels larger than those fitted as standard on the model's basic version, then resistance increases. High speed results in increased wind resistance. Fuel quality, road and traffic conditions, weather and the condition of the car. Related information • • • Economical driving (p. 300) Fuel - petrol (p. 298) Fuel - diesel (p. 298) Even a combination of the above-mentioned examples can result in significantly improved consumption. For further information, please refer to the regulations referred to2. Large deviations in fuel consumption may arise in a comparison with the EU driving cycles2 which are used in the certification of the car and on which the consumption figures in the table are based. Consumption is higher and power output lower for fuel with an octane rating of 91 RON. 2 456 Official fuel consumption figures are based on two standardised driving cycles in a laboratory environment ("EU driving cycles") all in accordance with EU Regulation no 692/2008 and 715/2007 (Euro 5 / Euro 6) and UN ECE Regulation no 101. The regulations cover the driving cycles for city driving and driving on main roads. - City driving - the measurement starts with cold starting the engine. The driving is simulated. - Driving on main roads - the car is accelerated and braked at speeds between 0-120 km/h. The driving is simulated. - Cars with manual transmission are started in 2nd gear. The value for combined driving, which is reported in the table, is a combination of city driving and driving on main roads, in accordance with legal requirements. CO2 emissions - the exhaust gases are collected in order to calculate the carbon dioxide emissions during the two driving cycles. These are then analysed and give the value for CO2 emissions. 12 Specifications Tyres - approved tyre pressures Approved tyre pressures for each respective engine alternative can be read in the table. Engine Tyre size 205/60 R16 All Speed Load, 1 - 3 persons Max. load (km/h) Front Rear Front Rear Front/rear (kPa)B (kPa) (kPa) (kPa) (kPa) 0 - 160 240 230 260 260 260 160 + 260 240 280 280 – max. 80 420 420 420 420 – ECO pressureA 225/50 R17 225/45 R18 225/40 R19 Temporary Spare Tyre A B 12 Economical driving. In certain countries there is the "bar" unit beside the SI unit "Pascal": 1 bar = 100 kPa. NOTE All engines, tyres or combinations of these are not always available in all markets. Related information • • • Tyres - dimensions (p. 316) Tyres - air pressure (p. 322) Type designations (p. 438) 457 12 Specifications Electrical system The electrical system is single-pole and uses the chassis and engine casing as a conductor. The car has a voltage-regulated AC alternator. The size, type and performance of the starter battery depend on the car's equipment and function. IMPORTANT If the battery is replaced, take care to replace it with a battery with the same cold starting capacity, reserve capacity and type as the original battery (see the label on the battery). 12 Related information • • • 458 Starter battery - specification (p. 459) Starter battery - replacement (p. 353) Starter battery (p. 351) 12 Specifications Starter battery - specification The starter battery is used to drive the starter motor and other electrical equipment in the car. Engine A B Voltage (V) Cold start capacity, Reserve capacity CCA - Cold Cranking Amperes (A) (minutes) Petrol 12 520–800 100–160 Diesel 12 700–800 135–160 Petrol/Diesel, manual gearbox with Start/Stop function 12 720A 130 Petrol/Diesel, automatic gearbox with Start/Stop function 12 800B 140 12 Battery type EFB (Enhanced Flooded Battery) must be used in cars with manual gearbox and the Start/Stop function. Battery type AGM (Absorbed Glass Mat) must be used in cars with automatic gearbox and the Start/Stop function. IMPORTANT If the battery is replaced, take care to replace it with a battery with the same cold starting capacity, reserve capacity and type as the original battery (see the label on the battery). Related information • • • Starter battery - replacement (p. 353) Starter battery (p. 351) Battery - Start/Stop (p. 353) NOTE • The battery's container size should be consistent with the original battery's dimensions. • The battery's height is different depending on size. 459 12 Specifications Type approval - remote control key system Type approval for the remote control key system can be read in the table. Country/Area China Lock system, standard Country/Area EU, China Hong Kong 12 Keyless lock system (Keyless drive) Country/Area EU Korea 460 Related information • Remote control key with key blade (p. 159) Type approval - radar system Type approval for the radar system can be read in the table. 12 Specifications Country/ Area Singapore IDA: Infocomm Development Authority of Singapore. Brazil 12 Europe Delphi Electronics & Safety hereby declares that L2C0038TR and L2C0049TR are in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. This declaration of conformity may, if necessary, be consulted with Delphi Electronics & Safety / One Corporate Center / Kokomo, Indiana 46904-9005 USA. Related information • Radar sensor (p. 209) 461 12 Specifications Type approval - Bluetooth® Type approval for Bluetooth® can be read in the table. 12 462 12 Specifications Declaration of Conformity (Declaration of Conformity) Country/ Area Countries in the EU: Exporting country: Japan Manufacturer: Alpine Electronics Inc. Type of equipment: Bluetooth® device For further information visit http://ec.europa.eu/enterprise/rtte/faq.htm #informing 12 }} 463 12 Specifications || Country/ Area Czech Republic: Alpine Electronics, Inc. tímto prohlašuje, že tento Bluetooth® Module je ve shodě se základními požadavky a dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES. Denmark: Undertegnede Alpine Electronics, Inc. erklærer herved, at følgende udstyr Bluetooth® Module overholder de væsentlige krav og øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF. Germany: Hiermit erklärt Alpine Electronics, Inc., dass sich das Gerät Bluetooth® Module in Übereinstimmung mit den grundlegenden Anforderungen und den übrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999/5/EG befindet. Estonia: Käesolevaga kinnitab Alpine Electronics, Inc. seadme Bluetooth® Module vastavust direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele teistele asjakohastele sätetele. UK Hereby, Alpine Electronics, Inc., declares that this Bluetooth® Module is in compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. Spain: Por medio de la presente Alpine Electronics, Inc. declara que el Bluetooth® Module cumple con los requisitos esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999/5/CE. Greece: ΜΕ ΗΝ ΠΑΡΟ ΣΑ Alpine Electronics, Inc. ΗΛΩΝΕ Ο Bluetooth® Module Σ ΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕ Α ΠΡΟΣ ΑΠΑ ΗΣΕ Σ Α Σ ΛΟ ΠΕΣ ΣΧΕ ΕΣ Α ΑΞΕ Σ ΗΣ Ο Η ΑΣ 1999/5/Ε . France: Par la présente Alpine Electronics, Inc. déclare que l'appareil Bluetooth® Module est conforme aux exigences essentielles et aux autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE. Italy: Con la presente Alpine Electronics, Inc. dichiara che questo Bluetooth® Module è conforme ai requisiti essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE. Latvia: Ar šo Alpine Electronics, Inc. deklarē, ka Bluetooth® Module atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām prasībām un citiem ar to saistītajiem noteikumiem. Lithuania: Šiuo Alpine Electronics, Inc. deklaruoja, kad šis Bluetooth® Module atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas 1999/5/EB Direktyvos nuostatas. 12 464 ΣΟ ΣΩ ΕΣ 12 Specifications Country/ Area Netherlands: Hierbij verklaart Alpine Electronics, Inc. dat het toestel Bluetooth® Module in overeenstemming is met de essentiële eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG. Malta: Hawnhekk, Alpine Electronics, Inc., jiddikjara li dan Bluetooth® Module jikkonforma mal-ħtiġijiet essenzjali u ma provvedimenti oħrajn relevanti li hemm fid-Dirrettiva 1999/5/EC. Hungary: Alulírott, Alpine Electronics, Inc. nyilatkozom, hogy a Bluetooth® Module megfelel a vonatkozó alapvetõ követelményeknek és az 1999/5/EC irányelv egyéb elõírásainak. Poland: Niniejszym Alpine Electronics, Inc. oświadcza, że Bluetooth® Module jest zgodny z zasadniczymi wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC. Bluetooth® Portugal: Alpine Electronics, Inc. declara que este Directiva 1999/5/CE. Slovenia: Alpine Electronics, Inc. izjavlja, da je ta Bluetooth® Module v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES. Slovakia: Alpine Electronics, Inc. týmto vyhlasuje, že Bluetooth® Module spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky príslušné ustanovenia Smernice 1999/5/ES. Finland: Alpine Electronics, Inc. vakuuttaa täten että Bluetooth® Module tyyppinen laite on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten ja sitä koskevien direktiivin muiden ehtojen mukainen. Sweden: Härmed intygar Alpine Electronics, Inc. att denna Bluetooth® Module står I överensstämmelse med de väsentliga egenskapskrav och övriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgår av direktiv 1999/5/EG. Iceland: Alpine Electronics, Inc. hereby certifies that this Bluetooth® Module conforms to the essential characteristic requirements and other relevant regulations of directive 1999/5/EC. Norway: Alpine Electronics, Inc. erklærer herved at utstyret Bluetooth® Module er i samsvar med de grunnleggende krav og øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF. 12 Module está conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras disposições da }} 465 12 Specifications || Country/ Area China: 第十三条 进口和生产厂商在其产品的说明书或使用手册中,应刊印下述有关内容 1. 标明附件中所规定的技术指标和使用范围,说明所有控制 ■ 使用频率 2.4 - 2.4835 GHz ■ 等效全向辐射 ■ 最大 率(EIRP) 率谱密度 ■ 载频容限 • • • • • 天线增益 天线增益 10dBi 时 ≤100 mW 或≤20 dBm ① ≤20 dBm / MHz(EIRP) ① 率(对应载波±2.5 倍信道带宽以外) ≤-36 dBm / 100 kHz (30 - 1000 MHz) ≤-33 dBm / 100 kHz (2.4 - 2.4835 GHz) ≤-40 dBm / 1 MHz (3.4 - 3.53 GHz) ≤-40 dBm / 1 MHz (5.725 - 5.85 GHz) ≤-30 dBm / 1 MHz (其它 1 - 12.75 GHz) 2. 不得擅自更改发射频率 大发射 率(包括额外 3. 使用时不得对各种合法的无线电通信业 继续使用 4. 使用微 率无线电设备,必须忍 5. 不得在飞机和机场附近使用 466 10dBi 时 20 ppm ■ 杂散发射(辐射) 12 调整及开关等使用方法 装射频 产生有害干扰 各种无线电业 率放大器),不得擅自外接天线或改用其它发射天线 一旦发现有干扰现象时,应立即停止使用,并采 的干扰或工业 科学及医疗应用设备的辐射干扰 措施消除干扰后方可 12 Specifications Country/ Area Taiwan: 低効率電波輻射性電機管理辧法第十条 第十二條 經型式認證合格之低功率射頻電機,非經許可,公司 商號或使用者均不得擅自 變更頻率 加大功率或變更原設計之特性及功能 第十四條 低功率射頻電機之使用不得影響飛航安全及干擾合法通信;經發現有干擾現象時, 應立即停用,並改善至無干擾時方得繼續使用 前項合法通信,指依電信法規定 作業之無線電通信 低功率射頻電機須忍受合法通信或工業 科學及醫療用電波 輻射性電機設備之 干擾 12 }} 467 12 Specifications || Country/ Area South Korea: 제품 정보 Volvo Car Korea 신청자 코드: KCC-CMM-N25-IAM21L3, KCC-CMM-N25-IAM21L2 and KCC-CMM-N25-IAM21L1 제품 명: Bluetooth Audio Navigation Radio 모델 명: IAM2.1 산 날짜: March/2010 Alpine Electronics, Inc 12 Made in Japan 고객 정보 Volvo Car Korea 볼보자동차코리아 서울시 용산구 한남 2 동 726-173 볼보빌딩 4 층 볼보자동차 고객센터 1588-1777 http://www.volvocars.com/kr 사용자 주의사항 ※당해 무선설비는 전파혼신 가능성이 있으므로 인명안전과 관련된 서비스는 할 수 없습니다 468 12 Specifications Country/ Area The United Arab Emirates: South Africa: 12 Jamaica: Approved for use in Jamaica SMA EI: IAM2.1 Thailand: This telecommunication equipment conforms to NTC technical requirement. Oman Related information • • Bluetooth® handsfree phone (p. 403) Media Bluetooth®* (p. 398) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 469 12 Specifications Licenses Sensus software 12 470 This software uses parts of sources from clib2 and Prex Embedded Real-time OS Source (Copyright (c) 1982, 1986, 1991, 1993, 1994), and Quercus Robusta (Copyright (c) 1990, 1993), The Regents of the University of California. All or some portions are derived from material licensed to the University of California by American Telephone and Telegraph Co. or Unix System Laboratories, Inc. and are reproduced herein with the permission of UNIX System Laboratories, Inc. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. Neither the name of the <ORGANIZATION> nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission. THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group. This software uses parts of sources from "libtess". The Original Code is: OpenGL Sample Implementation, Version 1.2.1, released January 26, 2000, developed by Silicon Graphics, Inc. The Original Code is Copyright (c) 1991-2000 Silicon Graphics, Inc. Copyright in any portions created by third parties is as indicated elsewhere herein. All Rights Reserved. Copyright (C) [1991-2000] Silicon Graphics, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: The above copyright notice including the dates of first publication and either this permission notice or a reference to http://oss.sgi.com/ projects/FreeB/ shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of the Software. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL SILICON GRAPHICS, INC. BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE. Except as contained in this notice, the name of Silicon Graphics, Inc. shall not be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from Silicon Graphics, Inc. 12 Specifications This software is based in parts on the work of the FreeType Team. this product by VCC / or for as long as VCC offers spare parts or customer support. GNU Lesser General Public License (LGPL), etc. This software uses parts of SSLeay Library: Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]). All rights reserved Portions of this product uses software copyrighted © v2.4.3/2010 The FreeTypeProject (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved. You have the right of acquisition, modification, and distribution of the source code of the GPL/LGPL software. Combined Instrument Panel Software Open Source Software Notice This product uses certain free / open source and other software originating from third parties, that is subject to the GNU General Public License version 2 and 3 (GPLv2/ GPLv3), GNU Lesser General Public License version 3 (LGPLv3), The FreeType Project License (“FreeType License”) and other different and/or additional copyright licenses, disclaimers and notices. The links how to access the exact terms of GPLv2, GPLv3, LGPLv3, and the other open source software licenses, disclaimers, acknowledgements and notices are provided to you below. Please refer to the exact terms of the relevant License, regarding your rights under said licenses. Volvo Car Corporation (VCC) offers to provide the source code of said free/open source software to you for a charge covering the cost of performing such distribution, such as the cost of media, shipping and handling, upon written request. Please contact your nearest Volvo Dealer. This offer is valid for a period of at least three (3) years from the date of the distribution of This product includes software under following licenses: GPL v2 : http://www.gnu.org/licenses/oldlicenses/gpl-2.0.html • • • Linux kernel (merge between MontaVista 2.6.31 kernel and kernel from L2.6.31_MX51_ER_1007 BSP) uBoot (based on v2009.08) busybox (based on version 1.13.2.) GCC runtime library exception: http:// www.gnu.org/licenses/gcc-exception.html • libgcc_s.so.1 LGPL v3: http://www.gnu.org/licenses/ lgpl.html • You may download Source Code from the following website at no charge: http:// www.embedded-carmultimedia.jp/linux/oss/ download/TVM_8351_013 The website provides the Source Code "As Is" and without warranty of any kind. By downloading Source Code, you expressly assume all risk and liability associated with downloading and using the Source Code and complying with the user agreements that accompany each Source Code. 12 Please note that we cannot respond to any inquiries regarding the source code. DivX® Libc.so.6, libpthread.so.0, Librt.so.1 The FreeType Project License: http:// www.freetype.org/FTL.TXT • libfreetype.so.6 (version 2.4.3) Linux software This product contains software licensed under GNU General Public License (GPL) or DivX Certified® to play DivX® video. DivX®, DivX Certified® and associated logos are }} 471 12 Specifications || registered trademarks of DivX, Inc. and are used under license. ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX® is a digital video format created by DivX, Inc. This is an official DivX Certified device that plays DivX video. Visit www.divx.com for more information and software tools to convert your files into DivX video. 12 ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: This DivX Certified® device must be registered in order to play DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD) content. To generate the registration code, locate the DivX VOD section in the device setup menu. Go to http://vod.divx.com with this code to complete the registration process and learn more about DivX VOD. Covered by one or more of the following U.S. Patents: 7,295,673; 7,460,668; 7,515,710; 7,519,274. Related information • Volvo Sensus (p. 70) Symbols in the display There are a variety of different symbols in the display in the car. The symbols are divided into warning, indicator and information symbols. Shown below are the most common symbols with their meanings and a reference to where in the manual further information can be found. - Red warning symbol, illuminates when a fault has been indicated which could affect the safety and/or driveability of the car. An explanatory text is shown in the combined instrument panel at the same time. - Information symbol, illuminates in combination with text in the combined instrument panel, when a deviation in any of the car's systems has occurred. The yellow symbol information can also illuminate in combination with other symbols. Warning symbols in the combined instrument panel Symbol 472 Symbol * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Specification See Low oil pressure (p. 66) Parking brake applied, digital instrument (p. 66), (p. 292) Specification See Parking brake applied, analogue instrument (p. 66) Airbags – SRS (p. 28), (p. 66) Seatbelt reminder (p. 24), (p. 66) Alternator not charging (p. 66) Fault in brake system (p. 66), (p. 289) Warning, safety mode (p. 28), (p. 38), (p. 66) Control symbols in the combined instrument panel Symbol Specification See ABL fault* (p. 65), (p. 84) Emissions system (p. 65) ABS fault (p. 65), (p. 289) Rear fog lamp on (p. 65), (p. 85) 12 Specifications Symbol Specification See Stability system, DSTC, Trailer stability assist* (p. 65), (p. 187), (p. 307) Stability system, sport mode (p. 65), (p. 187) Engine preheater (diesel) (p. 65) Low level in fuel tank (p. 65), (p. 142) Information, read display text Information symbols in the combined instrument panel Symbol Specification See Main beam with auto dimming AHB* (p. 83) Camera sensor* (p. 83) Adaptive cruise control* (p. 212) (p. 65) Adaptive cruise control* (p. 203), (p. 212) Main beam On (p. 65), (p. 82) (p. 212), (p. 214) Left-hand direction indicators (p. 65) Adaptive cruise control*, Distance Warning* (Distance Alert) (p. 202) Right-hand direction indicators (p. 65) Adaptive cruise control* Adaptive cruise control* (p. 203) Start/Stop*, engine autostopped (p. 65), (p. 280) Cruise control* (p. 194) Speed limiter (p. 191) Radar sensor* (p. 212), (p. 216), (p. 233) Symbol Specification See Start/Stop* (p. 286) Start/Stop* (p. 286) Start/Stop* (p. 286) Start/Stop* (p. 286) Camera sensor*, Laser sensor* (p. 222), (p. 233), (p. 237), (p. 243) Distance warning* (Distance Alert), City SafetyTM, Collision warning system*, Auto-brake* (p. 216), (p. 222), (p. 233) Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater* (p. 142) 12 }} * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 473 12 Specifications || Symbol 12 474 Specification See Activated timer* (p. 142) Symbol Specification See Gear indicator, manual gearbox (p. 272) Activated timer* (p. 142) Automatic gear positions (p. 273) ABL system* (p. 84) Registered speed information* (p. 188) Low battery (p. 142) Measuring the oil level (p. 337) Park Assist Pilot PAP* (p. 253) Rain sensor* (p. 93) Lane Keeping Aid* Information symbols in the roof console display Symbol Specification See (p. 241) Seatbelt reminder (p. 27) Driver Alert System*, Lane Keeping Aid* (p. 237), (p. 243) Airbag, passenger seat, activated (p. 31) Driver Alert System*, Time for a break (p. 236), (p. 237) Airbag, passenger seat, deactivated (p. 31) * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. Related information • Combined instrument panel - meaning of indicator symbols (p. 65) • Combined instrument cluster - meaning of warning symbols (p. 66) • Messages - handling (p. 104) 12 Specifications 12 475 13 Alphabetical Index A ACC – Adaptive cruise control................. 199 Active Bending Lights (ABL)...................... 84 Active high beam....................................... 83 Active Park Assist.................................... function............................................... Limitations.......................................... operation............................................. Symbols and messages..................... 13 253 253 256 254 257 Alarm for accidents and disasters........... 383 Airbag activating/deactivating, PACOS........... 31 driver's side.................................... 30, 37 passenger side......................... 30, 31, 37 Alcolock................................................... 264 AIRBAG ..................................................... 30 Airbag system............................................ 29 warning symbol.................................... 28 Active Xenon headlamps........................... 84 Air cleaning material............................................... 129 passenger compartment.... 127, 128, 129 Active Yaw Control.................................. 185 Air conditioning........................................ 135 Adapting driving characteristics.............. 262 Air conditioning, fluid volume and grade............................... 453 Adaptive Cruise Control........................... change cruise control functionality..... deactivate........................................... fault tracing......................................... function............................................... managing speed................................. overtaking........................................... overview.............................................. radar sensor........................................ setting the time interval...................... standby mode..................................... temporary deactivation....................... 199 208 206 211 200 203 205 202 209 204 204 204 Additional heater electric........................................ 143, 144 fuel-driven........................................... 143 476 Adjusting the steering wheel...................... 77 Air conditioning system repair................................................... 341 Allergy and asthma inducing substances. 128 All Wheel Drive, (AWD)............................. 288 All Wheel Drive (AWD).............................. 288 Approach lighting.............................. 89, 162 Audio settings............................................... 376 surround..................................... 371, 377 Audio and media introduction......................................... manage the system............................ menu overview.................................... menus................................................. overview.............................................. 371 372 428 374 372 Audio profile............................................. 378 Air distribution.......................................... 129 Recirculation....................................... 137 table.................................................... 138 audio system functions............................................. 376 overview.............................................. 372 Air quality system IAQS........................... 128 Audio system........................................... 371 Alarm........................................ 181, 182, 183 alarm indicator.................................... 182 alarm signals....................................... 183 automatic activation........................... 182 automatic re-arming........................... 182 checking the alarm............................. 164 reduced alarm level............................ 183 remote control key not working.......... 183 Audio volume........................................... external audio source......................... phone.................................................. phone/media player............................ ring signal, phone............................... speed/noise compensation................ 372 398 405 405 405 378 Automatic car washes............................. 364 13 Alphabetical Index Automatic gearbox.......................... 273, 276 manual gear positions (Geartronic)..... 274 towing and recovery........................... 308 trailer................................................... 302 Automatic relocking................................. 174 AUX input......................................... 372, 395 AWD, All Wheel Drive............................... 288 B Backrest..................................................... 73 front seat, lowering............................... 73 Backrest rear seat, lowering...................... 76 Bag holder .............................................. 154 folding................................................. 154 Battery..................................... 294, 351, 459 jump starting....................................... 270 maintenance....................................... 351 overload.............................................. 294 remote control.................................... 427 remote control key/PCC..................... 167 specification....................................... 459 symbols on the battery....................... 352 warning symbols................................. 352 BLIS................................................. 257, 258 Bluetooth® handsfree............................................ media.................................................. microphone off................................... streaming audio.................................. transfer call to mobile......................... C 403 398 404 398 404 Calls incoming............................................. 403 operation............................................. 403 Bonnet, opening...................................... 335 Car care................................................... 364 Brake and clutch fluid.............................. 341 Car care, leather upholstery.................... 367 Brake fluid grade and volume............................... 451 Cargo area cargo net............................................. lighting.................................................. loading................................................ mounting points.................................. parcel shelf......................................... Brake light.................................................. 86 Brakes.............................................. 289, 291 Anti-lock braking system, ABS........... 291 brake light............................................. 86 brake system.............................. 289, 291 Emergency Brake Assistance, EBA ... 291 emergency brake lights........................ 86 filling brake fluid.................................. 341 handbrake........................................... 292 symbols in the combined instrument panel................................................... 290 Bulbs, see Lighting.................................. 343 Camera sensor................................ 219, 231 155 88 152 153 157 Car upholstery......................................... 367 13 Car washing............................................. 364 Catalytic converter Recovery............................................. 309 CD............................................................ 391 Changing wheels..................................... 318 Checking the engine oil level................... 336 Children child safety locks.................................. 42 child seat and airbag............................ 48 child seats and side airbags................. 34 location in car....................................... 48 safety.............................................. 34, 42 477 13 Alphabetical Index Child safety locks............................ 179, 180 Child seats................................................. ISOFIX fixture system for child seats... recommended...................................... size classes for child seats with ISOFIX fixture system................................. types..................................................... upper mounting points for child seats.. 13 42 48 44 49 50 52 Collision Warning System with Auto Brake....................................................... 223 resume set speed............................... 198 temporary deactivation....................... 197 CTA.......................................................... 260 Cyclist detection...................................... 225 CZIP (Clear Zone Interior Package)......... 128 City Safety™............................................ 217 Colour code, paint................................... 369 D Cleaning automatic car wash............................ car washing........................................ rims..................................................... seatbelts............................................. upholstery........................................... Combined instrument panel................ 60, 61 DAB Radio....................................... 379, 388 Compass................................................. 100 calibration........................................... 101 Daytime running lights............................... 81 364 364 365 368 367 Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)........ 128 Climate control actual temperature............................. auto-regulation................................... general................................................ personal preferences.......................... sensors............................................... temperature control............................ 126 134 126 129 127 135 Clock, adjustment...................................... 69 CO2 emissions......................................... 454 Collision..................................................... 38 Collision warning............................. 223, 224 478 Collision warning system function............................................... 224 general limitations............................... 229 operation............................................. 228 Pedestrian detection........................... 227 Radar sensor.............................. 209, 217 Condensation in headlamps.................... 364 Controls centre console.................................... 372 Controls, lights........................................... 78 Deadlock.................................................. 178 deactivation........................................ 178 temporary deactivation....................... 178 Defroster.................................................. 136 Control symbols................................... 61, 63 Detachable towbar storage................................................ 303 Coolant volume and grade............................... 449 Diesel....................................................... 298 run out of fuel..................................... 298 Coolant, checking and filling................... 340 Diesel particle filter.................................. 299 Cooling system........................................ 293 overheating......................................... 293 Digital radio (DAB).................................... 388 Corner Traction Control........................... 185 Dipstick, electronic.................................. 338 Crash, see Collision................................... 38 Direction indicator..................................... 87 Cruise control.......................................... 194 deactivate........................................... 199 managing speed................................. 195 Direction indicators.................................... 87 Dimensions.............................................. 440 direction of rotation................................. 312 13 Alphabetical Index Disengaging the gear selector inhibitor... 278 Display lighting.......................................... 80 Electrical socket...................................... 151 cargo area........................................... 155 Distance Warning.................................... 214 Limitations.......................................... 215 Symbols and messages..................... 216 Electrical system...................................... 458 Door mirrors............................................... 97 Emergency equipment first aid kit........................................... 324 warning triangle.................................. 323 Driver Alert Control.................................. 235 operation............................................. 236 Driver Alert System.................................. 235 Driving...................................................... cooling system.................................... with a tailer......................................... with the tailgate open......................... 295 293 301 294 Driving in water........................................ 293 Driving with a trailer towball load........................................ 442 towing capacity.................................. 442 DVD.......................................................... 391 E ECC, electronic climate control............... 131 Electronic climate control - ECC............. 131 Electronic temperature control - ETC...... 132 Emergency puncture repair............. 324, 325 action.................................................. 326 inflating the tyres................................ 329 rechecking.......................................... 328 stowing components.......................... 330 Engine drag control................................. 185 Engine oil......................................... 336, 446 adverse driving conditions.................. 446 filter..................................................... 336 grade and volume............................... 447 Engine specifications............................... 445 Equalizer.................................................. 378 Error messages Adaptive Cruise Control..................... Driver Alert Control............................. LKA..................................................... see Messages and symbols............... Emissions of carbon dioxide................... 454 Error messages in BLIS........................... 262 Engine deactivate........................................... overheating......................................... start..................................................... Start/Stop........................................... ETC, electronic temperature control........ 132 270 301 268 279 Economical driving.................................. 300 ECO pressure.................................. 322, 457 Engine block heater................................. 140 Ecolabelling, FSC, owner's manual........... 22 Engine compartment coolant................................................ 340 oil........................................................ 336 overview.............................................. 335 Emergency puncture repair kit location............................................... 325 overview.............................................. 326 sealing fluid......................................... 330 Engine and passenger compartment heater direct start/immediate stop................ 141 messages........................................... 142 timer.................................................... 141 EcoGuide................................................... 64 Engine braking, automatic....................... 288 212 237 243 212 13 External dimensions................................ 440 F Fan ECC.................................................... 134 ETC..................................................... 134 Fault tracing for the camera sensor......... 220 479 13 Alphabetical Index First aid.................................................... 324 First aid kit............................................... 324 Fluids, capacities..... 449, 450, 451, 452, 453 Fluids and oils.................. 449, 450, 451, 453 Fog lamp rear........................................................ 85 Fuses....................................................... changing............................................. engine compartment.......................... General............................................... under front right seat.......................... under glovebox................................... 355 355 356 355 362 359 FSC, ecolabelling....................................... 22 13 Fuel.................................................. 297, 298 fuel consumption................................ 454 fuel economy...................................... 322 fuel filter.............................................. 299 Fuel-driven heater direct start/immediate stop................ 141 timer.................................................... 141 Hazard warning flashers............................ 86 HDC......................................................... 288 Headlamp control...................................... 78 G Gearbox........................................... 271, 272 automatic.................................... 273, 276 manual................................................ 272 Gear selector inhibitor............................. 278 Gear selector inhibitor, mechanical disengagement................................................. 278 Gear shift indicator.................................. 272 Geartronic................................................ 274 Headlamp pattern, adjusting..................... 90 Headlamp pattern adjustment................... 90 Active Bending Lights .......................... 90 Halogen headlamp............................... 90 Headlamps............................................... 343 head restraint centre seat, rear.................................... 76 front seat............................................... 73 lowering................................................ 76 Heating rearview and door mirrors.................... 98 rear window.......................................... 98 seats................................................... 133 Fuelling............................................ 178, 299 filling................................................... 296 filling with reserve fuel can................. 299 fuel filler flap....................................... 296 fuel filler flap, locking.......................... 178 fuel filler flap, manual opening............ 296 Glass laminated/reinforced............................. 22 Glovebox................................................. 149 cooling................................................ 150 locking................................................ 176 Heat-reflecting windscreen........................ 18 Fuel tank volume................................................ 452 Gross vehicle weight............................... 441 Hill Descent Control................................. 288 GSI - Gear selector assistance................ 272 Hill Start Assist........................................ 279 Fuse box.................................................. 355 480 Handbrake............................................... 292 Headlamp levelling.................................... 80 Foot brake....................................... 289, 291 Front seat head restraint........................................ 73 H Glass roof, roller blind.............................. 100 High engine temperature......................... 301 High-pressure headlamp washing............. 94 Home safe light duration........................... 89 13 Alphabetical Index Horn........................................................... 78 I Interior rearview mirror............................... 99 automatic dimming............................... 99 L Intermittent wiping..................................... 93 Labels...................................................... 438 iPod®, connection................................... 396 Laminated glass......................................... 22 Lamps, see Lighting................................ 342 IAQS - Interior Air Quality System........... 128 Image settings......................................... 394 Immobiliser.............................................. 161 Lane keeping assistant operation............................................. 241 J Indicator symbols...................................... 65 Jack......................................................... 315 Inflatable curtain.................................. 34, 37 Jacket holder........................................... 148 Information button, PCC.......................... 164 Journey statistics..................................... 124 Information display.............................. 60, 61 Jump starting........................................... 270 Infotainment system source buttons.................................... 372 voice control....................................... 413 K Infotainment system (Audio and media).. 371 Kerb weight.............................................. 441 Inlaid mats............................................... 150 Key........................................... 159, 160, 172 Instrument lighting, see Lighting................ 80 Key blade......................................... 165, 166 Instrument overview left-hand drive car................................ 54 right-hand drive car.............................. 57 Keyless drive 168, 169, 170, 171, 172, 173, Instruments and controls..................... 54, 57 Interior Air Quality System (IAQS) Air cleaning......................................... 128 Interior lighting, see Lighting..................... 87 269 Keyless - locking..................................... 170 Keyless start (keyless drive) 168, 169, 170, 171, 172, 173, 269 Keyless - unlocking................................. 171 Keypad in the steering wheel............ 78, 372 Key positions............................................. 71 Lane keeping assistant - LKA.................. 239 Laser sensor............................................ 220 Leather upholstery, washing instructions 367 Light indications, PCC............................. 164 Lighting.................................................... 342 Active Xenon headlamps...................... 84 approach lighting.......................... 89, 162 automatic lighting, passenger compartment............................................... 88 bulbs, specifications........................... 348 controls................................................. 87 daytime running lights.......................... 81 display lighting...................................... 80 headlamp levelling................................ 80 home safe lighting................................ 89 instrument lighting................................ 80 in the passenger compartment............. 87 main/dipped beam............................... 82 position/parking lamps......................... 80 rear fog lamp........................................ 85 tunnel detection.................................... 82 13 481 13 Alphabetical Index Lighting, bulb replacement...................... 343 daytime running lights........................ 346 dipped beam (cars with halogen headlamps)................................................. 344 direction indicators, front.................... 345 main beam (cars with active xenon headlamps)......................................... 345 main beam (cars with halogen headlamps)................................................. 344 position/parking lamps....................... 345 rear bulb holder: direction indicators, brake lamps and reversing lamps...... 346 rear fog lamps..................................... 347 vanity mirror........................................ 348 LKA - Lane keeping assistant.................. 239 13 Loading cargo area................................... 152, 154 General....................................... 152, 153 long load............................................. 153 mounting points.................................. 153 roof load............................................. 153 Lock locking................................................ 173 manual locking.................................... 174 unlocking.................................... 173, 175 Lockable wheel bolts............................... 314 Lock confirmation ................................... 160 Lock indicator.......................................... 161 482 Locking/unlocking inside.................................................. 175 tailgate................................................ 176 M Main/dipped beam, see Lighting............... 82 Main beam, automatic activation.............. 83 maintenance Rustproofing....................................... 366 Making calls............................................. 403 Manual gearbox....................................... GSI - Gear selector assistance........... Towing and recovery.......................... trailer................................................... 272 272 308 302 Manual gear positions (Geartronic).......... 274 Max. roof load.......................................... 441 Media, Bluetooth®.................................... 398 Media player.................................... 379, 390 compatible file formats....................... 394 Memory function in seat............................ 74 Menu navigation audio and media.......... 374 Menus Combined instrument panel............... 101 menu overview, analogue................... 102 menu overview, digital........................ 102 Messages................................................ 104 Information display............................. 103 Messages and symbols Adaptive Cruise Control..................... 212 Collision Warning with Auto Brake.......................................... 222, 233 Driver Alert Control............................. 237 Engine block heater and passenger compartment heater........................... 142 LKA..................................................... 243 Messages in BLIS.................................... 262 Meters fuel gauge....................................... 60, 61 speedometer................................... 60, 61 tachometer..................................... 60, 61 Microphone.............................................. 404 misting attending to the windows................... 126 Misting condensation in headlamps............... 364 Mobile phone connect............................................... handsfree............................................ register phone..................................... voice control....................................... 400 403 400 413 Mood lighting............................................. 88 MY CAR 104, 105, 106, 108, 109, 111, 112, 113, 114 13 Alphabetical Index N News broadcasts..................................... 384 fault indicator...................................... 248 function............................................... 245 parking assistance sensors................ 248 Park assist camera.................................. 249 settings............................................... 252 O Parking brake........................................... 292 Oil, see also Engine oil..................... 446, 447 Passenger compartment filter................. 127 Oil level low.............................................. 336 Passenger compartment heater.............. 140 Output...................................................... 445 Passenger compartment lighting automatic.............................................. 88 outside temperature gauge....................... 68 Owner's manual, ecolabelling.................... 22 PCC – Personal Car Communicator functions............................................. 162 range........................................... 165, 169 P Pedestrian airbag....................................... 40 folding up.............................................. 42 moving the car...................................... 41 Overheating............................................. 301 PACOS....................................................... 31 Paintwork colour code......................................... 369 damage and touch-up........................ 368 Panel lighting............................................. 80 Panic function.......................................... 162 PAP - Active Park Assist.......................... 253 Parcel shelf.............................................. 157 Park Assist............................................... 245 backward............................................ 247 Pedestrian detection................................ 223 Petrol grade............................................. 298 Phone connect............................................... handsfree............................................ incoming call....................................... making calls........................................ phone book......................................... phone book, shortcut......................... receiving a call.................................... register phone..................................... voice control....................................... 400 403 403 403 406 406 404 400 413 Pocket park assist - PAP......................... 253 Polishing.................................................. 365 Position/parking lamps.............................. 80 Power guide............................................... 64 Power seat................................................. 74 Powershift gearbox.......................... 276, 308 Power windows......................................... 95 Q Queue Assist............................................ 206 Queue Assistant....................................... 206 13 R Radar sensor........................................... 200 Limitations.......................................... 209 Radio....................................................... 379 DAB............................................ 379, 388 Radio programme types (PTY)................ 384 Rain sensor................................................ 93 RDS.......................................................... 382 Rear bulbs location............................................... 346 483 13 Alphabetical Index Rear seat Heating............................................... 133 Resetting, trip meter........................ 117, 121 Resetting the door mirrors......................... 98 seatbelt reminder.................................. 27 seatbelt tensioner................................. 27 Rearview and door mirrors compass............................................. 100 door...................................................... 97 electrically retractable........................... 98 heating.................................................. 98 interior................................................... 99 Resetting the power windows................... 96 Seatbelt reminder...................................... 27 Retractable power door mirrors................. 98 Seatbelt tensioner................................ 27, 37 Reverse gear inhibitor.............................. 272 Rear window, defrosting............................ 98 Road sign information............................. 188 Limitations.......................................... 190 operation............................................. 188 Recommendations during driving............ 295 Roller blind for glass roof......................... 100 Recommended child seats table...................................................... 44 Roof load, max. weight............................ 441 Seats.......................................................... 73 head restraints, rear.............................. 76 heating................................................ 133 Heating............................................... 133 lowering the front backrest................... 73 lowering the rear backrest.................... 76 power.................................................... 74 Rustproofing............................................ 366 Securing loads (Loading)......................... 153 Sensus....................................................... 70 Recovery.................................................. 310 13 Refrigerant............................................... 341 Regeneration........................................... 299 Relay/fuse box, see Fuses....................... 355 Remote control........................................ 425 battery replacement............................ 427 Remote control immobiliser..................... 162 Remote control key......................... 159, 160 battery replacement............................ 167 detachable key blade................. 165, 166 functions............................................. 162 loss..................................................... 159 range........................................... 163, 169 Remote control key system, type approval............................................................ 460 484 Service position....................................... 349 S Service programme................................. 332 Safety lock children................................................. 42 Set time interval....................................... 214 Safety mode.............................................. 38 moving the car...................................... 40 start attempt......................................... 39 Signal input, external....................... 372, 395 Sealing fluid............................................. 330 Seat, see Seats.......................................... 73 Seatbelt...................................................... loosen................................................... pregnancy............................................. putting on............................................. rear seat................................................ 24 26 26 25 27 Side airbag SIPS.................................. 33, 37 SIPS airbag................................................ 33 Skidding................................................... 295 slippery driving conditions....................... 295 Soot filter................................................. 299 SOOT FILTER FULL................................. 299 spare wheel..................................... 317, 318 installation........................................... 320 taking out............................................ 318 13 Alphabetical Index Speed limiter............................................ 191 alarm for speed exceeded.................. 194 deactivation........................................ 194 getting started............................ 191, 192 temporary deactivation....................... 193 Speed ratings, tyres................................. 317 Spin control............................................. 185 Stability and traction control system 185, 187 operation............................................. 186 Stability system....................................... 185 Stains....................................................... 367 Start/Stop................................................ 279 Function and operation...................... 280 the engine does not stop.................... 281 Storage spaces in the passenger compartment.................................................. 146 surround.......................................... 371, 377 Switching off the engine.......................... 270 Symbols indicator symbols..................... 61, 63, 65 warning symbols............................. 61, 63 Symbols and messages Adaptive Cruise Control..................... 212 Collision Warning with Auto Brake.......................................... 222, 233 Driver Alert Control............................. 237 LKA..................................................... 243 System tripping.................................................. 37 Steering force, speed related.................. 262 Steering force level, see Steering force... 262 Steering lock............................................ 270 Steering wheel........................................... 77 keypad.......................................... 78, 372 steering wheel adjustment.................... 77 Stone chips and scratches...................... 368 Storage spaces driver's side........................................ glovebox............................................. Jacket holder...................................... tunnel console.................................... 148 149 148 148 Towbar, see Towing equipment.............. 303 Towbar - detachable attachment/removal.................... 304, 306 Towing..................................................... 308 towing eye.......................................... 309 Towing bracket........................................ 303 specifications...................................... 304 Towing capacity and towball load........... 442 Towing eye.............................................. 309 Traction control........................................ 185 Traffic information (TP) ........................... 383 Trailer....................................................... cable................................................... driving with a trailer............................ snaking............................................... 301 301 301 307 13 Trailer stability assist............................... 185 T Tailgate Locking/unlocking.............................. 176 Temperature actual temperature............................. 126 Trailer Stability Assist.............................. 307 Transmission............................................ 272 Transmission oil volume and grade............................... 450 Transponder.............................................. 18 Temperature control................................ 135 Tread depth............................................. 315 Total airing function......................... 126, 176 Tread wear indicators.............................. 314 Towbar detachable, attachment...................... 304 detachable, removal........................... 306 Trip computer.................. 114, 119, 123, 124 analogue instrument panel................. 115 Trip meter.................................................. 68 485 13 Alphabetical Index Trip meter, resetting........................ 117, 121 Troubleshooting Adaptive Cruise Control..................... 211 TSA - trailer stability assist ............. 185, 307 Tunnel console........................................ 12 V socket......................................... armrest................................................ cigarette lighter and ashtray............... 148 151 149 149 U Unlocking from the inside.................................... 175 from the outside................................. 173 Unlocking with the key blade................... 171 USB, connection...................................... 396 Warning sound collision warning system.................... 228 USB input................................................ 395 Warning symbols........................... 61, 63, 66 Warning triangle....................................... 323 Tunnel detection........................................ 82 TV............................................................. 421 13 Type approval Bluetooth®.......................................... 462 radar system....................................... 460 remote control key system................. 460 Type designations................................... 438 Tyre dimension........................................ 316 Tyre load index........................................ 316 V Vanity mirror...................................... 88, 150 486 Washer fluid volume................................................ 451 Washer fluid, filling................................... 351 Voice control, mobile phone.................... 413 Washers rear window.......................................... 94 washer fluid, filling.............................. 351 windscreen........................................... 94 Volvo Sensus............................................. 70 Water and dirt-repellent coating.............. 366 Ventilation................................................ 129 Vibration damper..................................... 303 Water-repellent surface, cleaning............ 366 Tyre pressure label.................................. 322 Tyres direction of rotation............................ 312 maintenance....................................... 312 pressure...................................... 322, 457 puncture repair................................... 324 specifications...................................... 457 tread depth......................................... 315 tread wear indicators.......................... 314 winter tyres......................................... 315 Fault in brake system........................... 66 Low oil pressure................................... 66 Parking brake applied........................... 66 seatbelt reminder............................ 27, 66 Warning................................................ 66 W Warning lamp Adaptive Cruise Control..................... 200 collision warning system.................... 228 stability and traction control system.. 185 Warning lamps Airbags – SRS....................................... 66 alternator not charging......................... 66 Waxing..................................................... 365 Weights kerb weight......................................... 441 Wheel bolts.............................................. 314 lockable.............................................. 314 Wheel rim, dimensions............................ 316 Wheel rims cleaning.............................................. 365 13 Alphabetical Index Wheels removal............................................... 319 snow chains........................................ 315 spare wheel........................................ 317 Wheels and tyres..................................... 317 Whiplash injury, WHIPS............................. 35 WHIPS child seat/booster cushion................... 36 seating position.................................... 36 whiplash protection........................ 35, 37 Windows, rearview and door mirrors. 22, 366 Windscreen heating................................................ 136 Windscreen, heating.................................. 98 Windscreen washing.................................. 94 13 Windscreen wiper...................................... 93 rain sensor............................................ 93 Winter driving........................................... 295 Winter tyres.............................................. 315 Wiper blades............................................ changing............................................. Cleaning.............................................. replacing, rear window....................... Service position.................................. 349 349 350 350 349 Wipers and washing.................................. 93 487 13 Alphabetical Index 13 488 Volvo Car Corporation 16803 (English), AT 1348, Printed in Sweden, Göteborg 2013, Copyright © 2000-2013 Volvo Car Corporation
* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
advertisement